Merge changes from emacs-23 branch.
[bpt/emacs.git] / doc / misc / org.texi
1
2 \input texinfo
3 @c %**start of header
4 @setfilename ../../info/org
5 @settitle The Org Manual
6
7 @set VERSION 7.01
8 @set DATE July 2010
9
10 @c Use proper quote and backtick for code sections in PDF output
11 @c Cf. Texinfo manual 14.2
12 @set txicodequoteundirected
13 @set txicodequotebacktick
14
15 @c Version and Contact Info
16 @set MAINTAINERSITE @uref{http://orgmode.org,maintainers webpage}
17 @set AUTHOR Carsten Dominik
18 @set MAINTAINER Carsten Dominik
19 @set MAINTAINEREMAIL @email{carsten at orgmode dot org}
20 @set MAINTAINERCONTACT @uref{mailto:carsten at orgmode dot org,contact the maintainer}
21 @c %**end of header
22 @finalout
23
24 @c Macro definitions
25 @iftex
26 @c @hyphenation{time-stamp time-stamps time-stamp-ing time-stamp-ed}
27 @end iftex
28 @macro Ie {}
29 I.e.,
30 @end macro
31 @macro ie {}
32 i.e.,
33 @end macro
34 @macro Eg {}
35 E.g.,
36 @end macro
37 @macro eg {}
38 e.g.,
39 @end macro
40
41 @c Subheadings inside a table.
42 @macro tsubheading{text}
43 @ifinfo
44 @subsubheading \text\
45 @end ifinfo
46 @ifnotinfo
47 @item @b{\text\}
48 @end ifnotinfo
49 @end macro
50
51 @copying
52 This manual is for Org version @value{VERSION}.
53
54 Copyright @copyright{} 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010
55 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
56
57 @quotation
58 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
59 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
60 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
61 Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
62 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the license
63 is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License.''
64
65 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have the freedom to copy and
66 modify this GNU manual. Buying copies from the FSF supports it in
67 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
68
69 This document is part of a collection distributed under the GNU Free
70 Documentation License. If you want to distribute this document
71 separately from the collection, you can do so by adding a copy of the
72 license to the document, as described in section 6 of the license.
73 @end quotation
74 @end copying
75
76 @dircategory Emacs
77 @direntry
78 * Org Mode: (org). Outline-based notes management and organizer
79 @end direntry
80
81 @titlepage
82 @title The Org Manual
83
84 @subtitle Release @value{VERSION}
85 @author by Carsten Dominik
86 with contributions by David O'Toole, Bastien Guerry, Philip Rooke, Dan Davison, Eric Schulte, and Thomas Dye
87
88 @c The following two commands start the copyright page.
89 @page
90 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
91 @insertcopying
92 @end titlepage
93
94 @c Output the table of contents at the beginning.
95 @contents
96
97 @ifnottex
98 @node Top, Introduction, (dir), (dir)
99 @top Org Mode Manual
100
101 @insertcopying
102 @end ifnottex
103
104 @menu
105 * Introduction:: Getting started
106 * Document Structure:: A tree works like your brain
107 * Tables:: Pure magic for quick formatting
108 * Hyperlinks:: Notes in context
109 * TODO Items:: Every tree branch can be a TODO item
110 * Tags:: Tagging headlines and matching sets of tags
111 * Properties and Columns:: Storing information about an entry
112 * Dates and Times:: Making items useful for planning
113 * Capture - Refile - Archive:: The ins and outs for projects
114 * Agenda Views:: Collecting information into views
115 * Markup:: Prepare text for rich export
116 * Exporting:: Sharing and publishing of notes
117 * Publishing:: Create a web site of linked Org files
118 * Working With Source Code:: Export, evaluate, and tangle code blocks
119 * Miscellaneous:: All the rest which did not fit elsewhere
120 * Hacking:: How to hack your way around
121 * MobileOrg:: Viewing and capture on a mobile device
122 * History and Acknowledgments:: How Org came into being
123 * Main Index:: An index of Org's concepts and features
124 * Key Index:: Key bindings and where they are described
125 * Variable Index:: Variables mentioned in the manual
126
127 @detailmenu
128 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
129
130 Introduction
131
132 * Summary:: Brief summary of what Org does
133 * Installation:: How to install a downloaded version of Org
134 * Activation:: How to activate Org for certain buffers
135 * Feedback:: Bug reports, ideas, patches etc.
136 * Conventions:: Type-setting conventions in the manual
137
138 Document structure
139
140 * Outlines:: Org is based on Outline mode
141 * Headlines:: How to typeset Org tree headlines
142 * Visibility cycling:: Show and hide, much simplified
143 * Motion:: Jumping to other headlines
144 * Structure editing:: Changing sequence and level of headlines
145 * Sparse trees:: Matches embedded in context
146 * Plain lists:: Additional structure within an entry
147 * Drawers:: Tucking stuff away
148 * Blocks:: Folding blocks
149 * Footnotes:: How footnotes are defined in Org's syntax
150 * Orgstruct mode:: Structure editing outside Org
151
152 Tables
153
154 * Built-in table editor:: Simple tables
155 * Column width and alignment:: Overrule the automatic settings
156 * Column groups:: Grouping to trigger vertical lines
157 * Orgtbl mode:: The table editor as minor mode
158 * The spreadsheet:: The table editor has spreadsheet capabilities
159 * Org-Plot:: Plotting from org tables
160
161 The spreadsheet
162
163 * References:: How to refer to another field or range
164 * Formula syntax for Calc:: Using Calc to compute stuff
165 * Formula syntax for Lisp:: Writing formulas in Emacs Lisp
166 * Field formulas:: Formulas valid for a single field
167 * Column formulas:: Formulas valid for an entire column
168 * Editing and debugging formulas:: Fixing formulas
169 * Updating the table:: Recomputing all dependent fields
170 * Advanced features:: Field names, parameters and automatic recalc
171
172 Hyperlinks
173
174 * Link format:: How links in Org are formatted
175 * Internal links:: Links to other places in the current file
176 * External links:: URL-like links to the world
177 * Handling links:: Creating, inserting and following
178 * Using links outside Org:: Linking from my C source code?
179 * Link abbreviations:: Shortcuts for writing complex links
180 * Search options:: Linking to a specific location
181 * Custom searches:: When the default search is not enough
182
183 Internal links
184
185 * Radio targets:: Make targets trigger links in plain text
186
187 TODO items
188
189 * TODO basics:: Marking and displaying TODO entries
190 * TODO extensions:: Workflow and assignments
191 * Progress logging:: Dates and notes for progress
192 * Priorities:: Some things are more important than others
193 * Breaking down tasks:: Splitting a task into manageable pieces
194 * Checkboxes:: Tick-off lists
195
196 Extended use of TODO keywords
197
198 * Workflow states:: From TODO to DONE in steps
199 * TODO types:: I do this, Fred does the rest
200 * Multiple sets in one file:: Mixing it all, and still finding your way
201 * Fast access to TODO states:: Single letter selection of a state
202 * Per-file keywords:: Different files, different requirements
203 * Faces for TODO keywords:: Highlighting states
204 * TODO dependencies:: When one task needs to wait for others
205
206 Progress logging
207
208 * Closing items:: When was this entry marked DONE?
209 * Tracking TODO state changes:: When did the status change?
210 * Tracking your habits:: How consistent have you been?
211
212 Tags
213
214 * Tag inheritance:: Tags use the tree structure of the outline
215 * Setting tags:: How to assign tags to a headline
216 * Tag searches:: Searching for combinations of tags
217
218 Properties and columns
219
220 * Property syntax:: How properties are spelled out
221 * Special properties:: Access to other Org-mode features
222 * Property searches:: Matching property values
223 * Property inheritance:: Passing values down the tree
224 * Column view:: Tabular viewing and editing
225 * Property API:: Properties for Lisp programmers
226
227 Column view
228
229 * Defining columns:: The COLUMNS format property
230 * Using column view:: How to create and use column view
231 * Capturing column view:: A dynamic block for column view
232
233 Defining columns
234
235 * Scope of column definitions:: Where defined, where valid?
236 * Column attributes:: Appearance and content of a column
237
238 Dates and times
239
240 * Timestamps:: Assigning a time to a tree entry
241 * Creating timestamps:: Commands which insert timestamps
242 * Deadlines and scheduling:: Planning your work
243 * Clocking work time:: Tracking how long you spend on a task
244 * Resolving idle time:: Resolving time if you've been idle
245 * Effort estimates:: Planning work effort in advance
246 * Relative timer:: Notes with a running timer
247
248 Creating timestamps
249
250 * The date/time prompt:: How Org-mode helps you entering date and time
251 * Custom time format:: Making dates look different
252
253 Deadlines and scheduling
254
255 * Inserting deadline/schedule:: Planning items
256 * Repeated tasks:: Items that show up again and again
257
258 Capture - Refile - Archive
259
260 * Capture:: Capturing new stuff
261 * Attachments:: Add files to tasks
262 * RSS Feeds:: Getting input from RSS feeds
263 * Protocols:: External (e.g. Browser) access to Emacs and Org
264 * Refiling notes:: Moving a tree from one place to another
265 * Archiving:: What to do with finished projects
266
267 Capture
268
269 * Setting up capture:: Where notes will be stored
270 * Using capture:: Commands to invoke and terminate capture
271 * Capture templates:: Define the outline of different note types
272
273 Capture templates
274
275 * Template elements:: What is needed for a complete template entry
276 * Template expansion:: Filling in information about time and context
277
278 Archiving
279
280 * Moving subtrees:: Moving a tree to an archive file
281 * Internal archiving:: Switch off a tree but keep it in the file
282
283 Agenda views
284
285 * Agenda files:: Files being searched for agenda information
286 * Agenda dispatcher:: Keyboard access to agenda views
287 * Built-in agenda views:: What is available out of the box?
288 * Presentation and sorting:: How agenda items are prepared for display
289 * Agenda commands:: Remote editing of Org trees
290 * Custom agenda views:: Defining special searches and views
291 * Exporting Agenda Views:: Writing a view to a file
292 * Agenda column view:: Using column view for collected entries
293
294 The built-in agenda views
295
296 * Weekly/daily agenda:: The calendar page with current tasks
297 * Global TODO list:: All unfinished action items
298 * Matching tags and properties:: Structured information with fine-tuned search
299 * Timeline:: Time-sorted view for single file
300 * Search view:: Find entries by searching for text
301 * Stuck projects:: Find projects you need to review
302
303 Presentation and sorting
304
305 * Categories:: Not all tasks are equal
306 * Time-of-day specifications:: How the agenda knows the time
307 * Sorting of agenda items:: The order of things
308
309 Custom agenda views
310
311 * Storing searches:: Type once, use often
312 * Block agenda:: All the stuff you need in a single buffer
313 * Setting Options:: Changing the rules
314
315 Markup for rich export
316
317 * Structural markup elements:: The basic structure as seen by the exporter
318 * Images and tables:: Tables and Images will be included
319 * Literal examples:: Source code examples with special formatting
320 * Include files:: Include additional files into a document
321 * Index entries:: Making an index
322 * Macro replacement:: Use macros to create complex output
323 * Embedded LaTeX:: LaTeX can be freely used inside Org documents
324
325 Structural markup elements
326
327 * Document title:: Where the title is taken from
328 * Headings and sections:: The document structure as seen by the exporter
329 * Table of contents:: The if and where of the table of contents
330 * Initial text:: Text before the first heading?
331 * Lists:: Lists
332 * Paragraphs:: Paragraphs
333 * Footnote markup:: Footnotes
334 * Emphasis and monospace:: Bold, italic, etc.
335 * Horizontal rules:: Make a line
336 * Comment lines:: What will *not* be exported
337
338 Embedded La@TeX{}
339
340 * Special symbols:: Greek letters and other symbols
341 * Subscripts and superscripts:: Simple syntax for raising/lowering text
342 * LaTeX fragments:: Complex formulas made easy
343 * Previewing LaTeX fragments:: What will this snippet look like?
344 * CDLaTeX mode:: Speed up entering of formulas
345
346 Exporting
347
348 * Selective export:: Using tags to select and exclude trees
349 * Export options:: Per-file export settings
350 * The export dispatcher:: How to access exporter commands
351 * ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export:: Exporting to flat files with encoding
352 * HTML export:: Exporting to HTML
353 * LaTeX and PDF export:: Exporting to La@TeX{}, and processing to PDF
354 * DocBook export:: Exporting to DocBook
355 * TaskJuggler export:: Exporting to TaskJuggler
356 * Freemind export:: Exporting to Freemind mind maps
357 * XOXO export:: Exporting to XOXO
358 * iCalendar export:: Exporting in iCalendar format
359
360 HTML export
361
362 * HTML Export commands:: How to invoke HTML export
363 * Quoting HTML tags:: Using direct HTML in Org-mode
364 * Links in HTML export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
365 * Tables in HTML export:: How to modify the formatting of tables
366 * Images in HTML export:: How to insert figures into HTML output
367 * Text areas in HTML export:: An alternative way to show an example
368 * CSS support:: Changing the appearance of the output
369 * JavaScript support:: Info and Folding in a web browser
370
371 La@TeX{} and PDF export
372
373 * LaTeX/PDF export commands:: Which key invokes which commands
374 * Header and sectioning:: Setting up the export file structure
375 * Quoting LaTeX code:: Incorporating literal La@TeX{} code
376 * Tables in LaTeX export:: Options for exporting tables to La@TeX{}
377 * Images in LaTeX export:: How to insert figures into La@TeX{} output
378 * Beamer class export:: Turning the file into a presentation
379
380 DocBook export
381
382 * DocBook export commands:: How to invoke DocBook export
383 * Quoting DocBook code:: Incorporating DocBook code in Org files
384 * Recursive sections:: Recursive sections in DocBook
385 * Tables in DocBook export:: Tables are exported as HTML tables
386 * Images in DocBook export:: How to insert figures into DocBook output
387 * Special characters:: How to handle special characters
388
389 Publishing
390
391 * Configuration:: Defining projects
392 * Uploading files:: How to get files up on the server
393 * Sample configuration:: Example projects
394 * Triggering publication:: Publication commands
395
396 Configuration
397
398 * Project alist:: The central configuration variable
399 * Sources and destinations:: From here to there
400 * Selecting files:: What files are part of the project?
401 * Publishing action:: Setting the function doing the publishing
402 * Publishing options:: Tweaking HTML export
403 * Publishing links:: Which links keep working after publishing?
404 * Sitemap:: Generating a list of all pages
405 * Generating an index:: An index that reaches across pages
406
407 Sample configuration
408
409 * Simple example:: One-component publishing
410 * Complex example:: A multi-component publishing example
411
412 Working with source code
413
414 * Structure of code blocks:: Code block syntax described
415 * Editing source code:: Language major-mode editing
416 * Exporting code blocks:: Export contents and/or results
417 * Extracting source code:: Create pure source code files
418 * Evaluating code blocks:: Place results of evaluation in the Org-mode buffer
419 * Library of Babel:: Use and contribute to a library of useful code blocks
420 * Languages:: List of supported code block languages
421 * Header arguments:: Configure code block functionality
422 * Results of evaluation:: How evaluation results are handled
423 * Noweb reference syntax:: Literate programming in Org-mode
424 * Key bindings and useful functions:: Work quickly with code blocks
425 * Batch execution:: Call functions from the command line
426
427 Header arguments
428
429 * Using header arguments:: Different ways to set header arguments
430 * Specific header arguments:: List of header arguments
431
432 Using header arguments
433
434 * System-wide header arguments:: Set global default values
435 * Language-specific header arguments:: Set default values by language
436 * Buffer-wide header arguments:: Set default values for a specific buffer
437 * Header arguments in Org-mode properties:: Set default values for a buffer or heading
438 * Code block specific header arguments:: The most common way to set values
439
440 Specific header arguments
441
442 * var:: Pass arguments to code blocks
443 * results:: Specify the type of results and how they will be collected and handled
444 * file:: Specify a path for file output
445 * dir:: Specify the default directory for code block execution
446 * exports:: Export code and/or results
447 * tangle:: Toggle tangling and specify file name
448 * no-expand:: Turn off variable assignment and noweb expansion during tangling
449 * session:: Preserve the state of code evaluation
450 * noweb:: Toggle expansion of noweb references
451 * cache:: Avoid re-evaluating unchanged code blocks
452 * hlines:: Handle horizontal lines in tables
453 * colnames:: Handle column names in tables
454 * rownames:: Handle row names in tables
455 * shebang:: Make tangled files executable
456
457 Miscellaneous
458
459 * Completion:: M-TAB knows what you need
460 * Speed keys:: Electric commands at the beginning of a headline
461 * Code evaluation security:: Org mode files evaluate inline code
462 * Customization:: Adapting Org to your taste
463 * In-buffer settings:: Overview of the #+KEYWORDS
464 * The very busy C-c C-c key:: When in doubt, press C-c C-c
465 * Clean view:: Getting rid of leading stars in the outline
466 * TTY keys:: Using Org on a tty
467 * Interaction:: Other Emacs packages
468
469 Interaction with other packages
470
471 * Cooperation:: Packages Org cooperates with
472 * Conflicts:: Packages that lead to conflicts
473
474 Hacking
475
476 * Hooks:: Who to reach into Org's internals
477 * Add-on packages:: Available extensions
478 * Adding hyperlink types:: New custom link types
479 * Context-sensitive commands:: How to add functionality to such commands
480 * Tables in arbitrary syntax:: Orgtbl for La@TeX{} and other programs
481 * Dynamic blocks:: Automatically filled blocks
482 * Special agenda views:: Customized views
483 * Extracting agenda information:: Postprocessing of agenda information
484 * Using the property API:: Writing programs that use entry properties
485 * Using the mapping API:: Mapping over all or selected entries
486
487 Tables and lists in arbitrary syntax
488
489 * Radio tables:: Sending and receiving radio tables
490 * A LaTeX example:: Step by step, almost a tutorial
491 * Translator functions:: Copy and modify
492 * Radio lists:: Doing the same for lists
493
494 MobileOrg
495
496 * Setting up the staging area:: Where to interact with the mobile device
497 * Pushing to MobileOrg:: Uploading Org files and agendas
498 * Pulling from MobileOrg:: Integrating captured and flagged items
499
500 @end detailmenu
501 @end menu
502
503 @node Introduction, Document Structure, Top, Top
504 @chapter Introduction
505 @cindex introduction
506
507 @menu
508 * Summary:: Brief summary of what Org does
509 * Installation:: How to install a downloaded version of Org
510 * Activation:: How to activate Org for certain buffers
511 * Feedback:: Bug reports, ideas, patches etc.
512 * Conventions:: Type-setting conventions in the manual
513 @end menu
514
515 @node Summary, Installation, Introduction, Introduction
516 @section Summary
517 @cindex summary
518
519 Org is a mode for keeping notes, maintaining TODO lists, and doing
520 project planning with a fast and effective plain-text system.
521
522 Org develops organizational tasks around NOTES files that contain
523 lists or information about projects as plain text. Org is
524 implemented on top of Outline mode, which makes it possible to keep the
525 content of large files well structured. Visibility cycling and
526 structure editing help to work with the tree. Tables are easily created
527 with a built-in table editor. Org supports TODO items, deadlines,
528 timestamps, and scheduling. It dynamically compiles entries into an
529 agenda that utilizes and smoothly integrates much of the Emacs calendar
530 and diary. Plain text URL-like links connect to websites, emails,
531 Usenet messages, BBDB entries, and any files related to the projects.
532 For printing and sharing of notes, an Org file can be exported as a
533 structured ASCII file, as HTML, or (TODO and agenda items only) as an
534 iCalendar file. It can also serve as a publishing tool for a set of
535 linked web pages.
536
537 As a project planning environment, Org works by adding metadata to outline
538 nodes. Based on this data, specific entries can be extracted in queries and
539 create dynamic @i{agenda views}.
540
541 Org mode contains the Org Babel environment which allows to work with
542 embedded source code block in a file, to facilitate code evaluation,
543 documentation, and tangling.
544
545 Org's automatic, context-sensitive table editor with spreadsheet
546 capabilities can be integrated into any major mode by activating the
547 minor Orgtbl mode. Using a translation step, it can be used to maintain
548 tables in arbitrary file types, for example in La@TeX{}. The structure
549 editing and list creation capabilities can be used outside Org with
550 the minor Orgstruct mode.
551
552 Org keeps simple things simple. When first fired up, it should
553 feel like a straightforward, easy to use outliner. Complexity is not
554 imposed, but a large amount of functionality is available when you need
555 it. Org is a toolbox and can be used in different ways and for different
556 ends, for example:
557
558 @example
559 @r{@bullet{} an outline extension with visibility cycling and structure editing}
560 @r{@bullet{} an ASCII system and table editor for taking structured notes}
561 @r{@bullet{} a TODO list editor}
562 @r{@bullet{} a full agenda and planner with deadlines and work scheduling}
563 @pindex GTD, Getting Things Done
564 @r{@bullet{} an environment in which to implement David Allen's GTD system}
565 @r{@bullet{} a simple hypertext system, with HTML and La@TeX{} export}
566 @r{@bullet{} a publishing tool to create a set of interlinked webpages}
567 @r{@bullet{} an environment for literate programming}
568 @end example
569
570
571 @cindex FAQ
572 There is a website for Org which provides links to the newest
573 version of Org, as well as additional information, frequently asked
574 questions (FAQ), links to tutorials, etc@. This page is located at
575 @uref{http://orgmode.org}.
576
577 @page
578
579
580 @node Installation, Activation, Summary, Introduction
581 @section Installation
582 @cindex installation
583 @cindex XEmacs
584
585 @b{Important:} @i{If you are using a version of Org that is part of the Emacs
586 distribution or an XEmacs package, please skip this section and go directly
587 to @ref{Activation}.}
588
589 If you have downloaded Org from the Web, either as a distribution @file{.zip}
590 or @file{.tar} file, or as a Git archive, you must take the following steps
591 to install it: go into the unpacked Org distribution directory and edit the
592 top section of the file @file{Makefile}. You must set the name of the Emacs
593 binary (likely either @file{emacs} or @file{xemacs}), and the paths to the
594 directories where local Lisp and Info files are kept. If you don't have
595 access to the system-wide directories, you can simply run Org directly from
596 the distribution directory by adding the @file{lisp} subdirectory to the
597 Emacs load path. To do this, add the following line to @file{.emacs}:
598
599 @example
600 (setq load-path (cons "~/path/to/orgdir/lisp" load-path))
601 @end example
602
603 @noindent
604 If you plan to use code from the @file{contrib} subdirectory, do a similar
605 step for this directory:
606
607 @example
608 (setq load-path (cons "~/path/to/orgdir/contrib/lisp" load-path))
609 @end example
610
611 @sp 2
612 @cartouche
613 XEmacs users now need to install the file @file{noutline.el} from
614 the @file{xemacs} sub-directory of the Org distribution. Use the
615 command:
616
617 @example
618 make install-noutline
619 @end example
620 @end cartouche
621 @sp 2
622
623 @noindent Now byte-compile the Lisp files with the shell command:
624
625 @example
626 make
627 @end example
628
629 @noindent If you are running Org from the distribution directory, this is
630 all. If you want to install Org into the system directories, use (as
631 administrator)
632
633 @example
634 make install
635 @end example
636
637 Installing Info files is system dependent, because of differences in the
638 @file{install-info} program. In Debian it copies the info files into the
639 correct directory and modifies the info directory file. In many other
640 systems, the files need to be copied to the correct directory separately, and
641 @file{install-info} then only modifies the directory file. Check your system
642 documentation to find out which of the following commands you need:
643
644 @example
645 make install-info
646 make install-info-debian
647 @end example
648
649 Then add the following line to @file{.emacs}. It is needed so that
650 Emacs can autoload functions that are located in files not immediately loaded
651 when Org-mode starts.
652 @lisp
653 (require 'org-install)
654 @end lisp
655
656 Do not forget to activate Org as described in the following section.
657 @page
658
659 @node Activation, Feedback, Installation, Introduction
660 @section Activation
661 @cindex activation
662 @cindex autoload
663 @cindex global key bindings
664 @cindex key bindings, global
665
666 Add the following lines to your @file{.emacs} file. The last three lines
667 define @emph{global} keys for the commands @command{org-store-link},
668 @command{org-agenda}, and @command{org-iswitchb}---please choose suitable
669 keys yourself.
670
671 @lisp
672 ;; The following lines are always needed. Choose your own keys.
673 (add-to-list 'auto-mode-alist '("\\.org\\'" . org-mode))
674 (global-set-key "\C-cl" 'org-store-link)
675 (global-set-key "\C-ca" 'org-agenda)
676 (global-set-key "\C-cb" 'org-iswitchb)
677 @end lisp
678
679 Furthermore, you must activate @code{font-lock-mode} in Org
680 buffers, because significant functionality depends on font-locking being
681 active. You can do this with either one of the following two lines
682 (XEmacs users must use the second option):
683 @lisp
684 (global-font-lock-mode 1) ; for all buffers
685 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-on-font-lock) ; Org buffers only
686 @end lisp
687
688 @cindex Org-mode, turning on
689 With this setup, all files with extension @samp{.org} will be put
690 into Org-mode. As an alternative, make the first line of a file look
691 like this:
692
693 @example
694 MY PROJECTS -*- mode: org; -*-
695 @end example
696
697 @vindex org-insert-mode-line-in-empty-file
698 @noindent which will select Org-mode for this buffer no matter what
699 the file's name is. See also the variable
700 @code{org-insert-mode-line-in-empty-file}.
701
702 Many commands in Org work on the region if the region is @i{active}. To make
703 use of this, you need to have @code{transient-mark-mode}
704 (@code{zmacs-regions} in XEmacs) turned on. In Emacs 23 this is the default,
705 in Emacs 22 you need to do this yourself with
706 @lisp
707 (transient-mark-mode 1)
708 @end lisp
709 @noindent If you do not like @code{transient-mark-mode}, you can create an
710 active region by using the mouse to select a region, or pressing
711 @kbd{C-@key{SPC}} twice before moving the cursor.
712
713 @node Feedback, Conventions, Activation, Introduction
714 @section Feedback
715 @cindex feedback
716 @cindex bug reports
717 @cindex maintainer
718 @cindex author
719
720 If you find problems with Org, or if you have questions, remarks, or ideas
721 about it, please mail to the Org mailing list @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org}.
722 If you are not a member of the mailing list, your mail will be passed to the
723 list after a moderator has approved it.
724
725 For bug reports, please provide as much information as possible, including
726 the version information of Emacs (@kbd{M-x emacs-version @key{RET}}) and Org
727 (@kbd{M-x org-version @key{RET}}), as well as the Org related setup in
728 @file{.emacs}. The easiest way to do this is to use the command
729 @example
730 @kbd{M-x org-submit-bug-report}
731 @end example
732 @noindent which will put all this information into an Emacs mail buffer so
733 that you only need to add your description. If you re not sending the Email
734 from within Emacs, please copy and paste the content into your Email program.
735
736 If an error occurs, a backtrace can be very useful (see below on how to
737 create one). Often a small example file helps, along with clear information
738 about:
739
740 @enumerate
741 @item What exactly did you do?
742 @item What did you expect to happen?
743 @item What happened instead?
744 @end enumerate
745 @noindent Thank you for helping to improve this mode.
746
747 @subsubheading How to create a useful backtrace
748
749 @cindex backtrace of an error
750 If working with Org produces an error with a message you don't
751 understand, you may have hit a bug. The best way to report this is by
752 providing, in addition to what was mentioned above, a @emph{backtrace}.
753 This is information from the built-in debugger about where and how the
754 error occurred. Here is how to produce a useful backtrace:
755
756 @enumerate
757 @item
758 Reload uncompiled versions of all Org-mode Lisp files. The backtrace
759 contains much more information if it is produced with uncompiled code.
760 To do this, use
761 @example
762 C-u M-x org-reload RET
763 @end example
764 @noindent
765 or select @code{Org -> Refresh/Reload -> Reload Org uncompiled} from the
766 menu.
767 @item
768 Go to the @code{Options} menu and select @code{Enter Debugger on Error}
769 (XEmacs has this option in the @code{Troubleshooting} sub-menu).
770 @item
771 Do whatever you have to do to hit the error. Don't forget to
772 document the steps you take.
773 @item
774 When you hit the error, a @file{*Backtrace*} buffer will appear on the
775 screen. Save this buffer to a file (for example using @kbd{C-x C-w}) and
776 attach it to your bug report.
777 @end enumerate
778
779 @node Conventions, , Feedback, Introduction
780 @section Typesetting conventions used in this manual
781
782 Org uses three types of keywords: TODO keywords, tags, and property
783 names. In this manual we use the following conventions:
784
785 @table @code
786 @item TODO
787 @itemx WAITING
788 TODO keywords are written with all capitals, even if they are
789 user-defined.
790 @item boss
791 @itemx ARCHIVE
792 User-defined tags are written in lowercase; built-in tags with special
793 meaning are written with all capitals.
794 @item Release
795 @itemx PRIORITY
796 User-defined properties are capitalized; built-in properties with
797 special meaning are written with all capitals.
798 @end table
799
800 @node Document Structure, Tables, Introduction, Top
801 @chapter Document structure
802 @cindex document structure
803 @cindex structure of document
804
805 Org is based on Outline mode and provides flexible commands to
806 edit the structure of the document.
807
808 @menu
809 * Outlines:: Org is based on Outline mode
810 * Headlines:: How to typeset Org tree headlines
811 * Visibility cycling:: Show and hide, much simplified
812 * Motion:: Jumping to other headlines
813 * Structure editing:: Changing sequence and level of headlines
814 * Sparse trees:: Matches embedded in context
815 * Plain lists:: Additional structure within an entry
816 * Drawers:: Tucking stuff away
817 * Blocks:: Folding blocks
818 * Footnotes:: How footnotes are defined in Org's syntax
819 * Orgstruct mode:: Structure editing outside Org
820 @end menu
821
822 @node Outlines, Headlines, Document Structure, Document Structure
823 @section Outlines
824 @cindex outlines
825 @cindex Outline mode
826
827 Org is implemented on top of Outline mode. Outlines allow a
828 document to be organized in a hierarchical structure, which (at least
829 for me) is the best representation of notes and thoughts. An overview
830 of this structure is achieved by folding (hiding) large parts of the
831 document to show only the general document structure and the parts
832 currently being worked on. Org greatly simplifies the use of
833 outlines by compressing the entire show/hide functionality into a single
834 command, @command{org-cycle}, which is bound to the @key{TAB} key.
835
836 @node Headlines, Visibility cycling, Outlines, Document Structure
837 @section Headlines
838 @cindex headlines
839 @cindex outline tree
840 @vindex org-special-ctrl-a/e
841 @vindex org-special-ctrl-k
842 @vindex org-ctrl-k-protect-subtree
843
844 Headlines define the structure of an outline tree. The headlines in Org
845 start with one or more stars, on the left margin@footnote{See the variables
846 @code{org-special-ctrl-a/e}, @code{org-special-ctrl-k}, and
847 @code{org-ctrl-k-protect-subtree} to configure special behavior of @kbd{C-a},
848 @kbd{C-e}, and @kbd{C-k} in headlines.}. For example:
849
850 @example
851 * Top level headline
852 ** Second level
853 *** 3rd level
854 some text
855 *** 3rd level
856 more text
857
858 * Another top level headline
859 @end example
860
861 @noindent Some people find the many stars too noisy and would prefer an
862 outline that has whitespace followed by a single star as headline
863 starters. @ref{Clean view}, describes a setup to realize this.
864
865 @vindex org-cycle-separator-lines
866 An empty line after the end of a subtree is considered part of it and
867 will be hidden when the subtree is folded. However, if you leave at
868 least two empty lines, one empty line will remain visible after folding
869 the subtree, in order to structure the collapsed view. See the
870 variable @code{org-cycle-separator-lines} to modify this behavior.
871
872 @node Visibility cycling, Motion, Headlines, Document Structure
873 @section Visibility cycling
874 @cindex cycling, visibility
875 @cindex visibility cycling
876 @cindex trees, visibility
877 @cindex show hidden text
878 @cindex hide text
879
880 Outlines make it possible to hide parts of the text in the buffer.
881 Org uses just two commands, bound to @key{TAB} and
882 @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} to change the visibility in the buffer.
883
884 @cindex subtree visibility states
885 @cindex subtree cycling
886 @cindex folded, subtree visibility state
887 @cindex children, subtree visibility state
888 @cindex subtree, subtree visibility state
889 @table @kbd
890 @kindex @key{TAB}
891 @item @key{TAB}
892 @emph{Subtree cycling}: Rotate current subtree among the states
893
894 @example
895 ,-> FOLDED -> CHILDREN -> SUBTREE --.
896 '-----------------------------------'
897 @end example
898
899 @vindex org-cycle-emulate-tab
900 @vindex org-cycle-global-at-bob
901 The cursor must be on a headline for this to work@footnote{see, however,
902 the option @code{org-cycle-emulate-tab}.}. When the cursor is at the
903 beginning of the buffer and the first line is not a headline, then
904 @key{TAB} actually runs global cycling (see below)@footnote{see the
905 option @code{org-cycle-global-at-bob}.}. Also when called with a prefix
906 argument (@kbd{C-u @key{TAB}}), global cycling is invoked.
907
908 @cindex global visibility states
909 @cindex global cycling
910 @cindex overview, global visibility state
911 @cindex contents, global visibility state
912 @cindex show all, global visibility state
913 @kindex S-@key{TAB}
914 @item S-@key{TAB}
915 @itemx C-u @key{TAB}
916 @emph{Global cycling}: Rotate the entire buffer among the states
917
918 @example
919 ,-> OVERVIEW -> CONTENTS -> SHOW ALL --.
920 '--------------------------------------'
921 @end example
922
923 When @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} is called with a numeric prefix argument N, the
924 CONTENTS view up to headlines of level N will be shown. Note that inside
925 tables, @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} jumps to the previous field.
926
927 @cindex show all, command
928 @kindex C-u C-u C-u @key{TAB}
929 @item C-u C-u C-u @key{TAB}
930 Show all, including drawers.
931 @kindex C-c C-r
932 @item C-c C-r
933 Reveal context around point, showing the current entry, the following heading
934 and the hierarchy above. Useful for working near a location that has been
935 exposed by a sparse tree command (@pxref{Sparse trees}) or an agenda command
936 (@pxref{Agenda commands}). With a prefix argument show, on each
937 level, all sibling headings. With double prefix arg, also show the entire
938 subtree of the parent.
939 @kindex C-c C-k
940 @item C-c C-k
941 Expose all the headings of the subtree, CONTENT view for just one subtree.
942 @kindex C-c C-x b
943 @item C-c C-x b
944 Show the current subtree in an indirect buffer@footnote{The indirect
945 buffer
946 @ifinfo
947 (@pxref{Indirect Buffers,,,emacs,GNU Emacs Manual})
948 @end ifinfo
949 @ifnotinfo
950 (see the Emacs manual for more information about indirect buffers)
951 @end ifnotinfo
952 will contain the entire buffer, but will be narrowed to the current
953 tree. Editing the indirect buffer will also change the original buffer,
954 but without affecting visibility in that buffer.}. With a numeric
955 prefix argument N, go up to level N and then take that tree. If N is
956 negative then go up that many levels. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix, do not remove
957 the previously used indirect buffer.
958 @end table
959
960 @vindex org-startup-folded
961 @cindex @code{overview}, STARTUP keyword
962 @cindex @code{content}, STARTUP keyword
963 @cindex @code{showall}, STARTUP keyword
964 @cindex @code{showeverything}, STARTUP keyword
965
966 When Emacs first visits an Org file, the global state is set to
967 OVERVIEW, i.e. only the top level headlines are visible. This can be
968 configured through the variable @code{org-startup-folded}, or on a
969 per-file basis by adding one of the following lines anywhere in the
970 buffer:
971
972 @example
973 #+STARTUP: overview
974 #+STARTUP: content
975 #+STARTUP: showall
976 #+STARTUP: showeverything
977 @end example
978
979 @cindex property, VISIBILITY
980 @noindent
981 Furthermore, any entries with a @samp{VISIBILITY} property (@pxref{Properties
982 and Columns}) will get their visibility adapted accordingly. Allowed values
983 for this property are @code{folded}, @code{children}, @code{content}, and
984 @code{all}.
985 @table @kbd
986 @kindex C-u C-u @key{TAB}
987 @item C-u C-u @key{TAB}
988 Switch back to the startup visibility of the buffer, i.e. whatever is
989 requested by startup options and @samp{VISIBILITY} properties in individual
990 entries.
991 @end table
992
993 @node Motion, Structure editing, Visibility cycling, Document Structure
994 @section Motion
995 @cindex motion, between headlines
996 @cindex jumping, to headlines
997 @cindex headline navigation
998 The following commands jump to other headlines in the buffer.
999
1000 @table @kbd
1001 @kindex C-c C-n
1002 @item C-c C-n
1003 Next heading.
1004 @kindex C-c C-p
1005 @item C-c C-p
1006 Previous heading.
1007 @kindex C-c C-f
1008 @item C-c C-f
1009 Next heading same level.
1010 @kindex C-c C-b
1011 @item C-c C-b
1012 Previous heading same level.
1013 @kindex C-c C-u
1014 @item C-c C-u
1015 Backward to higher level heading.
1016 @kindex C-c C-j
1017 @item C-c C-j
1018 Jump to a different place without changing the current outline
1019 visibility. Shows the document structure in a temporary buffer, where
1020 you can use the following keys to find your destination:
1021 @vindex org-goto-auto-isearch
1022 @example
1023 @key{TAB} @r{Cycle visibility.}
1024 @key{down} / @key{up} @r{Next/previous visible headline.}
1025 @key{RET} @r{Select this location.}
1026 @kbd{/} @r{Do a Sparse-tree search}
1027 @r{The following keys work if you turn off @code{org-goto-auto-isearch}}
1028 n / p @r{Next/previous visible headline.}
1029 f / b @r{Next/previous headline same level.}
1030 u @r{One level up.}
1031 0-9 @r{Digit argument.}
1032 q @r{Quit}
1033 @end example
1034 @vindex org-goto-interface
1035 @noindent
1036 See also the variable @code{org-goto-interface}.
1037 @end table
1038
1039 @node Structure editing, Sparse trees, Motion, Document Structure
1040 @section Structure editing
1041 @cindex structure editing
1042 @cindex headline, promotion and demotion
1043 @cindex promotion, of subtrees
1044 @cindex demotion, of subtrees
1045 @cindex subtree, cut and paste
1046 @cindex pasting, of subtrees
1047 @cindex cutting, of subtrees
1048 @cindex copying, of subtrees
1049 @cindex sorting, of subtrees
1050 @cindex subtrees, cut and paste
1051
1052 @table @kbd
1053 @kindex M-@key{RET}
1054 @item M-@key{RET}
1055 @vindex org-M-RET-may-split-line
1056 Insert new heading with same level as current. If the cursor is in a
1057 plain list item, a new item is created (@pxref{Plain lists}). To force
1058 creation of a new headline, use a prefix argument, or first press @key{RET}
1059 to get to the beginning of the next line. When this command is used in
1060 the middle of a line, the line is split and the rest of the line becomes
1061 the new headline@footnote{If you do not want the line to be split,
1062 customize the variable @code{org-M-RET-may-split-line}.}. If the
1063 command is used at the beginning of a headline, the new headline is
1064 created before the current line. If at the beginning of any other line,
1065 the content of that line is made the new heading. If the command is
1066 used at the end of a folded subtree (i.e. behind the ellipses at the end
1067 of a headline), then a headline like the current one will be inserted
1068 after the end of the subtree.
1069 @kindex C-@key{RET}
1070 @item C-@key{RET}
1071 Just like @kbd{M-@key{RET}}, except when adding a new heading below the
1072 current heading, the new heading is placed after the body instead of before
1073 it. This command works from anywhere in the entry.
1074 @kindex M-S-@key{RET}
1075 @item M-S-@key{RET}
1076 @vindex org-treat-insert-todo-heading-as-state-change
1077 Insert new TODO entry with same level as current heading. See also the
1078 variable @code{org-treat-insert-todo-heading-as-state-change}.
1079 @kindex C-S-@key{RET}
1080 @item C-S-@key{RET}
1081 Insert new TODO entry with same level as current heading. Like
1082 @kbd{C-@key{RET}}, the new headline will be inserted after the current
1083 subtree.
1084 @kindex @key{TAB}
1085 @item @key{TAB} @r{in new, empty entry}
1086 In a new entry with no text yet, the first @key{TAB} demotes the entry to
1087 become a child of the previous one. The next @key{TAB} makes it a parent,
1088 and so on, all the way to top level. Yet another @key{TAB}, and you are back
1089 to the initial level.
1090 @kindex M-@key{left}
1091 @item M-@key{left}
1092 Promote current heading by one level.
1093 @kindex M-@key{right}
1094 @item M-@key{right}
1095 Demote current heading by one level.
1096 @kindex M-S-@key{left}
1097 @item M-S-@key{left}
1098 Promote the current subtree by one level.
1099 @kindex M-S-@key{right}
1100 @item M-S-@key{right}
1101 Demote the current subtree by one level.
1102 @kindex M-S-@key{up}
1103 @item M-S-@key{up}
1104 Move subtree up (swap with previous subtree of same
1105 level).
1106 @kindex M-S-@key{down}
1107 @item M-S-@key{down}
1108 Move subtree down (swap with next subtree of same level).
1109 @kindex C-c C-x C-w
1110 @item C-c C-x C-w
1111 Kill subtree, i.e. remove it from buffer but save in kill ring.
1112 With a numeric prefix argument N, kill N sequential subtrees.
1113 @kindex C-c C-x M-w
1114 @item C-c C-x M-w
1115 Copy subtree to kill ring. With a numeric prefix argument N, copy the N
1116 sequential subtrees.
1117 @kindex C-c C-x C-y
1118 @item C-c C-x C-y
1119 Yank subtree from kill ring. This does modify the level of the subtree to
1120 make sure the tree fits in nicely at the yank position. The yank level can
1121 also be specified with a numeric prefix argument, or by yanking after a
1122 headline marker like @samp{****}.
1123 @kindex C-y
1124 @item C-y
1125 @vindex org-yank-adjusted-subtrees
1126 @vindex org-yank-folded-subtrees
1127 Depending on the variables @code{org-yank-adjusted-subtrees} and
1128 @code{org-yank-folded-subtrees}, Org's internal @code{yank} command will
1129 paste subtrees folded and in a clever way, using the same command as @kbd{C-c
1130 C-x C-y}. With the default settings, no level adjustment will take place,
1131 but the yanked tree will be folded unless doing so would swallow text
1132 previously visible. Any prefix argument to this command will force a normal
1133 @code{yank} to be executed, with the prefix passed along. A good way to
1134 force a normal yank is @kbd{C-u C-y}. If you use @code{yank-pop} after a
1135 yank, it will yank previous kill items plainly, without adjustment and
1136 folding.
1137 @kindex C-c C-x c
1138 @item C-c C-x c
1139 Clone a subtree by making a number of sibling copies of it. You will be
1140 prompted for the number of copies to make, and you can also specify if any
1141 timestamps in the entry should be shifted. This can be useful, for example,
1142 to create a number of tasks related to a series of lectures to prepare. For
1143 more details, see the docstring of the command
1144 @code{org-clone-subtree-with-time-shift}.
1145 @kindex C-c C-w
1146 @item C-c C-w
1147 Refile entry or region to a different location. @xref{Refiling notes}.
1148 @kindex C-c ^
1149 @item C-c ^
1150 Sort same-level entries. When there is an active region, all entries in the
1151 region will be sorted. Otherwise the children of the current headline are
1152 sorted. The command prompts for the sorting method, which can be
1153 alphabetically, numerically, by time (first timestamp with active preferred,
1154 creation time, scheduled time, deadline time), by priority, by TODO keyword
1155 (in the sequence the keywords have been defined in the setup) or by the value
1156 of a property. Reverse sorting is possible as well. You can also supply
1157 your own function to extract the sorting key. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix,
1158 sorting will be case-sensitive. With two @kbd{C-u C-u} prefixes, duplicate
1159 entries will also be removed.
1160 @kindex C-x n s
1161 @item C-x n s
1162 Narrow buffer to current subtree.
1163 @kindex C-x n w
1164 @item C-x n w
1165 Widen buffer to remove narrowing.
1166 @kindex C-c *
1167 @item C-c *
1168 Turn a normal line or plain list item into a headline (so that it becomes a
1169 subheading at its location). Also turn a headline into a normal line by
1170 removing the stars. If there is an active region, turn all lines in the
1171 region into headlines. If the first line in the region was an item, turn
1172 only the item lines into headlines. Finally, if the first line is a
1173 headline, remove the stars from all headlines in the region.
1174 @end table
1175
1176 @cindex region, active
1177 @cindex active region
1178 @cindex transient mark mode
1179 When there is an active region (Transient Mark mode), promotion and
1180 demotion work on all headlines in the region. To select a region of
1181 headlines, it is best to place both point and mark at the beginning of a
1182 line, mark at the beginning of the first headline, and point at the line
1183 just after the last headline to change. Note that when the cursor is
1184 inside a table (@pxref{Tables}), the Meta-Cursor keys have different
1185 functionality.
1186
1187
1188 @node Sparse trees, Plain lists, Structure editing, Document Structure
1189 @section Sparse trees
1190 @cindex sparse trees
1191 @cindex trees, sparse
1192 @cindex folding, sparse trees
1193 @cindex occur, command
1194
1195 @vindex org-show-hierarchy-above
1196 @vindex org-show-following-heading
1197 @vindex org-show-siblings
1198 @vindex org-show-entry-below
1199 An important feature of Org-mode is the ability to construct @emph{sparse
1200 trees} for selected information in an outline tree, so that the entire
1201 document is folded as much as possible, but the selected information is made
1202 visible along with the headline structure above it@footnote{See also the
1203 variables @code{org-show-hierarchy-above}, @code{org-show-following-heading},
1204 @code{org-show-siblings}, and @code{org-show-entry-below} for detailed
1205 control on how much context is shown around each match.}. Just try it out
1206 and you will see immediately how it works.
1207
1208 Org-mode contains several commands creating such trees, all these
1209 commands can be accessed through a dispatcher:
1210
1211 @table @kbd
1212 @kindex C-c /
1213 @item C-c /
1214 This prompts for an extra key to select a sparse-tree creating command.
1215 @kindex C-c / r
1216 @item C-c / r
1217 @vindex org-remove-highlights-with-change
1218 Occur. Prompts for a regexp and shows a sparse tree with all matches. If
1219 the match is in a headline, the headline is made visible. If the match is in
1220 the body of an entry, headline and body are made visible. In order to
1221 provide minimal context, also the full hierarchy of headlines above the match
1222 is shown, as well as the headline following the match. Each match is also
1223 highlighted; the highlights disappear when the buffer is changed by an
1224 editing command@footnote{This depends on the option
1225 @code{org-remove-highlights-with-change}}, or by pressing @kbd{C-c C-c}.
1226 When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, previous highlights are kept,
1227 so several calls to this command can be stacked.
1228 @end table
1229
1230 @noindent
1231 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
1232 For frequently used sparse trees of specific search strings, you can
1233 use the variable @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} to define fast
1234 keyboard access to specific sparse trees. These commands will then be
1235 accessible through the agenda dispatcher (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).
1236 For example:
1237
1238 @lisp
1239 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
1240 '(("f" occur-tree "FIXME")))
1241 @end lisp
1242
1243 @noindent will define the key @kbd{C-c a f} as a shortcut for creating
1244 a sparse tree matching the string @samp{FIXME}.
1245
1246 The other sparse tree commands select headings based on TODO keywords,
1247 tags, or properties and will be discussed later in this manual.
1248
1249 @kindex C-c C-e v
1250 @cindex printing sparse trees
1251 @cindex visible text, printing
1252 To print a sparse tree, you can use the Emacs command
1253 @code{ps-print-buffer-with-faces} which does not print invisible parts
1254 of the document @footnote{This does not work under XEmacs, because
1255 XEmacs uses selective display for outlining, not text properties.}.
1256 Or you can use the command @kbd{C-c C-e v} to export only the visible
1257 part of the document and print the resulting file.
1258
1259 @node Plain lists, Drawers, Sparse trees, Document Structure
1260 @section Plain lists
1261 @cindex plain lists
1262 @cindex lists, plain
1263 @cindex lists, ordered
1264 @cindex ordered lists
1265
1266 Within an entry of the outline tree, hand-formatted lists can provide
1267 additional structure. They also provide a way to create lists of
1268 checkboxes (@pxref{Checkboxes}). Org supports editing such lists,
1269 and the HTML exporter (@pxref{Exporting}) parses and formats them.
1270
1271 Org knows ordered lists, unordered lists, and description lists.
1272 @itemize @bullet
1273 @item
1274 @emph{Unordered} list items start with @samp{-}, @samp{+}, or
1275 @samp{*}@footnote{When using @samp{*} as a bullet, lines must be indented or
1276 they will be seen as top-level headlines. Also, when you are hiding leading
1277 stars to get a clean outline view, plain list items starting with a star are
1278 visually indistinguishable from true headlines. In short: even though
1279 @samp{*} is supported, it may be better to not use it for plain list items.}
1280 as bullets.
1281 @item
1282 @emph{Ordered} list items start with a numeral followed by either a period or
1283 a right parenthesis, such as @samp{1.} or @samp{1)}. If you want a list to
1284 start a different value (e.g. 20), start the text of the item with
1285 @code{[@@start:20]}.
1286 @item
1287 @emph{Description} list items are unordered list items, and contain the
1288 separator @samp{ :: } to separate the description @emph{term} from the
1289 description.
1290 @end itemize
1291
1292 @vindex org-empty-line-terminates-plain-lists
1293 Items belonging to the same list must have the same indentation on the first
1294 line. In particular, if an ordered list reaches number @samp{10.}, then the
1295 2--digit numbers must be written left-aligned with the other numbers in the
1296 list. Indentation also determines the end of a list item. It ends before
1297 the next line that is indented like the bullet/number, or less. Empty lines
1298 are part of the previous item, so you can have several paragraphs in one
1299 item. If you would like an empty line to terminate all currently open plain
1300 lists, configure the variable @code{org-empty-line-terminates-plain-lists}.
1301 Here is an example:
1302
1303 @example
1304 @group
1305 ** Lord of the Rings
1306 My favorite scenes are (in this order)
1307 1. The attack of the Rohirrim
1308 2. Eowyn's fight with the witch king
1309 + this was already my favorite scene in the book
1310 + I really like Miranda Otto.
1311 3. Peter Jackson being shot by Legolas
1312 - on DVD only
1313 He makes a really funny face when it happens.
1314 But in the end, no individual scenes matter but the film as a whole.
1315 Important actors in this film are:
1316 - @b{Elijah Wood} :: He plays Frodo
1317 - @b{Sean Austin} :: He plays Sam, Frodo's friend. I still remember
1318 him very well from his role as Mikey Walsh in @i{The Goonies}.
1319 @end group
1320 @end example
1321
1322 Org supports these lists by tuning filling and wrapping commands to deal with
1323 them correctly@footnote{Org only changes the filling settings for Emacs. For
1324 XEmacs, you should use Kyle E. Jones' @file{filladapt.el}. To turn this on,
1325 put into @file{.emacs}: @code{(require 'filladapt)}}, and by exporting them
1326 properly (@pxref{Exporting}). Since indentation is what governs the
1327 structure of these lists, many structural constructs like @code{#+BEGIN_...}
1328 blocks can be indented to signal that they should be part of a list item.
1329
1330 @vindex org-list-demote-modify-bullet
1331 If you find that using a different bullet for a sub-list (than that used for
1332 the current list-level) improves readability, customize the variable
1333 @code{org-list-demote-modify-bullet}.
1334
1335 The following commands act on items when the cursor is in the first line
1336 of an item (the line with the bullet or number).
1337
1338 @table @kbd
1339 @kindex @key{TAB}
1340 @item @key{TAB}
1341 @vindex org-cycle-include-plain-lists
1342 Items can be folded just like headline levels. Normally this works only if
1343 the cursor is on a plain list item. For more details, see the variable
1344 @code{org-cycle-include-plain-lists}. to @code{integrate}, plain list items
1345 will be treated like low-level. The level of an item is then given by the
1346 indentation of the bullet/number. Items are always subordinate to real
1347 headlines, however; the hierarchies remain completely separated.
1348
1349 If @code{org-cycle-include-plain-lists} has not been set, @key{TAB}
1350 fixes the indentation of the current line in a heuristic way.
1351 @kindex M-@key{RET}
1352 @item M-@key{RET}
1353 @vindex org-M-RET-may-split-line
1354 Insert new item at current level. With a prefix argument, force a new
1355 heading (@pxref{Structure editing}). If this command is used in the middle
1356 of a line, the line is @emph{split} and the rest of the line becomes the new
1357 item@footnote{If you do not want the line to be split, customize the variable
1358 @code{org-M-RET-may-split-line}.}. If this command is executed in the
1359 @emph{whitespace before a bullet or number}, the new item is created
1360 @emph{before} the current item. If the command is executed in the white
1361 space before the text that is part of an item but does not contain the
1362 bullet, a bullet is added to the current line.
1363 @kindex M-S-@key{RET}
1364 @item M-S-@key{RET}
1365 Insert a new item with a checkbox (@pxref{Checkboxes}).
1366 @kindex @key{TAB}
1367 @item @key{TAB} @r{in new, empty item}
1368 In a new item with no text yet, the first @key{TAB} demotes the item to
1369 become a child of the previous one. The next @key{TAB} makes it a parent,
1370 and so on, all the way to the left margin. Yet another @key{TAB}, and you
1371 are back to the initial level.
1372 @kindex S-@key{up}
1373 @kindex S-@key{down}
1374 @item S-@key{up}
1375 @itemx S-@key{down}
1376 @cindex shift-selection-mode
1377 @vindex org-support-shift-select
1378 Jump to the previous/next item in the current list, but only if
1379 @code{org-support-shift-select} is off. If not, you can still use paragraph
1380 jumping commands like @kbd{C-@key{up}} and @kbd{C-@key{down}} to quite
1381 similar effect.
1382 @kindex M-S-@key{up}
1383 @kindex M-S-@key{down}
1384 @item M-S-@key{up}
1385 @itemx M-S-@key{down}
1386 Move the item including subitems up/down (swap with previous/next item
1387 of same indentation). If the list is ordered, renumbering is
1388 automatic.
1389 @kindex M-@key{left}
1390 @kindex M-@key{right}
1391 @item M-@key{left}
1392 @itemx M-@key{right}
1393 Decrease/increase the indentation of an item, leaving children alone.
1394 @kindex M-S-@key{left}
1395 @kindex M-S-@key{right}
1396 @item M-S-@key{left}
1397 @itemx M-S-@key{right}
1398 Decrease/increase the indentation of the item, including subitems.
1399 Initially, the item tree is selected based on current indentation.
1400 When these commands are executed several times in direct succession,
1401 the initially selected region is used, even if the new indentation
1402 would imply a different hierarchy. To use the new hierarchy, break
1403 the command chain with a cursor motion or so.
1404 @kindex C-c C-c
1405 @item C-c C-c
1406 If there is a checkbox (@pxref{Checkboxes}) in the item line, toggle the
1407 state of the checkbox. If not, this command makes sure that all the
1408 items on this list level use the same bullet. Furthermore, if this is
1409 an ordered list, make sure the numbering is OK.
1410 @kindex C-c -
1411 @item C-c -
1412 Cycle the entire list level through the different itemize/enumerate bullets
1413 (@samp{-}, @samp{+}, @samp{*}, @samp{1.}, @samp{1)}). With a numeric prefix
1414 argument N, select the Nth bullet from this list. If there is an active
1415 region when calling this, all lines will be converted to list items. If the
1416 first line already was a list item, any item markers will be removed from the
1417 list. Finally, even without an active region, a normal line will be
1418 converted into a list item.
1419 @kindex C-c *
1420 @item C-c *
1421 Turn a plain list item into a headline (so that it becomes a subheading at
1422 its location). @xref{Structure editing}, for a detailed explanation.
1423 @kindex S-@key{left}
1424 @kindex S-@key{right}
1425 @item S-@key{left}/@key{right}
1426 @vindex org-support-shift-select
1427 This command also cycles bullet styles when the cursor in on the bullet or
1428 anywhere in an item line, details depending on
1429 @code{org-support-shift-select}.
1430 @kindex C-c ^
1431 @item C-c ^
1432 Sort the plain list. You will be prompted for the sorting method:
1433 numerically, alphabetically, by time, or by custom function.
1434 @end table
1435
1436 @node Drawers, Blocks, Plain lists, Document Structure
1437 @section Drawers
1438 @cindex drawers
1439 @cindex #+DRAWERS
1440 @cindex visibility cycling, drawers
1441
1442 @vindex org-drawers
1443 Sometimes you want to keep information associated with an entry, but you
1444 normally don't want to see it. For this, Org-mode has @emph{drawers}.
1445 Drawers need to be configured with the variable
1446 @code{org-drawers}@footnote{You can define drawers on a per-file basis
1447 with a line like @code{#+DRAWERS: HIDDEN PROPERTIES STATE}}. Drawers
1448 look like this:
1449
1450 @example
1451 ** This is a headline
1452 Still outside the drawer
1453 :DRAWERNAME:
1454 This is inside the drawer.
1455 :END:
1456 After the drawer.
1457 @end example
1458
1459 Visibility cycling (@pxref{Visibility cycling}) on the headline will hide and
1460 show the entry, but keep the drawer collapsed to a single line. In order to
1461 look inside the drawer, you need to move the cursor to the drawer line and
1462 press @key{TAB} there. Org-mode uses the @code{PROPERTIES} drawer for
1463 storing properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}), and you can also arrange
1464 for state change notes (@pxref{Tracking TODO state changes}) and clock times
1465 (@pxref{Clocking work time}) to be stored in a drawer @code{LOGBOOK}. If you
1466 want to store a quick note in the LOGBOOK drawer, in a similar way as this is
1467 done by state changes, use
1468
1469 @table @kbd
1470 @kindex C-c C-z
1471 @item C-c C-z
1472 Add a time-stamped note to the LOGBOOK drawer.
1473 @end table
1474
1475 @node Blocks, Footnotes, Drawers, Document Structure
1476 @section Blocks
1477
1478 @vindex org-hide-block-startup
1479 @cindex blocks, folding
1480 Org-mode uses begin...end blocks for various purposes from including source
1481 code examples (@pxref{Literal examples}) to capturing time logging
1482 information (@pxref{Clocking work time}). These blocks can be folded and
1483 unfolded by pressing TAB in the begin line. You can also get all blocks
1484 folded at startup by configuring the variable @code{org-hide-block-startup}
1485 or on a per-file basis by using
1486
1487 @cindex @code{hideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
1488 @cindex @code{nohideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
1489 @example
1490 #+STARTUP: hideblocks
1491 #+STARTUP: nohideblocks
1492 @end example
1493
1494 @node Footnotes, Orgstruct mode, Blocks, Document Structure
1495 @section Footnotes
1496 @cindex footnotes
1497
1498 Org-mode supports the creation of footnotes. In contrast to the
1499 @file{footnote.el} package, Org-mode's footnotes are designed for work on a
1500 larger document, not only for one-off documents like emails. The basic
1501 syntax is similar to the one used by @file{footnote.el}, i.e. a footnote is
1502 defined in a paragraph that is started by a footnote marker in square
1503 brackets in column 0, no indentation allowed. If you need a paragraph break
1504 inside a footnote, use the La@TeX{} idiom @samp{\par}. The footnote reference
1505 is simply the marker in square brackets, inside text. For example:
1506
1507 @example
1508 The Org homepage[fn:1] now looks a lot better than it used to.
1509 ...
1510 [fn:1] The link is: http://orgmode.org
1511 @end example
1512
1513 Org-mode extends the number-based syntax to @emph{named} footnotes and
1514 optional inline definition. Using plain numbers as markers (as
1515 @file{footnote.el} does) is supported for backward compatibility, but not
1516 encouraged because of possible conflicts with La@TeX{} snippets (@pxref{Embedded
1517 LaTeX}). Here are the valid references:
1518
1519 @table @code
1520 @item [1]
1521 A plain numeric footnote marker. Compatible with @file{footnote.el}, but not
1522 recommended because something like @samp{[1]} could easily be part of a code
1523 snippet.
1524 @item [fn:name]
1525 A named footnote reference, where @code{name} is a unique label word, or, for
1526 simplicity of automatic creation, a number.
1527 @item [fn:: This is the inline definition of this footnote]
1528 A La@TeX{}-like anonymous footnote where the definition is given directly at the
1529 reference point.
1530 @item [fn:name: a definition]
1531 An inline definition of a footnote, which also specifies a name for the note.
1532 Since Org allows multiple references to the same note, you can then use
1533 @code{[fn:name]} to create additional references.
1534 @end table
1535
1536 @vindex org-footnote-auto-label
1537 Footnote labels can be created automatically, or you can create names yourself.
1538 This is handled by the variable @code{org-footnote-auto-label} and its
1539 corresponding @code{#+STARTUP} keywords, see the docstring of that variable
1540 for details.
1541
1542 @noindent The following command handles footnotes:
1543
1544 @table @kbd
1545 @kindex C-c C-x f
1546 @item C-c C-x f
1547 The footnote action command.
1548
1549 When the cursor is on a footnote reference, jump to the definition. When it
1550 is at a definition, jump to the (first) reference.
1551
1552 @vindex org-footnote-define-inline
1553 @vindex org-footnote-section
1554 @vindex org-footnote-auto-adjust
1555 Otherwise, create a new footnote. Depending on the variable
1556 @code{org-footnote-define-inline}@footnote{The corresponding in-buffer
1557 setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: fninline} or @code{#+STARTUP: nofninline}}, the
1558 definition will be placed right into the text as part of the reference, or
1559 separately into the location determined by the variable
1560 @code{org-footnote-section}.
1561
1562 When this command is called with a prefix argument, a menu of additional
1563 options is offered:
1564 @example
1565 s @r{Sort the footnote definitions by reference sequence. During editing,}
1566 @r{Org makes no effort to sort footnote definitions into a particular}
1567 @r{sequence. If you want them sorted, use this command, which will}
1568 @r{also move entries according to @code{org-footnote-section}. Automatic}
1569 @r{sorting after each insertion/deletion can be configured using the}
1570 @r{variable @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.}
1571 r @r{Renumber the simple @code{fn:N} footnotes. Automatic renumbering}
1572 @r{after each insertion/deletion can be configured using the variable}
1573 @r{@code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.}
1574 S @r{Short for first @code{r}, then @code{s} action.}
1575 n @r{Normalize the footnotes by collecting all definitions (including}
1576 @r{inline definitions) into a special section, and then numbering them}
1577 @r{in sequence. The references will then also be numbers. This is}
1578 @r{meant to be the final step before finishing a document (e.g. sending}
1579 @r{off an email). The exporters do this automatically, and so could}
1580 @r{something like @code{message-send-hook}.}
1581 d @r{Delete the footnote at point, and all definitions of and references}
1582 @r{to it.}
1583 @end example
1584 Depending on the variable @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}@footnote{the
1585 corresponding in-buffer options are @code{fnadjust} and @code{nofnadjust}.},
1586 renumbering and sorting footnotes can be automatic after each insertion or
1587 deletion.
1588
1589 @kindex C-c C-c
1590 @item C-c C-c
1591 If the cursor is on a footnote reference, jump to the definition. If it is a
1592 the definition, jump back to the reference. When called at a footnote
1593 location with a prefix argument, offer the same menu as @kbd{C-c C-x f}.
1594 @kindex C-c C-o
1595 @kindex mouse-1
1596 @kindex mouse-2
1597 @item C-c C-o @r{or} mouse-1/2
1598 Footnote labels are also links to the corresponding definition/reference, and
1599 you can use the usual commands to follow these links.
1600 @end table
1601
1602 @node Orgstruct mode, , Footnotes, Document Structure
1603 @section The Orgstruct minor mode
1604 @cindex Orgstruct mode
1605 @cindex minor mode for structure editing
1606
1607 If you like the intuitive way the Org-mode structure editing and list
1608 formatting works, you might want to use these commands in other modes like
1609 Text mode or Mail mode as well. The minor mode @code{orgstruct-mode} makes
1610 this possible. Toggle the mode with @kbd{M-x orgstruct-mode}, or
1611 turn it on by default, for example in Mail mode, with one of:
1612
1613 @lisp
1614 (add-hook 'mail-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgstruct)
1615 (add-hook 'mail-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgstruct++)
1616 @end lisp
1617
1618 When this mode is active and the cursor is on a line that looks to Org like a
1619 headline or the first line of a list item, most structure editing commands
1620 will work, even if the same keys normally have different functionality in the
1621 major mode you are using. If the cursor is not in one of those special
1622 lines, Orgstruct mode lurks silently in the shadow. When you use
1623 @code{orgstruct++-mode}, Org will also export indentation and autofill
1624 settings into that mode, and detect item context after the first line of an
1625 item.
1626
1627 @node Tables, Hyperlinks, Document Structure, Top
1628 @chapter Tables
1629 @cindex tables
1630 @cindex editing tables
1631
1632 Org comes with a fast and intuitive table editor. Spreadsheet-like
1633 calculations are supported in connection with the Emacs @file{calc}
1634 package
1635 @ifinfo
1636 (@pxref{Top,Calc,,Calc,Gnu Emacs Calculator Manual}).
1637 @end ifinfo
1638 @ifnotinfo
1639 (see the Emacs Calculator manual for more information about the Emacs
1640 calculator).
1641 @end ifnotinfo
1642
1643 @menu
1644 * Built-in table editor:: Simple tables
1645 * Column width and alignment:: Overrule the automatic settings
1646 * Column groups:: Grouping to trigger vertical lines
1647 * Orgtbl mode:: The table editor as minor mode
1648 * The spreadsheet:: The table editor has spreadsheet capabilities
1649 * Org-Plot:: Plotting from org tables
1650 @end menu
1651
1652 @node Built-in table editor, Column width and alignment, Tables, Tables
1653 @section The built-in table editor
1654 @cindex table editor, built-in
1655
1656 Org makes it easy to format tables in plain ASCII. Any line with
1657 @samp{|} as the first non-whitespace character is considered part of a
1658 table. @samp{|} is also the column separator. A table might look like
1659 this:
1660
1661 @example
1662 | Name | Phone | Age |
1663 |-------+-------+-----|
1664 | Peter | 1234 | 17 |
1665 | Anna | 4321 | 25 |
1666 @end example
1667
1668 A table is re-aligned automatically each time you press @key{TAB} or
1669 @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} inside the table. @key{TAB} also moves to
1670 the next field (@key{RET} to the next row) and creates new table rows
1671 at the end of the table or before horizontal lines. The indentation
1672 of the table is set by the first line. Any line starting with
1673 @samp{|-} is considered as a horizontal separator line and will be
1674 expanded on the next re-align to span the whole table width. So, to
1675 create the above table, you would only type
1676
1677 @example
1678 |Name|Phone|Age|
1679 |-
1680 @end example
1681
1682 @noindent and then press @key{TAB} to align the table and start filling in
1683 fields. Even faster would be to type @code{|Name|Phone|Age} followed by
1684 @kbd{C-c @key{RET}}.
1685
1686 @vindex org-enable-table-editor
1687 @vindex org-table-auto-blank-field
1688 When typing text into a field, Org treats @key{DEL},
1689 @key{Backspace}, and all character keys in a special way, so that
1690 inserting and deleting avoids shifting other fields. Also, when
1691 typing @emph{immediately after the cursor was moved into a new field
1692 with @kbd{@key{TAB}}, @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} or @kbd{@key{RET}}}, the
1693 field is automatically made blank. If this behavior is too
1694 unpredictable for you, configure the variables
1695 @code{org-enable-table-editor} and @code{org-table-auto-blank-field}.
1696
1697 @table @kbd
1698 @tsubheading{Creation and conversion}
1699 @kindex C-c |
1700 @item C-c |
1701 Convert the active region to table. If every line contains at least one
1702 TAB character, the function assumes that the material is tab separated.
1703 If every line contains a comma, comma-separated values (CSV) are assumed.
1704 If not, lines are split at whitespace into fields. You can use a prefix
1705 argument to force a specific separator: @kbd{C-u} forces CSV, @kbd{C-u
1706 C-u} forces TAB, and a numeric argument N indicates that at least N
1707 consecutive spaces, or alternatively a TAB will be the separator.
1708 @*
1709 If there is no active region, this command creates an empty Org
1710 table. But it's easier just to start typing, like
1711 @kbd{|Name|Phone|Age @key{RET} |- @key{TAB}}.
1712
1713 @tsubheading{Re-aligning and field motion}
1714 @kindex C-c C-c
1715 @item C-c C-c
1716 Re-align the table without moving the cursor.
1717 @c
1718 @kindex @key{TAB}
1719 @item @key{TAB}
1720 Re-align the table, move to the next field. Creates a new row if
1721 necessary.
1722 @c
1723 @kindex S-@key{TAB}
1724 @item S-@key{TAB}
1725 Re-align, move to previous field.
1726 @c
1727 @kindex @key{RET}
1728 @item @key{RET}
1729 Re-align the table and move down to next row. Creates a new row if
1730 necessary. At the beginning or end of a line, @key{RET} still does
1731 NEWLINE, so it can be used to split a table.
1732 @c
1733 @kindex M-a
1734 @item M-a
1735 Move to beginning of the current table field, or on to the previous field.
1736 @kindex M-e
1737 @item M-e
1738 Move to end of the current table field, or on to the next field.
1739
1740 @tsubheading{Column and row editing}
1741 @kindex M-@key{left}
1742 @kindex M-@key{right}
1743 @item M-@key{left}
1744 @itemx M-@key{right}
1745 Move the current column left/right.
1746 @c
1747 @kindex M-S-@key{left}
1748 @item M-S-@key{left}
1749 Kill the current column.
1750 @c
1751 @kindex M-S-@key{right}
1752 @item M-S-@key{right}
1753 Insert a new column to the left of the cursor position.
1754 @c
1755 @kindex M-@key{up}
1756 @kindex M-@key{down}
1757 @item M-@key{up}
1758 @itemx M-@key{down}
1759 Move the current row up/down.
1760 @c
1761 @kindex M-S-@key{up}
1762 @item M-S-@key{up}
1763 Kill the current row or horizontal line.
1764 @c
1765 @kindex M-S-@key{down}
1766 @item M-S-@key{down}
1767 Insert a new row above the current row. With a prefix argument, the line is
1768 created below the current one.
1769 @c
1770 @kindex C-c -
1771 @item C-c -
1772 Insert a horizontal line below current row. With a prefix argument, the line
1773 is created above the current line.
1774 @c
1775 @kindex C-c @key{RET}
1776 @item C-c @key{RET}
1777 Insert a horizontal line below current row, and move the cursor into the row
1778 below that line.
1779 @c
1780 @kindex C-c ^
1781 @item C-c ^
1782 Sort the table lines in the region. The position of point indicates the
1783 column to be used for sorting, and the range of lines is the range
1784 between the nearest horizontal separator lines, or the entire table. If
1785 point is before the first column, you will be prompted for the sorting
1786 column. If there is an active region, the mark specifies the first line
1787 and the sorting column, while point should be in the last line to be
1788 included into the sorting. The command prompts for the sorting type
1789 (alphabetically, numerically, or by time). When called with a prefix
1790 argument, alphabetic sorting will be case-sensitive.
1791
1792 @tsubheading{Regions}
1793 @kindex C-c C-x M-w
1794 @item C-c C-x M-w
1795 Copy a rectangular region from a table to a special clipboard. Point and
1796 mark determine edge fields of the rectangle. If there is no active region,
1797 copy just the current field. The process ignores horizontal separator lines.
1798 @c
1799 @kindex C-c C-x C-w
1800 @item C-c C-x C-w
1801 Copy a rectangular region from a table to a special clipboard, and
1802 blank all fields in the rectangle. So this is the ``cut'' operation.
1803 @c
1804 @kindex C-c C-x C-y
1805 @item C-c C-x C-y
1806 Paste a rectangular region into a table.
1807 The upper left corner ends up in the current field. All involved fields
1808 will be overwritten. If the rectangle does not fit into the present table,
1809 the table is enlarged as needed. The process ignores horizontal separator
1810 lines.
1811 @c
1812 @kindex M-@key{RET}
1813 @itemx M-@kbd{RET}
1814 Wrap several fields in a column like a paragraph. If there is an active
1815 region, and both point and mark are in the same column, the text in the
1816 column is wrapped to minimum width for the given number of lines. A numeric
1817 prefix argument may be used to change the number of desired lines. If there
1818 is no region, the current field is split at the cursor position and the text
1819 fragment to the right of the cursor is prepended to the field one line
1820 down. If there is no region, but you specify a prefix argument, the current
1821 field is made blank, and the content is appended to the field above.
1822
1823 @tsubheading{Calculations}
1824 @cindex formula, in tables
1825 @cindex calculations, in tables
1826 @cindex region, active
1827 @cindex active region
1828 @cindex transient mark mode
1829 @kindex C-c +
1830 @item C-c +
1831 Sum the numbers in the current column, or in the rectangle defined by
1832 the active region. The result is shown in the echo area and can
1833 be inserted with @kbd{C-y}.
1834 @c
1835 @kindex S-@key{RET}
1836 @item S-@key{RET}
1837 @vindex org-table-copy-increment
1838 When current field is empty, copy from first non-empty field above. When not
1839 empty, copy current field down to next row and move cursor along with it.
1840 Depending on the variable @code{org-table-copy-increment}, integer field
1841 values will be incremented during copy. Integers that are too large will not
1842 be incremented. Also, a @code{0} prefix argument temporarily disables the
1843 increment. This key is also used by shift-selection and related modes
1844 (@pxref{Conflicts}).
1845
1846 @tsubheading{Miscellaneous}
1847 @kindex C-c `
1848 @item C-c `
1849 Edit the current field in a separate window. This is useful for fields that
1850 are not fully visible (@pxref{Column width and alignment}). When called with
1851 a @kbd{C-u} prefix, just make the full field visible, so that it can be
1852 edited in place.
1853 @c
1854 @item M-x org-table-import
1855 Import a file as a table. The table should be TAB or whitespace
1856 separated. Use, for example, to import a spreadsheet table or data
1857 from a database, because these programs generally can write
1858 TAB-separated text files. This command works by inserting the file into
1859 the buffer and then converting the region to a table. Any prefix
1860 argument is passed on to the converter, which uses it to determine the
1861 separator.
1862 @item C-c |
1863 Tables can also be imported by pasting tabular text into the Org
1864 buffer, selecting the pasted text with @kbd{C-x C-x} and then using the
1865 @kbd{C-c |} command (see above under @i{Creation and conversion}).
1866 @c
1867 @item M-x org-table-export
1868 @vindex org-table-export-default-format
1869 Export the table, by default as a TAB-separated file. Use for data
1870 exchange with, for example, spreadsheet or database programs. The format
1871 used to export the file can be configured in the variable
1872 @code{org-table-export-default-format}. You may also use properties
1873 @code{TABLE_EXPORT_FILE} and @code{TABLE_EXPORT_FORMAT} to specify the file
1874 name and the format for table export in a subtree. Org supports quite
1875 general formats for exported tables. The exporter format is the same as the
1876 format used by Orgtbl radio tables, see @ref{Translator functions}, for a
1877 detailed description.
1878 @end table
1879
1880 If you don't like the automatic table editor because it gets in your
1881 way on lines which you would like to start with @samp{|}, you can turn
1882 it off with
1883
1884 @lisp
1885 (setq org-enable-table-editor nil)
1886 @end lisp
1887
1888 @noindent Then the only table command that still works is
1889 @kbd{C-c C-c} to do a manual re-align.
1890
1891 @node Column width and alignment, Column groups, Built-in table editor, Tables
1892 @section Column width and alignment
1893 @cindex narrow columns in tables
1894 @cindex alignment in tables
1895
1896 The width of columns is automatically determined by the table editor. And
1897 also the alignment of a column is determined automatically from the fraction
1898 of number-like versus non-number fields in the column.
1899
1900 Sometimes a single field or a few fields need to carry more text, leading to
1901 inconveniently wide columns. Or maybe you want to make a table with several
1902 columns having a fixed width, regardless of content. To set@footnote{This
1903 feature does not work on XEmacs.} the width of a column, one field anywhere
1904 in the column may contain just the string @samp{<N>} where @samp{N} is an
1905 integer specifying the width of the column in characters. The next re-align
1906 will then set the width of this column to this value.
1907
1908 @example
1909 @group
1910 |---+------------------------------| |---+--------|
1911 | | | | | <6> |
1912 | 1 | one | | 1 | one |
1913 | 2 | two | ----\ | 2 | two |
1914 | 3 | This is a long chunk of text | ----/ | 3 | This=> |
1915 | 4 | four | | 4 | four |
1916 |---+------------------------------| |---+--------|
1917 @end group
1918 @end example
1919
1920 @noindent
1921 Fields that are wider become clipped and end in the string @samp{=>}.
1922 Note that the full text is still in the buffer, it is only invisible.
1923 To see the full text, hold the mouse over the field---a tool-tip window
1924 will show the full content. To edit such a field, use the command
1925 @kbd{C-c `} (that is @kbd{C-c} followed by the backquote). This will
1926 open a new window with the full field. Edit it and finish with @kbd{C-c
1927 C-c}.
1928
1929 @vindex org-startup-align-all-tables
1930 When visiting a file containing a table with narrowed columns, the
1931 necessary character hiding has not yet happened, and the table needs to
1932 be aligned before it looks nice. Setting the option
1933 @code{org-startup-align-all-tables} will realign all tables in a file
1934 upon visiting, but also slow down startup. You can also set this option
1935 on a per-file basis with:
1936
1937 @example
1938 #+STARTUP: align
1939 #+STARTUP: noalign
1940 @end example
1941
1942 If you would like to overrule the automatic alignment of number-rich columns
1943 to the right and of string-rich column to the left, you and use @samp{<r>} or
1944 @samp{<l>} in a similar fashion. You may also combine alignment and field
1945 width like this: @samp{<l10>}.
1946
1947 Lines which only contain these formatting cookies will be removed
1948 automatically when exporting the document.
1949
1950 @node Column groups, Orgtbl mode, Column width and alignment, Tables
1951 @section Column groups
1952 @cindex grouping columns in tables
1953
1954 When Org exports tables, it does so by default without vertical
1955 lines because that is visually more satisfying in general. Occasionally
1956 however, vertical lines can be useful to structure a table into groups
1957 of columns, much like horizontal lines can do for groups of rows. In
1958 order to specify column groups, you can use a special row where the
1959 first field contains only @samp{/}. The further fields can either
1960 contain @samp{<} to indicate that this column should start a group,
1961 @samp{>} to indicate the end of a column, or @samp{<>} to make a column
1962 a group of its own. Boundaries between column groups will upon export be
1963 marked with vertical lines. Here is an example:
1964
1965 @example
1966 | N | N^2 | N^3 | N^4 | sqrt(n) | sqrt[4](N) |
1967 |---+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
1968 | / | < | | > | < | > |
1969 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 |
1970 | 2 | 4 | 8 | 16 | 1.4142 | 1.1892 |
1971 | 3 | 9 | 27 | 81 | 1.7321 | 1.3161 |
1972 |---+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
1973 #+TBLFM: $2=$1^2::$3=$1^3::$4=$1^4::$5=sqrt($1)::$6=sqrt(sqrt(($1)))
1974 @end example
1975
1976 It is also sufficient to just insert the column group starters after
1977 every vertical line you would like to have:
1978
1979 @example
1980 | N | N^2 | N^3 | N^4 | sqrt(n) | sqrt[4](N) |
1981 |----+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
1982 | / | < | | | < | |
1983 @end example
1984
1985 @node Orgtbl mode, The spreadsheet, Column groups, Tables
1986 @section The Orgtbl minor mode
1987 @cindex Orgtbl mode
1988 @cindex minor mode for tables
1989
1990 If you like the intuitive way the Org table editor works, you
1991 might also want to use it in other modes like Text mode or Mail mode.
1992 The minor mode Orgtbl mode makes this possible. You can always toggle
1993 the mode with @kbd{M-x orgtbl-mode}. To turn it on by default, for
1994 example in mail mode, use
1995
1996 @lisp
1997 (add-hook 'mail-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgtbl)
1998 @end lisp
1999
2000 Furthermore, with some special setup, it is possible to maintain tables
2001 in arbitrary syntax with Orgtbl mode. For example, it is possible to
2002 construct La@TeX{} tables with the underlying ease and power of
2003 Orgtbl mode, including spreadsheet capabilities. For details, see
2004 @ref{Tables in arbitrary syntax}.
2005
2006 @node The spreadsheet, Org-Plot, Orgtbl mode, Tables
2007 @section The spreadsheet
2008 @cindex calculations, in tables
2009 @cindex spreadsheet capabilities
2010 @cindex @file{calc} package
2011
2012 The table editor makes use of the Emacs @file{calc} package to implement
2013 spreadsheet-like capabilities. It can also evaluate Emacs Lisp forms to
2014 derive fields from other fields. While fully featured, Org's implementation
2015 is not identical to other spreadsheets. For example, Org knows the concept
2016 of a @emph{column formula} that will be applied to all non-header fields in a
2017 column without having to copy the formula to each relevant field. There is
2018 also a formula debugger, and a formula editor with features for highlighting
2019 fields in the table corresponding to the references at the point in the
2020 formula, moving these references by arrow keys
2021
2022 @menu
2023 * References:: How to refer to another field or range
2024 * Formula syntax for Calc:: Using Calc to compute stuff
2025 * Formula syntax for Lisp:: Writing formulas in Emacs Lisp
2026 * Field formulas:: Formulas valid for a single field
2027 * Column formulas:: Formulas valid for an entire column
2028 * Editing and debugging formulas:: Fixing formulas
2029 * Updating the table:: Recomputing all dependent fields
2030 * Advanced features:: Field names, parameters and automatic recalc
2031 @end menu
2032
2033 @node References, Formula syntax for Calc, The spreadsheet, The spreadsheet
2034 @subsection References
2035 @cindex references
2036
2037 To compute fields in the table from other fields, formulas must
2038 reference other fields or ranges. In Org, fields can be referenced
2039 by name, by absolute coordinates, and by relative coordinates. To find
2040 out what the coordinates of a field are, press @kbd{C-c ?} in that
2041 field, or press @kbd{C-c @}} to toggle the display of a grid.
2042
2043 @subsubheading Field references
2044 @cindex field references
2045 @cindex references, to fields
2046
2047 Formulas can reference the value of another field in two ways. Like in
2048 any other spreadsheet, you may reference fields with a letter/number
2049 combination like @code{B3}, meaning the 2nd field in the 3rd row.
2050 @c Such references are always fixed to that field, they don't change
2051 @c when you copy and paste a formula to a different field. So
2052 @c Org's @code{B3} behaves like @code{$B$3} in other spreadsheets.
2053
2054 @noindent
2055 Org also uses another, more general operator that looks like this:
2056 @example
2057 @@@var{row}$@var{column}
2058 @end example
2059
2060 @noindent
2061 Column references can be absolute like @samp{1}, @samp{2},...@samp{@var{N}},
2062 or relative to the current column like @samp{+1} or @samp{-2}.
2063
2064 The row specification only counts data lines and ignores horizontal
2065 separator lines (hlines). You can use absolute row numbers
2066 @samp{1}...@samp{@var{N}}, and row numbers relative to the current row like
2067 @samp{+3} or @samp{-1}. Or specify the row relative to one of the
2068 hlines: @samp{I} refers to the first hline@footnote{Note that only
2069 hlines are counted that @emph{separate} table lines. If the table
2070 starts with a hline above the header, it does not count.}, @samp{II} to
2071 the second, etc@. @samp{-I} refers to the first such line above the
2072 current line, @samp{+I} to the first such line below the current line.
2073 You can also write @samp{III+2} which is the second data line after the
2074 third hline in the table.
2075
2076 @samp{0} refers to the current row and column. Also, if you omit
2077 either the column or the row part of the reference, the current
2078 row/column is implied.
2079
2080 Org's references with @emph{unsigned} numbers are fixed references
2081 in the sense that if you use the same reference in the formula for two
2082 different fields, the same field will be referenced each time.
2083 Org's references with @emph{signed} numbers are floating
2084 references because the same reference operator can reference different
2085 fields depending on the field being calculated by the formula.
2086
2087 As a special case, references like @samp{$LR5} and @samp{$LR12} can be used
2088 to refer in a stable way to the 5th and 12th field in the last row of the
2089 table.
2090
2091 Here are a few examples:
2092
2093 @example
2094 @@2$3 @r{2nd row, 3rd column}
2095 C2 @r{same as previous}
2096 $5 @r{column 5 in the current row}
2097 E& @r{same as previous}
2098 @@2 @r{current column, row 2}
2099 @@-1$-3 @r{the field one row up, three columns to the left}
2100 @@-I$2 @r{field just under hline above current row, column 2}
2101 @end example
2102
2103 @subsubheading Range references
2104 @cindex range references
2105 @cindex references, to ranges
2106
2107 You may reference a rectangular range of fields by specifying two field
2108 references connected by two dots @samp{..}. If both fields are in the
2109 current row, you may simply use @samp{$2..$7}, but if at least one field
2110 is in a different row, you need to use the general @code{@@row$column}
2111 format at least for the first field (i.e the reference must start with
2112 @samp{@@} in order to be interpreted correctly). Examples:
2113
2114 @example
2115 $1..$3 @r{First three fields in the current row.}
2116 $P..$Q @r{Range, using column names (see under Advanced)}
2117 @@2$1..@@4$3 @r{6 fields between these two fields.}
2118 A2..C4 @r{Same as above.}
2119 @@-1$-2..@@-1 @r{3 numbers from the column to the left, 2 up to current row}
2120 @end example
2121
2122 @noindent Range references return a vector of values that can be fed
2123 into Calc vector functions. Empty fields in ranges are normally
2124 suppressed, so that the vector contains only the non-empty fields (but
2125 see the @samp{E} mode switch below). If there are no non-empty fields,
2126 @samp{[0]} is returned to avoid syntax errors in formulas.
2127
2128 @subsubheading Field coordinates in formulas
2129 @cindex field coordinates
2130 @cindex coordinates, of field
2131 @cindex row, of field coordinates
2132 @cindex column, of field coordinates
2133
2134 For Calc formulas and Lisp formulas @code{@@#} and @code{$#} can be used to
2135 get the row or column number of the field where the formula result goes.
2136 The traditional Lisp formula equivalents are @code{org-table-current-dline}
2137 and @code{org-table-current-column}. Examples:
2138
2139 @example
2140 if(@@# % 2, $#, string("")) @r{column number on odd lines only}
2141 $3 = remote(FOO, @@@@#$2) @r{copy column 2 from table FOO into}
2142 @r{column 3 of the current table}
2143 @end example
2144
2145 @noindent For the second example, table FOO must have at least as many rows
2146 as the current table. Inefficient@footnote{The computation time scales as
2147 O(N^2) because table FOO is parsed for each field to be copied.} for large
2148 number of rows.
2149
2150 @subsubheading Named references
2151 @cindex named references
2152 @cindex references, named
2153 @cindex name, of column or field
2154 @cindex constants, in calculations
2155 @cindex #+CONSTANTS
2156
2157 @vindex org-table-formula-constants
2158 @samp{$name} is interpreted as the name of a column, parameter or
2159 constant. Constants are defined globally through the variable
2160 @code{org-table-formula-constants}, and locally (for the file) through a
2161 line like
2162
2163 @example
2164 #+CONSTANTS: c=299792458. pi=3.14 eps=2.4e-6
2165 @end example
2166
2167 @noindent
2168 @vindex constants-unit-system
2169 @pindex constants.el
2170 Also properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}) can be used as
2171 constants in table formulas: for a property @samp{:Xyz:} use the name
2172 @samp{$PROP_Xyz}, and the property will be searched in the current
2173 outline entry and in the hierarchy above it. If you have the
2174 @file{constants.el} package, it will also be used to resolve constants,
2175 including natural constants like @samp{$h} for Planck's constant, and
2176 units like @samp{$km} for kilometers@footnote{@file{constants.el} can
2177 supply the values of constants in two different unit systems, @code{SI}
2178 and @code{cgs}. Which one is used depends on the value of the variable
2179 @code{constants-unit-system}. You can use the @code{#+STARTUP} options
2180 @code{constSI} and @code{constcgs} to set this value for the current
2181 buffer.}. Column names and parameters can be specified in special table
2182 lines. These are described below, see @ref{Advanced features}. All
2183 names must start with a letter, and further consist of letters and
2184 numbers.
2185
2186 @subsubheading Remote references
2187 @cindex remote references
2188 @cindex references, remote
2189 @cindex references, to a different table
2190 @cindex name, of column or field
2191 @cindex constants, in calculations
2192 @cindex #+TBLNAME
2193
2194 You may also reference constants, fields and ranges from a different table,
2195 either in the current file or even in a different file. The syntax is
2196
2197 @example
2198 remote(NAME-OR-ID,REF)
2199 @end example
2200
2201 @noindent
2202 where NAME can be the name of a table in the current file as set by a
2203 @code{#+TBLNAME: NAME} line before the table. It can also be the ID of an
2204 entry, even in a different file, and the reference then refers to the first
2205 table in that entry. REF is an absolute field or range reference as
2206 described above for example @code{@@3$3} or @code{$somename}, valid in the
2207 referenced table.
2208
2209 @node Formula syntax for Calc, Formula syntax for Lisp, References, The spreadsheet
2210 @subsection Formula syntax for Calc
2211 @cindex formula syntax, Calc
2212 @cindex syntax, of formulas
2213
2214 A formula can be any algebraic expression understood by the Emacs
2215 @file{Calc} package. @b{Note that @file{calc} has the
2216 non-standard convention that @samp{/} has lower precedence than
2217 @samp{*}, so that @samp{a/b*c} is interpreted as @samp{a/(b*c)}.} Before
2218 evaluation by @code{calc-eval} (@pxref{Calling Calc from
2219 Your Programs,calc-eval,Calling Calc from Your Lisp Programs,Calc,GNU
2220 Emacs Calc Manual}),
2221 @c FIXME: The link to the Calc manual in HTML does not work.
2222 variable substitution takes place according to the rules described above.
2223 @cindex vectors, in table calculations
2224 The range vectors can be directly fed into the Calc vector functions
2225 like @samp{vmean} and @samp{vsum}.
2226
2227 @cindex format specifier
2228 @cindex mode, for @file{calc}
2229 @vindex org-calc-default-modes
2230 A formula can contain an optional mode string after a semicolon. This
2231 string consists of flags to influence Calc and other modes during
2232 execution. By default, Org uses the standard Calc modes (precision
2233 12, angular units degrees, fraction and symbolic modes off). The display
2234 format, however, has been changed to @code{(float 8)} to keep tables
2235 compact. The default settings can be configured using the variable
2236 @code{org-calc-default-modes}.
2237
2238 @example
2239 p20 @r{set the internal Calc calculation precision to 20 digits}
2240 n3 s3 e2 f4 @r{Normal, scientific, engineering, or fixed}
2241 @r{format of the result of Calc passed back to Org.}
2242 @r{Calc formatting is unlimited in precision as}
2243 @r{long as the Calc calculation precision is greater.}
2244 D R @r{angle modes: degrees, radians}
2245 F S @r{fraction and symbolic modes}
2246 N @r{interpret all fields as numbers, use 0 for non-numbers}
2247 T @r{force text interpretation}
2248 E @r{keep empty fields in ranges}
2249 L @r{literal}
2250 @end example
2251
2252 @noindent
2253 Unless you use large integer numbers or high-precision-calculation
2254 and -display for floating point numbers you may alternatively provide a
2255 @code{printf} format specifier to reformat the Calc result after it has been
2256 passed back to Org instead of letting Calc already do the
2257 formatting@footnote{The @code{printf} reformatting is limited in precision
2258 because the value passed to it is converted into an @code{integer} or
2259 @code{double}. The @code{integer} is limited in size by truncating the
2260 signed value to 32 bits. The @code{double} is limited in precision to 64
2261 bits overall which leaves approximately 16 significant decimal digits.}.
2262 A few examples:
2263
2264 @example
2265 $1+$2 @r{Sum of first and second field}
2266 $1+$2;%.2f @r{Same, format result to two decimals}
2267 exp($2)+exp($1) @r{Math functions can be used}
2268 $0;%.1f @r{Reformat current cell to 1 decimal}
2269 ($3-32)*5/9 @r{Degrees F -> C conversion}
2270 $c/$1/$cm @r{Hz -> cm conversion, using @file{constants.el}}
2271 tan($1);Dp3s1 @r{Compute in degrees, precision 3, display SCI 1}
2272 sin($1);Dp3%.1e @r{Same, but use printf specifier for display}
2273 vmean($2..$7) @r{Compute column range mean, using vector function}
2274 vmean($2..$7);EN @r{Same, but treat empty fields as 0}
2275 taylor($3,x=7,2) @r{taylor series of $3, at x=7, second degree}
2276 @end example
2277
2278 Calc also contains a complete set of logical operations. For example
2279
2280 @example
2281 if($1<20,teen,string("")) @r{``teen'' if age $1 less than 20, else empty}
2282 @end example
2283
2284 @node Formula syntax for Lisp, Field formulas, Formula syntax for Calc, The spreadsheet
2285 @subsection Emacs Lisp forms as formulas
2286 @cindex Lisp forms, as table formulas
2287
2288 It is also possible to write a formula in Emacs Lisp; this can be useful
2289 for string manipulation and control structures, if Calc's
2290 functionality is not enough. If a formula starts with a single-quote
2291 followed by an opening parenthesis, then it is evaluated as a Lisp form.
2292 The evaluation should return either a string or a number. Just as with
2293 @file{calc} formulas, you can specify modes and a printf format after a
2294 semicolon. With Emacs Lisp forms, you need to be conscious about the way
2295 field references are interpolated into the form. By default, a
2296 reference will be interpolated as a Lisp string (in double-quotes)
2297 containing the field. If you provide the @samp{N} mode switch, all
2298 referenced elements will be numbers (non-number fields will be zero) and
2299 interpolated as Lisp numbers, without quotes. If you provide the
2300 @samp{L} flag, all fields will be interpolated literally, without quotes.
2301 I.e., if you want a reference to be interpreted as a string by the Lisp
2302 form, enclose the reference operator itself in double-quotes, like
2303 @code{"$3"}. Ranges are inserted as space-separated fields, so you can
2304 embed them in list or vector syntax. A few examples, note how the
2305 @samp{N} mode is used when we do computations in Lisp.
2306
2307 @example
2308 @r{Swap the first two characters of the content of column 1}
2309 '(concat (substring $1 1 2) (substring $1 0 1) (substring $1 2))
2310 @r{Add columns 1 and 2, equivalent to Calc's @code{$1+$2}}
2311 '(+ $1 $2);N
2312 @r{Compute the sum of columns 1-4, like Calc's @code{vsum($1..$4)}}
2313 '(apply '+ '($1..$4));N
2314 @end example
2315
2316 @node Field formulas, Column formulas, Formula syntax for Lisp, The spreadsheet
2317 @subsection Field formulas
2318 @cindex field formula
2319 @cindex formula, for individual table field
2320
2321 To assign a formula to a particular field, type it directly into the
2322 field, preceded by @samp{:=}, for example @samp{:=$1+$2}. When you
2323 press @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in
2324 the field, the formula will be stored as the formula for this field,
2325 evaluated, and the current field replaced with the result.
2326
2327 @cindex #+TBLFM
2328 Formulas are stored in a special line starting with @samp{#+TBLFM:}
2329 directly below the table. If you typed the equation in the 4th field of
2330 the 3rd data line in the table, the formula will look like
2331 @samp{@@3$4=$1+$2}. When inserting/deleting/swapping column and rows
2332 with the appropriate commands, @i{absolute references} (but not relative
2333 ones) in stored formulas are modified in order to still reference the
2334 same field. Of course this is not true if you edit the table structure
2335 with normal editing commands---then you must fix the equations yourself.
2336 The left-hand side of a formula may also be a named field (@pxref{Advanced
2337 features}), or a last-row reference like @samp{$LR3}.
2338
2339 Instead of typing an equation into the field, you may also use the
2340 following command
2341
2342 @table @kbd
2343 @kindex C-u C-c =
2344 @item C-u C-c =
2345 Install a new formula for the current field. The command prompts for a
2346 formula with default taken from the @samp{#+TBLFM:} line, applies
2347 it to the current field, and stores it.
2348 @end table
2349
2350 @node Column formulas, Editing and debugging formulas, Field formulas, The spreadsheet
2351 @subsection Column formulas
2352 @cindex column formula
2353 @cindex formula, for table column
2354
2355 Often in a table, the same formula should be used for all fields in a
2356 particular column. Instead of having to copy the formula to all fields
2357 in that column, Org allows you to assign a single formula to an entire
2358 column. If the table contains horizontal separator hlines, everything
2359 before the first such line is considered part of the table @emph{header}
2360 and will not be modified by column formulas.
2361
2362 To assign a formula to a column, type it directly into any field in the
2363 column, preceded by an equal sign, like @samp{=$1+$2}. When you press
2364 @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the field,
2365 the formula will be stored as the formula for the current column, evaluated
2366 and the current field replaced with the result. If the field contains only
2367 @samp{=}, the previously stored formula for this column is used. For each
2368 column, Org will only remember the most recently used formula. In the
2369 @samp{#+TBLFM:} line, column formulas will look like @samp{$4=$1+$2}. The left-hand
2370 side of a column formula cannot currently be the name of column, it
2371 must be the numeric column reference.
2372
2373 Instead of typing an equation into the field, you may also use the
2374 following command:
2375
2376 @table @kbd
2377 @kindex C-c =
2378 @item C-c =
2379 Install a new formula for the current column and replace current field with
2380 the result of the formula. The command prompts for a formula, with default
2381 taken from the @samp{#+TBLFM} line, applies it to the current field and
2382 stores it. With a numeric prefix argument(e.g. @kbd{C-5 C-c =}) the command
2383 will apply it to that many consecutive fields in the current column.
2384 @end table
2385
2386 @node Editing and debugging formulas, Updating the table, Column formulas, The spreadsheet
2387 @subsection Editing and debugging formulas
2388 @cindex formula editing
2389 @cindex editing, of table formulas
2390
2391 @vindex org-table-use-standard-references
2392 You can edit individual formulas in the minibuffer or directly in the
2393 field. Org can also prepare a special buffer with all active
2394 formulas of a table. When offering a formula for editing, Org
2395 converts references to the standard format (like @code{B3} or @code{D&})
2396 if possible. If you prefer to only work with the internal format (like
2397 @code{@@3$2} or @code{$4}), configure the variable
2398 @code{org-table-use-standard-references}.
2399
2400 @table @kbd
2401 @kindex C-c =
2402 @kindex C-u C-c =
2403 @item C-c =
2404 @itemx C-u C-c =
2405 Edit the formula associated with the current column/field in the
2406 minibuffer. See @ref{Column formulas}, and @ref{Field formulas}.
2407 @kindex C-u C-u C-c =
2408 @item C-u C-u C-c =
2409 Re-insert the active formula (either a
2410 field formula, or a column formula) into the current field, so that you
2411 can edit it directly in the field. The advantage over editing in the
2412 minibuffer is that you can use the command @kbd{C-c ?}.
2413 @kindex C-c ?
2414 @item C-c ?
2415 While editing a formula in a table field, highlight the field(s)
2416 referenced by the reference at the cursor position in the formula.
2417 @kindex C-c @}
2418 @item C-c @}
2419 Toggle the display of row and column numbers for a table, using
2420 overlays. These are updated each time the table is aligned; you can
2421 force it with @kbd{C-c C-c}.
2422 @kindex C-c @{
2423 @item C-c @{
2424 Toggle the formula debugger on and off. See below.
2425 @kindex C-c '
2426 @item C-c '
2427 Edit all formulas for the current table in a special buffer, where the
2428 formulas will be displayed one per line. If the current field has an
2429 active formula, the cursor in the formula editor will mark it.
2430 While inside the special buffer, Org will automatically highlight
2431 any field or range reference at the cursor position. You may edit,
2432 remove and add formulas, and use the following commands:
2433 @table @kbd
2434 @kindex C-c C-c
2435 @kindex C-x C-s
2436 @item C-c C-c
2437 @itemx C-x C-s
2438 Exit the formula editor and store the modified formulas. With @kbd{C-u}
2439 prefix, also apply the new formulas to the entire table.
2440 @kindex C-c C-q
2441 @item C-c C-q
2442 Exit the formula editor without installing changes.
2443 @kindex C-c C-r
2444 @item C-c C-r
2445 Toggle all references in the formula editor between standard (like
2446 @code{B3}) and internal (like @code{@@3$2}).
2447 @kindex @key{TAB}
2448 @item @key{TAB}
2449 Pretty-print or indent Lisp formula at point. When in a line containing
2450 a Lisp formula, format the formula according to Emacs Lisp rules.
2451 Another @key{TAB} collapses the formula back again. In the open
2452 formula, @key{TAB} re-indents just like in Emacs Lisp mode.
2453 @kindex M-@key{TAB}
2454 @item M-@key{TAB}
2455 Complete Lisp symbols, just like in Emacs Lisp mode.
2456 @kindex S-@key{up}
2457 @kindex S-@key{down}
2458 @kindex S-@key{left}
2459 @kindex S-@key{right}
2460 @item S-@key{up}/@key{down}/@key{left}/@key{right}
2461 Shift the reference at point. For example, if the reference is
2462 @code{B3} and you press @kbd{S-@key{right}}, it will become @code{C3}.
2463 This also works for relative references and for hline references.
2464 @kindex M-S-@key{up}
2465 @kindex M-S-@key{down}
2466 @item M-S-@key{up}/@key{down}
2467 Move the test line for column formulas in the Org buffer up and
2468 down.
2469 @kindex M-@key{up}
2470 @kindex M-@key{down}
2471 @item M-@key{up}/@key{down}
2472 Scroll the window displaying the table.
2473 @kindex C-c @}
2474 @item C-c @}
2475 Turn the coordinate grid in the table on and off.
2476 @end table
2477 @end table
2478
2479 Making a table field blank does not remove the formula associated with
2480 the field, because that is stored in a different line (the @samp{#+TBLFM}
2481 line)---during the next recalculation the field will be filled again.
2482 To remove a formula from a field, you have to give an empty reply when
2483 prompted for the formula, or to edit the @samp{#+TBLFM} line.
2484
2485 @kindex C-c C-c
2486 You may edit the @samp{#+TBLFM} directly and re-apply the changed
2487 equations with @kbd{C-c C-c} in that line or with the normal
2488 recalculation commands in the table.
2489
2490 @subsubheading Debugging formulas
2491 @cindex formula debugging
2492 @cindex debugging, of table formulas
2493 When the evaluation of a formula leads to an error, the field content
2494 becomes the string @samp{#ERROR}. If you would like see what is going
2495 on during variable substitution and calculation in order to find a bug,
2496 turn on formula debugging in the @code{Tbl} menu and repeat the
2497 calculation, for example by pressing @kbd{C-u C-u C-c = @key{RET}} in a
2498 field. Detailed information will be displayed.
2499
2500 @node Updating the table, Advanced features, Editing and debugging formulas, The spreadsheet
2501 @subsection Updating the table
2502 @cindex recomputing table fields
2503 @cindex updating, table
2504
2505 Recalculation of a table is normally not automatic, but needs to be
2506 triggered by a command. See @ref{Advanced features}, for a way to make
2507 recalculation at least semi-automatic.
2508
2509 In order to recalculate a line of a table or the entire table, use the
2510 following commands:
2511
2512 @table @kbd
2513 @kindex C-c *
2514 @item C-c *
2515 Recalculate the current row by first applying the stored column formulas
2516 from left to right, and all field formulas in the current row.
2517 @c
2518 @kindex C-u C-c *
2519 @item C-u C-c *
2520 @kindex C-u C-c C-c
2521 @itemx C-u C-c C-c
2522 Recompute the entire table, line by line. Any lines before the first
2523 hline are left alone, assuming that these are part of the table header.
2524 @c
2525 @kindex C-u C-u C-c *
2526 @kindex C-u C-u C-c C-c
2527 @item C-u C-u C-c *
2528 @itemx C-u C-u C-c C-c
2529 Iterate the table by recomputing it until no further changes occur.
2530 This may be necessary if some computed fields use the value of other
2531 fields that are computed @i{later} in the calculation sequence.
2532 @item M-x org-table-recalculate-buffer-tables
2533 Recompute all tables in the current buffer.
2534 @item M-x org-table-iterate-buffer-tables
2535 Iterate all tables in the current buffer, in order to converge table-to-table
2536 dependencies.
2537 @end table
2538
2539 @node Advanced features, , Updating the table, The spreadsheet
2540 @subsection Advanced features
2541
2542 If you want the recalculation of fields to happen automatically, or if
2543 you want to be able to assign @i{names} to fields and columns, you need
2544 to reserve the first column of the table for special marking characters.
2545 @table @kbd
2546 @kindex C-#
2547 @item C-#
2548 Rotate the calculation mark in first column through the states @samp{ },
2549 @samp{#}, @samp{*}, @samp{!}, @samp{$}. When there is an active region,
2550 change all marks in the region.
2551 @end table
2552
2553 Here is an example of a table that collects exam results of students and
2554 makes use of these features:
2555
2556 @example
2557 @group
2558 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2559 | | Student | Prob 1 | Prob 2 | Prob 3 | Total | Note |
2560 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2561 | ! | | P1 | P2 | P3 | Tot | |
2562 | # | Maximum | 10 | 15 | 25 | 50 | 10.0 |
2563 | ^ | | m1 | m2 | m3 | mt | |
2564 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2565 | # | Peter | 10 | 8 | 23 | 41 | 8.2 |
2566 | # | Sam | 2 | 4 | 3 | 9 | 1.8 |
2567 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2568 | | Average | | | | 29.7 | |
2569 | ^ | | | | | at | |
2570 | $ | max=50 | | | | | |
2571 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2572 #+TBLFM: $6=vsum($P1..$P3)::$7=10*$Tot/$max;%.1f::$at=vmean(@@-II..@@-I);%.1f
2573 @end group
2574 @end example
2575
2576 @noindent @b{Important}: please note that for these special tables,
2577 recalculating the table with @kbd{C-u C-c *} will only affect rows that
2578 are marked @samp{#} or @samp{*}, and fields that have a formula assigned
2579 to the field itself. The column formulas are not applied in rows with
2580 empty first field.
2581
2582 @cindex marking characters, tables
2583 The marking characters have the following meaning:
2584 @table @samp
2585 @item !
2586 The fields in this line define names for the columns, so that you may
2587 refer to a column as @samp{$Tot} instead of @samp{$6}.
2588 @item ^
2589 This row defines names for the fields @emph{above} the row. With such
2590 a definition, any formula in the table may use @samp{$m1} to refer to
2591 the value @samp{10}. Also, if you assign a formula to a names field, it
2592 will be stored as @samp{$name=...}.
2593 @item _
2594 Similar to @samp{^}, but defines names for the fields in the row
2595 @emph{below}.
2596 @item $
2597 Fields in this row can define @emph{parameters} for formulas. For
2598 example, if a field in a @samp{$} row contains @samp{max=50}, then
2599 formulas in this table can refer to the value 50 using @samp{$max}.
2600 Parameters work exactly like constants, only that they can be defined on
2601 a per-table basis.
2602 @item #
2603 Fields in this row are automatically recalculated when pressing
2604 @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} in this row. Also, this row
2605 is selected for a global recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}. Unmarked
2606 lines will be left alone by this command.
2607 @item *
2608 Selects this line for global recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}, but
2609 not for automatic recalculation. Use this when automatic
2610 recalculation slows down editing too much.
2611 @item
2612 Unmarked lines are exempt from recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}.
2613 All lines that should be recalculated should be marked with @samp{#}
2614 or @samp{*}.
2615 @item /
2616 Do not export this line. Useful for lines that contain the narrowing
2617 @samp{<N>} markers or column group markers.
2618 @end table
2619
2620 Finally, just to whet your appetite for what can be done with the
2621 fantastic @file{calc.el} package, here is a table that computes the Taylor
2622 series of degree @code{n} at location @code{x} for a couple of
2623 functions.
2624
2625 @example
2626 @group
2627 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
2628 | | Func | n | x | Result |
2629 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
2630 | # | exp(x) | 1 | x | 1 + x |
2631 | # | exp(x) | 2 | x | 1 + x + x^2 / 2 |
2632 | # | exp(x) | 3 | x | 1 + x + x^2 / 2 + x^3 / 6 |
2633 | # | x^2+sqrt(x) | 2 | x=0 | x*(0.5 / 0) + x^2 (2 - 0.25 / 0) / 2 |
2634 | # | x^2+sqrt(x) | 2 | x=1 | 2 + 2.5 x - 2.5 + 0.875 (x - 1)^2 |
2635 | * | tan(x) | 3 | x | 0.0175 x + 1.77e-6 x^3 |
2636 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
2637 #+TBLFM: $5=taylor($2,$4,$3);n3
2638 @end group
2639 @end example
2640
2641 @node Org-Plot, , The spreadsheet, Tables
2642 @section Org-Plot
2643 @cindex graph, in tables
2644 @cindex plot tables using Gnuplot
2645 @cindex #+PLOT
2646
2647 Org-Plot can produce 2D and 3D graphs of information stored in org tables
2648 using @file{Gnuplot} @uref{http://www.gnuplot.info/} and @file{gnuplot-mode}
2649 @uref{http://cars9.uchicago.edu/~ravel/software/gnuplot-mode.html}. To see
2650 this in action, ensure that you have both Gnuplot and Gnuplot mode installed
2651 on your system, then call @code{org-plot/gnuplot} on the following table.
2652
2653 @example
2654 @group
2655 #+PLOT: title:"Citas" ind:1 deps:(3) type:2d with:histograms set:"yrange [0:]"
2656 | Sede | Max cites | H-index |
2657 |-----------+-----------+---------|
2658 | Chile | 257.72 | 21.39 |
2659 | Leeds | 165.77 | 19.68 |
2660 | Sao Paolo | 71.00 | 11.50 |
2661 | Stockholm | 134.19 | 14.33 |
2662 | Morelia | 257.56 | 17.67 |
2663 @end group
2664 @end example
2665
2666 Notice that Org Plot is smart enough to apply the table's headers as labels.
2667 Further control over the labels, type, content, and appearance of plots can
2668 be exercised through the @code{#+PLOT:} lines preceding a table. See below
2669 for a complete list of Org-plot options. For more information and examples
2670 see the Org-plot tutorial at
2671 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-tutorials/org-plot.php}.
2672
2673 @subsubheading Plot Options
2674
2675 @table @code
2676 @item set
2677 Specify any @command{gnuplot} option to be set when graphing.
2678
2679 @item title
2680 Specify the title of the plot.
2681
2682 @item ind
2683 Specify which column of the table to use as the @code{x} axis.
2684
2685 @item deps
2686 Specify the columns to graph as a Lisp style list, surrounded by parentheses
2687 and separated by spaces for example @code{dep:(3 4)} to graph the third and
2688 fourth columns (defaults to graphing all other columns aside from the @code{ind}
2689 column).
2690
2691 @item type
2692 Specify whether the plot will be @code{2d}, @code{3d}, or @code{grid}.
2693
2694 @item with
2695 Specify a @code{with} option to be inserted for every col being plotted
2696 (e.g. @code{lines}, @code{points}, @code{boxes}, @code{impulses}, etc...).
2697 Defaults to @code{lines}.
2698
2699 @item file
2700 If you want to plot to a file, specify @code{"@var{path/to/desired/output-file}"}.
2701
2702 @item labels
2703 List of labels to be used for the deps (defaults to the column headers if
2704 they exist).
2705
2706 @item line
2707 Specify an entire line to be inserted in the Gnuplot script.
2708
2709 @item map
2710 When plotting @code{3d} or @code{grid} types, set this to @code{t} to graph a
2711 flat mapping rather than a @code{3d} slope.
2712
2713 @item timefmt
2714 Specify format of Org-mode timestamps as they will be parsed by Gnuplot.
2715 Defaults to @samp{%Y-%m-%d-%H:%M:%S}.
2716
2717 @item script
2718 If you want total control, you can specify a script file (place the file name
2719 between double-quotes) which will be used to plot. Before plotting, every
2720 instance of @code{$datafile} in the specified script will be replaced with
2721 the path to the generated data file. Note: even if you set this option, you
2722 may still want to specify the plot type, as that can impact the content of
2723 the data file.
2724 @end table
2725
2726 @node Hyperlinks, TODO Items, Tables, Top
2727 @chapter Hyperlinks
2728 @cindex hyperlinks
2729
2730 Like HTML, Org provides links inside a file, external links to
2731 other files, Usenet articles, emails, and much more.
2732
2733 @menu
2734 * Link format:: How links in Org are formatted
2735 * Internal links:: Links to other places in the current file
2736 * External links:: URL-like links to the world
2737 * Handling links:: Creating, inserting and following
2738 * Using links outside Org:: Linking from my C source code?
2739 * Link abbreviations:: Shortcuts for writing complex links
2740 * Search options:: Linking to a specific location
2741 * Custom searches:: When the default search is not enough
2742 @end menu
2743
2744 @node Link format, Internal links, Hyperlinks, Hyperlinks
2745 @section Link format
2746 @cindex link format
2747 @cindex format, of links
2748
2749 Org will recognize plain URL-like links and activate them as
2750 clickable links. The general link format, however, looks like this:
2751
2752 @example
2753 [[link][description]] @r{or alternatively} [[link]]
2754 @end example
2755
2756 @noindent
2757 Once a link in the buffer is complete (all brackets present), Org
2758 will change the display so that @samp{description} is displayed instead
2759 of @samp{[[link][description]]} and @samp{link} is displayed instead of
2760 @samp{[[link]]}. Links will be highlighted in the face @code{org-link},
2761 which by default is an underlined face. You can directly edit the
2762 visible part of a link. Note that this can be either the @samp{link}
2763 part (if there is no description) or the @samp{description} part. To
2764 edit also the invisible @samp{link} part, use @kbd{C-c C-l} with the
2765 cursor on the link.
2766
2767 If you place the cursor at the beginning or just behind the end of the
2768 displayed text and press @key{BACKSPACE}, you will remove the
2769 (invisible) bracket at that location. This makes the link incomplete
2770 and the internals are again displayed as plain text. Inserting the
2771 missing bracket hides the link internals again. To show the
2772 internal structure of all links, use the menu entry
2773 @code{Org->Hyperlinks->Literal links}.
2774
2775 @node Internal links, External links, Link format, Hyperlinks
2776 @section Internal links
2777 @cindex internal links
2778 @cindex links, internal
2779 @cindex targets, for links
2780
2781 @cindex property, CUSTOM_ID
2782 If the link does not look like a URL, it is considered to be internal in the
2783 current file. The most important case is a link like
2784 @samp{[[#my-custom-id]]} which will link to the entry with the
2785 @code{CUSTOM_ID} property @samp{my-custom-id}. Such custom IDs are very good
2786 for HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}) where they produce pretty section
2787 links. You are responsible yourself to make sure these custom IDs are unique
2788 in a file.
2789
2790 Links such as @samp{[[My Target]]} or @samp{[[My Target][Find my target]]}
2791 lead to a text search in the current file.
2792
2793 The link can be followed with @kbd{C-c C-o} when the cursor is on the link,
2794 or with a mouse click (@pxref{Handling links}). Links to custom IDs will
2795 point to the corresponding headline. The preferred match for a text link is
2796 a @i{dedicated target}: the same string in double angular brackets. Targets
2797 may be located anywhere; sometimes it is convenient to put them into a
2798 comment line. For example
2799
2800 @example
2801 # <<My Target>>
2802 @end example
2803
2804 @noindent In HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}), such targets will become
2805 named anchors for direct access through @samp{http} links@footnote{Note that
2806 text before the first headline is usually not exported, so the first such
2807 target should be after the first headline, or in the line directly before the
2808 first headline.}.
2809
2810 If no dedicated target exists, Org will search for the words in the link. In
2811 the above example the search would be for @samp{my target}. Links starting
2812 with a star like @samp{*My Target} restrict the search to
2813 headlines@footnote{To insert a link targeting a headline, in-buffer
2814 completion can be used. Just type a star followed by a few optional letters
2815 into the buffer and press @kbd{M-@key{TAB}}. All headlines in the current
2816 buffer will be offered as completions. @xref{Handling links}, for more
2817 commands creating links.}. When searching, Org-mode will first try an
2818 exact match, but then move on to more and more lenient searches. For
2819 example, the link @samp{[[*My Targets]]} will find any of the following:
2820
2821 @example
2822 ** My targets
2823 ** TODO my targets are bright
2824 ** my 20 targets are
2825 @end example
2826
2827
2828 Following a link pushes a mark onto Org's own mark ring. You can
2829 return to the previous position with @kbd{C-c &}. Using this command
2830 several times in direct succession goes back to positions recorded
2831 earlier.
2832
2833 @menu
2834 * Radio targets:: Make targets trigger links in plain text
2835 @end menu
2836
2837 @node Radio targets, , Internal links, Internal links
2838 @subsection Radio targets
2839 @cindex radio targets
2840 @cindex targets, radio
2841 @cindex links, radio targets
2842
2843 Org can automatically turn any occurrences of certain target names
2844 in normal text into a link. So without explicitly creating a link, the
2845 text connects to the target radioing its position. Radio targets are
2846 enclosed by triple angular brackets. For example, a target @samp{<<<My
2847 Target>>>} causes each occurrence of @samp{my target} in normal text to
2848 become activated as a link. The Org file is scanned automatically
2849 for radio targets only when the file is first loaded into Emacs. To
2850 update the target list during editing, press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the
2851 cursor on or at a target.
2852
2853 @node External links, Handling links, Internal links, Hyperlinks
2854 @section External links
2855 @cindex links, external
2856 @cindex external links
2857 @cindex links, external
2858 @cindex Gnus links
2859 @cindex BBDB links
2860 @cindex IRC links
2861 @cindex URL links
2862 @cindex file links
2863 @cindex VM links
2864 @cindex RMAIL links
2865 @cindex WANDERLUST links
2866 @cindex MH-E links
2867 @cindex USENET links
2868 @cindex SHELL links
2869 @cindex Info links
2870 @cindex Elisp links
2871
2872 Org supports links to files, websites, Usenet and email messages,
2873 BBDB database entries and links to both IRC conversations and their
2874 logs. External links are URL-like locators. They start with a short
2875 identifying string followed by a colon. There can be no space after
2876 the colon. The following list shows examples for each link type.
2877
2878 @example
2879 http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik @r{on the web}
2880 doi:10.1000/182 @r{DOI for an electronic resource}
2881 file:/home/dominik/images/jupiter.jpg @r{file, absolute path}
2882 /home/dominik/images/jupiter.jpg @r{same as above}
2883 file:papers/last.pdf @r{file, relative path}
2884 ./papers/last.pdf @r{same as above}
2885 file:/myself@@some.where:papers/last.pdf @r{file, path on remote machine}
2886 /myself@@some.where:papers/last.pdf @r{same as above}
2887 file:sometextfile::NNN @r{file with line number to jump to}
2888 file:projects.org @r{another Org file}
2889 file:projects.org::some words @r{text search in Org file}
2890 file:projects.org::*task title @r{heading search in Org file}
2891 docview:papers/last.pdf::NNN @r{open file in doc-view mode at page NNN}
2892 id:B7423F4D-2E8A-471B-8810-C40F074717E9 @r{Link to heading by ID}
2893 news:comp.emacs @r{Usenet link}
2894 mailto:adent@@galaxy.net @r{Mail link}
2895 vm:folder @r{VM folder link}
2896 vm:folder#id @r{VM message link}
2897 vm://myself@@some.where.org/folder#id @r{VM on remote machine}
2898 wl:folder @r{WANDERLUST folder link}
2899 wl:folder#id @r{WANDERLUST message link}
2900 mhe:folder @r{MH-E folder link}
2901 mhe:folder#id @r{MH-E message link}
2902 rmail:folder @r{RMAIL folder link}
2903 rmail:folder#id @r{RMAIL message link}
2904 gnus:group @r{Gnus group link}
2905 gnus:group#id @r{Gnus article link}
2906 bbdb:R.*Stallman @r{BBDB link (with regexp)}
2907 irc:/irc.com/#emacs/bob @r{IRC link}
2908 info:org:External%20links @r{Info node link (with encoded space)}
2909 shell:ls *.org @r{A shell command}
2910 elisp:org-agenda @r{Interactive Elisp command}
2911 elisp:(find-file-other-frame "Elisp.org") @r{Elisp form to evaluate}
2912 @end example
2913
2914 A link should be enclosed in double brackets and may contain a
2915 descriptive text to be displayed instead of the URL (@pxref{Link
2916 format}), for example:
2917
2918 @example
2919 [[http://www.gnu.org/software/emacs/][GNU Emacs]]
2920 @end example
2921
2922 @noindent
2923 If the description is a file name or URL that points to an image, HTML
2924 export (@pxref{HTML export}) will inline the image as a clickable
2925 button. If there is no description at all and the link points to an
2926 image,
2927 that image will be inlined into the exported HTML file.
2928
2929 @cindex square brackets, around links
2930 @cindex plain text external links
2931 Org also finds external links in the normal text and activates them
2932 as links. If spaces must be part of the link (for example in
2933 @samp{bbdb:Richard Stallman}), or if you need to remove ambiguities
2934 about the end of the link, enclose them in square brackets.
2935
2936 @node Handling links, Using links outside Org, External links, Hyperlinks
2937 @section Handling links
2938 @cindex links, handling
2939
2940 Org provides methods to create a link in the correct syntax, to
2941 insert it into an Org file, and to follow the link.
2942
2943 @table @kbd
2944 @kindex C-c l
2945 @cindex storing links
2946 @item C-c l
2947 Store a link to the current location. This is a @emph{global} command (you
2948 must create the key binding yourself) which can be used in any buffer to
2949 create a link. The link will be stored for later insertion into an Org
2950 buffer (see below). What kind of link will be created depends on the current
2951 buffer:
2952
2953 @b{Org-mode buffers}@*
2954 For Org files, if there is a @samp{<<target>>} at the cursor, the link points
2955 to the target. Otherwise it points to the current headline, which will also
2956 be the description.
2957
2958 @vindex org-link-to-org-use-id
2959 @cindex property, CUSTOM_ID
2960 @cindex property, ID
2961 If the headline has a @code{CUSTOM_ID} property, a link to this custom ID
2962 will be stored. In addition or alternatively (depending on the value of
2963 @code{org-link-to-org-use-id}), a globally unique @code{ID} property will be
2964 created and/or used to construct a link. So using this command in Org
2965 buffers will potentially create two links: a human-readable from the custom
2966 ID, and one that is globally unique and works even if the entry is moved from
2967 file to file. Later, when inserting the link, you need to decide which one
2968 to use.
2969
2970 @b{Email/News clients: VM, Rmail, Wanderlust, MH-E, Gnus}@*
2971 Pretty much all Emacs mail clients are supported. The link will point to the
2972 current article, or, in some GNUS buffers, to the group. The description is
2973 constructed from the author and the subject.
2974
2975 @b{Web browsers: W3 and W3M}@*
2976 Here the link will be the current URL, with the page title as description.
2977
2978 @b{Contacts: BBDB}@*
2979 Links created in a BBDB buffer will point to the current entry.
2980
2981 @b{Chat: IRC}@*
2982 @vindex org-irc-link-to-logs
2983 For IRC links, if you set the variable @code{org-irc-link-to-logs} to
2984 @code{t}, a @samp{file:/} style link to the relevant point in the logs for
2985 the current conversation is created. Otherwise an @samp{irc:/} style link to
2986 the user/channel/server under the point will be stored.
2987
2988 @b{Other files}@*
2989 For any other files, the link will point to the file, with a search string
2990 (@pxref{Search options}) pointing to the contents of the current line. If
2991 there is an active region, the selected words will form the basis of the
2992 search string. If the automatically created link is not working correctly or
2993 accurately enough, you can write custom functions to select the search string
2994 and to do the search for particular file types---see @ref{Custom searches}.
2995 The key binding @kbd{C-c l} is only a suggestion---see @ref{Installation}.
2996
2997 @b{Agenda view}@*
2998 When the cursor is in an agenda view, the created link points to the
2999 entry referenced by the current line.
3000
3001 @c
3002 @kindex C-c C-l
3003 @cindex link completion
3004 @cindex completion, of links
3005 @cindex inserting links
3006 @item C-c C-l
3007 @vindex org-keep-stored-link-after-insertion
3008 Insert a link@footnote{ Note that you don't have to use this command to
3009 insert a link. Links in Org are plain text, and you can type or paste them
3010 straight into the buffer. By using this command, the links are automatically
3011 enclosed in double brackets, and you will be asked for the optional
3012 descriptive text.}. This prompts for a link to be inserted into the buffer.
3013 You can just type a link, using text for an internal link, or one of the link
3014 type prefixes mentioned in the examples above. The link will be inserted
3015 into the buffer@footnote{After insertion of a stored link, the link will be
3016 removed from the list of stored links. To keep it in the list later use, use
3017 a triple @kbd{C-u} prefix argument to @kbd{C-c C-l}, or configure the option
3018 @code{org-keep-stored-link-after-insertion}.}, along with a descriptive text.
3019 If some text was selected when this command is called, the selected text
3020 becomes the default description.
3021
3022 @b{Inserting stored links}@*
3023 All links stored during the
3024 current session are part of the history for this prompt, so you can access
3025 them with @key{up} and @key{down} (or @kbd{M-p/n}).
3026
3027 @b{Completion support}@* Completion with @key{TAB} will help you to insert
3028 valid link prefixes like @samp{http:} or @samp{ftp:}, including the prefixes
3029 defined through link abbreviations (@pxref{Link abbreviations}). If you
3030 press @key{RET} after inserting only the @var{prefix}, Org will offer
3031 specific completion support for some link types@footnote{This works by
3032 calling a special function @code{org-PREFIX-complete-link}.} For
3033 example, if you type @kbd{file @key{RET}}, file name completion (alternative
3034 access: @kbd{C-u C-c C-l}, see below) will be offered, and after @kbd{bbdb
3035 @key{RET}} you can complete contact names.
3036 @kindex C-u C-c C-l
3037 @cindex file name completion
3038 @cindex completion, of file names
3039 @item C-u C-c C-l
3040 When @kbd{C-c C-l} is called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, a link to
3041 a file will be inserted and you may use file name completion to select
3042 the name of the file. The path to the file is inserted relative to the
3043 directory of the current Org file, if the linked file is in the current
3044 directory or in a sub-directory of it, or if the path is written relative
3045 to the current directory using @samp{../}. Otherwise an absolute path
3046 is used, if possible with @samp{~/} for your home directory. You can
3047 force an absolute path with two @kbd{C-u} prefixes.
3048 @c
3049 @item C-c C-l @ @r{(with cursor on existing link)}
3050 When the cursor is on an existing link, @kbd{C-c C-l} allows you to edit the
3051 link and description parts of the link.
3052 @c
3053 @cindex following links
3054 @kindex C-c C-o
3055 @kindex @key{RET}
3056 @item C-c C-o @ @r{(or, if @code{org-return-follows-link} is set, also} @key{RET}
3057 @vindex org-file-apps
3058 Open link at point. This will launch a web browser for URLs (using
3059 @command{browse-url-at-point}), run VM/MH-E/Wanderlust/Rmail/Gnus/BBDB for
3060 the corresponding links, and execute the command in a shell link. When the
3061 cursor is on an internal link, this command runs the corresponding search.
3062 When the cursor is on a TAG list in a headline, it creates the corresponding
3063 TAGS view. If the cursor is on a timestamp, it compiles the agenda for that
3064 date. Furthermore, it will visit text and remote files in @samp{file:} links
3065 with Emacs and select a suitable application for local non-text files.
3066 Classification of files is based on file extension only. See option
3067 @code{org-file-apps}. If you want to override the default application and
3068 visit the file with Emacs, use a @kbd{C-u} prefix. If you want to avoid
3069 opening in Emacs, use a @kbd{C-u C-u} prefix.@*
3070 If the cursor is on a headline, but not on a link, offer all links in the
3071 headline and entry text.
3072 @c
3073 @kindex mouse-2
3074 @kindex mouse-1
3075 @item mouse-2
3076 @itemx mouse-1
3077 On links, @kbd{mouse-2} will open the link just as @kbd{C-c C-o}
3078 would. Under Emacs 22, @kbd{mouse-1} will also follow a link.
3079 @c
3080 @kindex mouse-3
3081 @item mouse-3
3082 @vindex org-display-internal-link-with-indirect-buffer
3083 Like @kbd{mouse-2}, but force file links to be opened with Emacs, and
3084 internal links to be displayed in another window@footnote{See the
3085 variable @code{org-display-internal-link-with-indirect-buffer}}.
3086 @c
3087 @cindex inlining images
3088 @cindex images, inlining
3089 @kindex C-c C-x C-v
3090 @item C-c C-x C-v
3091 Toggle the inline display of linked images. Normally this will only inline
3092 images that have no description part in the link, i.e. images that will also
3093 be inlined during export. When called with a prefix argument, also display
3094 images that do have a link description.
3095 @cindex mark ring
3096 @kindex C-c %
3097 @item C-c %
3098 Push the current position onto the mark ring, to be able to return
3099 easily. Commands following an internal link do this automatically.
3100 @c
3101 @cindex links, returning to
3102 @kindex C-c &
3103 @item C-c &
3104 Jump back to a recorded position. A position is recorded by the
3105 commands following internal links, and by @kbd{C-c %}. Using this
3106 command several times in direct succession moves through a ring of
3107 previously recorded positions.
3108 @c
3109 @kindex C-c C-x C-n
3110 @kindex C-c C-x C-p
3111 @cindex links, finding next/previous
3112 @item C-c C-x C-n
3113 @itemx C-c C-x C-p
3114 Move forward/backward to the next link in the buffer. At the limit of
3115 the buffer, the search fails once, and then wraps around. The key
3116 bindings for this are really too long, you might want to bind this also
3117 to @kbd{C-n} and @kbd{C-p}
3118 @lisp
3119 (add-hook 'org-load-hook
3120 (lambda ()
3121 (define-key 'org-mode-map "\C-n" 'org-next-link)
3122 (define-key 'org-mode-map "\C-p" 'org-previous-link)))
3123 @end lisp
3124 @end table
3125
3126 @node Using links outside Org, Link abbreviations, Handling links, Hyperlinks
3127 @section Using links outside Org
3128
3129 You can insert and follow links that have Org syntax not only in
3130 Org, but in any Emacs buffer. For this, you should create two
3131 global commands, like this (please select suitable global keys
3132 yourself):
3133
3134 @lisp
3135 (global-set-key "\C-c L" 'org-insert-link-global)
3136 (global-set-key "\C-c o" 'org-open-at-point-global)
3137 @end lisp
3138
3139 @node Link abbreviations, Search options, Using links outside Org, Hyperlinks
3140 @section Link abbreviations
3141 @cindex link abbreviations
3142 @cindex abbreviation, links
3143
3144 Long URLs can be cumbersome to type, and often many similar links are
3145 needed in a document. For this you can use link abbreviations. An
3146 abbreviated link looks like this
3147
3148 @example
3149 [[linkword:tag][description]]
3150 @end example
3151
3152 @noindent
3153 @vindex org-link-abbrev-alist
3154 where the tag is optional.
3155 The @i{linkword} must be a word, starting with a letter, followed by
3156 letters, numbers, @samp{-}, and @samp{_}. Abbreviations are resolved
3157 according to the information in the variable @code{org-link-abbrev-alist}
3158 that relates the linkwords to replacement text. Here is an example:
3159
3160 @lisp
3161 @group
3162 (setq org-link-abbrev-alist
3163 '(("bugzilla" . "http://10.1.2.9/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=")
3164 ("google" . "http://www.google.com/search?q=")
3165 ("ads" . "http://adsabs.harvard.edu/cgi-bin/
3166 nph-abs_connect?author=%s&db_key=AST")))
3167 @end group
3168 @end lisp
3169
3170 If the replacement text contains the string @samp{%s}, it will be
3171 replaced with the tag. Otherwise the tag will be appended to the string
3172 in order to create the link. You may also specify a function that will
3173 be called with the tag as the only argument to create the link.
3174
3175 With the above setting, you could link to a specific bug with
3176 @code{[[bugzilla:129]]}, search the web for @samp{OrgMode} with
3177 @code{[[google:OrgMode]]} and find out what the Org author is
3178 doing besides Emacs hacking with @code{[[ads:Dominik,C]]}.
3179
3180 If you need special abbreviations just for a single Org buffer, you
3181 can define them in the file with
3182
3183 @cindex #+LINK
3184 @example
3185 #+LINK: bugzilla http://10.1.2.9/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=
3186 #+LINK: google http://www.google.com/search?q=%s
3187 @end example
3188
3189 @noindent
3190 In-buffer completion (@pxref{Completion}) can be used after @samp{[} to
3191 complete link abbreviations. You may also define a function
3192 @code{org-PREFIX-complete-link} that implements special (e.g. completion)
3193 support for inserting such a link with @kbd{C-c C-l}. Such a function should
3194 not accept any arguments, and return the full link with prefix.
3195
3196 @node Search options, Custom searches, Link abbreviations, Hyperlinks
3197 @section Search options in file links
3198 @cindex search option in file links
3199 @cindex file links, searching
3200
3201 File links can contain additional information to make Emacs jump to a
3202 particular location in the file when following a link. This can be a
3203 line number or a search option after a double@footnote{For backward
3204 compatibility, line numbers can also follow a single colon.} colon. For
3205 example, when the command @kbd{C-c l} creates a link (@pxref{Handling
3206 links}) to a file, it encodes the words in the current line as a search
3207 string that can be used to find this line back later when following the
3208 link with @kbd{C-c C-o}.
3209
3210 Here is the syntax of the different ways to attach a search to a file
3211 link, together with an explanation:
3212
3213 @example
3214 [[file:~/code/main.c::255]]
3215 [[file:~/xx.org::My Target]]
3216 [[file:~/xx.org::*My Target]]
3217 [[file:~/xx.org::#my-custom-id]]
3218 [[file:~/xx.org::/regexp/]]
3219 @end example
3220
3221 @table @code
3222 @item 255
3223 Jump to line 255.
3224 @item My Target
3225 Search for a link target @samp{<<My Target>>}, or do a text search for
3226 @samp{my target}, similar to the search in internal links, see
3227 @ref{Internal links}. In HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}), such a file
3228 link will become an HTML reference to the corresponding named anchor in
3229 the linked file.
3230 @item *My Target
3231 In an Org file, restrict search to headlines.
3232 @item #my-custom-id
3233 Link to a heading with a @code{CUSTOM_ID} property
3234 @item /regexp/
3235 Do a regular expression search for @code{regexp}. This uses the Emacs
3236 command @code{occur} to list all matches in a separate window. If the
3237 target file is in Org-mode, @code{org-occur} is used to create a
3238 sparse tree with the matches.
3239 @c If the target file is a directory,
3240 @c @code{grep} will be used to search all files in the directory.
3241 @end table
3242
3243 As a degenerate case, a file link with an empty file name can be used
3244 to search the current file. For example, @code{[[file:::find me]]} does
3245 a search for @samp{find me} in the current file, just as
3246 @samp{[[find me]]} would.
3247
3248 @node Custom searches, , Search options, Hyperlinks
3249 @section Custom Searches
3250 @cindex custom search strings
3251 @cindex search strings, custom
3252
3253 The default mechanism for creating search strings and for doing the
3254 actual search related to a file link may not work correctly in all
3255 cases. For example, Bib@TeX{} database files have many entries like
3256 @samp{year="1993"} which would not result in good search strings,
3257 because the only unique identification for a Bib@TeX{} entry is the
3258 citation key.
3259
3260 @vindex org-create-file-search-functions
3261 @vindex org-execute-file-search-functions
3262 If you come across such a problem, you can write custom functions to set
3263 the right search string for a particular file type, and to do the search
3264 for the string in the file. Using @code{add-hook}, these functions need
3265 to be added to the hook variables
3266 @code{org-create-file-search-functions} and
3267 @code{org-execute-file-search-functions}. See the docstring for these
3268 variables for more information. Org actually uses this mechanism
3269 for Bib@TeX{} database files, and you can use the corresponding code as
3270 an implementation example. See the file @file{org-bibtex.el}.
3271
3272 @node TODO Items, Tags, Hyperlinks, Top
3273 @chapter TODO items
3274 @cindex TODO items
3275
3276 Org-mode does not maintain TODO lists as separate documents@footnote{Of
3277 course, you can make a document that contains only long lists of TODO items,
3278 but this is not required.}. Instead, TODO items are an integral part of the
3279 notes file, because TODO items usually come up while taking notes! With Org
3280 mode, simply mark any entry in a tree as being a TODO item. In this way,
3281 information is not duplicated, and the entire context from which the TODO
3282 item emerged is always present.
3283
3284 Of course, this technique for managing TODO items scatters them
3285 throughout your notes file. Org-mode compensates for this by providing
3286 methods to give you an overview of all the things that you have to do.
3287
3288 @menu
3289 * TODO basics:: Marking and displaying TODO entries
3290 * TODO extensions:: Workflow and assignments
3291 * Progress logging:: Dates and notes for progress
3292 * Priorities:: Some things are more important than others
3293 * Breaking down tasks:: Splitting a task into manageable pieces
3294 * Checkboxes:: Tick-off lists
3295 @end menu
3296
3297 @node TODO basics, TODO extensions, TODO Items, TODO Items
3298 @section Basic TODO functionality
3299
3300 Any headline becomes a TODO item when it starts with the word
3301 @samp{TODO}, for example:
3302
3303 @example
3304 *** TODO Write letter to Sam Fortune
3305 @end example
3306
3307 @noindent
3308 The most important commands to work with TODO entries are:
3309
3310 @table @kbd
3311 @kindex C-c C-t
3312 @cindex cycling, of TODO states
3313 @item C-c C-t
3314 Rotate the TODO state of the current item among
3315
3316 @example
3317 ,-> (unmarked) -> TODO -> DONE --.
3318 '--------------------------------'
3319 @end example
3320
3321 The same rotation can also be done ``remotely'' from the timeline and
3322 agenda buffers with the @kbd{t} command key (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
3323
3324 @kindex C-u C-c C-t
3325 @item C-u C-c C-t
3326 Select a specific keyword using completion or (if it has been set up)
3327 the fast selection interface. For the latter, you need to assign keys
3328 to TODO states, see @ref{Per-file keywords}, and @ref{Setting tags}, for
3329 more information.
3330
3331 @kindex S-@key{right}
3332 @kindex S-@key{left}
3333 @vindex org-treat-S-cursor-todo-selection-as-state-change
3334 @item S-@key{right}
3335 @itemx S-@key{left}
3336 Select the following/preceding TODO state, similar to cycling. Useful
3337 mostly if more than two TODO states are possible (@pxref{TODO
3338 extensions}). See also @ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction
3339 with @code{shift-selection-mode}. See also the variable
3340 @code{org-treat-S-cursor-todo-selection-as-state-change}.
3341 @kindex C-c / t
3342 @cindex sparse tree, for TODO
3343 @itemx C-c / t
3344 @vindex org-todo-keywords
3345 View TODO items in a @emph{sparse tree} (@pxref{Sparse trees}). Folds the
3346 entire buffer, but shows all TODO items (with not-DONE state) and the
3347 headings hierarchy above them. With a prefix argument (or by using @kbd{C-c
3348 / T}), search for a specific TODO. You will be prompted for the keyword, and
3349 you can also give a list of keywords like @code{KWD1|KWD2|...} to list
3350 entries that match any one of these keywords. With numeric prefix argument
3351 N, show the tree for the Nth keyword in the variable
3352 @code{org-todo-keywords}. With two prefix arguments, find all TODO states,
3353 both un-done and done.
3354 @kindex C-c a t
3355 @item C-c a t
3356 Show the global TODO list. Collects the TODO items (with not-DONE states)
3357 from all agenda files (@pxref{Agenda Views}) into a single buffer. The new
3358 buffer will be in @code{agenda-mode}, which provides commands to examine and
3359 manipulate the TODO entries from the new buffer (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
3360 @xref{Global TODO list}, for more information.
3361 @kindex S-M-@key{RET}
3362 @item S-M-@key{RET}
3363 Insert a new TODO entry below the current one.
3364 @end table
3365
3366 @noindent
3367 @vindex org-todo-state-tags-triggers
3368 Changing a TODO state can also trigger tag changes. See the docstring of the
3369 option @code{org-todo-state-tags-triggers} for details.
3370
3371 @node TODO extensions, Progress logging, TODO basics, TODO Items
3372 @section Extended use of TODO keywords
3373 @cindex extended TODO keywords
3374
3375 @vindex org-todo-keywords
3376 By default, marked TODO entries have one of only two states: TODO and
3377 DONE. Org-mode allows you to classify TODO items in more complex ways
3378 with @emph{TODO keywords} (stored in @code{org-todo-keywords}). With
3379 special setup, the TODO keyword system can work differently in different
3380 files.
3381
3382 Note that @i{tags} are another way to classify headlines in general and
3383 TODO items in particular (@pxref{Tags}).
3384
3385 @menu
3386 * Workflow states:: From TODO to DONE in steps
3387 * TODO types:: I do this, Fred does the rest
3388 * Multiple sets in one file:: Mixing it all, and still finding your way
3389 * Fast access to TODO states:: Single letter selection of a state
3390 * Per-file keywords:: Different files, different requirements
3391 * Faces for TODO keywords:: Highlighting states
3392 * TODO dependencies:: When one task needs to wait for others
3393 @end menu
3394
3395 @node Workflow states, TODO types, TODO extensions, TODO extensions
3396 @subsection TODO keywords as workflow states
3397 @cindex TODO workflow
3398 @cindex workflow states as TODO keywords
3399
3400 You can use TODO keywords to indicate different @emph{sequential} states
3401 in the process of working on an item, for example@footnote{Changing
3402 this variable only becomes effective after restarting Org-mode in a
3403 buffer.}:
3404
3405 @lisp
3406 (setq org-todo-keywords
3407 '((sequence "TODO" "FEEDBACK" "VERIFY" "|" "DONE" "DELEGATED")))
3408 @end lisp
3409
3410 The vertical bar separates the TODO keywords (states that @emph{need
3411 action}) from the DONE states (which need @emph{no further action}). If
3412 you don't provide the separator bar, the last state is used as the DONE
3413 state.
3414 @cindex completion, of TODO keywords
3415 With this setup, the command @kbd{C-c C-t} will cycle an entry from TODO
3416 to FEEDBACK, then to VERIFY, and finally to DONE and DELEGATED. You may
3417 also use a numeric prefix argument to quickly select a specific state. For
3418 example @kbd{C-3 C-c C-t} will change the state immediately to VERIFY.
3419 Or you can use @kbd{S-@key{left}} to go backward through the sequence. If you
3420 define many keywords, you can use in-buffer completion
3421 (@pxref{Completion}) or even a special one-key selection scheme
3422 (@pxref{Fast access to TODO states}) to insert these words into the
3423 buffer. Changing a TODO state can be logged with a timestamp, see
3424 @ref{Tracking TODO state changes}, for more information.
3425
3426 @node TODO types, Multiple sets in one file, Workflow states, TODO extensions
3427 @subsection TODO keywords as types
3428 @cindex TODO types
3429 @cindex names as TODO keywords
3430 @cindex types as TODO keywords
3431
3432 The second possibility is to use TODO keywords to indicate different
3433 @emph{types} of action items. For example, you might want to indicate
3434 that items are for ``work'' or ``home''. Or, when you work with several
3435 people on a single project, you might want to assign action items
3436 directly to persons, by using their names as TODO keywords. This would
3437 be set up like this:
3438
3439 @lisp
3440 (setq org-todo-keywords '((type "Fred" "Sara" "Lucy" "|" "DONE")))
3441 @end lisp
3442
3443 In this case, different keywords do not indicate a sequence, but rather
3444 different types. So the normal work flow would be to assign a task to a
3445 person, and later to mark it DONE. Org-mode supports this style by adapting
3446 the workings of the command @kbd{C-c C-t}@footnote{This is also true for the
3447 @kbd{t} command in the timeline and agenda buffers.}. When used several
3448 times in succession, it will still cycle through all names, in order to first
3449 select the right type for a task. But when you return to the item after some
3450 time and execute @kbd{C-c C-t} again, it will switch from any name directly
3451 to DONE. Use prefix arguments or completion to quickly select a specific
3452 name. You can also review the items of a specific TODO type in a sparse tree
3453 by using a numeric prefix to @kbd{C-c / t}. For example, to see all things
3454 Lucy has to do, you would use @kbd{C-3 C-c / t}. To collect Lucy's items
3455 from all agenda files into a single buffer, you would use the numeric prefix
3456 argument as well when creating the global TODO list: @kbd{C-3 C-c a t}.
3457
3458 @node Multiple sets in one file, Fast access to TODO states, TODO types, TODO extensions
3459 @subsection Multiple keyword sets in one file
3460 @cindex TODO keyword sets
3461
3462 Sometimes you may want to use different sets of TODO keywords in
3463 parallel. For example, you may want to have the basic
3464 @code{TODO}/@code{DONE}, but also a workflow for bug fixing, and a
3465 separate state indicating that an item has been canceled (so it is not
3466 DONE, but also does not require action). Your setup would then look
3467 like this:
3468
3469 @lisp
3470 (setq org-todo-keywords
3471 '((sequence "TODO" "|" "DONE")
3472 (sequence "REPORT" "BUG" "KNOWNCAUSE" "|" "FIXED")
3473 (sequence "|" "CANCELED")))
3474 @end lisp
3475
3476 The keywords should all be different, this helps Org-mode to keep track
3477 of which subsequence should be used for a given entry. In this setup,
3478 @kbd{C-c C-t} only operates within a subsequence, so it switches from
3479 @code{DONE} to (nothing) to @code{TODO}, and from @code{FIXED} to
3480 (nothing) to @code{REPORT}. Therefore you need a mechanism to initially
3481 select the correct sequence. Besides the obvious ways like typing a
3482 keyword or using completion, you may also apply the following commands:
3483
3484 @table @kbd
3485 @kindex C-S-@key{right}
3486 @kindex C-S-@key{left}
3487 @kindex C-u C-u C-c C-t
3488 @item C-u C-u C-c C-t
3489 @itemx C-S-@key{right}
3490 @itemx C-S-@key{left}
3491 These keys jump from one TODO subset to the next. In the above example,
3492 @kbd{C-u C-u C-c C-t} or @kbd{C-S-@key{right}} would jump from @code{TODO} or
3493 @code{DONE} to @code{REPORT}, and any of the words in the second row to
3494 @code{CANCELED}. Note that the @kbd{C-S-} key binding conflict with
3495 @code{shift-selection-mode} (@pxref{Conflicts}).
3496 @kindex S-@key{right}
3497 @kindex S-@key{left}
3498 @item S-@key{right}
3499 @itemx S-@key{left}
3500 @kbd{S-@key{<left>}} and @kbd{S-@key{<right>}} and walk through @emph{all}
3501 keywords from all sets, so for example @kbd{S-@key{<right>}} would switch
3502 from @code{DONE} to @code{REPORT} in the example above. See also
3503 @ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction with
3504 @code{shift-selection-mode}.
3505 @end table
3506
3507 @node Fast access to TODO states, Per-file keywords, Multiple sets in one file, TODO extensions
3508 @subsection Fast access to TODO states
3509
3510 If you would like to quickly change an entry to an arbitrary TODO state
3511 instead of cycling through the states, you can set up keys for
3512 single-letter access to the states. This is done by adding the section
3513 key after each keyword, in parentheses. For example:
3514
3515 @lisp
3516 (setq org-todo-keywords
3517 '((sequence "TODO(t)" "|" "DONE(d)")
3518 (sequence "REPORT(r)" "BUG(b)" "KNOWNCAUSE(k)" "|" "FIXED(f)")
3519 (sequence "|" "CANCELED(c)")))
3520 @end lisp
3521
3522 @vindex org-fast-tag-selection-include-todo
3523 If you then press @code{C-c C-t} followed by the selection key, the entry
3524 will be switched to this state. @key{SPC} can be used to remove any TODO
3525 keyword from an entry.@footnote{Check also the variable
3526 @code{org-fast-tag-selection-include-todo}, it allows you to change the TODO
3527 state through the tags interface (@pxref{Setting tags}), in case you like to
3528 mingle the two concepts. Note that this means you need to come up with
3529 unique keys across both sets of keywords.}
3530
3531 @node Per-file keywords, Faces for TODO keywords, Fast access to TODO states, TODO extensions
3532 @subsection Setting up keywords for individual files
3533 @cindex keyword options
3534 @cindex per-file keywords
3535 @cindex #+TODO
3536 @cindex #+TYP_TODO
3537 @cindex #+SEQ_TODO
3538
3539 It can be very useful to use different aspects of the TODO mechanism in
3540 different files. For file-local settings, you need to add special lines
3541 to the file which set the keywords and interpretation for that file
3542 only. For example, to set one of the two examples discussed above, you
3543 need one of the following lines, starting in column zero anywhere in the
3544 file:
3545
3546 @example
3547 #+TODO: TODO FEEDBACK VERIFY | DONE CANCELED
3548 @end example
3549 @noindent (you may also write @code{#+SEQ_TODO} to be explicit about the
3550 interpretation, but it means the same as @code{#+TODO}), or
3551 @example
3552 #+TYP_TODO: Fred Sara Lucy Mike | DONE
3553 @end example
3554
3555 A setup for using several sets in parallel would be:
3556
3557 @example
3558 #+TODO: TODO | DONE
3559 #+TODO: REPORT BUG KNOWNCAUSE | FIXED
3560 #+TODO: | CANCELED
3561 @end example
3562
3563 @cindex completion, of option keywords
3564 @kindex M-@key{TAB}
3565 @noindent To make sure you are using the correct keyword, type
3566 @samp{#+} into the buffer and then use @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} completion.
3567
3568 @cindex DONE, final TODO keyword
3569 Remember that the keywords after the vertical bar (or the last keyword
3570 if no bar is there) must always mean that the item is DONE (although you
3571 may use a different word). After changing one of these lines, use
3572 @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the line to make the changes
3573 known to Org-mode@footnote{Org-mode parses these lines only when
3574 Org-mode is activated after visiting a file. @kbd{C-c C-c} with the
3575 cursor in a line starting with @samp{#+} is simply restarting Org-mode
3576 for the current buffer.}.
3577
3578 @node Faces for TODO keywords, TODO dependencies, Per-file keywords, TODO extensions
3579 @subsection Faces for TODO keywords
3580 @cindex faces, for TODO keywords
3581
3582 @vindex org-todo @r{(face)}
3583 @vindex org-done @r{(face)}
3584 @vindex org-todo-keyword-faces
3585 Org-mode highlights TODO keywords with special faces: @code{org-todo}
3586 for keywords indicating that an item still has to be acted upon, and
3587 @code{org-done} for keywords indicating that an item is finished. If
3588 you are using more than 2 different states, you might want to use
3589 special faces for some of them. This can be done using the variable
3590 @code{org-todo-keyword-faces}. For example:
3591
3592 @lisp
3593 @group
3594 (setq org-todo-keyword-faces
3595 '(("TODO" . org-warning) ("STARTED" . "yellow")
3596 ("CANCELED" . (:foreground "blue" :weight bold))))
3597 @end group
3598 @end lisp
3599
3600 While using a list with face properties as shown for CANCELED @emph{should}
3601 work, this does not aways seem to be the case. If necessary, define a
3602 special face and use that. A string is interpreted as a color. The variable
3603 @code{org-faces-easy-properties} determines if that color is interpreted as a
3604 foreground or a background color.
3605
3606 @node TODO dependencies, , Faces for TODO keywords, TODO extensions
3607 @subsection TODO dependencies
3608 @cindex TODO dependencies
3609 @cindex dependencies, of TODO states
3610
3611 @vindex org-enforce-todo-dependencies
3612 @cindex property, ORDERED
3613 The structure of Org files (hierarchy and lists) makes it easy to define TODO
3614 dependencies. Usually, a parent TODO task should not be marked DONE until
3615 all subtasks (defined as children tasks) are marked as DONE. And sometimes
3616 there is a logical sequence to a number of (sub)tasks, so that one task
3617 cannot be acted upon before all siblings above it are done. If you customize
3618 the variable @code{org-enforce-todo-dependencies}, Org will block entries
3619 from changing state to DONE while they have children that are not DONE.
3620 Furthermore, if an entry has a property @code{ORDERED}, each of its children
3621 will be blocked until all earlier siblings are marked DONE. Here is an
3622 example:
3623
3624 @example
3625 * TODO Blocked until (two) is done
3626 ** DONE one
3627 ** TODO two
3628
3629 * Parent
3630 :PROPERTIES:
3631 :ORDERED: t
3632 :END:
3633 ** TODO a
3634 ** TODO b, needs to wait for (a)
3635 ** TODO c, needs to wait for (a) and (b)
3636 @end example
3637
3638 @table @kbd
3639 @kindex C-c C-x o
3640 @item C-c C-x o
3641 @vindex org-track-ordered-property-with-tag
3642 @cindex property, ORDERED
3643 Toggle the @code{ORDERED} property of the current entry. A property is used
3644 for this behavior because this should be local to the current entry, not
3645 inherited like a tag. However, if you would like to @i{track} the value of
3646 this property with a tag for better visibility, customize the variable
3647 @code{org-track-ordered-property-with-tag}.
3648 @kindex C-u C-u C-u C-c C-t
3649 @item C-u C-u C-u C-c C-t
3650 Change TODO state, circumventing any state blocking.
3651 @end table
3652
3653 @vindex org-agenda-dim-blocked-tasks
3654 If you set the variable @code{org-agenda-dim-blocked-tasks}, TODO entries
3655 that cannot be closed because of such dependencies will be shown in a dimmed
3656 font or even made invisible in agenda views (@pxref{Agenda Views}).
3657
3658 @cindex checkboxes and TODO dependencies
3659 @vindex org-enforce-todo-dependencies
3660 You can also block changes of TODO states by looking at checkboxes
3661 (@pxref{Checkboxes}). If you set the variable
3662 @code{org-enforce-todo-checkbox-dependencies}, an entry that has unchecked
3663 checkboxes will be blocked from switching to DONE.
3664
3665 If you need more complex dependency structures, for example dependencies
3666 between entries in different trees or files, check out the contributed
3667 module @file{org-depend.el}.
3668
3669 @page
3670 @node Progress logging, Priorities, TODO extensions, TODO Items
3671 @section Progress logging
3672 @cindex progress logging
3673 @cindex logging, of progress
3674
3675 Org-mode can automatically record a timestamp and possibly a note when
3676 you mark a TODO item as DONE, or even each time you change the state of
3677 a TODO item. This system is highly configurable, settings can be on a
3678 per-keyword basis and can be localized to a file or even a subtree. For
3679 information on how to clock working time for a task, see @ref{Clocking
3680 work time}.
3681
3682 @menu
3683 * Closing items:: When was this entry marked DONE?
3684 * Tracking TODO state changes:: When did the status change?
3685 * Tracking your habits:: How consistent have you been?
3686 @end menu
3687
3688 @node Closing items, Tracking TODO state changes, Progress logging, Progress logging
3689 @subsection Closing items
3690
3691 The most basic logging is to keep track of @emph{when} a certain TODO
3692 item was finished. This is achieved with@footnote{The corresponding
3693 in-buffer setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: logdone}}.
3694
3695 @lisp
3696 (setq org-log-done 'time)
3697 @end lisp
3698
3699 @noindent
3700 Then each time you turn an entry from a TODO (not-done) state into any
3701 of the DONE states, a line @samp{CLOSED: [timestamp]} will be inserted
3702 just after the headline. If you turn the entry back into a TODO item
3703 through further state cycling, that line will be removed again. If you
3704 want to record a note along with the timestamp, use@footnote{The
3705 corresponding in-buffer setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: lognotedone}}
3706
3707 @lisp
3708 (setq org-log-done 'note)
3709 @end lisp
3710
3711 @noindent
3712 You will then be prompted for a note, and that note will be stored below
3713 the entry with a @samp{Closing Note} heading.
3714
3715 In the timeline (@pxref{Timeline}) and in the agenda
3716 (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}), you can then use the @kbd{l} key to
3717 display the TODO items with a @samp{CLOSED} timestamp on each day,
3718 giving you an overview of what has been done.
3719
3720 @node Tracking TODO state changes, Tracking your habits, Closing items, Progress logging
3721 @subsection Tracking TODO state changes
3722 @cindex drawer, for state change recording
3723
3724 @vindex org-log-states-order-reversed
3725 @vindex org-log-into-drawer
3726 @cindex property, LOG_INTO_DRAWER
3727 When TODO keywords are used as workflow states (@pxref{Workflow states}), you
3728 might want to keep track of when a state change occurred and maybe take a
3729 note about this change. You can either record just a timestamp, or a
3730 time-stamped note for a change. These records will be inserted after the
3731 headline as an itemized list, newest first@footnote{See the variable
3732 @code{org-log-states-order-reversed}}. When taking a lot of notes, you might
3733 want to get the notes out of the way into a drawer (@pxref{Drawers}).
3734 Customize the variable @code{org-log-into-drawer} to get this
3735 behavior---the recommended drawer for this is called @code{LOGBOOK}. You can
3736 also overrule the setting of this variable for a subtree by setting a
3737 @code{LOG_INTO_DRAWER} property.
3738
3739 Since it is normally too much to record a note for every state, Org-mode
3740 expects configuration on a per-keyword basis for this. This is achieved by
3741 adding special markers @samp{!} (for a timestamp) and @samp{@@} (for a note)
3742 in parentheses after each keyword. For example, with the setting
3743
3744 @lisp
3745 (setq org-todo-keywords
3746 '((sequence "TODO(t)" "WAIT(w@@/!)" "|" "DONE(d!)" "CANCELED(c@@)")))
3747 @end lisp
3748
3749 @noindent
3750 @vindex org-log-done
3751 you not only define global TODO keywords and fast access keys, but also
3752 request that a time is recorded when the entry is set to
3753 DONE@footnote{It is possible that Org-mode will record two timestamps
3754 when you are using both @code{org-log-done} and state change logging.
3755 However, it will never prompt for two notes---if you have configured
3756 both, the state change recording note will take precedence and cancel
3757 the @samp{Closing Note}.}, and that a note is recorded when switching to
3758 WAIT or CANCELED. The setting for WAIT is even more special: the
3759 @samp{!} after the slash means that in addition to the note taken when
3760 entering the state, a timestamp should be recorded when @i{leaving} the
3761 WAIT state, if and only if the @i{target} state does not configure
3762 logging for entering it. So it has no effect when switching from WAIT
3763 to DONE, because DONE is configured to record a timestamp only. But
3764 when switching from WAIT back to TODO, the @samp{/!} in the WAIT
3765 setting now triggers a timestamp even though TODO has no logging
3766 configured.
3767
3768 You can use the exact same syntax for setting logging preferences local
3769 to a buffer:
3770 @example
3771 #+TODO: TODO(t) WAIT(w@@/!) | DONE(d!) CANCELED(c@@)
3772 @end example
3773
3774 @cindex property, LOGGING
3775 In order to define logging settings that are local to a subtree or a
3776 single item, define a LOGGING property in this entry. Any non-empty
3777 LOGGING property resets all logging settings to nil. You may then turn
3778 on logging for this specific tree using STARTUP keywords like
3779 @code{lognotedone} or @code{logrepeat}, as well as adding state specific
3780 settings like @code{TODO(!)}. For example
3781
3782 @example
3783 * TODO Log each state with only a time
3784 :PROPERTIES:
3785 :LOGGING: TODO(!) WAIT(!) DONE(!) CANCELED(!)
3786 :END:
3787 * TODO Only log when switching to WAIT, and when repeating
3788 :PROPERTIES:
3789 :LOGGING: WAIT(@@) logrepeat
3790 :END:
3791 * TODO No logging at all
3792 :PROPERTIES:
3793 :LOGGING: nil
3794 :END:
3795 @end example
3796
3797 @node Tracking your habits, , Tracking TODO state changes, Progress logging
3798 @subsection Tracking your habits
3799 @cindex habits
3800
3801 Org has the ability to track the consistency of a special category of TODOs,
3802 called ``habits''. A habit has the following properties:
3803
3804 @enumerate
3805 @item
3806 You have enabled the @code{habits} module by customizing the variable
3807 @code{org-modules}.
3808 @item
3809 The habit is a TODO, with a TODO keyword representing an open state.
3810 @item
3811 The property @code{STYLE} is set to the value @code{habit}.
3812 @item
3813 The TODO has a scheduled date, with a @code{.+} style repeat interval.
3814 @item
3815 The TODO may also have minimum and maximum ranges specified by using the
3816 syntax @samp{.+2d/3d}, which says that you want to do the task at least every
3817 three days, but at most every two days.
3818 @item
3819 You must also have state logging for the @code{DONE} state enabled, in order
3820 for historical data to be represented in the consistency graph. If it's not
3821 enabled it's not an error, but the consistency graphs will be largely
3822 meaningless.
3823 @end enumerate
3824
3825 To give you an idea of what the above rules look like in action, here's an
3826 actual habit with some history:
3827
3828 @example
3829 ** TODO Shave
3830 SCHEDULED: <2009-10-17 Sat .+2d/4d>
3831 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-15 Thu]
3832 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-12 Mon]
3833 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-10 Sat]
3834 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-04 Sun]
3835 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-02 Fri]
3836 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-29 Tue]
3837 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-25 Fri]
3838 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-19 Sat]
3839 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-16 Wed]
3840 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-12 Sat]
3841 :PROPERTIES:
3842 :STYLE: habit
3843 :LAST_REPEAT: [2009-10-19 Mon 00:36]
3844 :END:
3845 @end example
3846
3847 What this habit says is: I want to shave at most every 2 days (given by the
3848 @code{SCHEDULED} date and repeat interval) and at least every 4 days. If
3849 today is the 15th, then the habit first appears in the agenda on Oct 17,
3850 after the minimum of 2 days has elapsed, and will appear overdue on Oct 19,
3851 after four days have elapsed.
3852
3853 What's really useful about habits is that they are displayed along with a
3854 consistency graph, to show how consistent you've been at getting that task
3855 done in the past. This graph shows every day that the task was done over the
3856 past three weeks, with colors for each day. The colors used are:
3857
3858 @table @code
3859 @item Blue
3860 If the task wasn't to be done yet on that day.
3861 @item Green
3862 If the task could have been done on that day.
3863 @item Yellow
3864 If the task was going to be overdue the next day.
3865 @item Red
3866 If the task was overdue on that day.
3867 @end table
3868
3869 In addition to coloring each day, the day is also marked with an asterisk if
3870 the task was actually done that day, and an exclamation mark to show where
3871 the current day falls in the graph.
3872
3873 There are several configuration variables that can be used to change the way
3874 habits are displayed in the agenda.
3875
3876 @table @code
3877 @item org-habit-graph-column
3878 The buffer column at which the consistency graph should be drawn. This will
3879 overwrite any text in that column, so it's a good idea to keep your habits'
3880 titles brief and to the point.
3881 @item org-habit-preceding-days
3882 The amount of history, in days before today, to appear in consistency graphs.
3883 @item org-habit-following-days
3884 The number of days after today that will appear in consistency graphs.
3885 @item org-habit-show-habits-only-for-today
3886 If non-nil, only show habits in today's agenda view. This is set to true by
3887 default.
3888 @end table
3889
3890 Lastly, pressing @kbd{K} in the agenda buffer will cause habits to
3891 temporarily be disabled and they won't appear at all. Press @kbd{K} again to
3892 bring them back. They are also subject to tag filtering, if you have habits
3893 which should only be done in certain contexts, for example.
3894
3895 @node Priorities, Breaking down tasks, Progress logging, TODO Items
3896 @section Priorities
3897 @cindex priorities
3898
3899 If you use Org-mode extensively, you may end up with enough TODO items that
3900 it starts to make sense to prioritize them. Prioritizing can be done by
3901 placing a @emph{priority cookie} into the headline of a TODO item, like this
3902
3903 @example
3904 *** TODO [#A] Write letter to Sam Fortune
3905 @end example
3906
3907 @noindent
3908 @vindex org-priority-faces
3909 By default, Org-mode supports three priorities: @samp{A}, @samp{B}, and
3910 @samp{C}. @samp{A} is the highest priority. An entry without a cookie is
3911 treated as priority @samp{B}. Priorities make a difference only in the
3912 agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}); outside the agenda, they have no
3913 inherent meaning to Org-mode. The cookies can be highlighted with special
3914 faces by customizing the variable @code{org-priority-faces}.
3915
3916 Priorities can be attached to any outline tree entries; they do not need
3917 to be TODO items.
3918
3919 @table @kbd
3920 @kindex @kbd{C-c ,}
3921 @item @kbd{C-c ,}
3922 Set the priority of the current headline. The command prompts for a
3923 priority character @samp{A}, @samp{B} or @samp{C}. When you press
3924 @key{SPC} instead, the priority cookie is removed from the headline.
3925 The priorities can also be changed ``remotely'' from the timeline and
3926 agenda buffer with the @kbd{,} command (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
3927 @c
3928 @kindex S-@key{up}
3929 @kindex S-@key{down}
3930 @item S-@key{up}
3931 @itemx S-@key{down}
3932 @vindex org-priority-start-cycle-with-default
3933 Increase/decrease priority of current headline@footnote{See also the option
3934 @code{org-priority-start-cycle-with-default}.}. Note that these keys are
3935 also used to modify timestamps (@pxref{Creating timestamps}). See also
3936 @ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction with
3937 @code{shift-selection-mode}.
3938 @end table
3939
3940 @vindex org-highest-priority
3941 @vindex org-lowest-priority
3942 @vindex org-default-priority
3943 You can change the range of allowed priorities by setting the variables
3944 @code{org-highest-priority}, @code{org-lowest-priority}, and
3945 @code{org-default-priority}. For an individual buffer, you may set
3946 these values (highest, lowest, default) like this (please make sure that
3947 the highest priority is earlier in the alphabet than the lowest
3948 priority):
3949
3950 @cindex #+PRIORITIES
3951 @example
3952 #+PRIORITIES: A C B
3953 @end example
3954
3955 @node Breaking down tasks, Checkboxes, Priorities, TODO Items
3956 @section Breaking tasks down into subtasks
3957 @cindex tasks, breaking down
3958 @cindex statistics, for TODO items
3959
3960 @vindex org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels
3961 It is often advisable to break down large tasks into smaller, manageable
3962 subtasks. You can do this by creating an outline tree below a TODO item,
3963 with detailed subtasks on the tree@footnote{To keep subtasks out of the
3964 global TODO list, see the @code{org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels}.}. To keep
3965 the overview over the fraction of subtasks that are already completed, insert
3966 either @samp{[/]} or @samp{[%]} anywhere in the headline. These cookies will
3967 be updated each time the TODO status of a child changes, or when pressing
3968 @kbd{C-c C-c} on the cookie. For example:
3969
3970 @example
3971 * Organize Party [33%]
3972 ** TODO Call people [1/2]
3973 *** TODO Peter
3974 *** DONE Sarah
3975 ** TODO Buy food
3976 ** DONE Talk to neighbor
3977 @end example
3978
3979 @cindex property, COOKIE_DATA
3980 If a heading has both checkboxes and TODO children below it, the meaning of
3981 the statistics cookie become ambiguous. Set the property
3982 @code{COOKIE_DATA} to either @samp{checkbox} or @samp{todo} to resolve
3983 this issue.
3984
3985 @vindex org-hierarchical-todo-statistics
3986 If you would like to have the statistics cookie count any TODO entries in the
3987 subtree (not just direct children), configure the variable
3988 @code{org-hierarchical-todo-statistics}. To do this for a single subtree,
3989 include the word @samp{recursive} into the value of the @code{COOKIE_DATA}
3990 property.
3991
3992 @example
3993 * Parent capturing statistics [2/20]
3994 :PROPERTIES:
3995 :COOKIE_DATA: todo recursive
3996 :END:
3997 @end example
3998
3999 If you would like a TODO entry to automatically change to DONE
4000 when all children are done, you can use the following setup:
4001
4002 @example
4003 (defun org-summary-todo (n-done n-not-done)
4004 "Switch entry to DONE when all subentries are done, to TODO otherwise."
4005 (let (org-log-done org-log-states) ; turn off logging
4006 (org-todo (if (= n-not-done 0) "DONE" "TODO"))))
4007
4008 (add-hook 'org-after-todo-statistics-hook 'org-summary-todo)
4009 @end example
4010
4011
4012 Another possibility is the use of checkboxes to identify (a hierarchy of) a
4013 large number of subtasks (@pxref{Checkboxes}).
4014
4015
4016 @node Checkboxes, , Breaking down tasks, TODO Items
4017 @section Checkboxes
4018 @cindex checkboxes
4019
4020 Every item in a plain list (@pxref{Plain lists}) can be made into a
4021 checkbox by starting it with the string @samp{[ ]}. This feature is
4022 similar to TODO items (@pxref{TODO Items}), but is more lightweight.
4023 Checkboxes are not included into the global TODO list, so they are often
4024 great to split a task into a number of simple steps. Or you can use
4025 them in a shopping list. To toggle a checkbox, use @kbd{C-c C-c}, or
4026 use the mouse (thanks to Piotr Zielinski's @file{org-mouse.el}).
4027
4028 Here is an example of a checkbox list.
4029
4030 @example
4031 * TODO Organize party [2/4]
4032 - [-] call people [1/3]
4033 - [ ] Peter
4034 - [X] Sarah
4035 - [ ] Sam
4036 - [X] order food
4037 - [ ] think about what music to play
4038 - [X] talk to the neighbors
4039 @end example
4040
4041 Checkboxes work hierarchically, so if a checkbox item has children that
4042 are checkboxes, toggling one of the children checkboxes will make the
4043 parent checkbox reflect if none, some, or all of the children are
4044 checked.
4045
4046 @cindex statistics, for checkboxes
4047 @cindex checkbox statistics
4048 @cindex property, COOKIE_DATA
4049 @vindex org-hierarchical-checkbox-statistics
4050 The @samp{[2/4]} and @samp{[1/3]} in the first and second line are cookies
4051 indicating how many checkboxes present in this entry have been checked off,
4052 and the total number of checkboxes present. This can give you an idea on how
4053 many checkboxes remain, even without opening a folded entry. The cookies can
4054 be placed into a headline or into (the first line of) a plain list item.
4055 Each cookie covers checkboxes of direct children structurally below the
4056 headline/item on which the cookie appears@footnote{Set the variable
4057 @code{org-hierarchical-checkbox-statistics} if you want such cookies to
4058 represent the all checkboxes below the cookie, not just the direct
4059 children.}. You have to insert the cookie yourself by typing either
4060 @samp{[/]} or @samp{[%]}. With @samp{[/]} you get an @samp{n out of m}
4061 result, as in the examples above. With @samp{[%]} you get information about
4062 the percentage of checkboxes checked (in the above example, this would be
4063 @samp{[50%]} and @samp{[33%]}, respectively). In a headline, a cookie can
4064 count either checkboxes below the heading or TODO states of children, and it
4065 will display whatever was changed last. Set the property @code{COOKIE_DATA}
4066 to either @samp{checkbox} or @samp{todo} to resolve this issue.
4067
4068 @cindex blocking, of checkboxes
4069 @cindex checkbox blocking
4070 @cindex property, ORDERED
4071 If the current outline node has an @code{ORDERED} property, checkboxes must
4072 be checked off in sequence, and an error will be thrown if you try to check
4073 off a box while there are unchecked boxes above it.
4074
4075 @noindent The following commands work with checkboxes:
4076
4077 @table @kbd
4078 @kindex C-c C-c
4079 @item C-c C-c
4080 Toggle checkbox status or (with prefix arg) checkbox presence at point. With
4081 double prefix argument, set it to @samp{[-]}, which is considered to be an
4082 intermediate state.
4083 @kindex C-c C-x C-b
4084 @item C-c C-x C-b
4085 Toggle checkbox status or (with prefix arg) checkbox presence at point. With
4086 double prefix argument, set it to @samp{[-]}, which is considered to be an
4087 intermediate state.
4088 @itemize @minus
4089 @item
4090 If there is an active region, toggle the first checkbox in the region
4091 and set all remaining boxes to the same status as the first. With a prefix
4092 arg, add or remove the checkbox for all items in the region.
4093 @item
4094 If the cursor is in a headline, toggle checkboxes in the region between
4095 this headline and the next (so @emph{not} the entire subtree).
4096 @item
4097 If there is no active region, just toggle the checkbox at point.
4098 @end itemize
4099 @kindex M-S-@key{RET}
4100 @item M-S-@key{RET}
4101 Insert a new item with a checkbox.
4102 This works only if the cursor is already in a plain list item
4103 (@pxref{Plain lists}).
4104 @kindex C-c C-x o
4105 @item C-c C-x o
4106 @vindex org-track-ordered-property-with-tag
4107 @cindex property, ORDERED
4108 Toggle the @code{ORDERED} property of the entry, to toggle if checkboxes must
4109 be checked off in sequence. A property is used for this behavior because
4110 this should be local to the current entry, not inherited like a tag.
4111 However, if you would like to @i{track} the value of this property with a tag
4112 for better visibility, customize the variable
4113 @code{org-track-ordered-property-with-tag}.
4114 @kindex C-c #
4115 @item C-c #
4116 Update the statistics cookie in the current outline entry. When called with
4117 a @kbd{C-u} prefix, update the entire file. Checkbox statistic cookies are
4118 updated automatically if you toggle checkboxes with @kbd{C-c C-c} and make
4119 new ones with @kbd{M-S-@key{RET}}. TODO statistics cookies update when
4120 changing TODO states. If you delete boxes/entries or add/change them by
4121 hand, use this command to get things back into sync. Or simply toggle any
4122 entry twice (checkboxes with @kbd{C-c C-c}).
4123 @end table
4124
4125 @node Tags, Properties and Columns, TODO Items, Top
4126 @chapter Tags
4127 @cindex tags
4128 @cindex headline tagging
4129 @cindex matching, tags
4130 @cindex sparse tree, tag based
4131
4132 An excellent way to implement labels and contexts for cross-correlating
4133 information is to assign @i{tags} to headlines. Org-mode has extensive
4134 support for tags.
4135
4136 @vindex org-tag-faces
4137 Every headline can contain a list of tags; they occur at the end of the
4138 headline. Tags are normal words containing letters, numbers, @samp{_}, and
4139 @samp{@@}. Tags must be preceded and followed by a single colon, e.g.,
4140 @samp{:work:}. Several tags can be specified, as in @samp{:work:urgent:}.
4141 Tags will by default be in bold face with the same color as the headline.
4142 You may specify special faces for specific tags using the variable
4143 @code{org-tag-faces}, in much the same way as you can for TODO keywords
4144 (@pxref{Faces for TODO keywords}).
4145
4146 @menu
4147 * Tag inheritance:: Tags use the tree structure of the outline
4148 * Setting tags:: How to assign tags to a headline
4149 * Tag searches:: Searching for combinations of tags
4150 @end menu
4151
4152 @node Tag inheritance, Setting tags, Tags, Tags
4153 @section Tag inheritance
4154 @cindex tag inheritance
4155 @cindex inheritance, of tags
4156 @cindex sublevels, inclusion into tags match
4157
4158 @i{Tags} make use of the hierarchical structure of outline trees. If a
4159 heading has a certain tag, all subheadings will inherit the tag as
4160 well. For example, in the list
4161
4162 @example
4163 * Meeting with the French group :work:
4164 ** Summary by Frank :boss:notes:
4165 *** TODO Prepare slides for him :action:
4166 @end example
4167
4168 @noindent
4169 the final heading will have the tags @samp{:work:}, @samp{:boss:},
4170 @samp{:notes:}, and @samp{:action:} even though the final heading is not
4171 explicitly marked with those tags. You can also set tags that all entries in
4172 a file should inherit just as if these tags were defined in a hypothetical
4173 level zero that surrounds the entire file. Use a line like this@footnote{As
4174 with all these in-buffer settings, pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} activates any
4175 changes in the line.}:
4176
4177 @cindex #+FILETAGS
4178 @example
4179 #+FILETAGS: :Peter:Boss:Secret:
4180 @end example
4181
4182 @noindent
4183 @vindex org-use-tag-inheritance
4184 @vindex org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance
4185 To limit tag inheritance to specific tags, or to turn it off entirely, use
4186 the variables @code{org-use-tag-inheritance} and
4187 @code{org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance}.
4188
4189 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
4190 When a headline matches during a tags search while tag inheritance is turned
4191 on, all the sublevels in the same tree will (for a simple match form) match
4192 as well@footnote{This is only true if the search does not involve more
4193 complex tests including properties (@pxref{Property searches}).}. The list
4194 of matches may then become very long. If you only want to see the first tags
4195 match in a subtree, configure the variable
4196 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels} (not recommended).
4197
4198 @node Setting tags, Tag searches, Tag inheritance, Tags
4199 @section Setting tags
4200 @cindex setting tags
4201 @cindex tags, setting
4202
4203 @kindex M-@key{TAB}
4204 Tags can simply be typed into the buffer at the end of a headline.
4205 After a colon, @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} offers completion on tags. There is
4206 also a special command for inserting tags:
4207
4208 @table @kbd
4209 @kindex C-c C-q
4210 @item C-c C-q
4211 @cindex completion, of tags
4212 @vindex org-tags-column
4213 Enter new tags for the current headline. Org-mode will either offer
4214 completion or a special single-key interface for setting tags, see
4215 below. After pressing @key{RET}, the tags will be inserted and aligned
4216 to @code{org-tags-column}. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, all
4217 tags in the current buffer will be aligned to that column, just to make
4218 things look nice. TAGS are automatically realigned after promotion,
4219 demotion, and TODO state changes (@pxref{TODO basics}).
4220 @kindex C-c C-c
4221 @item C-c C-c
4222 When the cursor is in a headline, this does the same as @kbd{C-c C-q}.
4223 @end table
4224
4225 @vindex org-tag-alist
4226 Org will support tag insertion based on a @emph{list of tags}. By
4227 default this list is constructed dynamically, containing all tags
4228 currently used in the buffer. You may also globally specify a hard list
4229 of tags with the variable @code{org-tag-alist}. Finally you can set
4230 the default tags for a given file with lines like
4231
4232 @cindex #+TAGS
4233 @example
4234 #+TAGS: @@work @@home @@tennisclub
4235 #+TAGS: laptop car pc sailboat
4236 @end example
4237
4238 If you have globally defined your preferred set of tags using the
4239 variable @code{org-tag-alist}, but would like to use a dynamic tag list
4240 in a specific file, add an empty TAGS option line to that file:
4241
4242 @example
4243 #+TAGS:
4244 @end example
4245
4246 @vindex org-tag-persistent-alist
4247 If you have a preferred set of tags that you would like to use in every file,
4248 in addition to those defined on a per-file basis by TAGS option lines, then
4249 you may specify a list of tags with the variable
4250 @code{org-tag-persistent-alist}. You may turn this off on a per-file basis
4251 by adding a STARTUP option line to that file:
4252
4253 @example
4254 #+STARTUP: noptag
4255 @end example
4256
4257 By default Org-mode uses the standard minibuffer completion facilities for
4258 entering tags. However, it also implements another, quicker, tag selection
4259 method called @emph{fast tag selection}. This allows you to select and
4260 deselect tags with just a single key press. For this to work well you should
4261 assign unique letters to most of your commonly used tags. You can do this
4262 globally by configuring the variable @code{org-tag-alist} in your
4263 @file{.emacs} file. For example, you may find the need to tag many items in
4264 different files with @samp{:@@home:}. In this case you can set something
4265 like:
4266
4267 @lisp
4268 (setq org-tag-alist '(("@@work" . ?w) ("@@home" . ?h) ("laptop" . ?l)))
4269 @end lisp
4270
4271 @noindent If the tag is only relevant to the file you are working on, then you
4272 can instead set the TAGS option line as:
4273
4274 @example
4275 #+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) laptop(l) pc(p)
4276 @end example
4277
4278 @noindent The tags interface will show the available tags in a splash
4279 window. If you want to start a new line after a specific tag, insert
4280 @samp{\n} into the tag list
4281
4282 @example
4283 #+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) \n laptop(l) pc(p)
4284 @end example
4285
4286 @noindent or write them in two lines:
4287
4288 @example
4289 #+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t)
4290 #+TAGS: laptop(l) pc(p)
4291 @end example
4292
4293 @noindent
4294 You can also group together tags that are mutually exclusive by using
4295 braces, as in:
4296
4297 @example
4298 #+TAGS: @{ @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) @} laptop(l) pc(p)
4299 @end example
4300
4301 @noindent you indicate that at most one of @samp{@@work}, @samp{@@home},
4302 and @samp{@@tennisclub} should be selected. Multiple such groups are allowed.
4303
4304 @noindent Don't forget to press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor in one of
4305 these lines to activate any changes.
4306
4307 @noindent
4308 To set these mutually exclusive groups in the variable @code{org-tags-alist},
4309 you must use the dummy tags @code{:startgroup} and @code{:endgroup} instead
4310 of the braces. Similarly, you can use @code{:newline} to indicate a line
4311 break. The previous example would be set globally by the following
4312 configuration:
4313
4314 @lisp
4315 (setq org-tag-alist '((:startgroup . nil)
4316 ("@@work" . ?w) ("@@home" . ?h)
4317 ("@@tennisclub" . ?t)
4318 (:endgroup . nil)
4319 ("laptop" . ?l) ("pc" . ?p)))
4320 @end lisp
4321
4322 If at least one tag has a selection key then pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} will
4323 automatically present you with a special interface, listing inherited tags,
4324 the tags of the current headline, and a list of all valid tags with
4325 corresponding keys@footnote{Keys will automatically be assigned to tags which
4326 have no configured keys.}. In this interface, you can use the following
4327 keys:
4328
4329 @table @kbd
4330 @item a-z...
4331 Pressing keys assigned to tags will add or remove them from the list of
4332 tags in the current line. Selecting a tag in a group of mutually
4333 exclusive tags will turn off any other tags from that group.
4334 @kindex @key{TAB}
4335 @item @key{TAB}
4336 Enter a tag in the minibuffer, even if the tag is not in the predefined
4337 list. You will be able to complete on all tags present in the buffer.
4338 @kindex @key{SPC}
4339 @item @key{SPC}
4340 Clear all tags for this line.
4341 @kindex @key{RET}
4342 @item @key{RET}
4343 Accept the modified set.
4344 @item C-g
4345 Abort without installing changes.
4346 @item q
4347 If @kbd{q} is not assigned to a tag, it aborts like @kbd{C-g}.
4348 @item !
4349 Turn off groups of mutually exclusive tags. Use this to (as an
4350 exception) assign several tags from such a group.
4351 @item C-c
4352 Toggle auto-exit after the next change (see below).
4353 If you are using expert mode, the first @kbd{C-c} will display the
4354 selection window.
4355 @end table
4356
4357 @noindent
4358 This method lets you assign tags to a headline with very few keys. With
4359 the above setup, you could clear the current tags and set @samp{@@home},
4360 @samp{laptop} and @samp{pc} tags with just the following keys: @kbd{C-c
4361 C-c @key{SPC} h l p @key{RET}}. Switching from @samp{@@home} to
4362 @samp{@@work} would be done with @kbd{C-c C-c w @key{RET}} or
4363 alternatively with @kbd{C-c C-c C-c w}. Adding the non-predefined tag
4364 @samp{Sarah} could be done with @kbd{C-c C-c @key{TAB} S a r a h
4365 @key{RET} @key{RET}}.
4366
4367 @vindex org-fast-tag-selection-single-key
4368 If you find that most of the time you need only a single key press to
4369 modify your list of tags, set the variable
4370 @code{org-fast-tag-selection-single-key}. Then you no longer have to
4371 press @key{RET} to exit fast tag selection---it will immediately exit
4372 after the first change. If you then occasionally need more keys, press
4373 @kbd{C-c} to turn off auto-exit for the current tag selection process
4374 (in effect: start selection with @kbd{C-c C-c C-c} instead of @kbd{C-c
4375 C-c}). If you set the variable to the value @code{expert}, the special
4376 window is not even shown for single-key tag selection, it comes up only
4377 when you press an extra @kbd{C-c}.
4378
4379 @node Tag searches, , Setting tags, Tags
4380 @section Tag searches
4381 @cindex tag searches
4382 @cindex searching for tags
4383
4384 Once a system of tags has been set up, it can be used to collect related
4385 information into special lists.
4386
4387 @table @kbd
4388 @kindex C-c \
4389 @kindex C-c / m
4390 @item C-c \
4391 @itemx C-c / m
4392 Create a sparse tree with all headlines matching a tags search. With a
4393 @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, ignore headlines that are not a TODO line.
4394 @kindex C-c a m
4395 @item C-c a m
4396 Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files.
4397 @xref{Matching tags and properties}.
4398 @kindex C-c a M
4399 @item C-c a M
4400 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
4401 Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files, but check
4402 only TODO items and force checking subitems (see variable
4403 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}).
4404 @end table
4405
4406 These commands all prompt for a match string which allows basic Boolean logic
4407 like @samp{+boss+urgent-project1}, to find entries with tags @samp{boss} and
4408 @samp{urgent}, but not @samp{project1}, or @samp{Kathy|Sally} to find entries
4409 which are tagged, like @samp{Kathy} or @samp{Sally}. The full syntax of the search
4410 string is rich and allows also matching against TODO keywords, entry levels
4411 and properties. For a complete description with many examples, see
4412 @ref{Matching tags and properties}.
4413
4414
4415 @node Properties and Columns, Dates and Times, Tags, Top
4416 @chapter Properties and columns
4417 @cindex properties
4418
4419 Properties are a set of key-value pairs associated with an entry. There
4420 are two main applications for properties in Org-mode. First, properties
4421 are like tags, but with a value. Second, you can use properties to
4422 implement (very basic) database capabilities in an Org buffer. For
4423 an example of the first application, imagine maintaining a file where
4424 you document bugs and plan releases for a piece of software. Instead of
4425 using tags like @code{:release_1:}, @code{:release_2:}, one can use a
4426 property, say @code{:Release:}, that in different subtrees has different
4427 values, such as @code{1.0} or @code{2.0}. For an example of the second
4428 application of properties, imagine keeping track of your music CDs,
4429 where properties could be things such as the album, artist, date of
4430 release, number of tracks, and so on.
4431
4432 Properties can be conveniently edited and viewed in column view
4433 (@pxref{Column view}).
4434
4435 @menu
4436 * Property syntax:: How properties are spelled out
4437 * Special properties:: Access to other Org-mode features
4438 * Property searches:: Matching property values
4439 * Property inheritance:: Passing values down the tree
4440 * Column view:: Tabular viewing and editing
4441 * Property API:: Properties for Lisp programmers
4442 @end menu
4443
4444 @node Property syntax, Special properties, Properties and Columns, Properties and Columns
4445 @section Property syntax
4446 @cindex property syntax
4447 @cindex drawer, for properties
4448
4449 Properties are key-value pairs. They need to be inserted into a special
4450 drawer (@pxref{Drawers}) with the name @code{PROPERTIES}. Each property
4451 is specified on a single line, with the key (surrounded by colons)
4452 first, and the value after it. Here is an example:
4453
4454 @example
4455 * CD collection
4456 ** Classic
4457 *** Goldberg Variations
4458 :PROPERTIES:
4459 :Title: Goldberg Variations
4460 :Composer: J.S. Bach
4461 :Artist: Glen Gould
4462 :Publisher: Deutsche Grammophon
4463 :NDisks: 1
4464 :END:
4465 @end example
4466
4467 You may define the allowed values for a particular property @samp{:Xyz:}
4468 by setting a property @samp{:Xyz_ALL:}. This special property is
4469 @emph{inherited}, so if you set it in a level 1 entry, it will apply to
4470 the entire tree. When allowed values are defined, setting the
4471 corresponding property becomes easier and is less prone to typing
4472 errors. For the example with the CD collection, we can predefine
4473 publishers and the number of disks in a box like this:
4474
4475 @example
4476 * CD collection
4477 :PROPERTIES:
4478 :NDisks_ALL: 1 2 3 4
4479 :Publisher_ALL: "Deutsche Grammophon" Philips EMI
4480 :END:
4481 @end example
4482
4483 If you want to set properties that can be inherited by any entry in a
4484 file, use a line like
4485 @cindex property, _ALL
4486 @cindex #+PROPERTY
4487 @example
4488 #+PROPERTY: NDisks_ALL 1 2 3 4
4489 @end example
4490
4491 @vindex org-global-properties
4492 Property values set with the global variable
4493 @code{org-global-properties} can be inherited by all entries in all
4494 Org files.
4495
4496 @noindent
4497 The following commands help to work with properties:
4498
4499 @table @kbd
4500 @kindex M-@key{TAB}
4501 @item M-@key{TAB}
4502 After an initial colon in a line, complete property keys. All keys used
4503 in the current file will be offered as possible completions.
4504 @kindex C-c C-x p
4505 @item C-c C-x p
4506 Set a property. This prompts for a property name and a value. If
4507 necessary, the property drawer is created as well.
4508 @item M-x org-insert-property-drawer
4509 Insert a property drawer into the current entry. The drawer will be
4510 inserted early in the entry, but after the lines with planning
4511 information like deadlines.
4512 @kindex C-c C-c
4513 @item C-c C-c
4514 With the cursor in a property drawer, this executes property commands.
4515 @item C-c C-c s
4516 Set a property in the current entry. Both the property and the value
4517 can be inserted using completion.
4518 @kindex S-@key{right}
4519 @kindex S-@key{left}
4520 @item S-@key{left}/@key{right}
4521 Switch property at point to the next/previous allowed value.
4522 @item C-c C-c d
4523 Remove a property from the current entry.
4524 @item C-c C-c D
4525 Globally remove a property, from all entries in the current file.
4526 @item C-c C-c c
4527 Compute the property at point, using the operator and scope from the
4528 nearest column format definition.
4529 @end table
4530
4531 @node Special properties, Property searches, Property syntax, Properties and Columns
4532 @section Special properties
4533 @cindex properties, special
4534
4535 Special properties provide an alternative access method to Org-mode
4536 features, like the TODO state or the priority of an entry, discussed in the
4537 previous chapters. This interface exists so that you can include
4538 these states in a column view (@pxref{Column view}), or to use them in
4539 queries. The following property names are special and should not be
4540 used as keys in the properties drawer:
4541
4542 @cindex property, special, TODO
4543 @cindex property, special, TAGS
4544 @cindex property, special, ALLTAGS
4545 @cindex property, special, CATEGORY
4546 @cindex property, special, PRIORITY
4547 @cindex property, special, DEADLINE
4548 @cindex property, special, SCHEDULED
4549 @cindex property, special, CLOSED
4550 @cindex property, special, TIMESTAMP
4551 @cindex property, special, TIMESTAMP_IA
4552 @cindex property, special, CLOCKSUM
4553 @cindex property, special, BLOCKED
4554 @c guessing that ITEM is needed in this area; also, should this list be sorted?
4555 @cindex property, special, ITEM
4556 @example
4557 TODO @r{The TODO keyword of the entry.}
4558 TAGS @r{The tags defined directly in the headline.}
4559 ALLTAGS @r{All tags, including inherited ones.}
4560 CATEGORY @r{The category of an entry.}
4561 PRIORITY @r{The priority of the entry, a string with a single letter.}
4562 DEADLINE @r{The deadline time string, without the angular brackets.}
4563 SCHEDULED @r{The scheduling timestamp, without the angular brackets.}
4564 CLOSED @r{When was this entry closed?}
4565 TIMESTAMP @r{The first keyword-less timestamp in the entry.}
4566 TIMESTAMP_IA @r{The first inactive timestamp in the entry.}
4567 CLOCKSUM @r{The sum of CLOCK intervals in the subtree. @code{org-clock-sum}}
4568 @r{must be run first to compute the values.}
4569 BLOCKED @r{"t" if task is currently blocked by children or siblings}
4570 ITEM @r{The content of the entry.}
4571 @end example
4572
4573 @node Property searches, Property inheritance, Special properties, Properties and Columns
4574 @section Property searches
4575 @cindex properties, searching
4576 @cindex searching, of properties
4577
4578 To create sparse trees and special lists with selection based on properties,
4579 the same commands are used as for tag searches (@pxref{Tag searches}).
4580 @table @kbd
4581 @kindex C-c \
4582 @kindex C-c / m
4583 @item C-c \
4584 @itemx C-c / m
4585 Create a sparse tree with all matching entries. With a
4586 @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, ignore headlines that are not a TODO line.
4587 @kindex C-c a m
4588 @item C-c a m
4589 Create a global list of tag/property matches from all agenda files.
4590 @xref{Matching tags and properties}.
4591 @kindex C-c a M
4592 @item C-c a M
4593 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
4594 Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files, but check
4595 only TODO items and force checking of subitems (see variable
4596 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}).
4597 @end table
4598
4599 The syntax for the search string is described in @ref{Matching tags and
4600 properties}.
4601
4602 There is also a special command for creating sparse trees based on a
4603 single property:
4604
4605 @table @kbd
4606 @kindex C-c / p
4607 @item C-c / p
4608 Create a sparse tree based on the value of a property. This first
4609 prompts for the name of a property, and then for a value. A sparse tree
4610 is created with all entries that define this property with the given
4611 value. If you enclose the value into curly braces, it is interpreted as
4612 a regular expression and matched against the property values.
4613 @end table
4614
4615 @node Property inheritance, Column view, Property searches, Properties and Columns
4616 @section Property Inheritance
4617 @cindex properties, inheritance
4618 @cindex inheritance, of properties
4619
4620 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
4621 The outline structure of Org-mode documents lends itself for an
4622 inheritance model of properties: if the parent in a tree has a certain
4623 property, the children can inherit this property. Org-mode does not
4624 turn this on by default, because it can slow down property searches
4625 significantly and is often not needed. However, if you find inheritance
4626 useful, you can turn it on by setting the variable
4627 @code{org-use-property-inheritance}. It may be set to @code{t} to make
4628 all properties inherited from the parent, to a list of properties
4629 that should be inherited, or to a regular expression that matches
4630 inherited properties. If a property has the value @samp{nil}, this is
4631 interpreted as an explicit undefine of he property, so that inheritance
4632 search will stop at this value and return @code{nil}.
4633
4634 Org-mode has a few properties for which inheritance is hard-coded, at
4635 least for the special applications for which they are used:
4636
4637 @cindex property, COLUMNS
4638 @table @code
4639 @item COLUMNS
4640 The @code{:COLUMNS:} property defines the format of column view
4641 (@pxref{Column view}). It is inherited in the sense that the level
4642 where a @code{:COLUMNS:} property is defined is used as the starting
4643 point for a column view table, independently of the location in the
4644 subtree from where columns view is turned on.
4645 @item CATEGORY
4646 @cindex property, CATEGORY
4647 For agenda view, a category set through a @code{:CATEGORY:} property
4648 applies to the entire subtree.
4649 @item ARCHIVE
4650 @cindex property, ARCHIVE
4651 For archiving, the @code{:ARCHIVE:} property may define the archive
4652 location for the entire subtree (@pxref{Moving subtrees}).
4653 @item LOGGING
4654 @cindex property, LOGGING
4655 The LOGGING property may define logging settings for an entry or a
4656 subtree (@pxref{Tracking TODO state changes}).
4657 @end table
4658
4659 @node Column view, Property API, Property inheritance, Properties and Columns
4660 @section Column view
4661
4662 A great way to view and edit properties in an outline tree is
4663 @emph{column view}. In column view, each outline node is turned into a
4664 table row. Columns in this table provide access to properties of the
4665 entries. Org-mode implements columns by overlaying a tabular structure
4666 over the headline of each item. While the headlines have been turned
4667 into a table row, you can still change the visibility of the outline
4668 tree. For example, you get a compact table by switching to CONTENTS
4669 view (@kbd{S-@key{TAB} S-@key{TAB}}, or simply @kbd{c} while column view
4670 is active), but you can still open, read, and edit the entry below each
4671 headline. Or, you can switch to column view after executing a sparse
4672 tree command and in this way get a table only for the selected items.
4673 Column view also works in agenda buffers (@pxref{Agenda Views}) where
4674 queries have collected selected items, possibly from a number of files.
4675
4676 @menu
4677 * Defining columns:: The COLUMNS format property
4678 * Using column view:: How to create and use column view
4679 * Capturing column view:: A dynamic block for column view
4680 @end menu
4681
4682 @node Defining columns, Using column view, Column view, Column view
4683 @subsection Defining columns
4684 @cindex column view, for properties
4685 @cindex properties, column view
4686
4687 Setting up a column view first requires defining the columns. This is
4688 done by defining a column format line.
4689
4690 @menu
4691 * Scope of column definitions:: Where defined, where valid?
4692 * Column attributes:: Appearance and content of a column
4693 @end menu
4694
4695 @node Scope of column definitions, Column attributes, Defining columns, Defining columns
4696 @subsubsection Scope of column definitions
4697
4698 To define a column format for an entire file, use a line like
4699
4700 @cindex #+COLUMNS
4701 @example
4702 #+COLUMNS: %25ITEM %TAGS %PRIORITY %TODO
4703 @end example
4704
4705 To specify a format that only applies to a specific tree, add a
4706 @code{:COLUMNS:} property to the top node of that tree, for example:
4707
4708 @example
4709 ** Top node for columns view
4710 :PROPERTIES:
4711 :COLUMNS: %25ITEM %TAGS %PRIORITY %TODO
4712 :END:
4713 @end example
4714
4715 If a @code{:COLUMNS:} property is present in an entry, it defines columns
4716 for the entry itself, and for the entire subtree below it. Since the
4717 column definition is part of the hierarchical structure of the document,
4718 you can define columns on level 1 that are general enough for all
4719 sublevels, and more specific columns further down, when you edit a
4720 deeper part of the tree.
4721
4722 @node Column attributes, , Scope of column definitions, Defining columns
4723 @subsubsection Column attributes
4724 A column definition sets the attributes of a column. The general
4725 definition looks like this:
4726
4727 @example
4728 %[@var{width}]@var{property}[(@var{title})][@{@var{summary-type}@}]
4729 @end example
4730
4731 @noindent
4732 Except for the percent sign and the property name, all items are
4733 optional. The individual parts have the following meaning:
4734
4735 @example
4736 @var{width} @r{An integer specifying the width of the column in characters.}
4737 @r{If omitted, the width will be determined automatically.}
4738 @var{property} @r{The property that should be edited in this column.}
4739 @r{Special properties representing meta data are allowed here}
4740 @r{as well (@pxref{Special properties})}
4741 (title) @r{The header text for the column. If omitted, the}
4742 @r{property name is used.}
4743 @{@var{summary-type}@} @r{The summary type. If specified, the column values for}
4744 @r{parent nodes are computed from the children.}
4745 @r{Supported summary types are:}
4746 @{+@} @r{Sum numbers in this column.}
4747 @{+;%.1f@} @r{Like @samp{+}, but format result with @samp{%.1f}.}
4748 @{$@} @r{Currency, short for @samp{+;%.2f}.}
4749 @{:@} @r{Sum times, HH:MM, plain numbers are hours.}
4750 @{X@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[X]} if all children are @samp{[X]}.}
4751 @{X/@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[n/m]}.}
4752 @{X%@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[n%]}.}
4753 @{min@} @r{Smallest number in column.}
4754 @{max@} @r{Largest number.}
4755 @{mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of numbers.}
4756 @{:min@} @r{Smallest time value in column.}
4757 @{:max@} @r{Largest time value.}
4758 @{:mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of time values.}
4759 @{@@min@} @r{Minimum age (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
4760 @{@@max@} @r{Maximum age (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
4761 @{@@mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of ages (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
4762 @end example
4763
4764 @noindent
4765 Be aware that you can only have one summary type for any property you
4766 include. Subsequent columns referencing the same property will all display the
4767 same summary information.
4768
4769 Here is an example for a complete columns definition, along with allowed
4770 values.
4771
4772 @example
4773 :COLUMNS: %25ITEM %9Approved(Approved?)@{X@} %Owner %11Status \@footnote{Please note that the COLUMNS definition must be on a single line---it is wrapped here only because of formatting constraints.}
4774 %10Time_Estimate@{:@} %CLOCKSUM
4775 :Owner_ALL: Tammy Mark Karl Lisa Don
4776 :Status_ALL: "In progress" "Not started yet" "Finished" ""
4777 :Approved_ALL: "[ ]" "[X]"
4778 @end example
4779
4780 @noindent
4781 The first column, @samp{%25ITEM}, means the first 25 characters of the
4782 item itself, i.e. of the headline. You probably always should start the
4783 column definition with the @samp{ITEM} specifier. The other specifiers
4784 create columns @samp{Owner} with a list of names as allowed values, for
4785 @samp{Status} with four different possible values, and for a checkbox
4786 field @samp{Approved}. When no width is given after the @samp{%}
4787 character, the column will be exactly as wide as it needs to be in order
4788 to fully display all values. The @samp{Approved} column does have a
4789 modified title (@samp{Approved?}, with a question mark). Summaries will
4790 be created for the @samp{Time_Estimate} column by adding time duration
4791 expressions like HH:MM, and for the @samp{Approved} column, by providing
4792 an @samp{[X]} status if all children have been checked. The
4793 @samp{CLOCKSUM} column is special, it lists the sum of CLOCK intervals
4794 in the subtree.
4795
4796 @node Using column view, Capturing column view, Defining columns, Column view
4797 @subsection Using column view
4798
4799 @table @kbd
4800 @tsubheading{Turning column view on and off}
4801 @kindex C-c C-x C-c
4802 @item C-c C-x C-c
4803 @vindex org-columns-default-format
4804 Turn on column view. If the cursor is before the first headline in the file,
4805 column view is turned on for the entire file, using the @code{#+COLUMNS}
4806 definition. If the cursor is somewhere inside the outline, this command
4807 searches the hierarchy, up from point, for a @code{:COLUMNS:} property that
4808 defines a format. When one is found, the column view table is established
4809 for the tree starting at the entry that contains the @code{:COLUMNS:}
4810 property. If no such property is found, the format is taken from the
4811 @code{#+COLUMNS} line or from the variable @code{org-columns-default-format},
4812 and column view is established for the current entry and its subtree.
4813 @kindex r
4814 @item r
4815 Recreate the column view, to include recent changes made in the buffer.
4816 @kindex g
4817 @item g
4818 Same as @kbd{r}.
4819 @kindex q
4820 @item q
4821 Exit column view.
4822 @tsubheading{Editing values}
4823 @item @key{left} @key{right} @key{up} @key{down}
4824 Move through the column view from field to field.
4825 @kindex S-@key{left}
4826 @kindex S-@key{right}
4827 @item S-@key{left}/@key{right}
4828 Switch to the next/previous allowed value of the field. For this, you
4829 have to have specified allowed values for a property.
4830 @item 1..9,0
4831 Directly select the nth allowed value, @kbd{0} selects the 10th value.
4832 @kindex n
4833 @kindex p
4834 @itemx n / p
4835 Same as @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}}
4836 @kindex e
4837 @item e
4838 Edit the property at point. For the special properties, this will
4839 invoke the same interface that you normally use to change that
4840 property. For example, when editing a TAGS property, the tag completion
4841 or fast selection interface will pop up.
4842 @kindex C-c C-c
4843 @item C-c C-c
4844 When there is a checkbox at point, toggle it.
4845 @kindex v
4846 @item v
4847 View the full value of this property. This is useful if the width of
4848 the column is smaller than that of the value.
4849 @kindex a
4850 @item a
4851 Edit the list of allowed values for this property. If the list is found
4852 in the hierarchy, the modified values is stored there. If no list is
4853 found, the new value is stored in the first entry that is part of the
4854 current column view.
4855 @tsubheading{Modifying the table structure}
4856 @kindex <
4857 @kindex >
4858 @item < / >
4859 Make the column narrower/wider by one character.
4860 @kindex S-M-@key{right}
4861 @item S-M-@key{right}
4862 Insert a new column, to the left of the current column.
4863 @kindex S-M-@key{left}
4864 @item S-M-@key{left}
4865 Delete the current column.
4866 @end table
4867
4868 @node Capturing column view, , Using column view, Column view
4869 @subsection Capturing column view
4870
4871 Since column view is just an overlay over a buffer, it cannot be
4872 exported or printed directly. If you want to capture a column view, use
4873 a @code{columnview} dynamic block (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). The frame
4874 of this block looks like this:
4875
4876 @cindex #+BEGIN, columnview
4877 @example
4878 * The column view
4879 #+BEGIN: columnview :hlines 1 :id "label"
4880
4881 #+END:
4882 @end example
4883
4884 @noindent This dynamic block has the following parameters:
4885
4886 @table @code
4887 @item :id
4888 This is the most important parameter. Column view is a feature that is
4889 often localized to a certain (sub)tree, and the capture block might be
4890 at a different location in the file. To identify the tree whose view to
4891 capture, you can use 4 values:
4892 @cindex property, ID
4893 @example
4894 local @r{use the tree in which the capture block is located}
4895 global @r{make a global view, including all headings in the file}
4896 "file:@var{path-to-file}"
4897 @r{run column view at the top of this file}
4898 "@var{ID}" @r{call column view in the tree that has an @code{:ID:}}
4899 @r{property with the value @i{label}. You can use}
4900 @r{@kbd{M-x org-id-copy} to create a globally unique ID for}
4901 @r{the current entry and copy it to the kill-ring.}
4902 @end example
4903 @item :hlines
4904 When @code{t}, insert an hline after every line. When a number @var{N}, insert
4905 an hline before each headline with level @code{<= @var{N}}.
4906 @item :vlines
4907 When set to @code{t}, force column groups to get vertical lines.
4908 @item :maxlevel
4909 When set to a number, don't capture entries below this level.
4910 @item :skip-empty-rows
4911 When set to @code{t}, skip rows where the only non-empty specifier of the
4912 column view is @code{ITEM}.
4913
4914 @end table
4915
4916 @noindent
4917 The following commands insert or update the dynamic block:
4918
4919 @table @kbd
4920 @kindex C-c C-x i
4921 @item C-c C-x i
4922 Insert a dynamic block capturing a column view. You will be prompted
4923 for the scope or ID of the view.
4924 @kindex C-c C-c
4925 @item C-c C-c
4926 @kindex C-c C-x C-u
4927 @itemx C-c C-x C-u
4928 Update dynamic block at point. The cursor needs to be in the
4929 @code{#+BEGIN} line of the dynamic block.
4930 @kindex C-u C-c C-x C-u
4931 @item C-u C-c C-x C-u
4932 Update all dynamic blocks (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). This is useful if
4933 you have several clock table blocks in a buffer.
4934 @end table
4935
4936 You can add formulas to the column view table and you may add plotting
4937 instructions in front of the table---these will survive an update of the
4938 block. If there is a @code{#+TBLFM:} after the table, the table will
4939 actually be recalculated automatically after an update.
4940
4941 An alternative way to capture and process property values into a table is
4942 provided by Eric Schulte's @file{org-collector.el} which is a contributed
4943 package@footnote{Contributed packages are not part of Emacs, but are
4944 distributed with the main distribution of Org (visit
4945 @uref{http://orgmode.org}).}. It provides a general API to collect
4946 properties from entries in a certain scope, and arbitrary Lisp expressions to
4947 process these values before inserting them into a table or a dynamic block.
4948
4949 @node Property API, , Column view, Properties and Columns
4950 @section The Property API
4951 @cindex properties, API
4952 @cindex API, for properties
4953
4954 There is a full API for accessing and changing properties. This API can
4955 be used by Emacs Lisp programs to work with properties and to implement
4956 features based on them. For more information see @ref{Using the
4957 property API}.
4958
4959 @node Dates and Times, Capture - Refile - Archive, Properties and Columns, Top
4960 @chapter Dates and times
4961 @cindex dates
4962 @cindex times
4963 @cindex timestamp
4964 @cindex date stamp
4965
4966 To assist project planning, TODO items can be labeled with a date and/or
4967 a time. The specially formatted string carrying the date and time
4968 information is called a @emph{timestamp} in Org-mode. This may be a
4969 little confusing because timestamp is often used as indicating when
4970 something was created or last changed. However, in Org-mode this term
4971 is used in a much wider sense.
4972
4973 @menu
4974 * Timestamps:: Assigning a time to a tree entry
4975 * Creating timestamps:: Commands which insert timestamps
4976 * Deadlines and scheduling:: Planning your work
4977 * Clocking work time:: Tracking how long you spend on a task
4978 * Resolving idle time:: Resolving time if you've been idle
4979 * Effort estimates:: Planning work effort in advance
4980 * Relative timer:: Notes with a running timer
4981 @end menu
4982
4983
4984 @node Timestamps, Creating timestamps, Dates and Times, Dates and Times
4985 @section Timestamps, deadlines, and scheduling
4986 @cindex timestamps
4987 @cindex ranges, time
4988 @cindex date stamps
4989 @cindex deadlines
4990 @cindex scheduling
4991
4992 A timestamp is a specification of a date (possibly with a time or a range of
4993 times) in a special format, either @samp{<2003-09-16 Tue>} or
4994 @samp{<2003-09-16 Tue 09:39>} or @samp{<2003-09-16 Tue
4995 12:00-12:30>}@footnote{This is inspired by the standard ISO 8601 date/time
4996 format. To use an alternative format, see @ref{Custom time format}.}. A
4997 timestamp can appear anywhere in the headline or body of an Org tree entry.
4998 Its presence causes entries to be shown on specific dates in the agenda
4999 (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}). We distinguish:
5000
5001 @table @var
5002 @item Plain timestamp; Event; Appointment
5003 @cindex timestamp
5004 A simple timestamp just assigns a date/time to an item. This is just
5005 like writing down an appointment or event in a paper agenda. In the
5006 timeline and agenda displays, the headline of an entry associated with a
5007 plain timestamp will be shown exactly on that date.
5008
5009 @example
5010 * Meet Peter at the movies <2006-11-01 Wed 19:15>
5011 * Discussion on climate change <2006-11-02 Thu 20:00-22:00>
5012 @end example
5013
5014 @item Timestamp with repeater interval
5015 @cindex timestamp, with repeater interval
5016 A timestamp may contain a @emph{repeater interval}, indicating that it
5017 applies not only on the given date, but again and again after a certain
5018 interval of N days (d), weeks (w), months (m), or years (y). The
5019 following will show up in the agenda every Wednesday:
5020
5021 @example
5022 * Pick up Sam at school <2007-05-16 Wed 12:30 +1w>
5023 @end example
5024
5025 @item Diary-style sexp entries
5026 For more complex date specifications, Org-mode supports using the
5027 special sexp diary entries implemented in the Emacs calendar/diary
5028 package. For example
5029
5030 @example
5031 * The nerd meeting on every 2nd Thursday of the month
5032 <%%(diary-float t 4 2)>
5033 @end example
5034
5035 @item Time/Date range
5036 @cindex timerange
5037 @cindex date range
5038 Two timestamps connected by @samp{--} denote a range. The headline
5039 will be shown on the first and last day of the range, and on any dates
5040 that are displayed and fall in the range. Here is an example:
5041
5042 @example
5043 ** Meeting in Amsterdam
5044 <2004-08-23 Mon>--<2004-08-26 Thu>
5045 @end example
5046
5047 @item Inactive timestamp
5048 @cindex timestamp, inactive
5049 @cindex inactive timestamp
5050 Just like a plain timestamp, but with square brackets instead of
5051 angular ones. These timestamps are inactive in the sense that they do
5052 @emph{not} trigger an entry to show up in the agenda.
5053
5054 @example
5055 * Gillian comes late for the fifth time [2006-11-01 Wed]
5056 @end example
5057
5058 @end table
5059
5060 @node Creating timestamps, Deadlines and scheduling, Timestamps, Dates and Times
5061 @section Creating timestamps
5062 @cindex creating timestamps
5063 @cindex timestamps, creating
5064
5065 For Org-mode to recognize timestamps, they need to be in the specific
5066 format. All commands listed below produce timestamps in the correct
5067 format.
5068
5069 @table @kbd
5070 @kindex C-c .
5071 @item C-c .
5072 Prompt for a date and insert a corresponding timestamp. When the cursor is
5073 at an existing timestamp in the buffer, the command is used to modify this
5074 timestamp instead of inserting a new one. When this command is used twice in
5075 succession, a time range is inserted.
5076 @c
5077 @kindex C-c !
5078 @item C-c !
5079 Like @kbd{C-c .}, but insert an inactive timestamp that will not cause
5080 an agenda entry.
5081 @c
5082 @kindex C-u C-c .
5083 @kindex C-u C-c !
5084 @item C-u C-c .
5085 @itemx C-u C-c !
5086 @vindex org-time-stamp-rounding-minutes
5087 Like @kbd{C-c .} and @kbd{C-c !}, but use the alternative format which
5088 contains date and time. The default time can be rounded to multiples of 5
5089 minutes, see the option @code{org-time-stamp-rounding-minutes}.
5090 @c
5091 @kindex C-c <
5092 @item C-c <
5093 Insert a timestamp corresponding to the cursor date in the Calendar.
5094 @c
5095 @kindex C-c >
5096 @item C-c >
5097 Access the Emacs calendar for the current date. If there is a
5098 timestamp in the current line, go to the corresponding date
5099 instead.
5100 @c
5101 @kindex C-c C-o
5102 @item C-c C-o
5103 Access the agenda for the date given by the timestamp or -range at
5104 point (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}).
5105 @c
5106 @kindex S-@key{left}
5107 @kindex S-@key{right}
5108 @item S-@key{left}
5109 @itemx S-@key{right}
5110 Change date at cursor by one day. These key bindings conflict with
5111 shift-selection and related modes (@pxref{Conflicts}).
5112 @c
5113 @kindex S-@key{up}
5114 @kindex S-@key{down}
5115 @item S-@key{up}
5116 @itemx S-@key{down}
5117 Change the item under the cursor in a timestamp. The cursor can be on a
5118 year, month, day, hour or minute. When the timestamp contains a time range
5119 like @samp{15:30-16:30}, modifying the first time will also shift the second,
5120 shifting the time block with constant length. To change the length, modify
5121 the second time. Note that if the cursor is in a headline and not at a
5122 timestamp, these same keys modify the priority of an item.
5123 (@pxref{Priorities}). The key bindings also conflict with shift-selection and
5124 related modes (@pxref{Conflicts}).
5125 @c
5126 @kindex C-c C-y
5127 @cindex evaluate time range
5128 @item C-c C-y
5129 Evaluate a time range by computing the difference between start and end.
5130 With a prefix argument, insert result after the time range (in a table: into
5131 the following column).
5132 @end table
5133
5134
5135 @menu
5136 * The date/time prompt:: How Org-mode helps you entering date and time
5137 * Custom time format:: Making dates look different
5138 @end menu
5139
5140 @node The date/time prompt, Custom time format, Creating timestamps, Creating timestamps
5141 @subsection The date/time prompt
5142 @cindex date, reading in minibuffer
5143 @cindex time, reading in minibuffer
5144
5145 @vindex org-read-date-prefer-future
5146 When Org-mode prompts for a date/time, the default is shown in default
5147 date/time format, and the prompt therefore seems to ask for a specific
5148 format. But it will in fact accept any string containing some date and/or
5149 time information, and it is really smart about interpreting your input. You
5150 can, for example, use @kbd{C-y} to paste a (possibly multi-line) string
5151 copied from an email message. Org-mode will find whatever information is in
5152 there and derive anything you have not specified from the @emph{default date
5153 and time}. The default is usually the current date and time, but when
5154 modifying an existing timestamp, or when entering the second stamp of a
5155 range, it is taken from the stamp in the buffer. When filling in
5156 information, Org-mode assumes that most of the time you will want to enter a
5157 date in the future: if you omit the month/year and the given day/month is
5158 @i{before} today, it will assume that you mean a future date@footnote{See the
5159 variable @code{org-read-date-prefer-future}. You may set that variable to
5160 the symbol @code{time} to even make a time before now shift the date to
5161 tomorrow.}. If the date has been automatically shifted into the future, the
5162 time prompt will show this with @samp{(=>F).}
5163
5164 For example, let's assume that today is @b{June 13, 2006}. Here is how
5165 various inputs will be interpreted, the items filled in by Org-mode are
5166 in @b{bold}.
5167
5168 @example
5169 3-2-5 --> 2003-02-05
5170 2/5/3 --> 2003-02-05
5171 14 --> @b{2006}-@b{06}-14
5172 12 --> @b{2006}-@b{07}-12
5173 2/5 --> @b{2007}-02-05
5174 Fri --> nearest Friday (default date or later)
5175 sep 15 --> @b{2006}-09-15
5176 feb 15 --> @b{2007}-02-15
5177 sep 12 9 --> 2009-09-12
5178 12:45 --> @b{2006}-@b{06}-@b{13} 12:45
5179 22 sept 0:34 --> @b{2006}-09-22 0:34
5180 w4 --> ISO week for of the current year @b{2006}
5181 2012 w4 fri --> Friday of ISO week 4 in 2012
5182 2012-w04-5 --> Same as above
5183 @end example
5184
5185 Furthermore you can specify a relative date by giving, as the
5186 @emph{first} thing in the input: a plus/minus sign, a number and a
5187 letter ([dwmy]) to indicate change in days, weeks, months, or years. With a
5188 single plus or minus, the date is always relative to today. With a
5189 double plus or minus, it is relative to the default date. If instead of
5190 a single letter, you use the abbreviation of day name, the date will be
5191 the nth such day. E.g.
5192
5193 @example
5194 +0 --> today
5195 . --> today
5196 +4d --> four days from today
5197 +4 --> same as above
5198 +2w --> two weeks from today
5199 ++5 --> five days from default date
5200 +2tue --> second Tuesday from now.
5201 @end example
5202
5203 @vindex parse-time-months
5204 @vindex parse-time-weekdays
5205 The function understands English month and weekday abbreviations. If
5206 you want to use unabbreviated names and/or other languages, configure
5207 the variables @code{parse-time-months} and @code{parse-time-weekdays}.
5208
5209 @cindex calendar, for selecting date
5210 @vindex org-popup-calendar-for-date-prompt
5211 Parallel to the minibuffer prompt, a calendar is popped up@footnote{If
5212 you don't need/want the calendar, configure the variable
5213 @code{org-popup-calendar-for-date-prompt}.}. When you exit the date
5214 prompt, either by clicking on a date in the calendar, or by pressing
5215 @key{RET}, the date selected in the calendar will be combined with the
5216 information entered at the prompt. You can control the calendar fully
5217 from the minibuffer:
5218
5219 @kindex <
5220 @kindex >
5221 @kindex M-v
5222 @kindex C-v
5223 @kindex mouse-1
5224 @kindex S-@key{right}
5225 @kindex S-@key{left}
5226 @kindex S-@key{down}
5227 @kindex S-@key{up}
5228 @kindex M-S-@key{right}
5229 @kindex M-S-@key{left}
5230 @kindex @key{RET}
5231 @example
5232 @key{RET} @r{Choose date at cursor in calendar.}
5233 mouse-1 @r{Select date by clicking on it.}
5234 S-@key{right}/@key{left} @r{One day forward/backward.}
5235 S-@key{down}/@key{up} @r{One week forward/backward.}
5236 M-S-@key{right}/@key{left} @r{One month forward/backward.}
5237 > / < @r{Scroll calendar forward/backward by one month.}
5238 M-v / C-v @r{Scroll calendar forward/backward by 3 months.}
5239 @end example
5240
5241 @vindex org-read-date-display-live
5242 The actions of the date/time prompt may seem complex, but I assure you they
5243 will grow on you, and you will start getting annoyed by pretty much any other
5244 way of entering a date/time out there. To help you understand what is going
5245 on, the current interpretation of your input will be displayed live in the
5246 minibuffer@footnote{If you find this distracting, turn the display of with
5247 @code{org-read-date-display-live}.}.
5248
5249 @node Custom time format, , The date/time prompt, Creating timestamps
5250 @subsection Custom time format
5251 @cindex custom date/time format
5252 @cindex time format, custom
5253 @cindex date format, custom
5254
5255 @vindex org-display-custom-times
5256 @vindex org-time-stamp-custom-formats
5257 Org-mode uses the standard ISO notation for dates and times as it is
5258 defined in ISO 8601. If you cannot get used to this and require another
5259 representation of date and time to keep you happy, you can get it by
5260 customizing the variables @code{org-display-custom-times} and
5261 @code{org-time-stamp-custom-formats}.
5262
5263 @table @kbd
5264 @kindex C-c C-x C-t
5265 @item C-c C-x C-t
5266 Toggle the display of custom formats for dates and times.
5267 @end table
5268
5269 @noindent
5270 Org-mode needs the default format for scanning, so the custom date/time
5271 format does not @emph{replace} the default format---instead it is put
5272 @emph{over} the default format using text properties. This has the
5273 following consequences:
5274 @itemize @bullet
5275 @item
5276 You cannot place the cursor onto a timestamp anymore, only before or
5277 after.
5278 @item
5279 The @kbd{S-@key{up}/@key{down}} keys can no longer be used to adjust
5280 each component of a timestamp. If the cursor is at the beginning of
5281 the stamp, @kbd{S-@key{up}/@key{down}} will change the stamp by one day,
5282 just like @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}}. At the end of the stamp, the
5283 time will be changed by one minute.
5284 @item
5285 If the timestamp contains a range of clock times or a repeater, these
5286 will not be overlayed, but remain in the buffer as they were.
5287 @item
5288 When you delete a timestamp character-by-character, it will only
5289 disappear from the buffer after @emph{all} (invisible) characters
5290 belonging to the ISO timestamp have been removed.
5291 @item
5292 If the custom timestamp format is longer than the default and you are
5293 using dates in tables, table alignment will be messed up. If the custom
5294 format is shorter, things do work as expected.
5295 @end itemize
5296
5297
5298 @node Deadlines and scheduling, Clocking work time, Creating timestamps, Dates and Times
5299 @section Deadlines and scheduling
5300
5301 A timestamp may be preceded by special keywords to facilitate planning:
5302
5303 @table @var
5304 @item DEADLINE
5305 @cindex DEADLINE keyword
5306
5307 Meaning: the task (most likely a TODO item, though not necessarily) is supposed
5308 to be finished on that date.
5309
5310 @vindex org-deadline-warning-days
5311 On the deadline date, the task will be listed in the agenda. In
5312 addition, the agenda for @emph{today} will carry a warning about the
5313 approaching or missed deadline, starting
5314 @code{org-deadline-warning-days} before the due date, and continuing
5315 until the entry is marked DONE. An example:
5316
5317 @example
5318 *** TODO write article about the Earth for the Guide
5319 The editor in charge is [[bbdb:Ford Prefect]]
5320 DEADLINE: <2004-02-29 Sun>
5321 @end example
5322
5323 You can specify a different lead time for warnings for a specific
5324 deadlines using the following syntax. Here is an example with a warning
5325 period of 5 days @code{DEADLINE: <2004-02-29 Sun -5d>}.
5326
5327 @item SCHEDULED
5328 @cindex SCHEDULED keyword
5329
5330 Meaning: you are planning to start working on that task on the given
5331 date.
5332
5333 @vindex org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-done
5334 The headline will be listed under the given date@footnote{It will still
5335 be listed on that date after it has been marked DONE. If you don't like
5336 this, set the variable @code{org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-done}.}. In
5337 addition, a reminder that the scheduled date has passed will be present
5338 in the compilation for @emph{today}, until the entry is marked DONE.
5339 I.e. the task will automatically be forwarded until completed.
5340
5341 @example
5342 *** TODO Call Trillian for a date on New Years Eve.
5343 SCHEDULED: <2004-12-25 Sat>
5344 @end example
5345
5346 @noindent
5347 @b{Important:} Scheduling an item in Org-mode should @i{not} be
5348 understood in the same way that we understand @i{scheduling a meeting}.
5349 Setting a date for a meeting is just a simple appointment, you should
5350 mark this entry with a simple plain timestamp, to get this item shown
5351 on the date where it applies. This is a frequent misunderstanding by
5352 Org users. In Org-mode, @i{scheduling} means setting a date when you
5353 want to start working on an action item.
5354 @end table
5355
5356 You may use timestamps with repeaters in scheduling and deadline
5357 entries. Org-mode will issue early and late warnings based on the
5358 assumption that the timestamp represents the @i{nearest instance} of
5359 the repeater. However, the use of diary sexp entries like
5360 @c
5361 @code{<%%(diary-float t 42)>}
5362 @c
5363 in scheduling and deadline timestamps is limited. Org-mode does not
5364 know enough about the internals of each sexp function to issue early and
5365 late warnings. However, it will show the item on each day where the
5366 sexp entry matches.
5367
5368 @menu
5369 * Inserting deadline/schedule:: Planning items
5370 * Repeated tasks:: Items that show up again and again
5371 @end menu
5372
5373 @node Inserting deadline/schedule, Repeated tasks, Deadlines and scheduling, Deadlines and scheduling
5374 @subsection Inserting deadlines or schedules
5375
5376 The following commands allow you to quickly insert a deadline or to schedule
5377 an item:
5378
5379 @table @kbd
5380 @c
5381 @kindex C-c C-d
5382 @item C-c C-d
5383 Insert @samp{DEADLINE} keyword along with a stamp. The insertion will happen
5384 in the line directly following the headline. When called with a prefix arg,
5385 an existing deadline will be removed from the entry. Depending on the
5386 variable @code{org-log-redeadline}@footnote{with corresponding
5387 @code{#+STARTUP} keywords @code{logredeadline}, @code{lognoteredeadline},
5388 and @code{nologredeadline}}, a note will be taken when changing an existing
5389 deadline.
5390 @c FIXME Any CLOSED timestamp will be removed.????????
5391 @c
5392 @kindex C-c C-s
5393 @item C-c C-s
5394 Insert @samp{SCHEDULED} keyword along with a stamp. The insertion will
5395 happen in the line directly following the headline. Any CLOSED timestamp
5396 will be removed. When called with a prefix argument, remove the scheduling
5397 date from the entry. Depending on the variable
5398 @code{org-log-reschedule}@footnote{with corresponding @code{#+STARTUP}
5399 keywords @code{logredeadline}, @code{lognoteredeadline}, and
5400 @code{nologredeadline}}, a note will be taken when changing an existing
5401 scheduling time.
5402 @c
5403 @kindex C-c C-x C-k
5404 @kindex k a
5405 @kindex k s
5406 @item C-c C-x C-k
5407 Mark the current entry for agenda action. After you have marked the entry
5408 like this, you can open the agenda or the calendar to find an appropriate
5409 date. With the cursor on the selected date, press @kbd{k s} or @kbd{k d} to
5410 schedule the marked item.
5411 @c
5412 @kindex C-c / d
5413 @cindex sparse tree, for deadlines
5414 @item C-c / d
5415 @vindex org-deadline-warning-days
5416 Create a sparse tree with all deadlines that are either past-due, or
5417 which will become due within @code{org-deadline-warning-days}.
5418 With @kbd{C-u} prefix, show all deadlines in the file. With a numeric
5419 prefix, check that many days. For example, @kbd{C-1 C-c / d} shows
5420 all deadlines due tomorrow.
5421 @c
5422 @kindex C-c / b
5423 @item C-c / b
5424 Sparse tree for deadlines and scheduled items before a given date.
5425 @c
5426 @kindex C-c / a
5427 @item C-c / a
5428 Sparse tree for deadlines and scheduled items after a given date.
5429 @end table
5430
5431 @node Repeated tasks, , Inserting deadline/schedule, Deadlines and scheduling
5432 @subsection Repeated tasks
5433 @cindex tasks, repeated
5434 @cindex repeated tasks
5435
5436 Some tasks need to be repeated again and again. Org-mode helps to
5437 organize such tasks using a so-called repeater in a DEADLINE, SCHEDULED,
5438 or plain timestamp. In the following example
5439 @example
5440 ** TODO Pay the rent
5441 DEADLINE: <2005-10-01 Sat +1m>
5442 @end example
5443 @noindent
5444 the @code{+1m} is a repeater; the intended interpretation is that the task
5445 has a deadline on <2005-10-01> and repeats itself every (one) month starting
5446 from that time. If you need both a repeater and a special warning period in
5447 a deadline entry, the repeater should come first and the warning period last:
5448 @code{DEADLINE: <2005-10-01 Sat +1m -3d>}.
5449
5450 @vindex org-todo-repeat-to-state
5451 Deadlines and scheduled items produce entries in the agenda when they are
5452 over-due, so it is important to be able to mark such an entry as completed
5453 once you have done so. When you mark a DEADLINE or a SCHEDULE with the TODO
5454 keyword DONE, it will no longer produce entries in the agenda. The problem
5455 with this is, however, that then also the @emph{next} instance of the
5456 repeated entry will not be active. Org-mode deals with this in the following
5457 way: When you try to mark such an entry DONE (using @kbd{C-c C-t}), it will
5458 shift the base date of the repeating timestamp by the repeater interval, and
5459 immediately set the entry state back to TODO@footnote{In fact, the target
5460 state is taken from, in this sequence, the @code{REPEAT_TO_STATE} property or
5461 the variable @code{org-todo-repeat-to-state}. If neither of these is
5462 specified, the target state defaults to the first state of the TODO state
5463 sequence.}. In the example above, setting the state to DONE would actually
5464 switch the date like this:
5465
5466 @example
5467 ** TODO Pay the rent
5468 DEADLINE: <2005-11-01 Tue +1m>
5469 @end example
5470
5471 @vindex org-log-repeat
5472 A timestamp@footnote{You can change this using the option
5473 @code{org-log-repeat}, or the @code{#+STARTUP} options @code{logrepeat},
5474 @code{lognoterepeat}, and @code{nologrepeat}. With @code{lognoterepeat}, you
5475 will also be prompted for a note.} will be added under the deadline, to keep
5476 a record that you actually acted on the previous instance of this deadline.
5477
5478 As a consequence of shifting the base date, this entry will no longer be
5479 visible in the agenda when checking past dates, but all future instances
5480 will be visible.
5481
5482 With the @samp{+1m} cookie, the date shift will always be exactly one
5483 month. So if you have not paid the rent for three months, marking this
5484 entry DONE will still keep it as an overdue deadline. Depending on the
5485 task, this may not be the best way to handle it. For example, if you
5486 forgot to call you father for 3 weeks, it does not make sense to call
5487 him 3 times in a single day to make up for it. Finally, there are tasks
5488 like changing batteries which should always repeat a certain time
5489 @i{after} the last time you did it. For these tasks, Org-mode has
5490 special repeaters markers with @samp{++} and @samp{.+}. For example:
5491
5492 @example
5493 ** TODO Call Father
5494 DEADLINE: <2008-02-10 Sun ++1w>
5495 Marking this DONE will shift the date by at least one week,
5496 but also by as many weeks as it takes to get this date into
5497 the future. However, it stays on a Sunday, even if you called
5498 and marked it done on Saturday.
5499 ** TODO Check the batteries in the smoke detectors
5500 DEADLINE: <2005-11-01 Tue .+1m>
5501 Marking this DONE will shift the date to one month after
5502 today.
5503 @end example
5504
5505 You may have both scheduling and deadline information for a specific
5506 task---just make sure that the repeater intervals on both are the same.
5507
5508 An alternative to using a repeater is to create a number of copies of a task
5509 subtree, with dates shifted in each copy. The command @kbd{C-c C-x c} was
5510 created for this purpose, it is described in @ref{Structure editing}.
5511
5512
5513 @node Clocking work time, Resolving idle time, Deadlines and scheduling, Dates and Times
5514 @section Clocking work time
5515
5516 Org-mode allows you to clock the time you spend on specific tasks in a
5517 project. When you start working on an item, you can start the clock.
5518 When you stop working on that task, or when you mark the task done, the
5519 clock is stopped and the corresponding time interval is recorded. It
5520 also computes the total time spent on each subtree of a project. And it
5521 remembers a history or tasks recently clocked, to that you can jump quickly
5522 between a number of tasks absorbing your time.
5523
5524 To save the clock history across Emacs sessions, use
5525 @lisp
5526 (setq org-clock-persist 'history)
5527 (org-clock-persistence-insinuate)
5528 @end lisp
5529 When you clock into a new task after resuming Emacs, the incomplete
5530 clock@footnote{To resume the clock under the assumption that you have worked
5531 on this task while outside Emacs, use @code{(setq org-clock-persist t)}.}
5532 will be found (@pxref{Resolving idle time}) and you will be prompted about
5533 what to do with it.
5534
5535 @table @kbd
5536 @kindex C-c C-x C-i
5537 @item C-c C-x C-i
5538 @vindex org-clock-into-drawer
5539 Start the clock on the current item (clock-in). This inserts the CLOCK
5540 keyword together with a timestamp. If this is not the first clocking of
5541 this item, the multiple CLOCK lines will be wrapped into a
5542 @code{:LOGBOOK:} drawer (see also the variable
5543 @code{org-clock-into-drawer}). When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument,
5544 select the task from a list of recently clocked tasks. With two @kbd{C-u
5545 C-u} prefixes, clock into the task at point and mark it as the default task.
5546 The default task will always be available when selecting a clocking task,
5547 with letter @kbd{d}.@*
5548 @cindex property: CLOCK_MODELINE_TOTAL
5549 @cindex property: LAST_REPEAT
5550 @vindex org-clock-modeline-total
5551 While the clock is running, the current clocking time is shown in the mode
5552 line, along with the title of the task. The clock time shown will be all
5553 time ever clocked for this task and its children. If the task has an effort
5554 estimate (@pxref{Effort estimates}), the mode line displays the current
5555 clocking time against it@footnote{To add an effort estimate ``on the fly'',
5556 hook a function doing this to @code{org-clock-in-prepare-hook}.} If the task
5557 is a repeating one (@pxref{Repeated tasks}), only the time since the last
5558 reset of the task @footnote{as recorded by the @code{LAST_REPEAT} property}
5559 will be shown. More control over what time is shown can be exercised with
5560 the @code{CLOCK_MODELINE_TOTAL} property. It may have the values
5561 @code{current} to show only the current clocking instance, @code{today} to
5562 show all time clocked on this tasks today (see also the variable
5563 @code{org-extend-today-until}), @code{all} to include all time, or
5564 @code{auto} which is the default@footnote{See also the variable
5565 @code{org-clock-modeline-total}.}.@* Clicking with @kbd{mouse-1} onto the
5566 mode line entry will pop up a menu with clocking options.
5567 @kindex C-c C-x C-o
5568 @item C-c C-x C-o
5569 @vindex org-log-note-clock-out
5570 Stop the clock (clock-out). This inserts another timestamp at the same
5571 location where the clock was last started. It also directly computes
5572 the resulting time in inserts it after the time range as @samp{=>
5573 HH:MM}. See the variable @code{org-log-note-clock-out} for the
5574 possibility to record an additional note together with the clock-out
5575 timestamp@footnote{The corresponding in-buffer setting is:
5576 @code{#+STARTUP: lognoteclock-out}}.
5577 @kindex C-c C-x C-e
5578 @item C-c C-x C-e
5579 Update the effort estimate for the current clock task.
5580 @kindex C-c C-y
5581 @kindex C-c C-c
5582 @item C-c C-y @ @ @r{or}@ @ C-c C-c
5583 Recompute the time interval after changing one of the timestamps. This
5584 is only necessary if you edit the timestamps directly. If you change
5585 them with @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} keys, the update is automatic.
5586 @kindex C-c C-t
5587 @item C-c C-t
5588 Changing the TODO state of an item to DONE automatically stops the clock
5589 if it is running in this same item.
5590 @kindex C-c C-x C-x
5591 @item C-c C-x C-x
5592 Cancel the current clock. This is useful if a clock was started by
5593 mistake, or if you ended up working on something else.
5594 @kindex C-c C-x C-j
5595 @item C-c C-x C-j
5596 Jump to the entry that contains the currently running clock. With a
5597 @kbd{C-u} prefix arg, select the target task from a list of recently clocked
5598 tasks.
5599 @kindex C-c C-x C-d
5600 @item C-c C-x C-d
5601 @vindex org-remove-highlights-with-change
5602 Display time summaries for each subtree in the current buffer. This
5603 puts overlays at the end of each headline, showing the total time
5604 recorded under that heading, including the time of any subheadings. You
5605 can use visibility cycling to study the tree, but the overlays disappear
5606 when you change the buffer (see variable
5607 @code{org-remove-highlights-with-change}) or press @kbd{C-c C-c}.
5608 @kindex C-c C-x C-r
5609 @item C-c C-x C-r
5610 Insert a dynamic block (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}) containing a clock
5611 report as an Org-mode table into the current file. When the cursor is
5612 at an existing clock table, just update it. When called with a prefix
5613 argument, jump to the first clock report in the current document and
5614 update it.
5615 @cindex #+BEGIN, clocktable
5616 @example
5617 #+BEGIN: clocktable :maxlevel 2 :emphasize nil :scope file
5618 #+END: clocktable
5619 @end example
5620 @noindent
5621 If such a block already exists at point, its content is replaced by the
5622 new table. The @samp{BEGIN} line can specify options:
5623 @example
5624 :maxlevel @r{Maximum level depth to which times are listed in the table.}
5625 :emphasize @r{When @code{t}, emphasize level one and level two items.}
5626 :scope @r{The scope to consider. This can be any of the following:}
5627 nil @r{the current buffer or narrowed region}
5628 file @r{the full current buffer}
5629 subtree @r{the subtree where the clocktable is located}
5630 tree@var{N} @r{the surrounding level @var{N} tree, for example @code{tree3}}
5631 tree @r{the surrounding level 1 tree}
5632 agenda @r{all agenda files}
5633 ("file"..) @r{scan these files}
5634 file-with-archives @r{current file and its archives}
5635 agenda-with-archives @r{all agenda files, including archives}
5636 :block @r{The time block to consider. This block is specified either}
5637 @r{absolute, or relative to the current time and may be any of}
5638 @r{these formats:}
5639 2007-12-31 @r{New year eve 2007}
5640 2007-12 @r{December 2007}
5641 2007-W50 @r{ISO-week 50 in 2007}
5642 2007 @r{the year 2007}
5643 today, yesterday, today-@var{N} @r{a relative day}
5644 thisweek, lastweek, thisweek-@var{N} @r{a relative week}
5645 thismonth, lastmonth, thismonth-@var{N} @r{a relative month}
5646 thisyear, lastyear, thisyear-@var{N} @r{a relative year}
5647 @r{Use @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}} keys to shift the time interval.}
5648 :tstart @r{A time string specifying when to start considering times.}
5649 :tend @r{A time string specifying when to stop considering times.}
5650 :step @r{@code{week} or @code{day}, to split the table into chunks.}
5651 @r{To use this, @code{:block} or @code{:tstart}, @code{:tend} are needed.}
5652 :stepskip0 @r{Don't show steps that have zero time}
5653 :tags @r{A tags match to select entries that should contribute}
5654 :link @r{Link the item headlines in the table to their origins.}
5655 :formula @r{Content of a @code{#+TBLFM} line to be added and evaluated.}
5656 @r{As a special case, @samp{:formula %} adds a column with % time.}
5657 @r{If you do not specify a formula here, any existing formula.}
5658 @r{below the clock table will survive updates and be evaluated.}
5659 :timestamp @r{A timestamp for the entry, when available. Look for SCHEDULED,}
5660 @r{DEADLINE, TIMESTAMP and TIMESTAMP_IA, in this order.}
5661 @end example
5662 To get a clock summary of the current level 1 tree, for the current
5663 day, you could write
5664 @example
5665 #+BEGIN: clocktable :maxlevel 2 :block today :scope tree1 :link t
5666 #+END: clocktable
5667 @end example
5668 @noindent
5669 and to use a specific time range you could write@footnote{Note that all
5670 parameters must be specified in a single line---the line is broken here
5671 only to fit it into the manual.}
5672 @example
5673 #+BEGIN: clocktable :tstart "<2006-08-10 Thu 10:00>"
5674 :tend "<2006-08-10 Thu 12:00>"
5675 #+END: clocktable
5676 @end example
5677 A summary of the current subtree with % times would be
5678 @example
5679 #+BEGIN: clocktable :scope subtree :link t :formula %
5680 #+END: clocktable
5681 @end example
5682 @kindex C-c C-c
5683 @item C-c C-c
5684 @kindex C-c C-x C-u
5685 @itemx C-c C-x C-u
5686 Update dynamic block at point. The cursor needs to be in the
5687 @code{#+BEGIN} line of the dynamic block.
5688 @kindex C-u C-c C-x C-u
5689 @item C-u C-c C-x C-u
5690 Update all dynamic blocks (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). This is useful if
5691 you have several clock table blocks in a buffer.
5692 @kindex S-@key{left}
5693 @kindex S-@key{right}
5694 @item S-@key{left}
5695 @itemx S-@key{right}
5696 Shift the current @code{:block} interval and update the table. The cursor
5697 needs to be in the @code{#+BEGIN: clocktable} line for this command. If
5698 @code{:block} is @code{today}, it will be shifted to @code{today-1} etc.
5699 @end table
5700
5701 The @kbd{l} key may be used in the timeline (@pxref{Timeline}) and in
5702 the agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}) to show which tasks have been
5703 worked on or closed during a day.
5704
5705 @node Resolving idle time, Effort estimates, Clocking work time, Dates and Times
5706 @section Resolving idle time
5707 @cindex resolve idle time
5708
5709 @cindex idle, resolve, dangling
5710 If you clock in on a work item, and then walk away from your
5711 computer---perhaps to take a phone call---you often need to ``resolve'' the
5712 time you were away by either subtracting it from the current clock, or
5713 applying it to another one.
5714
5715 @vindex org-clock-idle-time
5716 By customizing the variable @code{org-clock-idle-time} to some integer, such
5717 as 10 or 15, Emacs can alert you when you get back to your computer after
5718 being idle for that many minutes@footnote{On computers using Mac OS X,
5719 idleness is based on actual user idleness, not just Emacs' idle time. For
5720 X11, you can install a utility program @file{x11idle.c}, available in the
5721 UTILITIES directory of the Org git distribution, to get the same general
5722 treatment of idleness. On other systems, idle time refers to Emacs idle time
5723 only.}, and ask what you want to do with the idle time. There will be a
5724 question waiting for you when you get back, indicating how much idle time has
5725 passed (constantly updated with the current amount), as well as a set of
5726 choices to correct the discrepancy:
5727
5728 @table @kbd
5729 @item k
5730 To keep some or all of the minutes and stay clocked in, press @kbd{k}. Org
5731 will ask how many of the minutes to keep. Press @key{RET} to keep them all,
5732 effectively changing nothing, or enter a number to keep that many minutes.
5733 @item K
5734 If you use the shift key and press @kbd{K}, it will keep however many minutes
5735 you request and then immediately clock out of that task. If you keep all of
5736 the minutes, this is the same as just clocking out of the current task.
5737 @item s
5738 To keep none of the minutes, use @kbd{s} to subtract all the away time from
5739 the clock, and then check back in from the moment you returned.
5740 @item S
5741 To keep none of the minutes and just clock out at the start of the away time,
5742 use the shift key and press @kbd{S}. Remember that using shift will always
5743 leave you clocked out, no matter which option you choose.
5744 @item C
5745 To cancel the clock altogether, use @kbd{C}. Note that if instead of
5746 canceling you subtract the away time, and the resulting clock amount is less
5747 than a minute, the clock will still be canceled rather than clutter up the
5748 log with an empty entry.
5749 @end table
5750
5751 What if you subtracted those away minutes from the current clock, and now
5752 want to apply them to a new clock? Simply clock in to any task immediately
5753 after the subtraction. Org will notice that you have subtracted time ``on
5754 the books'', so to speak, and will ask if you want to apply those minutes to
5755 the next task you clock in on.
5756
5757 There is one other instance when this clock resolution magic occurs. Say you
5758 were clocked in and hacking away, and suddenly your cat chased a mouse who
5759 scared a hamster that crashed into your UPS's power button! You suddenly
5760 lose all your buffers, but thanks to auto-save you still have your recent Org
5761 mode changes, including your last clock in.
5762
5763 If you restart Emacs and clock into any task, Org will notice that you have a
5764 dangling clock which was never clocked out from your last session. Using
5765 that clock's starting time as the beginning of the unaccounted-for period,
5766 Org will ask how you want to resolve that time. The logic and behavior is
5767 identical to dealing with away time due to idleness, it's just happening due
5768 to a recovery event rather than a set amount of idle time.
5769
5770 You can also check all the files visited by your Org agenda for dangling
5771 clocks at any time using @kbd{M-x org-resolve-clocks}.
5772
5773 @node Effort estimates, Relative timer, Resolving idle time, Dates and Times
5774 @section Effort estimates
5775 @cindex effort estimates
5776
5777 @cindex property, Effort
5778 @vindex org-effort-property
5779 If you want to plan your work in a very detailed way, or if you need to
5780 produce offers with quotations of the estimated work effort, you may want to
5781 assign effort estimates to entries. If you are also clocking your work, you
5782 may later want to compare the planned effort with the actual working time, a
5783 great way to improve planning estimates. Effort estimates are stored in a
5784 special property @samp{Effort}@footnote{You may change the property being
5785 used with the variable @code{org-effort-property}.}. You can set the effort
5786 for an entry with the following commands:
5787
5788 @table @kbd
5789 @kindex C-c C-x e
5790 @item C-c C-x e
5791 Set the effort estimate for the current entry. With a numeric prefix
5792 argument, set it to the NTH allowed value (see below). This command is also
5793 accessible from the agenda with the @kbd{e} key.
5794 @kindex C-c C-x C-e
5795 @item C-c C-x C-e
5796 Modify the effort estimate of the item currently being clocked.
5797 @end table
5798
5799 Clearly the best way to work with effort estimates is through column view
5800 (@pxref{Column view}). You should start by setting up discrete values for
5801 effort estimates, and a @code{COLUMNS} format that displays these values
5802 together with clock sums (if you want to clock your time). For a specific
5803 buffer you can use
5804
5805 @example
5806 #+PROPERTY: Effort_ALL 0 0:10 0:30 1:00 2:00 3:00 4:00 5:00 6:00 7:00 8:00
5807 #+COLUMNS: %40ITEM(Task) %17Effort(Estimated Effort)@{:@} %CLOCKSUM
5808 @end example
5809
5810 @noindent
5811 @vindex org-global-properties
5812 @vindex org-columns-default-format
5813 or, even better, you can set up these values globally by customizing the
5814 variables @code{org-global-properties} and @code{org-columns-default-format}.
5815 In particular if you want to use this setup also in the agenda, a global
5816 setup may be advised.
5817
5818 The way to assign estimates to individual items is then to switch to column
5819 mode, and to use @kbd{S-@key{right}} and @kbd{S-@key{left}} to change the
5820 value. The values you enter will immediately be summed up in the hierarchy.
5821 In the column next to it, any clocked time will be displayed.
5822
5823 @vindex org-agenda-columns-add-appointments-to-effort-sum
5824 If you switch to column view in the daily/weekly agenda, the effort column
5825 will summarize the estimated work effort for each day@footnote{Please note
5826 the pitfalls of summing hierarchical data in a flat list (@pxref{Agenda
5827 column view}).}, and you can use this to find space in your schedule. To get
5828 an overview of the entire part of the day that is committed, you can set the
5829 option @code{org-agenda-columns-add-appointments-to-effort-sum}. The
5830 appointments on a day that take place over a specified time interval will
5831 then also be added to the load estimate of the day.
5832
5833 Effort estimates can be used in secondary agenda filtering that is triggered
5834 with the @kbd{/} key in the agenda (@pxref{Agenda commands}). If you have
5835 these estimates defined consistently, two or three key presses will narrow
5836 down the list to stuff that fits into an available time slot.
5837
5838 @node Relative timer, , Effort estimates, Dates and Times
5839 @section Taking notes with a relative timer
5840 @cindex relative timer
5841
5842 When taking notes during, for example, a meeting or a video viewing, it can
5843 be useful to have access to times relative to a starting time. Org provides
5844 such a relative timer and make it easy to create timed notes.
5845
5846 @table @kbd
5847 @kindex C-c C-x .
5848 @item C-c C-x .
5849 Insert a relative time into the buffer. The first time you use this, the
5850 timer will be started. When called with a prefix argument, the timer is
5851 restarted.
5852 @kindex C-c C-x -
5853 @item C-c C-x -
5854 Insert a description list item with the current relative time. With a prefix
5855 argument, first reset the timer to 0.
5856 @kindex M-@key{RET}
5857 @item M-@key{RET}
5858 Once the timer list is started, you can also use @kbd{M-@key{RET}} to insert
5859 new timer items.
5860 @kindex C-c C-x ,
5861 @item C-c C-x ,
5862 Pause the timer, or continue it if it is already paused.
5863 @c removed the sentence because it is redundant to the following item
5864 @kindex C-u C-c C-x ,
5865 @item C-u C-c C-x ,
5866 Stop the timer. After this, you can only start a new timer, not continue the
5867 old one. This command also removes the timer from the mode line.
5868 @kindex C-c C-x 0
5869 @item C-c C-x 0
5870 Reset the timer without inserting anything into the buffer. By default, the
5871 timer is reset to 0. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, reset the timer to
5872 specific starting offset. The user is prompted for the offset, with a
5873 default taken from a timer string at point, if any, So this can be used to
5874 restart taking notes after a break in the process. When called with a double
5875 prefix argument @kbd{C-u C-u}, change all timer strings in the active region
5876 by a certain amount. This can be used to fix timer strings if the timer was
5877 not started at exactly the right moment.
5878 @end table
5879
5880 @node Capture - Refile - Archive, Agenda Views, Dates and Times, Top
5881 @chapter Capture - Refile - Archive
5882 @cindex capture
5883
5884 An important part of any organization system is the ability to quickly
5885 capture new ideas and tasks, and to associate reference material with them.
5886 Org does this using a process called @i{capture}. It also can store files
5887 related to a task (@i{attachments}) in a special directory. Once in the
5888 system, tasks and projects need to be moved around. Moving completed project
5889 trees to an archive file keeps the system compact and fast.
5890
5891 @menu
5892 * Capture:: Capturing new stuff
5893 * Attachments:: Add files to tasks
5894 * RSS Feeds:: Getting input from RSS feeds
5895 * Protocols:: External (e.g. Browser) access to Emacs and Org
5896 * Refiling notes:: Moving a tree from one place to another
5897 * Archiving:: What to do with finished projects
5898 @end menu
5899
5900 @node Capture, Attachments, Capture - Refile - Archive, Capture - Refile - Archive
5901 @section Capture
5902 @cindex capture
5903
5904 Org's method for capturing new items is heavily inspired by John Wiegley
5905 excellent remember package. Up to version 6.36 Org used a special setup
5906 for @file{remember.el}. @file{org-remember.el} is still part of Org-mode for
5907 backward compatibility with existing setups. You can find the documentation
5908 for org-remember at @url{http://orgmode.org/org-remember.pdf}.
5909
5910 The new capturing setup described here is preferred and should be used by new
5911 users. To convert your @code{org-remember-templates}, run the command
5912 @example
5913 @kbd{M-x org-capture-import-remember-templates @key{RET}}
5914 @end example
5915 @noindent and then customize the new variable with @kbd{M-x
5916 customize-variable org-capture-templates}, check the result, and save the
5917 customization. You can then use both remember and capture until
5918 you are familiar with the new mechanism.
5919
5920 Capture lets you quickly store notes with little interruption of your work
5921 flow. The basic process of capturing is very similar to remember, but Org
5922 does enhance it with templates and more.
5923
5924 @menu
5925 * Setting up capture:: Where notes will be stored
5926 * Using capture:: Commands to invoke and terminate capture
5927 * Capture templates:: Define the outline of different note types
5928 @end menu
5929
5930 @node Setting up capture, Using capture, Capture, Capture
5931 @subsection Setting up capture
5932
5933 The following customization sets a default target file for notes, and defines
5934 a global key@footnote{Please select your own key, @kbd{C-c c} is only a
5935 suggestion.} for capturing new material.
5936
5937 @example
5938 (setq org-default-notes-file (concat org-directory "/notes.org"))
5939 (define-key global-map "\C-cc" 'org-capture)
5940 @end example
5941
5942 @node Using capture, Capture templates, Setting up capture, Capture
5943 @subsection Using capture
5944
5945 @table @kbd
5946 @kindex C-c c
5947 @item C-c c
5948 Call the command @code{org-capture}. If you have templates defined
5949 @pxref{Capture templates}, it will offer these templates for selection or use
5950 a new Org outline node as the default template. It will insert the template
5951 into the target file and switch to an indirect buffer narrowed to this new
5952 node. You may then insert the information you want.
5953
5954 @kindex C-c C-c
5955 @item C-c C-c
5956 Once you have finished entering information into the capture buffer,
5957 @kbd{C-c C-c} will return you to the window configuration before the capture
5958 process, so that you can resume your work without further distraction.
5959
5960 @kindex C-c C-w
5961 @item C-c C-w
5962 Finalize the capture process by refiling (@pxref{Refiling notes}) the note to
5963 a different place.
5964
5965 @kindex C-c C-k
5966 @item C-c C-k
5967 Abort the capture process and return to the previous state.
5968 @end table
5969
5970 You can also call @code{org-capture} in a special way from the agenda, using
5971 the @kbd{k c} key combination. With this access, any timestamps inserted by
5972 the selected capture template will default to the cursor date in the agenda,
5973 rather than to the current date.
5974
5975 @node Capture templates, , Using capture, Capture
5976 @subsection Capture templates
5977 @cindex templates, for Capture
5978
5979 You can use templates for different types of capture items, and
5980 for different target locations. The easiest way to create such templates is
5981 through the customize interface.
5982
5983 @table @kbd
5984 @kindex C-c c C
5985 @item C-c c C
5986 Customize the variable @code{org-capture-templates}.
5987 @end table
5988
5989 Before we give the formal description of template definitions, let's look at
5990 an example. Say you would like to use one template to create general TODO
5991 entries, and you want to put these entries under the heading @samp{Tasks} in
5992 your file @file{~/org/gtd.org}. Also, a date tree in the file
5993 @file{journal.org} should capture journal entries. A possible configuration
5994 would look like:
5995
5996 @example
5997 (setq org-capture-templates
5998 '(("t" "Todo" entry (file+headline "~/org/gtd.org" "Tasks")
5999 "* TODO %?\n %i\n %a")
6000 ("j" "Journal" entry (file+datetree "~/org/journal.org")
6001 "* %?\nEntered on %U\n %i\n %a")))
6002 @end example
6003
6004 @noindent If you then press @kbd{C-c c t}, Org will prepare the template
6005 for you like this:
6006 @example
6007 * TODO
6008 [[file:@var{link to where you initiated capture}]]
6009 @end example
6010
6011 @noindent
6012 During expansion of the template, @code{%a} has been replaced by a link to
6013 the location from where you called the capture command. This can be
6014 extremely useful for deriving tasks from emails, for example. You fill in
6015 the task definition, press @code{C-c C-c} and Org returns you to the same
6016 place where you started the capture process.
6017
6018
6019 @menu
6020 * Template elements:: What is needed for a complete template entry
6021 * Template expansion:: Filling in information about time and context
6022 @end menu
6023
6024 @node Template elements, Template expansion, Capture templates, Capture templates
6025 @subsubsection Template elements
6026
6027 Now lets look at the elements of a template definition. Each entry in
6028 @code{org-capture-templates} is a list with the following items:
6029
6030 @table @var
6031 @item keys
6032 The keys that will select the template, as a string, characters
6033 only, for example @code{"a"} for a template to be selected with a
6034 single key, or @code{"bt"} for selection with two keys. When using
6035 several keys, keys using the same prefix key must be sequential
6036 in the list and preceded by a 2-element entry explaining the
6037 prefix key, for example
6038 @example
6039 ("b" "Templates for marking stuff to buy")
6040 @end example
6041 @noindent If you do not define a template for the @kbd{C} key, this key will
6042 be used to open the customize buffer for this complex variable.
6043
6044 @item description
6045 A short string describing the template, which will be shown during
6046 selection.
6047
6048 @item type
6049 The type of entry, a symbol. Valid values are:
6050 @table @code
6051 @item entry
6052 An Org-mode node, with a headline. Will be filed as the child of the
6053 target entry or as a top-level entry. The target file should be an Org-mode
6054 file.
6055 @item item
6056 A plain list item, placed in the first plain list at the target
6057 location. Again the target file should be an Org file.
6058 @item checkitem
6059 A checkbox item. This only differs from the plain list item by the
6060 default template.
6061 @item table-line
6062 a new line in the first table at the target location. Where exactly the
6063 line will be inserted depends on the properties @code{:prepend} and
6064 @code{:table-line-pos} (see below).
6065 @item plain
6066 Text to be inserted as it is.
6067 @end table
6068
6069 @item target
6070 Specification of where the captured item should be placed.
6071 In Org-mode files, targets usually define a node. Entries will become
6072 children of this node, other types will be added to the table or list in the
6073 body of this node.
6074
6075 Valid values are:
6076 @table @code
6077 @item (file "path/to/file")
6078 Text will be placed at the beginning or end of that file.
6079
6080 @item (id "id of existing org entry")
6081 Filing as child of this entry, or in the body of the entry.
6082
6083 @item (file+headline "path/to/file" "node headline")
6084 Fast configuration if the target heading is unique in the file.
6085
6086 @item (file+olp "path/to/file" "Level 1 heading" "Level 2" ...)
6087 For non-unique headings, the full path is safer.
6088
6089 @item (file+regexp "path/to/file" "regexp to find location")
6090 Use a regular expression to position the cursor.
6091
6092 @item (file+datetree "path/to/file")
6093 Will create a heading in a date tree.
6094
6095 @item (file+function "path/to/file" function-finding-location)
6096 A function to find the right location in the file.
6097
6098 @item (clock)
6099 File to the entry that is currently being clocked.
6100
6101 @item (function function-finding-location)
6102 Most general way, write your own function to find both
6103 file and location.
6104 @end table
6105
6106 @item template
6107 The template for creating the capture item. If you leave this empty, an
6108 appropriate default template will be used. Otherwise this is a string with
6109 escape codes, which will be replaced depending on time and context of the
6110 capture call. The string with escapes may be loaded from a template file,
6111 using the special syntax @code{(file "path/to/template")}. See below for
6112 more details.
6113
6114 @item properties
6115 The rest of the entry is a property list of additional options.
6116 Recognized properties are:
6117 @table @code
6118 @item :prepend
6119 Normally new captured information will be appended at
6120 the target location (last child, last table line, last list item...).
6121 Setting this property will change that.
6122
6123 @item :immediate-finish
6124 When set, do not offer to edit the information, just
6125 file it away immediately. This makes sense if the template only needs
6126 information that can be added automatically.
6127
6128 @item :empty-lines
6129 Set this to the number of lines to insert
6130 before and after the new item. Default 0, only common other value is 1.
6131
6132 @item :clock-in
6133 Start the clock in this item.
6134
6135 @item :clock-resume
6136 If starting the capture interrupted a clock, restart that clock when finished
6137 with the capture.
6138
6139 @item :unnarrowed
6140 Do not narrow the target buffer, simply show the full buffer. Default is to
6141 narrow it so that you only see the new material.
6142 @end table
6143 @end table
6144
6145 @node Template expansion, , Template elements, Capture templates
6146 @subsubsection Template expansion
6147
6148 In the template itself, special @kbd{%}-escapes@footnote{If you need one of
6149 these sequences literally, escape the @kbd{%} with a backslash.} allow
6150 dynamic insertion of content:
6151
6152 @comment SJE: should these sentences terminate in period?
6153 @smallexample
6154 %^@{@var{prompt}@} @r{prompt the user for a string and replace this sequence with it.}
6155 @r{You may specify a default value and a completion table with}
6156 @r{%^@{prompt|default|completion2|completion3...@}}
6157 @r{The arrow keys access a prompt-specific history.}
6158 %a @r{annotation, normally the link created with @code{org-store-link}}
6159 %A @r{like @code{%a}, but prompt for the description part}
6160 %i @r{initial content, the region when capture is called while the}
6161 @r{region is active.}
6162 @r{The entire text will be indented like @code{%i} itself.}
6163 %t @r{timestamp, date only}
6164 %T @r{timestamp with date and time}
6165 %u, %U @r{like the above, but inactive timestamps}
6166 %^t @r{like @code{%t}, but prompt for date. Similarly @code{%^T}, @code{%^u}, @code{%^U}}
6167 @r{You may define a prompt like @code{%^@{Birthday@}t}}
6168 %n @r{user name (taken from @code{user-full-name})}
6169 %c @r{Current kill ring head.}
6170 %x @r{Content of the X clipboard.}
6171 %^C @r{Interactive selection of which kill or clip to use.}
6172 %^L @r{Like @code{%^C}, but insert as link.}
6173 %k @r{title of the currently clocked task}
6174 %K @r{link to the currently clocked task}
6175 %^g @r{prompt for tags, with completion on tags in target file.}
6176 %^G @r{prompt for tags, with completion all tags in all agenda files.}
6177 %^@{@var{prop}@}p @r{Prompt the user for a value for property @var{prop}}
6178 %:keyword @r{specific information for certain link types, see below}
6179 %[@var{file}] @r{insert the contents of the file given by @var{file}}
6180 %(@var{sexp}) @r{evaluate Elisp @var{sexp} and replace with the result}
6181 @end smallexample
6182
6183 @noindent
6184 For specific link types, the following keywords will be
6185 defined@footnote{If you define your own link types (@pxref{Adding
6186 hyperlink types}), any property you store with
6187 @code{org-store-link-props} can be accessed in capture templates in a
6188 similar way.}:
6189
6190 @vindex org-from-is-user-regexp
6191 @smallexample
6192 Link type | Available keywords
6193 -------------------+----------------------------------------------
6194 bbdb | %:name %:company
6195 bbdb | %::server %:port %:nick
6196 vm, wl, mh, rmail | %:type %:subject %:message-id
6197 | %:from %:fromname %:fromaddress
6198 | %:to %:toname %:toaddress
6199 | %:fromto @r{(either "to NAME" or "from NAME")@footnote{This will always be the other, not the user. See the variable @code{org-from-is-user-regexp}.}}
6200 gnus | %:group, @r{for messages also all email fields}
6201 w3, w3m | %:url
6202 info | %:file %:node
6203 calendar | %:date
6204 @end smallexample
6205
6206 @noindent
6207 To place the cursor after template expansion use:
6208
6209 @smallexample
6210 %? @r{After completing the template, position cursor here.}
6211 @end smallexample
6212
6213
6214 @node Attachments, RSS Feeds, Capture, Capture - Refile - Archive
6215 @section Attachments
6216 @cindex attachments
6217
6218 @vindex org-attach-directory
6219 It is often useful to associate reference material with an outline node/task.
6220 Small chunks of plain text can simply be stored in the subtree of a project.
6221 Hyperlinks (@pxref{Hyperlinks}) can establish associations with
6222 files that live elsewhere on your computer or in the cloud, like emails or
6223 source code files belonging to a project. Another method is @i{attachments},
6224 which are files located in a directory belonging to an outline node. Org
6225 uses directories named by the unique ID of each entry. These directories are
6226 located in the @file{data} directory which lives in the same directory where
6227 your Org file lives@footnote{If you move entries or Org files from one
6228 directory to another, you may want to configure @code{org-attach-directory}
6229 to contain an absolute path.}. If you initialize this directory with
6230 @code{git init}, Org will automatically commit changes when it sees them.
6231 The attachment system has been contributed to Org by John Wiegley.
6232
6233 In cases where it seems better to do so, you can also attach a directory of your
6234 choice to an entry. You can also make children inherit the attachment
6235 directory from a parent, so that an entire subtree uses the same attached
6236 directory.
6237
6238 @noindent The following commands deal with attachments:
6239
6240 @table @kbd
6241
6242 @kindex C-c C-a
6243 @item C-c C-a
6244 The dispatcher for commands related to the attachment system. After these
6245 keys, a list of commands is displayed and you must press an additional key
6246 to select a command:
6247
6248 @table @kbd
6249 @kindex C-c C-a a
6250 @item a
6251 @vindex org-attach-method
6252 Select a file and move it into the task's attachment directory. The file
6253 will be copied, moved, or linked, depending on @code{org-attach-method}.
6254 Note that hard links are not supported on all systems.
6255
6256 @kindex C-c C-a c
6257 @kindex C-c C-a m
6258 @kindex C-c C-a l
6259 @item c/m/l
6260 Attach a file using the copy/move/link method.
6261 Note that hard links are not supported on all systems.
6262
6263 @kindex C-c C-a n
6264 @item n
6265 Create a new attachment as an Emacs buffer.
6266
6267 @kindex C-c C-a z
6268 @item z
6269 Synchronize the current task with its attachment directory, in case you added
6270 attachments yourself.
6271
6272 @kindex C-c C-a o
6273 @item o
6274 @vindex org-file-apps
6275 Open current task's attachment. If there is more than one, prompt for a
6276 file name first. Opening will follow the rules set by @code{org-file-apps}.
6277 For more details, see the information on following hyperlinks
6278 (@pxref{Handling links}).
6279
6280 @kindex C-c C-a O
6281 @item O
6282 Also open the attachment, but force opening the file in Emacs.
6283
6284 @kindex C-c C-a f
6285 @item f
6286 Open the current task's attachment directory.
6287
6288 @kindex C-c C-a F
6289 @item F
6290 Also open the directory, but force using @command{dired} in Emacs.
6291
6292 @kindex C-c C-a d
6293 @item d
6294 Select and delete a single attachment.
6295
6296 @kindex C-c C-a D
6297 @item D
6298 Delete all of a task's attachments. A safer way is to open the directory in
6299 @command{dired} and delete from there.
6300
6301 @kindex C-c C-a s
6302 @item C-c C-a s
6303 @cindex property, ATTACH_DIR
6304 Set a specific directory as the entry's attachment directory. This works by
6305 putting the directory path into the @code{ATTACH_DIR} property.
6306
6307 @kindex C-c C-a i
6308 @item C-c C-a i
6309 @cindex property, ATTACH_DIR_INHERIT
6310 Set the @code{ATTACH_DIR_INHERIT} property, so that children will use the
6311 same directory for attachments as the parent does.
6312 @end table
6313 @end table
6314
6315 @node RSS Feeds, Protocols, Attachments, Capture - Refile - Archive
6316 @section RSS feeds
6317 @cindex RSS feeds
6318 @cindex Atom feeds
6319
6320 Org can add and change entries based on information found in RSS feeds and
6321 Atom feeds. You could use this to make a task out of each new podcast in a
6322 podcast feed. Or you could use a phone-based note-creating service on the
6323 web to import tasks into Org. To access feeds, configure the variable
6324 @code{org-feed-alist}. The docstring of this variable has detailed
6325 information. Here is just an example:
6326
6327 @example
6328 (setq org-feed-alist
6329 '(("Slashdot"
6330 "http://rss.slashdot.org/Slashdot/slashdot"
6331 "~/txt/org/feeds.org" "Slashdot Entries")))
6332 @end example
6333
6334 @noindent
6335 will configure that new items from the feed provided by
6336 @code{rss.slashdot.org} will result in new entries in the file
6337 @file{~/org/feeds.org} under the heading @samp{Slashdot Entries}, whenever
6338 the following command is used:
6339
6340 @table @kbd
6341 @kindex C-c C-x g
6342 @item C-c C-x g
6343 Collect items from the feeds configured in @code{org-feed-alist} and act upon
6344 them.
6345 @kindex C-c C-x G
6346 @item C-c C-x G
6347 Prompt for a feed name and go to the inbox configured for this feed.
6348 @end table
6349
6350 Under the same headline, Org will create a drawer @samp{FEEDSTATUS} in which
6351 it will store information about the status of items in the feed, to avoid
6352 adding the same item several times. You should add @samp{FEEDSTATUS} to the
6353 list of drawers in that file:
6354
6355 @example
6356 #+DRAWERS: LOGBOOK PROPERTIES FEEDSTATUS
6357 @end example
6358
6359 For more information, including how to read atom feeds, see
6360 @file{org-feed.el} and the docstring of @code{org-feed-alist}.
6361
6362 @node Protocols, Refiling notes, RSS Feeds, Capture - Refile - Archive
6363 @section Protocols for external access
6364 @cindex protocols, for external access
6365 @cindex emacsserver
6366
6367 You can set up Org for handling protocol calls from outside applications that
6368 are passed to Emacs through the @file{emacsserver}. For example, you can
6369 configure bookmarks in your web browser to send a link to the current page to
6370 Org and create a note from it using capture (@pxref{Capture}). Or you
6371 could create a bookmark that will tell Emacs to open the local source file of
6372 a remote website you are looking at with the browser. See
6373 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/org-protocol.php} for detailed
6374 documentation and setup instructions.
6375
6376 @node Refiling notes, Archiving, Protocols, Capture - Refile - Archive
6377 @section Refiling notes
6378 @cindex refiling notes
6379
6380 When reviewing the captured data, you may want to refile some of the entries
6381 into a different list, for example into a project. Cutting, finding the
6382 right location, and then pasting the note is cumbersome. To simplify this
6383 process, you can use the following special command:
6384
6385 @table @kbd
6386 @kindex C-c C-w
6387 @item C-c C-w
6388 @vindex org-reverse-note-order
6389 @vindex org-refile-targets
6390 @vindex org-refile-use-outline-path
6391 @vindex org-outline-path-complete-in-steps
6392 @vindex org-refile-allow-creating-parent-nodes
6393 @vindex org-log-refile
6394 @vindex org-refile-use-cache
6395 Refile the entry or region at point. This command offers possible locations
6396 for refiling the entry and lets you select one with completion. The item (or
6397 all items in the region) is filed below the target heading as a subitem.
6398 Depending on @code{org-reverse-note-order}, it will be either the first or
6399 last subitem.@*
6400 By default, all level 1 headlines in the current buffer are considered to be
6401 targets, but you can have more complex definitions across a number of files.
6402 See the variable @code{org-refile-targets} for details. If you would like to
6403 select a location via a file-path-like completion along the outline path, see
6404 the variables @code{org-refile-use-outline-path} and
6405 @code{org-outline-path-complete-in-steps}. If you would like to be able to
6406 create new nodes as new parents for refiling on the fly, check the
6407 variable @code{org-refile-allow-creating-parent-nodes}.
6408 When the variable @code{org-log-refile}@footnote{with corresponding
6409 @code{#+STARTUP} keywords @code{logrefile}, @code{lognoterefile},
6410 and @code{nologrefile}} is set, a time stamp or a note will be
6411 recorded when an entry has been refiled.
6412 @kindex C-u C-c C-w
6413 @item C-u C-c C-w
6414 Use the refile interface to jump to a heading.
6415 @kindex C-u C-u C-c C-w
6416 @item C-u C-u C-c C-w
6417 Jump to the location where @code{org-refile} last moved a tree to.
6418 @item C-2 C-c C-w
6419 Refile as the child of the item currently being clocked.
6420 @item C-0 C-c C-w @ @r{or} @ C-u C-u C-u C-c C-w
6421 Clear the target cache. Caching of refile targets can be turned on by
6422 setting @code{org-refile-use-cache}. To make the command seen new possible
6423 targets, you have to clear the cache with this command.
6424 @end table
6425
6426 @node Archiving, , Refiling notes, Capture - Refile - Archive
6427 @section Archiving
6428 @cindex archiving
6429
6430 When a project represented by a (sub)tree is finished, you may want
6431 to move the tree out of the way and to stop it from contributing to the
6432 agenda. Archiving is important to keep your working files compact and global
6433 searches like the construction of agenda views fast.
6434
6435 @table @kbd
6436 @kindex C-c C-x C-a
6437 @item C-c C-x C-a
6438 @vindex org-archive-default-command
6439 Archive the current entry using the command specified in the variable
6440 @code{org-archive-default-command}.
6441 @end table
6442
6443 @menu
6444 * Moving subtrees:: Moving a tree to an archive file
6445 * Internal archiving:: Switch off a tree but keep it in the file
6446 @end menu
6447
6448 @node Moving subtrees, Internal archiving, Archiving, Archiving
6449 @subsection Moving a tree to the archive file
6450 @cindex external archiving
6451
6452 The most common archiving action is to move a project tree to another file,
6453 the archive file.
6454
6455 @table @kbd
6456 @kindex C-c $
6457 @kindex C-c C-x C-s
6458 @item C-c C-x C-s@ @r{or short} @ C-c $
6459 @vindex org-archive-location
6460 Archive the subtree starting at the cursor position to the location
6461 given by @code{org-archive-location}.
6462 @kindex C-u C-c C-x C-s
6463 @item C-u C-c C-x C-s
6464 Check if any direct children of the current headline could be moved to
6465 the archive. To do this, each subtree is checked for open TODO entries.
6466 If none are found, the command offers to move it to the archive
6467 location. If the cursor is @emph{not} on a headline when this command
6468 is invoked, the level 1 trees will be checked.
6469 @end table
6470
6471 @cindex archive locations
6472 The default archive location is a file in the same directory as the
6473 current file, with the name derived by appending @file{_archive} to the
6474 current file name. For information and examples on how to change this,
6475 see the documentation string of the variable
6476 @code{org-archive-location}. There is also an in-buffer option for
6477 setting this variable, for example@footnote{For backward compatibility,
6478 the following also works: If there are several such lines in a file,
6479 each specifies the archive location for the text below it. The first
6480 such line also applies to any text before its definition. However,
6481 using this method is @emph{strongly} deprecated as it is incompatible
6482 with the outline structure of the document. The correct method for
6483 setting multiple archive locations in a buffer is using properties.}:
6484
6485 @cindex #+ARCHIVE
6486 @example
6487 #+ARCHIVE: %s_done::
6488 @end example
6489
6490 @cindex property, ARCHIVE
6491 @noindent
6492 If you would like to have a special ARCHIVE location for a single entry
6493 or a (sub)tree, give the entry an @code{:ARCHIVE:} property with the
6494 location as the value (@pxref{Properties and Columns}).
6495
6496 @vindex org-archive-save-context-info
6497 When a subtree is moved, it receives a number of special properties that
6498 record context information like the file from where the entry came, its
6499 outline path the archiving time etc. Configure the variable
6500 @code{org-archive-save-context-info} to adjust the amount of information
6501 added.
6502
6503
6504 @node Internal archiving, , Moving subtrees, Archiving
6505 @subsection Internal archiving
6506
6507 If you want to just switch off (for agenda views) certain subtrees without
6508 moving them to a different file, you can use the @code{ARCHIVE tag}.
6509
6510 A headline that is marked with the ARCHIVE tag (@pxref{Tags}) stays at
6511 its location in the outline tree, but behaves in the following way:
6512 @itemize @minus
6513 @item
6514 @vindex org-cycle-open-archived-trees
6515 It does not open when you attempt to do so with a visibility cycling
6516 command (@pxref{Visibility cycling}). You can force cycling archived
6517 subtrees with @kbd{C-@key{TAB}}, or by setting the option
6518 @code{org-cycle-open-archived-trees}. Also normal outline commands like
6519 @code{show-all} will open archived subtrees.
6520 @item
6521 @vindex org-sparse-tree-open-archived-trees
6522 During sparse tree construction (@pxref{Sparse trees}), matches in
6523 archived subtrees are not exposed, unless you configure the option
6524 @code{org-sparse-tree-open-archived-trees}.
6525 @item
6526 @vindex org-agenda-skip-archived-trees
6527 During agenda view construction (@pxref{Agenda Views}), the content of
6528 archived trees is ignored unless you configure the option
6529 @code{org-agenda-skip-archived-trees}, in which case these trees will always
6530 be included. In the agenda you can press @kbd{v a} to get archives
6531 temporarily included.
6532 @item
6533 @vindex org-export-with-archived-trees
6534 Archived trees are not exported (@pxref{Exporting}), only the headline
6535 is. Configure the details using the variable
6536 @code{org-export-with-archived-trees}.
6537 @item
6538 @vindex org-columns-skip-archived-trees
6539 Archived trees are excluded from column view unless the variable
6540 @code{org-columns-skip-archived-trees} is configured to @code{nil}.
6541 @end itemize
6542
6543 The following commands help manage the ARCHIVE tag:
6544
6545 @table @kbd
6546 @kindex C-c C-x a
6547 @item C-c C-x a
6548 Toggle the ARCHIVE tag for the current headline. When the tag is set,
6549 the headline changes to a shadowed face, and the subtree below it is
6550 hidden.
6551 @kindex C-u C-c C-x a
6552 @item C-u C-c C-x a
6553 Check if any direct children of the current headline should be archived.
6554 To do this, each subtree is checked for open TODO entries. If none are
6555 found, the command offers to set the ARCHIVE tag for the child. If the
6556 cursor is @emph{not} on a headline when this command is invoked, the
6557 level 1 trees will be checked.
6558 @kindex C-@kbd{TAB}
6559 @item C-@kbd{TAB}
6560 Cycle a tree even if it is tagged with ARCHIVE.
6561 @kindex C-c C-x A
6562 @item C-c C-x A
6563 Move the current entry to the @emph{Archive Sibling}. This is a sibling of
6564 the entry with the heading @samp{Archive} and the tag @samp{ARCHIVE}. The
6565 entry becomes a child of that sibling and in this way retains a lot of its
6566 original context, including inherited tags and approximate position in the
6567 outline.
6568 @end table
6569
6570
6571 @node Agenda Views, Markup, Capture - Refile - Archive, Top
6572 @chapter Agenda views
6573 @cindex agenda views
6574
6575 Due to the way Org works, TODO items, time-stamped items, and
6576 tagged headlines can be scattered throughout a file or even a number of
6577 files. To get an overview of open action items, or of events that are
6578 important for a particular date, this information must be collected,
6579 sorted and displayed in an organized way.
6580
6581 Org can select items based on various criteria and display them
6582 in a separate buffer. Seven different view types are provided:
6583
6584 @itemize @bullet
6585 @item
6586 an @emph{agenda} that is like a calendar and shows information
6587 for specific dates,
6588 @item
6589 a @emph{TODO list} that covers all unfinished
6590 action items,
6591 @item
6592 a @emph{match view}, showings headlines based on the tags, properties, and
6593 TODO state associated with them,
6594 @item
6595 a @emph{timeline view} that shows all events in a single Org file,
6596 in time-sorted view,
6597 @item
6598 a @emph{text search view} that shows all entries from multiple files
6599 that contain specified keywords,
6600 @item
6601 a @emph{stuck projects view} showing projects that currently don't move
6602 along, and
6603 @item
6604 @emph{custom views} that are special searches and combinations of different
6605 views.
6606 @end itemize
6607
6608 @noindent
6609 The extracted information is displayed in a special @emph{agenda
6610 buffer}. This buffer is read-only, but provides commands to visit the
6611 corresponding locations in the original Org files, and even to
6612 edit these files remotely.
6613
6614 @vindex org-agenda-window-setup
6615 @vindex org-agenda-restore-windows-after-quit
6616 Two variables control how the agenda buffer is displayed and whether the
6617 window configuration is restored when the agenda exits:
6618 @code{org-agenda-window-setup} and
6619 @code{org-agenda-restore-windows-after-quit}.
6620
6621 @menu
6622 * Agenda files:: Files being searched for agenda information
6623 * Agenda dispatcher:: Keyboard access to agenda views
6624 * Built-in agenda views:: What is available out of the box?
6625 * Presentation and sorting:: How agenda items are prepared for display
6626 * Agenda commands:: Remote editing of Org trees
6627 * Custom agenda views:: Defining special searches and views
6628 * Exporting Agenda Views:: Writing a view to a file
6629 * Agenda column view:: Using column view for collected entries
6630 @end menu
6631
6632 @node Agenda files, Agenda dispatcher, Agenda Views, Agenda Views
6633 @section Agenda files
6634 @cindex agenda files
6635 @cindex files for agenda
6636
6637 @vindex org-agenda-files
6638 The information to be shown is normally collected from all @emph{agenda
6639 files}, the files listed in the variable
6640 @code{org-agenda-files}@footnote{If the value of that variable is not a
6641 list, but a single file name, then the list of agenda files will be
6642 maintained in that external file.}. If a directory is part of this list,
6643 all files with the extension @file{.org} in this directory will be part
6644 of the list.
6645
6646 Thus, even if you only work with a single Org file, that file should
6647 be put into the list@footnote{When using the dispatcher, pressing
6648 @kbd{<} before selecting a command will actually limit the command to
6649 the current file, and ignore @code{org-agenda-files} until the next
6650 dispatcher command.}. You can customize @code{org-agenda-files}, but
6651 the easiest way to maintain it is through the following commands
6652
6653 @cindex files, adding to agenda list
6654 @table @kbd
6655 @kindex C-c [
6656 @item C-c [
6657 Add current file to the list of agenda files. The file is added to
6658 the front of the list. If it was already in the list, it is moved to
6659 the front. With a prefix argument, file is added/moved to the end.
6660 @kindex C-c ]
6661 @item C-c ]
6662 Remove current file from the list of agenda files.
6663 @kindex C-,
6664 @kindex C-'
6665 @item C-,
6666 @itemx C-'
6667 Cycle through agenda file list, visiting one file after the other.
6668 @kindex M-x org-iswitchb
6669 @item M-x org-iswitchb
6670 Command to use an @code{iswitchb}-like interface to switch to and between Org
6671 buffers.
6672 @end table
6673
6674 @noindent
6675 The Org menu contains the current list of files and can be used
6676 to visit any of them.
6677
6678 If you would like to focus the agenda temporarily on a file not in
6679 this list, or on just one file in the list, or even on only a subtree in a
6680 file, then this can be done in different ways. For a single agenda command,
6681 you may press @kbd{<} once or several times in the dispatcher
6682 (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}). To restrict the agenda scope for an
6683 extended period, use the following commands:
6684
6685 @table @kbd
6686 @kindex C-c C-x <
6687 @item C-c C-x <
6688 Permanently restrict the agenda to the current subtree. When with a
6689 prefix argument, or with the cursor before the first headline in a file,
6690 the agenda scope is set to the entire file. This restriction remains in
6691 effect until removed with @kbd{C-c C-x >}, or by typing either @kbd{<}
6692 or @kbd{>} in the agenda dispatcher. If there is a window displaying an
6693 agenda view, the new restriction takes effect immediately.
6694 @kindex C-c C-x >
6695 @item C-c C-x >
6696 Remove the permanent restriction created by @kbd{C-c C-x <}.
6697 @end table
6698
6699 @noindent
6700 When working with @file{speedbar.el}, you can use the following commands in
6701 the Speedbar frame:
6702 @table @kbd
6703 @kindex <
6704 @item < @r{in the speedbar frame}
6705 Permanently restrict the agenda to the item---either an Org file or a subtree
6706 in such a file---at the cursor in the Speedbar frame.
6707 If there is a window displaying an agenda view, the new restriction takes
6708 effect immediately.
6709 @kindex >
6710 @item > @r{in the speedbar frame}
6711 Lift the restriction.
6712 @end table
6713
6714 @node Agenda dispatcher, Built-in agenda views, Agenda files, Agenda Views
6715 @section The agenda dispatcher
6716 @cindex agenda dispatcher
6717 @cindex dispatching agenda commands
6718 The views are created through a dispatcher, which should be bound to a
6719 global key---for example @kbd{C-c a} (@pxref{Installation}). In the
6720 following we will assume that @kbd{C-c a} is indeed how the dispatcher
6721 is accessed and list keyboard access to commands accordingly. After
6722 pressing @kbd{C-c a}, an additional letter is required to execute a
6723 command. The dispatcher offers the following default commands:
6724 @table @kbd
6725 @item a
6726 Create the calendar-like agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}).
6727 @item t @r{/} T
6728 Create a list of all TODO items (@pxref{Global TODO list}).
6729 @item m @r{/} M
6730 Create a list of headlines matching a TAGS expression (@pxref{Matching
6731 tags and properties}).
6732 @item L
6733 Create the timeline view for the current buffer (@pxref{Timeline}).
6734 @item s
6735 Create a list of entries selected by a boolean expression of keywords
6736 and/or regular expressions that must or must not occur in the entry.
6737 @item /
6738 @vindex org-agenda-text-search-extra-files
6739 Search for a regular expression in all agenda files and additionally in
6740 the files listed in @code{org-agenda-text-search-extra-files}. This
6741 uses the Emacs command @code{multi-occur}. A prefix argument can be
6742 used to specify the number of context lines for each match, default is
6743 1.
6744 @item # @r{/} !
6745 Create a list of stuck projects (@pxref{Stuck projects}).
6746 @item <
6747 Restrict an agenda command to the current buffer@footnote{For backward
6748 compatibility, you can also press @kbd{1} to restrict to the current
6749 buffer.}. After pressing @kbd{<}, you still need to press the character
6750 selecting the command.
6751 @item < <
6752 If there is an active region, restrict the following agenda command to
6753 the region. Otherwise, restrict it to the current subtree@footnote{For
6754 backward compatibility, you can also press @kbd{0} to restrict to the
6755 current region/subtree.}. After pressing @kbd{< <}, you still need to press the
6756 character selecting the command.
6757 @end table
6758
6759 You can also define custom commands that will be accessible through the
6760 dispatcher, just like the default commands. This includes the
6761 possibility to create extended agenda buffers that contain several
6762 blocks together, for example the weekly agenda, the global TODO list and
6763 a number of special tags matches. @xref{Custom agenda views}.
6764
6765 @node Built-in agenda views, Presentation and sorting, Agenda dispatcher, Agenda Views
6766 @section The built-in agenda views
6767
6768 In this section we describe the built-in views.
6769
6770 @menu
6771 * Weekly/daily agenda:: The calendar page with current tasks
6772 * Global TODO list:: All unfinished action items
6773 * Matching tags and properties:: Structured information with fine-tuned search
6774 * Timeline:: Time-sorted view for single file
6775 * Search view:: Find entries by searching for text
6776 * Stuck projects:: Find projects you need to review
6777 @end menu
6778
6779 @node Weekly/daily agenda, Global TODO list, Built-in agenda views, Built-in agenda views
6780 @subsection The weekly/daily agenda
6781 @cindex agenda
6782 @cindex weekly agenda
6783 @cindex daily agenda
6784
6785 The purpose of the weekly/daily @emph{agenda} is to act like a page of a
6786 paper agenda, showing all the tasks for the current week or day.
6787
6788 @table @kbd
6789 @cindex org-agenda, command
6790 @kindex C-c a a
6791 @item C-c a a
6792 @vindex org-agenda-ndays
6793 Compile an agenda for the current week from a list of Org files. The agenda
6794 shows the entries for each day. With a numeric prefix@footnote{For backward
6795 compatibility, the universal prefix @kbd{C-u} causes all TODO entries to be
6796 listed before the agenda. This feature is deprecated, use the dedicated TODO
6797 list, or a block agenda instead (@pxref{Block agenda}).} (like @kbd{C-u 2 1
6798 C-c a a}) you may set the number of days to be displayed (see also the
6799 variable @code{org-agenda-ndays})
6800 @end table
6801
6802 Remote editing from the agenda buffer means, for example, that you can
6803 change the dates of deadlines and appointments from the agenda buffer.
6804 The commands available in the Agenda buffer are listed in @ref{Agenda
6805 commands}.
6806
6807 @subsubheading Calendar/Diary integration
6808 @cindex calendar integration
6809 @cindex diary integration
6810
6811 Emacs contains the calendar and diary by Edward M. Reingold. The
6812 calendar displays a three-month calendar with holidays from different
6813 countries and cultures. The diary allows you to keep track of
6814 anniversaries, lunar phases, sunrise/set, recurrent appointments
6815 (weekly, monthly) and more. In this way, it is quite complementary to
6816 Org. It can be very useful to combine output from Org with
6817 the diary.
6818
6819 In order to include entries from the Emacs diary into Org-mode's
6820 agenda, you only need to customize the variable
6821
6822 @lisp
6823 (setq org-agenda-include-diary t)
6824 @end lisp
6825
6826 @noindent After that, everything will happen automatically. All diary
6827 entries including holidays, anniversaries, etc., will be included in the
6828 agenda buffer created by Org-mode. @key{SPC}, @key{TAB}, and
6829 @key{RET} can be used from the agenda buffer to jump to the diary
6830 file in order to edit existing diary entries. The @kbd{i} command to
6831 insert new entries for the current date works in the agenda buffer, as
6832 well as the commands @kbd{S}, @kbd{M}, and @kbd{C} to display
6833 Sunrise/Sunset times, show lunar phases and to convert to other
6834 calendars, respectively. @kbd{c} can be used to switch back and forth
6835 between calendar and agenda.
6836
6837 If you are using the diary only for sexp entries and holidays, it is
6838 faster to not use the above setting, but instead to copy or even move
6839 the entries into an Org file. Org-mode evaluates diary-style sexp
6840 entries, and does it faster because there is no overhead for first
6841 creating the diary display. Note that the sexp entries must start at
6842 the left margin, no whitespace is allowed before them. For example,
6843 the following segment of an Org file will be processed and entries
6844 will be made in the agenda:
6845
6846 @example
6847 * Birthdays and similar stuff
6848 #+CATEGORY: Holiday
6849 %%(org-calendar-holiday) ; special function for holiday names
6850 #+CATEGORY: Ann
6851 %%(diary-anniversary 5 14 1956)@footnote{Note that the order of the arguments (month, day, year) depends on the setting of @code{calendar-date-style}.} Arthur Dent is %d years old
6852 %%(diary-anniversary 10 2 1869) Mahatma Gandhi would be %d years old
6853 @end example
6854
6855 @subsubheading Anniversaries from BBDB
6856 @cindex BBDB, anniversaries
6857 @cindex anniversaries, from BBDB
6858
6859 If you are using the Big Brothers Database to store your contacts, you will
6860 very likely prefer to store anniversaries in BBDB rather than in a
6861 separate Org or diary file. Org supports this and will show BBDB
6862 anniversaries as part of the agenda. All you need to do is to add the
6863 following to one your your agenda files:
6864
6865 @example
6866 * Anniversaries
6867 :PROPERTIES:
6868 :CATEGORY: Anniv
6869 :END:
6870 %%(org-bbdb-anniversaries)
6871 @end example
6872
6873 You can then go ahead and define anniversaries for a BBDB record. Basically,
6874 you need to press @kbd{C-o anniversary @key{RET}} with the cursor in a BBDB
6875 record and then add the date in the format @code{YYYY-MM-DD}, followed by a
6876 space and the class of the anniversary (@samp{birthday} or @samp{wedding}, or
6877 a format string). If you omit the class, it will default to @samp{birthday}.
6878 Here are a few examples, the header for the file @file{org-bbdb.el} contains
6879 more detailed information.
6880
6881 @example
6882 1973-06-22
6883 1955-08-02 wedding
6884 2008-04-14 %s released version 6.01 of org-mode, %d years ago
6885 @end example
6886
6887 After a change to BBDB, or for the first agenda display during an Emacs
6888 session, the agenda display will suffer a short delay as Org updates its
6889 hash with anniversaries. However, from then on things will be very fast---much
6890 faster in fact than a long list of @samp{%%(diary-anniversary)} entries
6891 in an Org or Diary file.
6892
6893 @subsubheading Appointment reminders
6894 @cindex @file{appt.el}
6895 @cindex appointment reminders
6896
6897 Org can interact with Emacs appointments notification facility. To add all
6898 the appointments of your agenda files, use the command
6899 @code{org-agenda-to-appt}. This command also lets you filter through the
6900 list of your appointments and add only those belonging to a specific category
6901 or matching a regular expression. See the docstring for details.
6902
6903 @node Global TODO list, Matching tags and properties, Weekly/daily agenda, Built-in agenda views
6904 @subsection The global TODO list
6905 @cindex global TODO list
6906 @cindex TODO list, global
6907
6908 The global TODO list contains all unfinished TODO items formatted and
6909 collected into a single place.
6910
6911 @table @kbd
6912 @kindex C-c a t
6913 @item C-c a t
6914 Show the global TODO list. This collects the TODO items from all agenda
6915 files (@pxref{Agenda Views}) into a single buffer. By default, this lists
6916 items with a state the is not a DONE state. The buffer is in
6917 @code{agenda-mode}, so there are commands to examine and manipulate the TODO
6918 entries directly from that buffer (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
6919 @kindex C-c a T
6920 @item C-c a T
6921 @cindex TODO keyword matching
6922 @vindex org-todo-keywords
6923 Like the above, but allows selection of a specific TODO keyword. You can
6924 also do this by specifying a prefix argument to @kbd{C-c a t}. You are
6925 prompted for a keyword, and you may also specify several keywords by
6926 separating them with @samp{|} as the boolean OR operator. With a numeric
6927 prefix, the nth keyword in @code{org-todo-keywords} is selected.
6928 @kindex r
6929 The @kbd{r} key in the agenda buffer regenerates it, and you can give
6930 a prefix argument to this command to change the selected TODO keyword,
6931 for example @kbd{3 r}. If you often need a search for a specific
6932 keyword, define a custom command for it (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).@*
6933 Matching specific TODO keywords can also be done as part of a tags
6934 search (@pxref{Tag searches}).
6935 @end table
6936
6937 Remote editing of TODO items means that you can change the state of a
6938 TODO entry with a single key press. The commands available in the
6939 TODO list are described in @ref{Agenda commands}.
6940
6941 @cindex sublevels, inclusion into TODO list
6942 Normally the global TODO list simply shows all headlines with TODO
6943 keywords. This list can become very long. There are two ways to keep
6944 it more compact:
6945 @itemize @minus
6946 @item
6947 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-scheduled
6948 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-deadlines
6949 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-with-date
6950 Some people view a TODO item that has been @emph{scheduled} for execution or
6951 have a @emph{deadline} (@pxref{Timestamps}) as no longer @emph{open}.
6952 Configure the variables @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-scheduled},
6953 @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-deadlines}, and/or
6954 @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-with-date} to exclude such items from the
6955 global TODO list.
6956 @item
6957 @vindex org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels
6958 TODO items may have sublevels to break up the task into subtasks. In
6959 such cases it may be enough to list only the highest level TODO headline
6960 and omit the sublevels from the global list. Configure the variable
6961 @code{org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels} to get this behavior.
6962 @end itemize
6963
6964 @node Matching tags and properties, Timeline, Global TODO list, Built-in agenda views
6965 @subsection Matching tags and properties
6966 @cindex matching, of tags
6967 @cindex matching, of properties
6968 @cindex tags view
6969 @cindex match view
6970
6971 If headlines in the agenda files are marked with @emph{tags} (@pxref{Tags}),
6972 or have properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}), you can select headlines
6973 based on this metadata and collect them into an agenda buffer. The match
6974 syntax described here also applies when creating sparse trees with @kbd{C-c /
6975 m}.
6976
6977 @table @kbd
6978 @kindex C-c a m
6979 @item C-c a m
6980 Produce a list of all headlines that match a given set of tags. The
6981 command prompts for a selection criterion, which is a boolean logic
6982 expression with tags, like @samp{+work+urgent-withboss} or
6983 @samp{work|home} (@pxref{Tags}). If you often need a specific search,
6984 define a custom command for it (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).
6985 @kindex C-c a M
6986 @item C-c a M
6987 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
6988 @vindex org-agenda-tags-todo-honor-ignore-options
6989 Like @kbd{C-c a m}, but only select headlines that are also TODO items in a
6990 not-DONE state and force checking subitems (see variable
6991 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}). To exclude scheduled/deadline items,
6992 see the variable @code{org-agenda-tags-todo-honor-ignore-options}. Matching
6993 specific TODO keywords together with a tags match is also possible, see
6994 @ref{Tag searches}.
6995 @end table
6996
6997 The commands available in the tags list are described in @ref{Agenda
6998 commands}.
6999
7000 @subsubheading Match syntax
7001
7002 @cindex Boolean logic, for tag/property searches
7003 A search string can use Boolean operators @samp{&} for AND and @samp{|} for
7004 OR. @samp{&} binds more strongly than @samp{|}. Parentheses are currently
7005 not implemented. Each element in the search is either a tag, a regular
7006 expression matching tags, or an expression like @code{PROPERTY OPERATOR
7007 VALUE} with a comparison operator, accessing a property value. Each element
7008 may be preceded by @samp{-}, to select against it, and @samp{+} is syntactic
7009 sugar for positive selection. The AND operator @samp{&} is optional when
7010 @samp{+} or @samp{-} is present. Here are some examples, using only tags.
7011
7012 @table @samp
7013 @item +work-boss
7014 Select headlines tagged @samp{:work:}, but discard those also tagged
7015 @samp{:boss:}.
7016 @item work|laptop
7017 Selects lines tagged @samp{:work:} or @samp{:laptop:}.
7018 @item work|laptop+night
7019 Like before, but require the @samp{:laptop:} lines to be tagged also
7020 @samp{:night:}.
7021 @end table
7022
7023 @cindex regular expressions, with tags search
7024 Instead of a tag, you may also specify a regular expression enclosed in curly
7025 braces. For example,
7026 @samp{work+@{^boss.*@}} matches headlines that contain the tag
7027 @samp{:work:} and any tag @i{starting} with @samp{boss}.
7028
7029 @cindex TODO keyword matching, with tags search
7030 @cindex level, require for tags/property match
7031 @cindex category, require for tags/property match
7032 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
7033 You may also test for properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}) at the same
7034 time as matching tags. The properties may be real properties, or special
7035 properties that represent other metadata (@pxref{Special properties}). For
7036 example, the ``property'' @code{TODO} represents the TODO keyword of the
7037 entry. Or, the ``property'' @code{LEVEL} represents the level of an entry.
7038 So a search @samp{+LEVEL=3+boss-TODO="DONE"} lists all level three headlines
7039 that have the tag @samp{boss} and are @emph{not} marked with the TODO keyword
7040 DONE. In buffers with @code{org-odd-levels-only} set, @samp{LEVEL} does not
7041 count the number of stars, but @samp{LEVEL=2} will correspond to 3 stars etc.
7042
7043 Here are more examples:
7044 @table @samp
7045 @item work+TODO="WAITING"
7046 Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines with the specific TODO
7047 keyword @samp{WAITING}.
7048 @item work+TODO="WAITING"|home+TODO="WAITING"
7049 Waiting tasks both at work and at home.
7050 @end table
7051
7052 When matching properties, a number of different operators can be used to test
7053 the value of a property. Here is a complex example:
7054
7055 @example
7056 +work-boss+PRIORITY="A"+Coffee="unlimited"+Effort<2 \
7057 +With=@{Sarah\|Denny@}+SCHEDULED>="<2008-10-11>"
7058 @end example
7059
7060 @noindent
7061 The type of comparison will depend on how the comparison value is written:
7062 @itemize @minus
7063 @item
7064 If the comparison value is a plain number, a numerical comparison is done,
7065 and the allowed operators are @samp{<}, @samp{=}, @samp{>}, @samp{<=},
7066 @samp{>=}, and @samp{<>}.
7067 @item
7068 If the comparison value is enclosed in double-quotes,
7069 a string comparison is done, and the same operators are allowed.
7070 @item
7071 If the comparison value is enclosed in double-quotes @emph{and} angular
7072 brackets (like @samp{DEADLINE<="<2008-12-24 18:30>"}), both values are
7073 assumed to be date/time specifications in the standard Org way, and the
7074 comparison will be done accordingly. Special values that will be recognized
7075 are @code{"<now>"} for now (including time), and @code{"<today>"}, and
7076 @code{"<tomorrow>"} for these days at 0:00 hours, i.e. without a time
7077 specification. Also strings like @code{"<+5d>"} or @code{"<-2m>"} with units
7078 @code{d}, @code{w}, @code{m}, and @code{y} for day, week, month, and year,
7079 respectively, can be used.
7080 @item
7081 If the comparison value is enclosed
7082 in curly braces, a regexp match is performed, with @samp{=} meaning that the
7083 regexp matches the property value, and @samp{<>} meaning that it does not
7084 match.
7085 @end itemize
7086
7087 So the search string in the example finds entries tagged @samp{:work:} but
7088 not @samp{:boss:}, which also have a priority value @samp{A}, a
7089 @samp{:Coffee:} property with the value @samp{unlimited}, an @samp{Effort}
7090 property that is numerically smaller than 2, a @samp{:With:} property that is
7091 matched by the regular expression @samp{Sarah\|Denny}, and that are scheduled
7092 on or after October 11, 2008.
7093
7094 Accessing TODO, LEVEL, and CATEGORY during a search is fast. Accessing any
7095 other properties will slow down the search. However, once you have paid the
7096 price by accessing one property, testing additional properties is cheap
7097 again.
7098
7099 You can configure Org-mode to use property inheritance during a search, but
7100 beware that this can slow down searches considerably. See @ref{Property
7101 inheritance}, for details.
7102
7103 For backward compatibility, and also for typing speed, there is also a
7104 different way to test TODO states in a search. For this, terminate the
7105 tags/property part of the search string (which may include several terms
7106 connected with @samp{|}) with a @samp{/} and then specify a Boolean
7107 expression just for TODO keywords. The syntax is then similar to that for
7108 tags, but should be applied with care: for example, a positive selection on
7109 several TODO keywords cannot meaningfully be combined with boolean AND.
7110 However, @emph{negative selection} combined with AND can be meaningful. To
7111 make sure that only lines are checked that actually have any TODO keyword
7112 (resulting in a speed-up), use @kbd{C-c a M}, or equivalently start the TODO
7113 part after the slash with @samp{!}. Using @kbd{C-c a M} or @samp{/!} will
7114 not match TODO keywords in a DONE state. Examples:
7115
7116 @table @samp
7117 @item work/WAITING
7118 Same as @samp{work+TODO="WAITING"}
7119 @item work/!-WAITING-NEXT
7120 Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines that are neither @samp{WAITING}
7121 nor @samp{NEXT}
7122 @item work/!+WAITING|+NEXT
7123 Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines that are either @samp{WAITING} or
7124 @samp{NEXT}.
7125 @end table
7126
7127 @node Timeline, Search view, Matching tags and properties, Built-in agenda views
7128 @subsection Timeline for a single file
7129 @cindex timeline, single file
7130 @cindex time-sorted view
7131
7132 The timeline summarizes all time-stamped items from a single Org-mode
7133 file in a @emph{time-sorted view}. The main purpose of this command is
7134 to give an overview over events in a project.
7135
7136 @table @kbd
7137 @kindex C-c a L
7138 @item C-c a L
7139 Show a time-sorted view of the Org file, with all time-stamped items.
7140 When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, all unfinished TODO entries
7141 (scheduled or not) are also listed under the current date.
7142 @end table
7143
7144 @noindent
7145 The commands available in the timeline buffer are listed in
7146 @ref{Agenda commands}.
7147
7148 @node Search view, Stuck projects, Timeline, Built-in agenda views
7149 @subsection Search view
7150 @cindex search view
7151 @cindex text search
7152 @cindex searching, for text
7153
7154 This agenda view is a general text search facility for Org-mode entries.
7155 It is particularly useful to find notes.
7156
7157 @table @kbd
7158 @kindex C-c a s
7159 @item C-c a s
7160 This is a special search that lets you select entries by matching a substring
7161 or specific words using a boolean logic.
7162 @end table
7163 For example, the search string @samp{computer equipment} will find entries
7164 that contain @samp{computer equipment} as a substring. If the two words are
7165 separated by more space or a line break, the search will still match.
7166 Search view can also search for specific keywords in the entry, using Boolean
7167 logic. The search string @samp{+computer +wifi -ethernet -@{8\.11[bg]@}}
7168 will search for note entries that contain the keywords @code{computer}
7169 and @code{wifi}, but not the keyword @code{ethernet}, and which are also
7170 not matched by the regular expression @code{8\.11[bg]}, meaning to
7171 exclude both 8.11b and 8.11g. The first @samp{+} is necessary to turn on
7172 word search, other @samp{+} characters are optional. For more details, see
7173 the docstring of the command @code{org-search-view}.
7174
7175 @vindex org-agenda-text-search-extra-files
7176 Note that in addition to the agenda files, this command will also search
7177 the files listed in @code{org-agenda-text-search-extra-files}.
7178
7179 @node Stuck projects, , Search view, Built-in agenda views
7180 @subsection Stuck projects
7181
7182 If you are following a system like David Allen's GTD to organize your
7183 work, one of the ``duties'' you have is a regular review to make sure
7184 that all projects move along. A @emph{stuck} project is a project that
7185 has no defined next actions, so it will never show up in the TODO lists
7186 Org-mode produces. During the review, you need to identify such
7187 projects and define next actions for them.
7188
7189 @table @kbd
7190 @kindex C-c a #
7191 @item C-c a #
7192 List projects that are stuck.
7193 @kindex C-c a !
7194 @item C-c a !
7195 @vindex org-stuck-projects
7196 Customize the variable @code{org-stuck-projects} to define what a stuck
7197 project is and how to find it.
7198 @end table
7199
7200 You almost certainly will have to configure this view before it will
7201 work for you. The built-in default assumes that all your projects are
7202 level-2 headlines, and that a project is not stuck if it has at least
7203 one entry marked with a TODO keyword TODO or NEXT or NEXTACTION.
7204
7205 Let's assume that you, in your own way of using Org-mode, identify
7206 projects with a tag PROJECT, and that you use a TODO keyword MAYBE to
7207 indicate a project that should not be considered yet. Let's further
7208 assume that the TODO keyword DONE marks finished projects, and that NEXT
7209 and TODO indicate next actions. The tag @@SHOP indicates shopping and
7210 is a next action even without the NEXT tag. Finally, if the project
7211 contains the special word IGNORE anywhere, it should not be listed
7212 either. In this case you would start by identifying eligible projects
7213 with a tags/todo match@footnote{@xref{Tag searches}.}
7214 @samp{+PROJECT/-MAYBE-DONE}, and then check for TODO, NEXT, @@SHOP, and
7215 IGNORE in the subtree to identify projects that are not stuck. The
7216 correct customization for this is
7217
7218 @lisp
7219 (setq org-stuck-projects
7220 '("+PROJECT/-MAYBE-DONE" ("NEXT" "TODO") ("@@SHOP")
7221 "\\<IGNORE\\>"))
7222 @end lisp
7223
7224 Note that if a project is identified as non-stuck, the subtree of this entry
7225 will still be searched for stuck projects.
7226
7227 @node Presentation and sorting, Agenda commands, Built-in agenda views, Agenda Views
7228 @section Presentation and sorting
7229 @cindex presentation, of agenda items
7230
7231 @vindex org-agenda-prefix-format
7232 Before displaying items in an agenda view, Org-mode visually prepares
7233 the items and sorts them. Each item occupies a single line. The line
7234 starts with a @emph{prefix} that contains the @emph{category}
7235 (@pxref{Categories}) of the item and other important information. You can
7236 customize the prefix using the option @code{org-agenda-prefix-format}.
7237 The prefix is followed by a cleaned-up version of the outline headline
7238 associated with the item.
7239
7240 @menu
7241 * Categories:: Not all tasks are equal
7242 * Time-of-day specifications:: How the agenda knows the time
7243 * Sorting of agenda items:: The order of things
7244 @end menu
7245
7246 @node Categories, Time-of-day specifications, Presentation and sorting, Presentation and sorting
7247 @subsection Categories
7248
7249 @cindex category
7250 The category is a broad label assigned to each agenda item. By default,
7251 the category is simply derived from the file name, but you can also
7252 specify it with a special line in the buffer, like this@footnote{For
7253 backward compatibility, the following also works: if there are several
7254 such lines in a file, each specifies the category for the text below it.
7255 The first category also applies to any text before the first CATEGORY
7256 line. However, using this method is @emph{strongly} deprecated as it is
7257 incompatible with the outline structure of the document. The correct
7258 method for setting multiple categories in a buffer is using a
7259 property.}:
7260
7261 @example
7262 #+CATEGORY: Thesis
7263 @end example
7264
7265 @noindent
7266 @cindex property, CATEGORY
7267 If you would like to have a special CATEGORY for a single entry or a
7268 (sub)tree, give the entry a @code{:CATEGORY:} property with the
7269 special category you want to apply as the value.
7270
7271 @noindent
7272 The display in the agenda buffer looks best if the category is not
7273 longer than 10 characters.
7274
7275 @node Time-of-day specifications, Sorting of agenda items, Categories, Presentation and sorting
7276 @subsection Time-of-day specifications
7277 @cindex time-of-day specification
7278
7279 Org-mode checks each agenda item for a time-of-day specification. The
7280 time can be part of the timestamp that triggered inclusion into the
7281 agenda, for example as in @w{@samp{<2005-05-10 Tue 19:00>}}. Time
7282 ranges can be specified with two timestamps, like
7283 @c
7284 @w{@samp{<2005-05-10 Tue 20:30>--<2005-05-10 Tue 22:15>}}.
7285
7286 In the headline of the entry itself, a time(range) may also appear as
7287 plain text (like @samp{12:45} or a @samp{8:30-1pm}). If the agenda
7288 integrates the Emacs diary (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}), time
7289 specifications in diary entries are recognized as well.
7290
7291 For agenda display, Org-mode extracts the time and displays it in a
7292 standard 24 hour format as part of the prefix. The example times in
7293 the previous paragraphs would end up in the agenda like this:
7294
7295 @example
7296 8:30-13:00 Arthur Dent lies in front of the bulldozer
7297 12:45...... Ford Prefect arrives and takes Arthur to the pub
7298 19:00...... The Vogon reads his poem
7299 20:30-22:15 Marvin escorts the Hitchhikers to the bridge
7300 @end example
7301
7302 @cindex time grid
7303 If the agenda is in single-day mode, or for the display of today, the
7304 timed entries are embedded in a time grid, like
7305
7306 @example
7307 8:00...... ------------------
7308 8:30-13:00 Arthur Dent lies in front of the bulldozer
7309 10:00...... ------------------
7310 12:00...... ------------------
7311 12:45...... Ford Prefect arrives and takes Arthur to the pub
7312 14:00...... ------------------
7313 16:00...... ------------------
7314 18:00...... ------------------
7315 19:00...... The Vogon reads his poem
7316 20:00...... ------------------
7317 20:30-22:15 Marvin escorts the Hitchhikers to the bridge
7318 @end example
7319
7320 @vindex org-agenda-use-time-grid
7321 @vindex org-agenda-time-grid
7322 The time grid can be turned on and off with the variable
7323 @code{org-agenda-use-time-grid}, and can be configured with
7324 @code{org-agenda-time-grid}.
7325
7326 @node Sorting of agenda items, , Time-of-day specifications, Presentation and sorting
7327 @subsection Sorting of agenda items
7328 @cindex sorting, of agenda items
7329 @cindex priorities, of agenda items
7330 Before being inserted into a view, the items are sorted. How this is
7331 done depends on the type of view.
7332 @itemize @bullet
7333 @item
7334 @vindex org-agenda-files
7335 For the daily/weekly agenda, the items for each day are sorted. The
7336 default order is to first collect all items containing an explicit
7337 time-of-day specification. These entries will be shown at the beginning
7338 of the list, as a @emph{schedule} for the day. After that, items remain
7339 grouped in categories, in the sequence given by @code{org-agenda-files}.
7340 Within each category, items are sorted by priority (@pxref{Priorities}),
7341 which is composed of the base priority (2000 for priority @samp{A}, 1000
7342 for @samp{B}, and 0 for @samp{C}), plus additional increments for
7343 overdue scheduled or deadline items.
7344 @item
7345 For the TODO list, items remain in the order of categories, but within
7346 each category, sorting takes place according to priority
7347 (@pxref{Priorities}). The priority used for sorting derives from the
7348 priority cookie, with additions depending on how close an item is to its due
7349 or scheduled date.
7350 @item
7351 For tags matches, items are not sorted at all, but just appear in the
7352 sequence in which they are found in the agenda files.
7353 @end itemize
7354
7355 @vindex org-agenda-sorting-strategy
7356 Sorting can be customized using the variable
7357 @code{org-agenda-sorting-strategy}, and may also include criteria based on
7358 the estimated effort of an entry (@pxref{Effort estimates}).
7359
7360 @node Agenda commands, Custom agenda views, Presentation and sorting, Agenda Views
7361 @section Commands in the agenda buffer
7362 @cindex commands, in agenda buffer
7363
7364 Entries in the agenda buffer are linked back to the Org file or diary
7365 file where they originate. You are not allowed to edit the agenda
7366 buffer itself, but commands are provided to show and jump to the
7367 original entry location, and to edit the Org files ``remotely'' from
7368 the agenda buffer. In this way, all information is stored only once,
7369 removing the risk that your agenda and note files may diverge.
7370
7371 Some commands can be executed with mouse clicks on agenda lines. For
7372 the other commands, the cursor needs to be in the desired line.
7373
7374 @table @kbd
7375 @tsubheading{Motion}
7376 @cindex motion commands in agenda
7377 @kindex n
7378 @item n
7379 Next line (same as @key{up} and @kbd{C-p}).
7380 @kindex p
7381 @item p
7382 Previous line (same as @key{down} and @kbd{C-n}).
7383 @tsubheading{View/Go to Org file}
7384 @kindex mouse-3
7385 @kindex @key{SPC}
7386 @item mouse-3
7387 @itemx @key{SPC}
7388 Display the original location of the item in another window.
7389 With prefix arg, make sure that the entire entry is made visible in the
7390 outline, not only the heading.
7391 @c
7392 @kindex L
7393 @item L
7394 Display original location and recenter that window.
7395 @c
7396 @kindex mouse-2
7397 @kindex mouse-1
7398 @kindex @key{TAB}
7399 @item mouse-2
7400 @itemx mouse-1
7401 @itemx @key{TAB}
7402 Go to the original location of the item in another window. Under Emacs
7403 22, @kbd{mouse-1} will also works for this.
7404 @c
7405 @kindex @key{RET}
7406 @itemx @key{RET}
7407 Go to the original location of the item and delete other windows.
7408 @c
7409 @kindex F
7410 @item F
7411 @vindex org-agenda-start-with-follow-mode
7412 Toggle Follow mode. In Follow mode, as you move the cursor through
7413 the agenda buffer, the other window always shows the corresponding
7414 location in the Org file. The initial setting for this mode in new
7415 agenda buffers can be set with the variable
7416 @code{org-agenda-start-with-follow-mode}.
7417 @c
7418 @kindex C-c C-x b
7419 @item C-c C-x b
7420 Display the entire subtree of the current item in an indirect buffer. With a
7421 numeric prefix argument N, go up to level N and then take that tree. If N is
7422 negative, go up that many levels. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix, do not remove the
7423 previously used indirect buffer.
7424
7425 @kindex C-c C-o
7426 @item C-c C-o
7427 Follow a link in the entry. This will offer a selection of any links in the
7428 text belonging to the referenced Org node. If there is only one link, it
7429 will be followed without a selection prompt.
7430
7431 @tsubheading{Change display}
7432 @cindex display changing, in agenda
7433 @kindex o
7434 @item o
7435 Delete other windows.
7436 @c
7437 @kindex v d
7438 @kindex d
7439 @kindex v w
7440 @kindex w
7441 @kindex v m
7442 @kindex v y
7443 @item v d @ @r{or short} @ d
7444 @itemx v w @ @r{or short} @ w
7445 @itemx v m
7446 @itemx v y
7447 Switch to day/week/month/year view. When switching to day or week view,
7448 this setting becomes the default for subsequent agenda commands. Since
7449 month and year views are slow to create, they do not become the default.
7450 A numeric prefix argument may be used to jump directly to a specific day
7451 of the year, ISO week, month, or year, respectively. For example,
7452 @kbd{32 d} jumps to February 1st, @kbd{9 w} to ISO week number 9. When
7453 setting day, week, or month view, a year may be encoded in the prefix
7454 argument as well. For example, @kbd{200712 w} will jump to week 12 in
7455 2007. If such a year specification has only one or two digits, it will
7456 be mapped to the interval 1938-2037.
7457 @c
7458 @kindex f
7459 @item f
7460 @vindex org-agenda-ndays
7461 Go forward in time to display the following @code{org-agenda-ndays} days.
7462 For example, if the display covers a week, switch to the following week.
7463 With prefix arg, go forward that many times @code{org-agenda-ndays} days.
7464 @c
7465 @kindex b
7466 @item b
7467 Go backward in time to display earlier dates.
7468 @c
7469 @kindex .
7470 @item .
7471 Go to today.
7472 @c
7473 @kindex j
7474 @item j
7475 Prompt for a date and go there.
7476 @c
7477 @kindex D
7478 @item D
7479 Toggle the inclusion of diary entries. See @ref{Weekly/daily agenda}.
7480 @c
7481 @kindex v l
7482 @kindex v L
7483 @kindex l
7484 @item v l @ @r{or short} @ l
7485 @vindex org-log-done
7486 @vindex org-agenda-log-mode-items
7487 Toggle Logbook mode. In Logbook mode, entries that were marked DONE while
7488 logging was on (variable @code{org-log-done}) are shown in the agenda, as are
7489 entries that have been clocked on that day. You can configure the entry
7490 types that should be included in log mode using the variable
7491 @code{org-agenda-log-mode-items}. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, show
7492 all possible logbook entries, including state changes. When called with two
7493 prefix args @kbd{C-u C-u}, show only logging information, nothing else.
7494 @kbd{v L} is equivalent to @kbd{C-u v l}.
7495 @c
7496 @kindex v [
7497 @kindex [
7498 @item v [ @ @r{or short} @ [
7499 Include inactive timestamps into the current view. Only for weekly/daily
7500 agenda and timeline views.
7501 @c
7502 @kindex v a
7503 @kindex v A
7504 @item v a
7505 @itemx v A
7506 Toggle Archives mode. In Archives mode, trees that are marked
7507 @code{ARCHIVED} are also scanned when producing the agenda. When you use the
7508 capital @kbd{A}, even all archive files are included. To exit archives mode,
7509 press @kbd{v a} again.
7510 @c
7511 @kindex v R
7512 @kindex R
7513 @item v R @ @r{or short} @ R
7514 @vindex org-agenda-start-with-clockreport-mode
7515 Toggle Clockreport mode. In Clockreport mode, the daily/weekly agenda will
7516 always show a table with the clocked times for the timespan and file scope
7517 covered by the current agenda view. The initial setting for this mode in new
7518 agenda buffers can be set with the variable
7519 @code{org-agenda-start-with-clockreport-mode}.
7520 @c
7521 @kindex v E
7522 @kindex E
7523 @item v E @ @r{or short} @ E
7524 @vindex org-agenda-start-with-entry-text-mode
7525 @vindex org-agenda-entry-text-maxlines
7526 Toggle entry text mode. In entry text mode, a number of lines from the Org
7527 outline node referenced by an agenda line will be displayed below the line.
7528 The maximum number of lines is given by the variable
7529 @code{org-agenda-entry-text-maxlines}. Calling this command with a numeric
7530 prefix argument will temporarily modify that number to the prefix value.
7531 @c
7532 @kindex G
7533 @item G
7534 @vindex org-agenda-use-time-grid
7535 @vindex org-agenda-time-grid
7536 Toggle the time grid on and off. See also the variables
7537 @code{org-agenda-use-time-grid} and @code{org-agenda-time-grid}.
7538 @c
7539 @kindex r
7540 @item r
7541 Recreate the agenda buffer, for example to reflect the changes after
7542 modification of the timestamps of items with @kbd{S-@key{left}} and
7543 @kbd{S-@key{right}}. When the buffer is the global TODO list, a prefix
7544 argument is interpreted to create a selective list for a specific TODO
7545 keyword.
7546 @kindex g
7547 @item g
7548 Same as @kbd{r}.
7549 @c
7550 @kindex s
7551 @kindex C-x C-s
7552 @item s
7553 @itemx C-x C-s
7554 Save all Org buffers in the current Emacs session, and also the locations of
7555 IDs.
7556 @c
7557 @kindex C-c C-x C-c
7558 @item C-c C-x C-c
7559 @vindex org-columns-default-format
7560 Invoke column view (@pxref{Column view}) in the agenda buffer. The column
7561 view format is taken from the entry at point, or (if there is no entry at
7562 point), from the first entry in the agenda view. So whatever the format for
7563 that entry would be in the original buffer (taken from a property, from a
7564 @code{#+COLUMNS} line, or from the default variable
7565 @code{org-columns-default-format}), will be used in the agenda.
7566
7567 @kindex C-c C-x >
7568 @item C-c C-x >
7569 Remove the restriction lock on the agenda, if it is currently restricted to a
7570 file or subtree (@pxref{Agenda files}).
7571
7572 @tsubheading{Secondary filtering and query editing}
7573 @cindex filtering, by tag and effort, in agenda
7574 @cindex tag filtering, in agenda
7575 @cindex effort filtering, in agenda
7576 @cindex query editing, in agenda
7577
7578 @kindex /
7579 @item /
7580 @vindex org-agenda-filter-preset
7581 Filter the current agenda view with respect to a tag and/or effort estimates.
7582 The difference between this and a custom agenda command is that filtering is
7583 very fast, so that you can switch quickly between different filters without
7584 having to recreate the agenda@footnote{Custom commands can preset a filter by
7585 binding the variable @code{org-agenda-filter-preset} as an option. This
7586 filter will then be applied to the view and persist as a basic filter through
7587 refreshes and more secondary filtering.}
7588
7589 You will be prompted for a tag selection letter, SPC will mean any tag at
7590 all. Pressing @key{TAB} at that prompt will offer use completion to select a
7591 tag (including any tags that do not have a selection character). The command
7592 then hides all entries that do not contain or inherit this tag. When called
7593 with prefix arg, remove the entries that @emph{do} have the tag. A second
7594 @kbd{/} at the prompt will turn off the filter and unhide any hidden entries.
7595 If the first key you press is either @kbd{+} or @kbd{-}, the previous filter
7596 will be narrowed by requiring or forbidding the selected additional tag.
7597 Instead of pressing @kbd{+} or @kbd{-} after @kbd{/}, you can also
7598 immediately use the @kbd{\} command.
7599
7600 @vindex org-sort-agenda-noeffort-is-high
7601 In order to filter for effort estimates, you should set-up allowed
7602 efforts globally, for example
7603 @lisp
7604 (setq org-global-properties
7605 '(("Effort_ALL". "0 0:10 0:30 1:00 2:00 3:00 4:00")))
7606 @end lisp
7607 You can then filter for an effort by first typing an operator, one of
7608 @kbd{<}, @kbd{>}, and @kbd{=}, and then the one-digit index of an effort
7609 estimate in your array of allowed values, where @kbd{0} means the 10th value.
7610 The filter will then restrict to entries with effort smaller-or-equal, equal,
7611 or larger-or-equal than the selected value. If the digits 0-9 are not used
7612 as fast access keys to tags, you can also simply press the index digit
7613 directly without an operator. In this case, @kbd{<} will be assumed. For
7614 application of the operator, entries without a defined effort will be treated
7615 according to the value of @code{org-sort-agenda-noeffort-is-high}. To filter
7616 for tasks without effort definition, press @kbd{?} as the operator.
7617
7618 Org also supports automatic, context-aware tag filtering. If the variable
7619 @code{org-agenda-auto-exclude-function} is set to a user-defined function,
7620 that function can decide which tags should be excluded from the agenda
7621 automatically. Once this is set, the @kbd{/} command then accepts @kbd{RET}
7622 as a sub-option key and runs the auto exclusion logic. For example, let's
7623 say you use a @code{Net} tag to identify tasks which need network access, an
7624 @code{Errand} tag for errands in town, and a @code{Call} tag for making phone
7625 calls. You could auto-exclude these tags based on the availability of the
7626 Internet, and outside of business hours, with something like this:
7627
7628 @lisp
7629 @group
7630 (defun org-my-auto-exclude-function (tag)
7631 (and (cond
7632 ((string= tag "Net")
7633 (/= 0 (call-process "/sbin/ping" nil nil nil
7634 "-c1" "-q" "-t1" "mail.gnu.org")))
7635 ((or (string= tag "Errand") (string= tag "Call"))
7636 (let ((hour (nth 2 (decode-time))))
7637 (or (< hour 8) (> hour 21)))))
7638 (concat "-" tag)))
7639
7640 (setq org-agenda-auto-exclude-function 'org-my-auto-exclude-function)
7641 @end group
7642 @end lisp
7643
7644 @kindex \
7645 @item \
7646 Narrow the current agenda filter by an additional condition. When called with
7647 prefix arg, remove the entries that @emph{do} have the tag, or that do match
7648 the effort criterion. You can achieve the same effect by pressing @kbd{+} or
7649 @kbd{-} as the first key after the @kbd{/} command.
7650
7651 @kindex [
7652 @kindex ]
7653 @kindex @{
7654 @kindex @}
7655 @item [ ] @{ @}
7656 @table @i
7657 @item @r{in} search view
7658 add new search words (@kbd{[} and @kbd{]}) or new regular expressions
7659 (@kbd{@{} and @kbd{@}}) to the query string. The opening bracket/brace will
7660 add a positive search term prefixed by @samp{+}, indicating that this search
7661 term @i{must} occur/match in the entry. The closing bracket/brace will add a
7662 negative search term which @i{must not} occur/match in the entry for it to be
7663 selected.
7664 @end table
7665
7666 @page
7667 @tsubheading{Remote editing}
7668 @cindex remote editing, from agenda
7669
7670 @item 0-9
7671 Digit argument.
7672 @c
7673 @cindex undoing remote-editing events
7674 @cindex remote editing, undo
7675 @kindex C-_
7676 @item C-_
7677 Undo a change due to a remote editing command. The change is undone
7678 both in the agenda buffer and in the remote buffer.
7679 @c
7680 @kindex t
7681 @item t
7682 Change the TODO state of the item, both in the agenda and in the
7683 original org file.
7684 @c
7685 @kindex C-S-@key{right}
7686 @kindex C-S-@key{left}
7687 @item C-S-@key{right}@r{/}@key{left}
7688 Switch to the next/previous set of TODO keywords.
7689 @c
7690 @kindex C-k
7691 @item C-k
7692 @vindex org-agenda-confirm-kill
7693 Delete the current agenda item along with the entire subtree belonging
7694 to it in the original Org file. If the text to be deleted remotely
7695 is longer than one line, the kill needs to be confirmed by the user. See
7696 variable @code{org-agenda-confirm-kill}.
7697 @c
7698 @kindex C-c C-w
7699 @item C-c C-w
7700 Refile the entry at point.
7701 @c
7702 @kindex C-c C-x C-a
7703 @kindex a
7704 @item C-c C-x C-a @ @r{or short} @ a
7705 @vindex org-archive-default-command
7706 Archive the subtree corresponding to the entry at point using the default
7707 archiving command set in @code{org-archive-default-command}. When using the
7708 @code{a} key, confirmation will be required.
7709 @c
7710 @kindex C-c C-x a
7711 @item C-c C-x a
7712 Toggle the ARCHIVE tag for the current headline.
7713 @c
7714 @kindex C-c C-x A
7715 @item C-c C-x A
7716 Move the subtree corresponding to the current entry to its @emph{archive
7717 sibling}.
7718 @c
7719 @kindex $
7720 @kindex C-c C-x C-s
7721 @item C-c C-x C-s @ @r{or short} @ $
7722 Archive the subtree corresponding to the current headline. This means the
7723 entry will be moved to the configured archive location, most likely a
7724 different file.
7725 @c
7726 @kindex T
7727 @item T
7728 @vindex org-agenda-show-inherited-tags
7729 Show all tags associated with the current item. This is useful if you have
7730 turned off @code{org-agenda-show-inherited-tags}, but still want to see all
7731 tags of a headline occasionally.
7732 @c
7733 @kindex :
7734 @item :
7735 Set tags for the current headline. If there is an active region in the
7736 agenda, change a tag for all headings in the region.
7737 @c
7738 @kindex ,
7739 @item ,
7740 Set the priority for the current item. Org-mode prompts for the
7741 priority character. If you reply with @key{SPC}, the priority cookie
7742 is removed from the entry.
7743 @c
7744 @kindex P
7745 @item P
7746 Display weighted priority of current item.
7747 @c
7748 @kindex +
7749 @kindex S-@key{up}
7750 @item +
7751 @itemx S-@key{up}
7752 Increase the priority of the current item. The priority is changed in
7753 the original buffer, but the agenda is not resorted. Use the @kbd{r}
7754 key for this.
7755 @c
7756 @kindex -
7757 @kindex S-@key{down}
7758 @item -
7759 @itemx S-@key{down}
7760 Decrease the priority of the current item.
7761 @c
7762 @kindex C-c C-z
7763 @kindex z
7764 @item z @ @r{or also} @ C-c C-z
7765 @vindex org-log-into-drawer
7766 Add a note to the entry. This note will be recorded, and then files to the
7767 same location where state change notes are put. Depending on
7768 @code{org-log-into-drawer}, this maybe inside a drawer.
7769 @c
7770 @kindex C-c C-a
7771 @item C-c C-a
7772 Dispatcher for all command related to attachments.
7773 @c
7774 @kindex C-c C-s
7775 @item C-c C-s
7776 Schedule this item, with prefix arg remove the scheduling timestamp
7777 @c
7778 @kindex C-c C-d
7779 @item C-c C-d
7780 Set a deadline for this item, with prefix arg remove the deadline.
7781 @c
7782 @kindex k
7783 @item k
7784 Agenda actions, to set dates for selected items to the cursor date.
7785 This command also works in the calendar! The command prompts for an
7786 additional key:
7787 @example
7788 m @r{Mark the entry at point for action. You can also make entries}
7789 @r{in Org files with @kbd{C-c C-x C-k}.}
7790 d @r{Set the deadline of the marked entry to the date at point.}
7791 s @r{Schedule the marked entry at the date at point.}
7792 r @r{Call @code{org-capture} with the cursor date as default date.}
7793 @end example
7794 @noindent
7795 Press @kbd{r} afterward to refresh the agenda and see the effect of the
7796 command.
7797 @c
7798 @kindex S-@key{right}
7799 @item S-@key{right}
7800 Change the timestamp associated with the current line by one day into the
7801 future. With a numeric prefix argument, change it by that many days. For
7802 example, @kbd{3 6 5 S-@key{right}} will change it by a year. With a
7803 @kbd{C-u} prefix, change the time by one hour. If you immediately repeat the
7804 command, it will continue to change hours even without the prefix arg. With
7805 a double @kbd{C-u C-u} prefix, do the same for changing minutes. The stamp
7806 is changed in the original Org file, but the change is not directly reflected
7807 in the agenda buffer. Use @kbd{r} or @kbd{g} to update the buffer.
7808 @c
7809 @kindex S-@key{left}
7810 @item S-@key{left}
7811 Change the timestamp associated with the current line by one day
7812 into the past.
7813 @c
7814 @kindex >
7815 @item >
7816 Change the timestamp associated with the current line. The key @kbd{>} has
7817 been chosen, because it is the same as @kbd{S-.} on my keyboard.
7818 @c
7819 @kindex I
7820 @item I
7821 Start the clock on the current item. If a clock is running already, it
7822 is stopped first.
7823 @c
7824 @kindex O
7825 @item O
7826 Stop the previously started clock.
7827 @c
7828 @kindex X
7829 @item X
7830 Cancel the currently running clock.
7831
7832 @kindex J
7833 @item J
7834 Jump to the running clock in another window.
7835
7836 @tsubheading{Bulk remote editing selected entries}
7837 @cindex remote editing, bulk, from agenda
7838
7839 @kindex m
7840 @item m
7841 Mark the entry at point for bulk action.
7842
7843 @kindex u
7844 @item u
7845 Unmark entry for bulk action.
7846
7847 @kindex U
7848 @item U
7849 Unmark all marked entries for bulk action.
7850
7851 @kindex B
7852 @item B
7853 Bulk action: act on all marked entries in the agenda. This will prompt for
7854 another key to select the action to be applied. The prefix arg to @kbd{B}
7855 will be passed through to the @kbd{s} and @kbd{d} commands, to bulk-remove
7856 these special timestamps.
7857 @example
7858 r @r{Prompt for a single refile target and move all entries. The entries}
7859 @r{will no longer be in the agenda, refresh (@kbd{g}) to bring them back.}
7860 $ @r{Archive all selected entries.}
7861 A @r{Archive entries by moving them to their respective archive siblings.}
7862 t @r{Change TODO state. This prompts for a single TODO keyword and}
7863 @r{changes the state of all selected entries, bypassing blocking and}
7864 @r{suppressing logging notes (but not time stamps).}
7865 + @r{Add a tag to all selected entries.}
7866 - @r{Remove a tag from all selected entries.}
7867 s @r{Schedule all items to a new date. To shift existing schedule dates}
7868 @r{by a fixed number of days, use something starting with double plus}
7869 @r{at the prompt, for example @samp{++8d} or @samp{++2w}.}
7870 d @r{Set deadline to a specific date.}
7871 @end example
7872
7873
7874 @tsubheading{Calendar commands}
7875 @cindex calendar commands, from agenda
7876 @kindex c
7877 @item c
7878 Open the Emacs calendar and move to the date at the agenda cursor.
7879 @c
7880 @item c
7881 When in the calendar, compute and show the Org-mode agenda for the
7882 date at the cursor.
7883 @c
7884 @cindex diary entries, creating from agenda
7885 @kindex i
7886 @item i
7887 @vindex org-agenda-diary-file
7888 Insert a new entry into the diary, using the date at the cursor and (for
7889 block entries) the date at the mark. This will add to the Emacs diary
7890 file@footnote{This file is parsed for the agenda when
7891 @code{org-agenda-include-diary} is set.}, in a way similar to the @kbd{i}
7892 command in the calendar. The diary file will pop up in another window, where
7893 you can add the entry.
7894
7895 If you configure @code{org-agenda-diary-file} to point to an Org-mode file,
7896 Org will create entries (in org-mode syntax) in that file instead. Most
7897 entries will be stored in a date-based outline tree that will later make it
7898 easy to archive appointments from previous months/years. The tree will be
7899 built under an entry with a @code{DATE_TREE} property, or else with years as
7900 top-level entries. Emacs will prompt you for the entry text - if you specify
7901 it, the entry will be created in @code{org-agenda-diary-file} without further
7902 interaction. If you directly press @key{RET} at the prompt without typing
7903 text, the target file will be shown in another window for you to finish the
7904 entry there. See also the @kbd{k r} command.
7905 @c
7906 @kindex M
7907 @item M
7908 Show the phases of the moon for the three months around current date.
7909 @c
7910 @kindex S
7911 @item S
7912 Show sunrise and sunset times. The geographical location must be set
7913 with calendar variables, see the documentation for the Emacs calendar.
7914 @c
7915 @kindex C
7916 @item C
7917 Convert the date at cursor into many other cultural and historic
7918 calendars.
7919 @c
7920 @kindex H
7921 @item H
7922 Show holidays for three months around the cursor date.
7923
7924 @item M-x org-export-icalendar-combine-agenda-files
7925 Export a single iCalendar file containing entries from all agenda files.
7926 This is a globally available command, and also available in the agenda menu.
7927
7928 @tsubheading{Exporting to a file}
7929 @kindex C-x C-w
7930 @item C-x C-w
7931 @cindex exporting agenda views
7932 @cindex agenda views, exporting
7933 @vindex org-agenda-exporter-settings
7934 Write the agenda view to a file. Depending on the extension of the selected
7935 file name, the view will be exported as HTML (extension @file{.html} or
7936 @file{.htm}), Postscript (extension @file{.ps}), PDF (extension @file{.pdf}),
7937 and plain text (any other extension). When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix
7938 argument, immediately open the newly created file. Use the variable
7939 @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} to set options for @file{ps-print} and
7940 for @file{htmlize} to be used during export.
7941
7942 @tsubheading{Quit and Exit}
7943 @kindex q
7944 @item q
7945 Quit agenda, remove the agenda buffer.
7946 @c
7947 @kindex x
7948 @cindex agenda files, removing buffers
7949 @item x
7950 Exit agenda, remove the agenda buffer and all buffers loaded by Emacs
7951 for the compilation of the agenda. Buffers created by the user to
7952 visit Org files will not be removed.
7953 @end table
7954
7955
7956 @node Custom agenda views, Exporting Agenda Views, Agenda commands, Agenda Views
7957 @section Custom agenda views
7958 @cindex custom agenda views
7959 @cindex agenda views, custom
7960
7961 Custom agenda commands serve two purposes: to store and quickly access
7962 frequently used TODO and tags searches, and to create special composite
7963 agenda buffers. Custom agenda commands will be accessible through the
7964 dispatcher (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}), just like the default commands.
7965
7966 @menu
7967 * Storing searches:: Type once, use often
7968 * Block agenda:: All the stuff you need in a single buffer
7969 * Setting Options:: Changing the rules
7970 @end menu
7971
7972 @node Storing searches, Block agenda, Custom agenda views, Custom agenda views
7973 @subsection Storing searches
7974
7975 The first application of custom searches is the definition of keyboard
7976 shortcuts for frequently used searches, either creating an agenda
7977 buffer, or a sparse tree (the latter covering of course only the current
7978 buffer).
7979 @kindex C-c a C
7980 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
7981 Custom commands are configured in the variable
7982 @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}. You can customize this variable, for
7983 example by pressing @kbd{C-c a C}. You can also directly set it with
7984 Emacs Lisp in @file{.emacs}. The following example contains all valid
7985 search types:
7986
7987 @lisp
7988 @group
7989 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
7990 '(("w" todo "WAITING")
7991 ("W" todo-tree "WAITING")
7992 ("u" tags "+boss-urgent")
7993 ("v" tags-todo "+boss-urgent")
7994 ("U" tags-tree "+boss-urgent")
7995 ("f" occur-tree "\\<FIXME\\>")
7996 ("h" . "HOME+Name tags searches") ; description for "h" prefix
7997 ("hl" tags "+home+Lisa")
7998 ("hp" tags "+home+Peter")
7999 ("hk" tags "+home+Kim")))
8000 @end group
8001 @end lisp
8002
8003 @noindent
8004 The initial string in each entry defines the keys you have to press
8005 after the dispatcher command @kbd{C-c a} in order to access the command.
8006 Usually this will be just a single character, but if you have many
8007 similar commands, you can also define two-letter combinations where the
8008 first character is the same in several combinations and serves as a
8009 prefix key@footnote{You can provide a description for a prefix key by
8010 inserting a cons cell with the prefix and the description.}. The second
8011 parameter is the search type, followed by the string or regular
8012 expression to be used for the matching. The example above will
8013 therefore define:
8014
8015 @table @kbd
8016 @item C-c a w
8017 as a global search for TODO entries with @samp{WAITING} as the TODO
8018 keyword
8019 @item C-c a W
8020 as the same search, but only in the current buffer and displaying the
8021 results as a sparse tree
8022 @item C-c a u
8023 as a global tags search for headlines marked @samp{:boss:} but not
8024 @samp{:urgent:}
8025 @item C-c a v
8026 as the same search as @kbd{C-c a u}, but limiting the search to
8027 headlines that are also TODO items
8028 @item C-c a U
8029 as the same search as @kbd{C-c a u}, but only in the current buffer and
8030 displaying the result as a sparse tree
8031 @item C-c a f
8032 to create a sparse tree (again: current buffer only) with all entries
8033 containing the word @samp{FIXME}
8034 @item C-c a h
8035 as a prefix command for a HOME tags search where you have to press an
8036 additional key (@kbd{l}, @kbd{p} or @kbd{k}) to select a name (Lisa,
8037 Peter, or Kim) as additional tag to match.
8038 @end table
8039
8040 @node Block agenda, Setting Options, Storing searches, Custom agenda views
8041 @subsection Block agenda
8042 @cindex block agenda
8043 @cindex agenda, with block views
8044
8045 Another possibility is the construction of agenda views that comprise
8046 the results of @emph{several} commands, each of which creates a block in
8047 the agenda buffer. The available commands include @code{agenda} for the
8048 daily or weekly agenda (as created with @kbd{C-c a a}), @code{alltodo}
8049 for the global TODO list (as constructed with @kbd{C-c a t}), and the
8050 matching commands discussed above: @code{todo}, @code{tags}, and
8051 @code{tags-todo}. Here are two examples:
8052
8053 @lisp
8054 @group
8055 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8056 '(("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
8057 ((agenda "")
8058 (tags-todo "home")
8059 (tags "garden")))
8060 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
8061 ((agenda "")
8062 (tags-todo "work")
8063 (tags "office")))))
8064 @end group
8065 @end lisp
8066
8067 @noindent
8068 This will define @kbd{C-c a h} to create a multi-block view for stuff
8069 you need to attend to at home. The resulting agenda buffer will contain
8070 your agenda for the current week, all TODO items that carry the tag
8071 @samp{home}, and also all lines tagged with @samp{garden}. Finally the
8072 command @kbd{C-c a o} provides a similar view for office tasks.
8073
8074 @node Setting Options, , Block agenda, Custom agenda views
8075 @subsection Setting options for custom commands
8076 @cindex options, for custom agenda views
8077
8078 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
8079 Org-mode contains a number of variables regulating agenda construction
8080 and display. The global variables define the behavior for all agenda
8081 commands, including the custom commands. However, if you want to change
8082 some settings just for a single custom view, you can do so. Setting
8083 options requires inserting a list of variable names and values at the
8084 right spot in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}. For example:
8085
8086 @lisp
8087 @group
8088 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8089 '(("w" todo "WAITING"
8090 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-down))
8091 (org-agenda-prefix-format " Mixed: ")))
8092 ("U" tags-tree "+boss-urgent"
8093 ((org-show-following-heading nil)
8094 (org-show-hierarchy-above nil)))
8095 ("N" search ""
8096 ((org-agenda-files '("~org/notes.org"))
8097 (org-agenda-text-search-extra-files nil)))))
8098 @end group
8099 @end lisp
8100
8101 @noindent
8102 Now the @kbd{C-c a w} command will sort the collected entries only by
8103 priority, and the prefix format is modified to just say @samp{ Mixed: }
8104 instead of giving the category of the entry. The sparse tags tree of
8105 @kbd{C-c a U} will now turn out ultra-compact, because neither the
8106 headline hierarchy above the match, nor the headline following the match
8107 will be shown. The command @kbd{C-c a N} will do a text search limited
8108 to only a single file.
8109
8110 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
8111 For command sets creating a block agenda,
8112 @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} has two separate spots for setting
8113 options. You can add options that should be valid for just a single
8114 command in the set, and options that should be valid for all commands in
8115 the set. The former are just added to the command entry, the latter
8116 must come after the list of command entries. Going back to the block
8117 agenda example (@pxref{Block agenda}), let's change the sorting strategy
8118 for the @kbd{C-c a h} commands to @code{priority-down}, but let's sort
8119 the results for GARDEN tags query in the opposite order,
8120 @code{priority-up}. This would look like this:
8121
8122 @lisp
8123 @group
8124 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8125 '(("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
8126 ((agenda)
8127 (tags-todo "home")
8128 (tags "garden"
8129 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-up)))))
8130 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-down))))
8131 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
8132 ((agenda)
8133 (tags-todo "work")
8134 (tags "office")))))
8135 @end group
8136 @end lisp
8137
8138 As you see, the values and parentheses setting is a little complex.
8139 When in doubt, use the customize interface to set this variable---it
8140 fully supports its structure. Just one caveat: when setting options in
8141 this interface, the @emph{values} are just Lisp expressions. So if the
8142 value is a string, you need to add the double-quotes around the value
8143 yourself.
8144
8145
8146 @node Exporting Agenda Views, Agenda column view, Custom agenda views, Agenda Views
8147 @section Exporting Agenda Views
8148 @cindex agenda views, exporting
8149
8150 If you are away from your computer, it can be very useful to have a printed
8151 version of some agenda views to carry around. Org-mode can export custom
8152 agenda views as plain text, HTML@footnote{You need to install Hrvoje Niksic's
8153 @file{htmlize.el}.}, Postscript, PDF@footnote{To create PDF output, the
8154 ghostscript @file{ps2pdf} utility must be installed on the system. Selecting
8155 a PDF file with also create the postscript file.}, and iCalendar files. If
8156 you want to do this only occasionally, use the command
8157
8158 @table @kbd
8159 @kindex C-x C-w
8160 @item C-x C-w
8161 @cindex exporting agenda views
8162 @cindex agenda views, exporting
8163 @vindex org-agenda-exporter-settings
8164 Write the agenda view to a file. Depending on the extension of the selected
8165 file name, the view will be exported as HTML (extension @file{.html} or
8166 @file{.htm}), Postscript (extension @file{.ps}), iCalendar (extension
8167 @file{.ics}), or plain text (any other extension). Use the variable
8168 @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} to set options for @file{ps-print} and
8169 for @file{htmlize} to be used during export, for example
8170
8171 @vindex org-agenda-add-entry-text-maxlines
8172 @vindex htmlize-output-type
8173 @vindex ps-number-of-columns
8174 @vindex ps-landscape-mode
8175 @lisp
8176 (setq org-agenda-exporter-settings
8177 '((ps-number-of-columns 2)
8178 (ps-landscape-mode t)
8179 (org-agenda-add-entry-text-maxlines 5)
8180 (htmlize-output-type 'css)))
8181 @end lisp
8182 @end table
8183
8184 If you need to export certain agenda views frequently, you can associate
8185 any custom agenda command with a list of output file names
8186 @footnote{If you want to store standard views like the weekly agenda
8187 or the global TODO list as well, you need to define custom commands for
8188 them in order to be able to specify file names.}. Here is an example
8189 that first defines custom commands for the agenda and the global
8190 TODO list, together with a number of files to which to export them.
8191 Then we define two block agenda commands and specify file names for them
8192 as well. File names can be relative to the current working directory,
8193 or absolute.
8194
8195 @lisp
8196 @group
8197 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8198 '(("X" agenda "" nil ("agenda.html" "agenda.ps"))
8199 ("Y" alltodo "" nil ("todo.html" "todo.txt" "todo.ps"))
8200 ("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
8201 ((agenda "")
8202 (tags-todo "home")
8203 (tags "garden"))
8204 nil
8205 ("~/views/home.html"))
8206 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
8207 ((agenda)
8208 (tags-todo "work")
8209 (tags "office"))
8210 nil
8211 ("~/views/office.ps" "~/calendars/office.ics"))))
8212 @end group
8213 @end lisp
8214
8215 The extension of the file name determines the type of export. If it is
8216 @file{.html}, Org-mode will use the @file{htmlize.el} package to convert
8217 the buffer to HTML and save it to this file name. If the extension is
8218 @file{.ps}, @code{ps-print-buffer-with-faces} is used to produce
8219 Postscript output. If the extension is @file{.ics}, iCalendar export is
8220 run export over all files that were used to construct the agenda, and
8221 limit the export to entries listed in the agenda. Any other
8222 extension produces a plain ASCII file.
8223
8224 The export files are @emph{not} created when you use one of those
8225 commands interactively because this might use too much overhead.
8226 Instead, there is a special command to produce @emph{all} specified
8227 files in one step:
8228
8229 @table @kbd
8230 @kindex C-c a e
8231 @item C-c a e
8232 Export all agenda views that have export file names associated with
8233 them.
8234 @end table
8235
8236 You can use the options section of the custom agenda commands to also
8237 set options for the export commands. For example:
8238
8239 @lisp
8240 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8241 '(("X" agenda ""
8242 ((ps-number-of-columns 2)
8243 (ps-landscape-mode t)
8244 (org-agenda-prefix-format " [ ] ")
8245 (org-agenda-with-colors nil)
8246 (org-agenda-remove-tags t))
8247 ("theagenda.ps"))))
8248 @end lisp
8249
8250 @noindent
8251 This command sets two options for the Postscript exporter, to make it
8252 print in two columns in landscape format---the resulting page can be cut
8253 in two and then used in a paper agenda. The remaining settings modify
8254 the agenda prefix to omit category and scheduling information, and
8255 instead include a checkbox to check off items. We also remove the tags
8256 to make the lines compact, and we don't want to use colors for the
8257 black-and-white printer. Settings specified in
8258 @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} will also apply, but the settings
8259 in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} take precedence.
8260
8261 @noindent
8262 From the command line you may also use
8263 @example
8264 emacs -f org-batch-store-agenda-views -kill
8265 @end example
8266 @noindent
8267 or, if you need to modify some parameters@footnote{Quoting depends on the
8268 system you use, please check the FAQ for examples.}
8269 @example
8270 emacs -eval '(org-batch-store-agenda-views \
8271 org-agenda-ndays 30 \
8272 org-agenda-start-day "2007-11-01" \
8273 org-agenda-include-diary nil \
8274 org-agenda-files (quote ("~/org/project.org")))' \
8275 -kill
8276 @end example
8277 @noindent
8278 which will create the agenda views restricted to the file
8279 @file{~/org/project.org}, without diary entries and with a 30-day
8280 extent.
8281
8282 You can also extract agenda information in a way that allows further
8283 processing by other programs. See @ref{Extracting agenda information}, for
8284 more information.
8285
8286
8287 @node Agenda column view, , Exporting Agenda Views, Agenda Views
8288 @section Using column view in the agenda
8289 @cindex column view, in agenda
8290 @cindex agenda, column view
8291
8292 Column view (@pxref{Column view}) is normally used to view and edit
8293 properties embedded in the hierarchical structure of an Org file. It can be
8294 quite useful to use column view also from the agenda, where entries are
8295 collected by certain criteria.
8296
8297 @table @kbd
8298 @kindex C-c C-x C-c
8299 @item C-c C-x C-c
8300 Turn on column view in the agenda.
8301 @end table
8302
8303 To understand how to use this properly, it is important to realize that the
8304 entries in the agenda are no longer in their proper outline environment.
8305 This causes the following issues:
8306
8307 @enumerate
8308 @item
8309 @vindex org-columns-default-format
8310 @vindex org-overriding-columns-format
8311 Org needs to make a decision which @code{COLUMNS} format to use. Since the
8312 entries in the agenda are collected from different files, and different files
8313 may have different @code{COLUMNS} formats, this is a non-trivial problem.
8314 Org first checks if the variable @code{org-overriding-columns-format} is
8315 currently set, and if so, takes the format from there. Otherwise it takes
8316 the format associated with the first item in the agenda, or, if that item
8317 does not have a specific format (defined in a property, or in its file), it
8318 uses @code{org-columns-default-format}.
8319 @item
8320 @cindex property, special, CLOCKSUM
8321 If any of the columns has a summary type defined (@pxref{Column attributes}),
8322 turning on column view in the agenda will visit all relevant agenda files and
8323 make sure that the computations of this property are up to date. This is
8324 also true for the special @code{CLOCKSUM} property. Org will then sum the
8325 values displayed in the agenda. In the daily/weekly agenda, the sums will
8326 cover a single day, in all other views they cover the entire block. It is
8327 vital to realize that the agenda may show the same entry @emph{twice} (for
8328 example as scheduled and as a deadline), and it may show two entries from the
8329 same hierarchy (for example a @emph{parent} and its @emph{child}). In these
8330 cases, the summation in the agenda will lead to incorrect results because
8331 some values will count double.
8332 @item
8333 When the column view in the agenda shows the @code{CLOCKSUM}, that is always
8334 the entire clocked time for this item. So even in the daily/weekly agenda,
8335 the clocksum listed in column view may originate from times outside the
8336 current view. This has the advantage that you can compare these values with
8337 a column listing the planned total effort for a task---one of the major
8338 applications for column view in the agenda. If you want information about
8339 clocked time in the displayed period use clock table mode (press @kbd{R} in
8340 the agenda).
8341 @end enumerate
8342
8343
8344 @node Markup, Exporting, Agenda Views, Top
8345 @chapter Markup for rich export
8346
8347 When exporting Org-mode documents, the exporter tries to reflect the
8348 structure of the document as accurately as possible in the backend. Since
8349 export targets like HTML, La@TeX{}, or DocBook allow much richer formatting,
8350 Org-mode has rules on how to prepare text for rich export. This section
8351 summarizes the markup rules used in an Org-mode buffer.
8352
8353 @menu
8354 * Structural markup elements:: The basic structure as seen by the exporter
8355 * Images and tables:: Tables and Images will be included
8356 * Literal examples:: Source code examples with special formatting
8357 * Include files:: Include additional files into a document
8358 * Index entries:: Making an index
8359 * Macro replacement:: Use macros to create complex output
8360 * Embedded LaTeX:: LaTeX can be freely used inside Org documents
8361 @end menu
8362
8363 @node Structural markup elements, Images and tables, Markup, Markup
8364 @section Structural markup elements
8365
8366 @menu
8367 * Document title:: Where the title is taken from
8368 * Headings and sections:: The document structure as seen by the exporter
8369 * Table of contents:: The if and where of the table of contents
8370 * Initial text:: Text before the first heading?
8371 * Lists:: Lists
8372 * Paragraphs:: Paragraphs
8373 * Footnote markup:: Footnotes
8374 * Emphasis and monospace:: Bold, italic, etc.
8375 * Horizontal rules:: Make a line
8376 * Comment lines:: What will *not* be exported
8377 @end menu
8378
8379 @node Document title, Headings and sections, Structural markup elements, Structural markup elements
8380 @subheading Document title
8381 @cindex document title, markup rules
8382
8383 @noindent
8384 The title of the exported document is taken from the special line
8385
8386 @cindex #+TITLE
8387 @example
8388 #+TITLE: This is the title of the document
8389 @end example
8390
8391 @noindent
8392 If this line does not exist, the title is derived from the first non-empty,
8393 non-comment line in the buffer. If no such line exists, or if you have
8394 turned off exporting of the text before the first headline (see below), the
8395 title will be the file name without extension.
8396
8397 @cindex property, EXPORT_TITLE
8398 If you are exporting only a subtree by marking is as the region, the heading
8399 of the subtree will become the title of the document. If the subtree has a
8400 property @code{EXPORT_TITLE}, that will take precedence.
8401
8402 @node Headings and sections, Table of contents, Document title, Structural markup elements
8403 @subheading Headings and sections
8404 @cindex headings and sections, markup rules
8405
8406 @vindex org-export-headline-levels
8407 The outline structure of the document as described in @ref{Document
8408 Structure}, forms the basis for defining sections of the exported document.
8409 However, since the outline structure is also used for (for example) lists of
8410 tasks, only the first three outline levels will be used as headings. Deeper
8411 levels will become itemized lists. You can change the location of this
8412 switch globally by setting the variable @code{org-export-headline-levels}, or on a
8413 per-file basis with a line
8414
8415 @cindex #+OPTIONS
8416 @example
8417 #+OPTIONS: H:4
8418 @end example
8419
8420 @node Table of contents, Initial text, Headings and sections, Structural markup elements
8421 @subheading Table of contents
8422 @cindex table of contents, markup rules
8423
8424 @vindex org-export-with-toc
8425 The table of contents is normally inserted directly before the first headline
8426 of the file. If you would like to get it to a different location, insert the
8427 string @code{[TABLE-OF-CONTENTS]} on a line by itself at the desired
8428 location. The depth of the table of contents is by default the same as the
8429 number of headline levels, but you can choose a smaller number, or turn off
8430 the table of contents entirely, by configuring the variable
8431 @code{org-export-with-toc}, or on a per-file basis with a line like
8432
8433 @example
8434 #+OPTIONS: toc:2 (only to two levels in TOC)
8435 #+OPTIONS: toc:nil (no TOC at all)
8436 @end example
8437
8438 @node Initial text, Lists, Table of contents, Structural markup elements
8439 @subheading Text before the first headline
8440 @cindex text before first headline, markup rules
8441 @cindex #+TEXT
8442
8443 Org-mode normally exports the text before the first headline, and even uses
8444 the first line as the document title. The text will be fully marked up. If
8445 you need to include literal HTML, La@TeX{}, or DocBook code, use the special
8446 constructs described below in the sections for the individual exporters.
8447
8448 @vindex org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading
8449 Some people like to use the space before the first headline for setup and
8450 internal links and therefore would like to control the exported text before
8451 the first headline in a different way. You can do so by setting the variable
8452 @code{org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading} to @code{t}. On a per-file
8453 basis, you can get the same effect with @samp{#+OPTIONS: skip:t}.
8454
8455 @noindent
8456 If you still want to have some text before the first headline, use the
8457 @code{#+TEXT} construct:
8458
8459 @example
8460 #+OPTIONS: skip:t
8461 #+TEXT: This text will go before the *first* headline.
8462 #+TEXT: [TABLE-OF-CONTENTS]
8463 #+TEXT: This goes between the table of contents and the first headline
8464 @end example
8465
8466 @node Lists, Paragraphs, Initial text, Structural markup elements
8467 @subheading Lists
8468 @cindex lists, markup rules
8469
8470 Plain lists as described in @ref{Plain lists}, are translated to the backend's
8471 syntax for such lists. Most backends support unordered, ordered, and
8472 description lists.
8473
8474 @node Paragraphs, Footnote markup, Lists, Structural markup elements
8475 @subheading Paragraphs, line breaks, and quoting
8476 @cindex paragraphs, markup rules
8477
8478 Paragraphs are separated by at least one empty line. If you need to enforce
8479 a line break within a paragraph, use @samp{\\} at the end of a line.
8480
8481 To keep the line breaks in a region, but otherwise use normal formatting, you
8482 can use this construct, which can also be used to format poetry.
8483
8484 @cindex #+BEGIN_VERSE
8485 @example
8486 #+BEGIN_VERSE
8487 Great clouds overhead
8488 Tiny black birds rise and fall
8489 Snow covers Emacs
8490
8491 -- AlexSchroeder
8492 #+END_VERSE
8493 @end example
8494
8495 When quoting a passage from another document, it is customary to format this
8496 as a paragraph that is indented on both the left and the right margin. You
8497 can include quotations in Org-mode documents like this:
8498
8499 @cindex #+BEGIN_QUOTE
8500 @example
8501 #+BEGIN_QUOTE
8502 Everything should be made as simple as possible,
8503 but not any simpler -- Albert Einstein
8504 #+END_QUOTE
8505 @end example
8506
8507 If you would like to center some text, do it like this:
8508 @cindex #+BEGIN_CENTER
8509 @example
8510 #+BEGIN_CENTER
8511 Everything should be made as simple as possible, \\
8512 but not any simpler
8513 #+END_CENTER
8514 @end example
8515
8516
8517 @node Footnote markup, Emphasis and monospace, Paragraphs, Structural markup elements
8518 @subheading Footnote markup
8519 @cindex footnotes, markup rules
8520 @cindex @file{footnote.el}
8521
8522 Footnotes defined in the way described in @ref{Footnotes}, will be exported by
8523 all backends. Org allows multiple references to the same note, and
8524 different backends support this to varying degrees.
8525
8526 @node Emphasis and monospace, Horizontal rules, Footnote markup, Structural markup elements
8527 @subheading Emphasis and monospace
8528
8529 @cindex underlined text, markup rules
8530 @cindex bold text, markup rules
8531 @cindex italic text, markup rules
8532 @cindex verbatim text, markup rules
8533 @cindex code text, markup rules
8534 @cindex strike-through text, markup rules
8535 You can make words @b{*bold*}, @i{/italic/}, _underlined_, @code{=code=}
8536 and @code{~verbatim~}, and, if you must, @samp{+strike-through+}. Text
8537 in the code and verbatim string is not processed for Org-mode specific
8538 syntax, it is exported verbatim.
8539
8540 @node Horizontal rules, Comment lines, Emphasis and monospace, Structural markup elements
8541 @subheading Horizontal rules
8542 @cindex horizontal rules, markup rules
8543 A line consisting of only dashes, and at least 5 of them, will be
8544 exported as a horizontal line (@samp{<hr/>} in HTML).
8545
8546 @node Comment lines, , Horizontal rules, Structural markup elements
8547 @subheading Comment lines
8548 @cindex comment lines
8549 @cindex exporting, not
8550 @cindex #+BEGIN_COMMENT
8551
8552 Lines starting with @samp{#} in column zero are treated as comments and will
8553 never be exported. If you want an indented line to be treated as a comment,
8554 start it with @samp{#+ }. Also entire subtrees starting with the word
8555 @samp{COMMENT} will never be exported. Finally, regions surrounded by
8556 @samp{#+BEGIN_COMMENT} ... @samp{#+END_COMMENT} will not be exported.
8557
8558 @table @kbd
8559 @kindex C-c ;
8560 @item C-c ;
8561 Toggle the COMMENT keyword at the beginning of an entry.
8562 @end table
8563
8564
8565 @node Images and tables, Literal examples, Structural markup elements, Markup
8566 @section Images and Tables
8567
8568 @cindex tables, markup rules
8569 @cindex #+CAPTION
8570 @cindex #+LABEL
8571 Both the native Org-mode tables (@pxref{Tables}) and tables formatted with
8572 the @file{table.el} package will be exported properly. For Org-mode tables,
8573 the lines before the first horizontal separator line will become table header
8574 lines. You can use the following lines somewhere before the table to assign
8575 a caption and a label for cross references, and in the text you can refer to
8576 the object with @code{\ref@{tab:basic-data@}}:
8577
8578 @example
8579 #+CAPTION: This is the caption for the next table (or link)
8580 #+LABEL: tbl:basic-data
8581 | ... | ...|
8582 |-----|----|
8583 @end example
8584
8585 @cindex inlined images, markup rules
8586 Some backends (HTML, La@TeX{}, and DocBook) allow you to directly include
8587 images into the exported document. Org does this, if a link to an image
8588 files does not have a description part, for example @code{[[./img/a.jpg]]}.
8589 If you wish to define a caption for the image and maybe a label for internal
8590 cross references, make sure that the link is on a line by itself and precede
8591 it with @code{#+CAPTION} and @code{#+LABEL} as follows:
8592
8593 @example
8594 #+CAPTION: This is the caption for the next figure link (or table)
8595 #+LABEL: fig:SED-HR4049
8596 [[./img/a.jpg]]
8597 @end example
8598
8599 You may also define additional attributes for the figure. As this is
8600 backend-specific, see the sections about the individual backends for more
8601 information.
8602
8603
8604 @node Literal examples, Include files, Images and tables, Markup
8605 @section Literal examples
8606 @cindex literal examples, markup rules
8607 @cindex code line references, markup rules
8608
8609 You can include literal examples that should not be subjected to
8610 markup. Such examples will be typeset in monospace, so this is well suited
8611 for source code and similar examples.
8612 @cindex #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE
8613
8614 @example
8615 #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE
8616 Some example from a text file.
8617 #+END_EXAMPLE
8618 @end example
8619
8620 Note that such blocks may be @i{indented} in order to align nicely with
8621 indented text and in particular with plain list structure (@pxref{Plain
8622 lists}). For simplicity when using small examples, you can also start the
8623 example lines with a colon followed by a space. There may also be additional
8624 whitespace before the colon:
8625
8626 @example
8627 Here is an example
8628 : Some example from a text file.
8629 @end example
8630
8631 @cindex formatting source code, markup rules
8632 If the example is source code from a programming language, or any other text
8633 that can be marked up by font-lock in Emacs, you can ask for the example to
8634 look like the fontified Emacs buffer@footnote{Currently this works for the
8635 HTML backend, and requires the @file{htmlize.el} package version 1.34 or
8636 later. It also works for LaTeX with the listings package, if you turn on the
8637 option @code{org-export-latex-listings} and make sure that the listings
8638 package is included by the LaTeX header.}. This is done with the @samp{src}
8639 block, where you also need to specify the name of the major mode that should
8640 be used to fontify the example:
8641 @cindex #+BEGIN_SRC
8642
8643 @example
8644 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
8645 (defun org-xor (a b)
8646 "Exclusive or."
8647 (if a (not b) b))
8648 #+END_SRC
8649 @end example
8650
8651 Both in @code{example} and in @code{src} snippets, you can add a @code{-n}
8652 switch to the end of the @code{BEGIN} line, to get the lines of the example
8653 numbered. If you use a @code{+n} switch, the numbering from the previous
8654 numbered snippet will be continued in the current one. In literal examples,
8655 Org will interpret strings like @samp{(ref:name)} as labels, and use them as
8656 targets for special hyperlinks like @code{[[(name)]]} (i.e. the reference name
8657 enclosed in single parenthesis). In HTML, hovering the mouse over such a
8658 link will remote-highlight the corresponding code line, which is kind of
8659 cool.
8660
8661 You can also add a @code{-r} switch which @i{removes} the labels from the
8662 source code@footnote{Adding @code{-k} to @code{-n -r} will @i{keep} the
8663 labels in the source code while using line numbers for the links, which might
8664 be useful to explain those in an org-mode example code.}. With the @code{-n}
8665 switch, links to these references will be labeled by the line numbers from
8666 the code listing, otherwise links will use the labels with no parentheses.
8667 Here is an example:
8668
8669 @example
8670 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp -n -r
8671 (save-excursion (ref:sc)
8672 (goto-char (point-min)) (ref:jump)
8673 #+END_SRC
8674 In line [[(sc)]] we remember the current position. [[(jump)][Line (jump)]]
8675 jumps to point-min.
8676 @end example
8677
8678 @vindex org-coderef-label-format
8679 If the syntax for the label format conflicts with the language syntax, use a
8680 @code{-l} switch to change the format, for example @samp{#+BEGIN_SRC pascal
8681 -n -r -l "((%s))"}. See also the variable @code{org-coderef-label-format}.
8682
8683 HTML export also allows examples to be published as text areas, @xref{Text
8684 areas in HTML export}.
8685
8686 @table @kbd
8687 @kindex C-c '
8688 @item C-c '
8689 Edit the source code example at point in its native mode. This works by
8690 switching to a temporary buffer with the source code. You need to exit by
8691 pressing @kbd{C-c '} again@footnote{Upon exit, lines starting with @samp{*}
8692 or @samp{#} will get a comma prepended, to keep them from being interpreted
8693 by Org as outline nodes or special comments. These commas will be stripped
8694 for editing with @kbd{C-c '}, and also for export.}, the edited version will
8695 then replace the old version in the Org buffer. Fixed-width regions
8696 (where each line starts with a colon followed by a space) will be edited
8697 using @code{artist-mode}@footnote{You may select a different-mode with the
8698 variable @code{org-edit-fixed-width-region-mode}.} to allow creating ASCII
8699 drawings easily. Using this command in an empty line will create a new
8700 fixed-width region.
8701 @kindex C-c l
8702 @item C-c l
8703 Calling @code{org-store-link} while editing a source code example in a
8704 temporary buffer created with @kbd{C-c '} will prompt for a label, make sure
8705 that it is unique in the current buffer, and insert it with the proper
8706 formatting like @samp{(ref:label)} at the end of the current line. Then the
8707 label is stored as a link @samp{(label)}, for retrieval with @kbd{C-c C-l}.
8708 @end table
8709
8710
8711 @node Include files, Index entries, Literal examples, Markup
8712 @section Include files
8713 @cindex include files, markup rules
8714
8715 During export, you can include the content of another file. For example, to
8716 include your @file{.emacs} file, you could use:
8717 @cindex #+INCLUDE
8718
8719 @example
8720 #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" src emacs-lisp
8721 @end example
8722 @noindent
8723 The optional second and third parameter are the markup (e.g. @samp{quote},
8724 @samp{example}, or @samp{src}), and, if the markup is @samp{src}, the
8725 language for formatting the contents. The markup is optional, if it is not
8726 given, the text will be assumed to be in Org-mode format and will be
8727 processed normally. The include line will also allow additional keyword
8728 parameters @code{:prefix1} and @code{:prefix} to specify prefixes for the
8729 first line and for each following line, as well as any options accepted by
8730 the selected markup. For example, to include a file as an item, use
8731
8732 @example
8733 #+INCLUDE: "~/snippets/xx" :prefix1 " + " :prefix " "
8734 @end example
8735
8736 @table @kbd
8737 @kindex C-c '
8738 @item C-c '
8739 Visit the include file at point.
8740 @end table
8741
8742 @node Index entries, Macro replacement, Include files, Markup
8743 @section Index entries
8744 @cindex index entries, for publishing
8745
8746 You can specify entries that will be used for generating an index during
8747 publishing. This is done by lines starting with @code{#+INDEX}. An entry
8748 the contains an exclamation mark will create a sub item. See @ref{Generating
8749 an index} for more information.
8750
8751 @example
8752 * Curriculum Vitae
8753 #+INDEX: CV
8754 #+INDEX: Application!CV
8755 @end example
8756
8757
8758
8759
8760 @node Macro replacement, Embedded LaTeX, Index entries, Markup
8761 @section Macro replacement
8762 @cindex macro replacement, during export
8763 @cindex #+MACRO
8764
8765 You can define text snippets with
8766
8767 @example
8768 #+MACRO: name replacement text $1, $2 are arguments
8769 @end example
8770
8771 @noindent which can be referenced anywhere in the document (even in
8772 code examples) with @code{@{@{@{name(arg1,arg2)@}@}@}}. In addition to
8773 defined macros, @code{@{@{@{title@}@}@}}, @code{@{@{@{author@}@}@}}, etc.,
8774 will reference information set by the @code{#+TITLE:}, @code{#+AUTHOR:}, and
8775 similar lines. Also, @code{@{@{@{date(@var{FORMAT})@}@}@}} and
8776 @code{@{@{@{modification-time(@var{FORMAT})@}@}@}} refer to current date time
8777 and to the modification time of the file being exported, respectively.
8778 @var{FORMAT} should be a format string understood by
8779 @code{format-time-string}.
8780
8781 Macro expansion takes place during export, and some people use it to
8782 construct complex HTML code.
8783
8784
8785 @node Embedded LaTeX, , Macro replacement, Markup
8786 @section Embedded La@TeX{}
8787 @cindex @TeX{} interpretation
8788 @cindex La@TeX{} interpretation
8789
8790 Plain ASCII is normally sufficient for almost all note taking. One
8791 exception, however, are scientific notes which need to be able to contain
8792 mathematical symbols and the occasional formula. La@TeX{}@footnote{La@TeX{}
8793 is a macro system based on Donald E. Knuth's @TeX{} system. Many of the
8794 features described here as ``La@TeX{}'' are really from @TeX{}, but for
8795 simplicity I am blurring this distinction.} is widely used to typeset
8796 scientific documents. Org-mode supports embedding La@TeX{} code into its
8797 files, because many academics are used to reading La@TeX{} source code, and
8798 because it can be readily processed into images for HTML production.
8799
8800 It is not necessary to mark La@TeX{} macros and code in any special way.
8801 If you observe a few conventions, Org-mode knows how to find it and what
8802 to do with it.
8803
8804 @menu
8805 * Special symbols:: Greek letters and other symbols
8806 * Subscripts and superscripts:: Simple syntax for raising/lowering text
8807 * LaTeX fragments:: Complex formulas made easy
8808 * Previewing LaTeX fragments:: What will this snippet look like?
8809 * CDLaTeX mode:: Speed up entering of formulas
8810 @end menu
8811
8812 @node Special symbols, Subscripts and superscripts, Embedded LaTeX, Embedded LaTeX
8813 @subsection Special symbols
8814 @cindex math symbols
8815 @cindex special symbols
8816 @cindex @TeX{} macros
8817 @cindex La@TeX{} fragments, markup rules
8818 @cindex HTML entities
8819 @cindex La@TeX{} entities
8820
8821 You can use La@TeX{} macros to insert special symbols like @samp{\alpha} to
8822 indicate the Greek letter, or @samp{\to} to indicate an arrow. Completion
8823 for these macros is available, just type @samp{\} and maybe a few letters,
8824 and press @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} to see possible completions. Unlike La@TeX{}
8825 code, Org-mode allows these macros to be present without surrounding math
8826 delimiters, for example:
8827
8828 @example
8829 Angles are written as Greek letters \alpha, \beta and \gamma.
8830 @end example
8831
8832 @vindex org-entities
8833 During export, these symbols will be transformed into the native format of
8834 the exporter backend. Strings like @code{\alpha} will be exported as
8835 @code{&alpha;} in the HTML output, and as @code{$\alpha$} in the La@TeX{}
8836 output. Similarly, @code{\nbsp} will become @code{&nbsp;} in HTML and
8837 @code{~} in La@TeX{}. If you need such a symbol inside a word, terminate it
8838 like this: @samp{\Aacute@{@}stor}.
8839
8840 A large number of entities is provided, with names taken from both HTML and
8841 La@TeX{}, see the variable @code{org-entities} for the complete list.
8842 @samp{\-} is treated as a shy hyphen, and @samp{--}, @samp{---}, and
8843 @samp{...} are all converted into special commands creating hyphens of
8844 different lengths or a compact set of dots.
8845
8846 If you would like to see entities displayed as utf8 characters, use the
8847 following command@footnote{You can turn this on by default by setting the
8848 variable @code{org-pretty-entities}, or on a per-file base with the
8849 @code{#+STARTUP} option @code{entitiespretty}.}:
8850
8851 @table @kbd
8852 @kindex C-c C-x \
8853 @item C-c C-x \
8854 Toggle display of entities as UTF8 characters. This does not change the
8855 buffer content which remains plain ASCII, but it overlays the UTF8 character
8856 for display purposes only.
8857 @end table
8858
8859 @node Subscripts and superscripts, LaTeX fragments, Special symbols, Embedded LaTeX
8860 @subsection Subscripts and superscripts
8861 @cindex subscript
8862 @cindex superscript
8863
8864 Just like in La@TeX{}, @samp{^} and @samp{_} are used to indicate super-
8865 and subscripts. Again, these can be used without embedding them in
8866 math-mode delimiters. To increase the readability of ASCII text, it is
8867 not necessary (but OK) to surround multi-character sub- and superscripts
8868 with curly braces. For example
8869
8870 @example
8871 The mass if the sun is M_sun = 1.989 x 10^30 kg. The radius of
8872 the sun is R_@{sun@} = 6.96 x 10^8 m.
8873 @end example
8874
8875 @vindex org-export-with-sub-superscripts
8876 To avoid interpretation as raised or lowered text, you can quote @samp{^} and
8877 @samp{_} with a backslash: @samp{\^} and @samp{\_}. If you write a text
8878 where the underscore is often used in a different context, Org's convention
8879 to always interpret these as subscripts can get in your way. Configure the
8880 variable @code{org-export-with-sub-superscripts} to globally change this
8881 convention, or use, on a per-file basis:
8882
8883 @example
8884 #+OPTIONS: ^:@{@}
8885 @end example
8886
8887 @table @kbd
8888 @kindex C-c C-x \
8889 @item C-c C-x \
8890 In addition to showing entities as UTF8 characters, this command will also
8891 format sub- and superscripts in a WYSIWYM way.
8892 @end table
8893
8894 @node LaTeX fragments, Previewing LaTeX fragments, Subscripts and superscripts, Embedded LaTeX
8895 @subsection La@TeX{} fragments
8896 @cindex La@TeX{} fragments
8897
8898 @vindex org-format-latex-header
8899 With symbols, sub- and superscripts, HTML is pretty much at its end when
8900 it comes to representing mathematical formulas@footnote{Yes, there is
8901 MathML, but that is not yet fully supported by many browsers, and there
8902 is no decent converter for turning La@TeX{} or ASCII representations of
8903 formulas into MathML. So for the time being, converting formulas into
8904 images seems the way to go.}. More complex expressions need a dedicated
8905 formula processor. To this end, Org-mode can contain arbitrary La@TeX{}
8906 fragments. It provides commands to preview the typeset result of these
8907 fragments, and upon export to HTML, all fragments will be converted to
8908 images and inlined into the HTML document@footnote{The La@TeX{} export
8909 will not use images for displaying La@TeX{} fragments but include these
8910 fragments directly into the La@TeX{} code.}. For this to work you
8911 need to be on a system with a working La@TeX{} installation. You also
8912 need the @file{dvipng} program, available at
8913 @url{http://sourceforge.net/projects/dvipng/}. The La@TeX{} header that
8914 will be used when processing a fragment can be configured with the
8915 variable @code{org-format-latex-header}.
8916
8917 La@TeX{} fragments don't need any special marking at all. The following
8918 snippets will be identified as La@TeX{} source code:
8919 @itemize @bullet
8920 @item
8921 Environments of any kind. The only requirement is that the
8922 @code{\begin} statement appears on a new line, preceded by only
8923 whitespace.
8924 @item
8925 Text within the usual La@TeX{} math delimiters. To avoid conflicts with
8926 currency specifications, single @samp{$} characters are only recognized as
8927 math delimiters if the enclosed text contains at most two line breaks, is
8928 directly attached to the @samp{$} characters with no whitespace in between,
8929 and if the closing @samp{$} is followed by whitespace, punctuation or a dash.
8930 For the other delimiters, there is no such restriction, so when in doubt, use
8931 @samp{\(...\)} as inline math delimiters.
8932 @end itemize
8933
8934 @noindent For example:
8935
8936 @example
8937 \begin@{equation@} % arbitrary environments,
8938 x=\sqrt@{b@} % even tables, figures
8939 \end@{equation@} % etc
8940
8941 If $a^2=b$ and \( b=2 \), then the solution must be
8942 either $$ a=+\sqrt@{2@} $$ or \[ a=-\sqrt@{2@} \].
8943 @end example
8944
8945 @noindent
8946 @vindex org-format-latex-options
8947 If you need any of the delimiter ASCII sequences for other purposes, you
8948 can configure the option @code{org-format-latex-options} to deselect the
8949 ones you do not wish to have interpreted by the La@TeX{} converter.
8950
8951 @node Previewing LaTeX fragments, CDLaTeX mode, LaTeX fragments, Embedded LaTeX
8952 @subsection Previewing LaTeX fragments
8953 @cindex LaTeX fragments, preview
8954
8955 La@TeX{} fragments can be processed to produce preview images of the
8956 typeset expressions:
8957
8958 @table @kbd
8959 @kindex C-c C-x C-l
8960 @item C-c C-x C-l
8961 Produce a preview image of the La@TeX{} fragment at point and overlay it
8962 over the source code. If there is no fragment at point, process all
8963 fragments in the current entry (between two headlines). When called
8964 with a prefix argument, process the entire subtree. When called with
8965 two prefix arguments, or when the cursor is before the first headline,
8966 process the entire buffer.
8967 @kindex C-c C-c
8968 @item C-c C-c
8969 Remove the overlay preview images.
8970 @end table
8971
8972 @vindex org-format-latex-options
8973 You can customize the variable @code{org-format-latex-options} to influence
8974 some aspects of the preview. In particular, the @code{:scale} (and for HTML
8975 export, @code{:html-scale}) property can be used to adjust the size of the
8976 preview images.
8977
8978 During HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}), all La@TeX{} fragments are
8979 converted into images and inlined into the document if the following
8980 setting is active:
8981
8982 @lisp
8983 (setq org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments t)
8984 @end lisp
8985
8986 @node CDLaTeX mode, , Previewing LaTeX fragments, Embedded LaTeX
8987 @subsection Using CDLa@TeX{} to enter math
8988 @cindex CDLa@TeX{}
8989
8990 CDLa@TeX{} mode is a minor mode that is normally used in combination with a
8991 major La@TeX{} mode like AUC@TeX{} in order to speed-up insertion of
8992 environments and math templates. Inside Org-mode, you can make use of
8993 some of the features of CDLa@TeX{} mode. You need to install
8994 @file{cdlatex.el} and @file{texmathp.el} (the latter comes also with
8995 AUC@TeX{}) from @url{http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik/Tools/cdlatex}.
8996 Don't use CDLa@TeX{} mode itself under Org-mode, but use the light
8997 version @code{org-cdlatex-mode} that comes as part of Org-mode. Turn it
8998 on for the current buffer with @code{M-x org-cdlatex-mode}, or for all
8999 Org files with
9000
9001 @lisp
9002 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-on-org-cdlatex)
9003 @end lisp
9004
9005 When this mode is enabled, the following features are present (for more
9006 details see the documentation of CDLa@TeX{} mode):
9007 @itemize @bullet
9008 @kindex C-c @{
9009 @item
9010 Environment templates can be inserted with @kbd{C-c @{}.
9011 @item
9012 @kindex @key{TAB}
9013 The @key{TAB} key will do template expansion if the cursor is inside a
9014 La@TeX{} fragment@footnote{Org-mode has a method to test if the cursor is
9015 inside such a fragment, see the documentation of the function
9016 @code{org-inside-LaTeX-fragment-p}.}. For example, @key{TAB} will
9017 expand @code{fr} to @code{\frac@{@}@{@}} and position the cursor
9018 correctly inside the first brace. Another @key{TAB} will get you into
9019 the second brace. Even outside fragments, @key{TAB} will expand
9020 environment abbreviations at the beginning of a line. For example, if
9021 you write @samp{equ} at the beginning of a line and press @key{TAB},
9022 this abbreviation will be expanded to an @code{equation} environment.
9023 To get a list of all abbreviations, type @kbd{M-x cdlatex-command-help}.
9024 @item
9025 @kindex _
9026 @kindex ^
9027 @vindex cdlatex-simplify-sub-super-scripts
9028 Pressing @kbd{_} and @kbd{^} inside a La@TeX{} fragment will insert these
9029 characters together with a pair of braces. If you use @key{TAB} to move
9030 out of the braces, and if the braces surround only a single character or
9031 macro, they are removed again (depending on the variable
9032 @code{cdlatex-simplify-sub-super-scripts}).
9033 @item
9034 @kindex `
9035 Pressing the backquote @kbd{`} followed by a character inserts math
9036 macros, also outside La@TeX{} fragments. If you wait more than 1.5 seconds
9037 after the backquote, a help window will pop up.
9038 @item
9039 @kindex '
9040 Pressing the single-quote @kbd{'} followed by another character modifies
9041 the symbol before point with an accent or a font. If you wait more than
9042 1.5 seconds after the backquote, a help window will pop up. Character
9043 modification will work only inside La@TeX{} fragments, outside the quote
9044 is normal.
9045 @end itemize
9046
9047 @node Exporting, Publishing, Markup, Top
9048 @chapter Exporting
9049 @cindex exporting
9050
9051 Org-mode documents can be exported into a variety of other formats. For
9052 printing and sharing of notes, ASCII export produces a readable and simple
9053 version of an Org file. HTML export allows you to publish a notes file on
9054 the web, while the XOXO format provides a solid base for exchange with a
9055 broad range of other applications. La@TeX{} export lets you use Org-mode and
9056 its structured editing functions to easily create La@TeX{} files. DocBook
9057 export makes it possible to convert Org files to many other formats using
9058 DocBook tools. For project management you can create gantt and resource
9059 charts by using TaskJuggler export. To incorporate entries with associated
9060 times like deadlines or appointments into a desktop calendar program like
9061 iCal, Org-mode can also produce extracts in the iCalendar format. Currently
9062 Org-mode only supports export, not import of these different formats.
9063
9064 Org supports export of selected regions when @code{transient-mark-mode} is
9065 enabled (default in Emacs 23).
9066
9067 @menu
9068 * Selective export:: Using tags to select and exclude trees
9069 * Export options:: Per-file export settings
9070 * The export dispatcher:: How to access exporter commands
9071 * ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export:: Exporting to flat files with encoding
9072 * HTML export:: Exporting to HTML
9073 * LaTeX and PDF export:: Exporting to La@TeX{}, and processing to PDF
9074 * DocBook export:: Exporting to DocBook
9075 * TaskJuggler export:: Exporting to TaskJuggler
9076 * Freemind export:: Exporting to Freemind mind maps
9077 * XOXO export:: Exporting to XOXO
9078 * iCalendar export:: Exporting in iCalendar format
9079 @end menu
9080
9081 @node Selective export, Export options, Exporting, Exporting
9082 @section Selective export
9083 @cindex export, selective by tags
9084
9085 @vindex org-export-select-tags
9086 @vindex org-export-exclude-tags
9087 You may use tags to select the parts of a document that should be exported,
9088 or to exclude parts from export. This behavior is governed by two variables:
9089 @code{org-export-select-tags} and @code{org-export-exclude-tags}.
9090
9091 Org first checks if any of the @emph{select} tags is present in the buffer.
9092 If yes, all trees that do not carry one of these tags will be excluded. If a
9093 selected tree is a subtree, the heading hierarchy above it will also be
9094 selected for export, but not the text below those headings.
9095
9096 @noindent
9097 If none of the select tags is found, the whole buffer will be selected for
9098 export.
9099
9100 @noindent
9101 Finally, all subtrees that are marked by any of the @emph{exclude} tags will
9102 be removed from the export buffer.
9103
9104 @node Export options, The export dispatcher, Selective export, Exporting
9105 @section Export options
9106 @cindex options, for export
9107
9108 @cindex completion, of option keywords
9109 The exporter recognizes special lines in the buffer which provide
9110 additional information. These lines may be put anywhere in the file.
9111 The whole set of lines can be inserted into the buffer with @kbd{C-c
9112 C-e t}. For individual lines, a good way to make sure the keyword is
9113 correct is to type @samp{#+} and then use @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} completion
9114 (@pxref{Completion}). For a summary of other in-buffer settings not
9115 specifically related to export, see @ref{In-buffer settings}.
9116 In particular, note that you can place commonly-used (export) options in
9117 a separate file which can be included using @code{#+SETUPFILE}.
9118
9119 @table @kbd
9120 @kindex C-c C-e t
9121 @item C-c C-e t
9122 Insert template with export options, see example below.
9123 @end table
9124
9125 @cindex #+TITLE
9126 @cindex #+AUTHOR
9127 @cindex #+DATE
9128 @cindex #+EMAIL
9129 @cindex #+DESCRIPTION
9130 @cindex #+KEYWORDS
9131 @cindex #+LANGUAGE
9132 @cindex #+TEXT
9133 @cindex #+OPTIONS
9134 @cindex #+BIND
9135 @cindex #+LINK_UP
9136 @cindex #+LINK_HOME
9137 @cindex #+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS
9138 @cindex #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS
9139 @cindex #+XSLT
9140 @cindex #+LATEX_HEADER
9141 @vindex user-full-name
9142 @vindex user-mail-address
9143 @vindex org-export-default-language
9144 @example
9145 #+TITLE: the title to be shown (default is the buffer name)
9146 #+AUTHOR: the author (default taken from @code{user-full-name})
9147 #+DATE: a date, fixed, of a format string for @code{format-time-string}
9148 #+EMAIL: his/her email address (default from @code{user-mail-address})
9149 #+DESCRIPTION: the page description, e.g. for the XHTML meta tag
9150 #+KEYWORDS: the page keywords, e.g. for the XHTML meta tag
9151 #+LANGUAGE: language for HTML, e.g. @samp{en} (@code{org-export-default-language})
9152 #+TEXT: Some descriptive text to be inserted at the beginning.
9153 #+TEXT: Several lines may be given.
9154 #+OPTIONS: H:2 num:t toc:t \n:nil @@:t ::t |:t ^:t f:t TeX:t ...
9155 #+BIND: lisp-var lisp-val, e.g.: org-export-latex-low-levels itemize
9156 @r{You need to confirm using these, or configure @code{org-export-allow-BIND}}
9157 #+LINK_UP: the ``up'' link of an exported page
9158 #+LINK_HOME: the ``home'' link of an exported page
9159 #+LATEX_HEADER: extra line(s) for the LaTeX header, like \usepackage@{xyz@}
9160 #+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS: Tags that select a tree for export
9161 #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS: Tags that exclude a tree from export
9162 #+XSLT: the XSLT stylesheet used by DocBook exporter to generate FO file
9163 @end example
9164
9165 @noindent
9166 The OPTIONS line is a compact@footnote{If you want to configure many options
9167 this way, you can use several OPTIONS lines.} form to specify export settings. Here
9168 you can:
9169 @cindex headline levels
9170 @cindex section-numbers
9171 @cindex table of contents
9172 @cindex line-break preservation
9173 @cindex quoted HTML tags
9174 @cindex fixed-width sections
9175 @cindex tables
9176 @cindex @TeX{}-like syntax for sub- and superscripts
9177 @cindex footnotes
9178 @cindex special strings
9179 @cindex emphasized text
9180 @cindex @TeX{} macros
9181 @cindex La@TeX{} fragments
9182 @cindex author info, in export
9183 @cindex time info, in export
9184 @example
9185 H: @r{set the number of headline levels for export}
9186 num: @r{turn on/off section-numbers}
9187 toc: @r{turn on/off table of contents, or set level limit (integer)}
9188 \n: @r{turn on/off line-break-preservation (DOES NOT WORK)}
9189 @@: @r{turn on/off quoted HTML tags}
9190 :: @r{turn on/off fixed-width sections}
9191 |: @r{turn on/off tables}
9192 ^: @r{turn on/off @TeX{}-like syntax for sub- and superscripts. If}
9193 @r{you write "^:@{@}", @code{a_@{b@}} will be interpreted, but}
9194 @r{the simple @code{a_b} will be left as it is.}
9195 -: @r{turn on/off conversion of special strings.}
9196 f: @r{turn on/off footnotes like this[1].}
9197 todo: @r{turn on/off inclusion of TODO keywords into exported text}
9198 pri: @r{turn on/off priority cookies}
9199 tags: @r{turn on/off inclusion of tags, may also be @code{not-in-toc}}
9200 <: @r{turn on/off inclusion of any time/date stamps like DEADLINES}
9201 *: @r{turn on/off emphasized text (bold, italic, underlined)}
9202 TeX: @r{turn on/off simple @TeX{} macros in plain text}
9203 LaTeX: @r{turn on/off La@TeX{} fragments}
9204 skip: @r{turn on/off skipping the text before the first heading}
9205 author: @r{turn on/off inclusion of author name/email into exported file}
9206 email: @r{turn on/off inclusion of author email into exported file}
9207 creator: @r{turn on/off inclusion of creator info into exported file}
9208 timestamp: @r{turn on/off inclusion creation time into exported file}
9209 d: @r{turn on/off inclusion of drawers}
9210 @end example
9211 @noindent
9212 These options take effect in both the HTML and La@TeX{} export, except
9213 for @code{TeX} and @code{LaTeX}, which are respectively @code{t} and
9214 @code{nil} for the La@TeX{} export.
9215
9216 When exporting only a single subtree by selecting it with @kbd{C-c @@} before
9217 calling an export command, the subtree can overrule some of the file's export
9218 settings with properties @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}, @code{EXPORT_TITLE},
9219 @code{EXPORT_TEXT}, @code{EXPORT_AUTHOR}, @code{EXPORT_DATE}, and
9220 @code{EXPORT_OPTIONS}.
9221
9222 @node The export dispatcher, ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, Export options, Exporting
9223 @section The export dispatcher
9224 @cindex dispatcher, for export commands
9225
9226 All export commands can be reached using the export dispatcher, which is a
9227 prefix key that prompts for an additional key specifying the command.
9228 Normally the entire file is exported, but if there is an active region that
9229 contains one outline tree, the first heading is used as document title and
9230 the subtrees are exported.
9231
9232 @table @kbd
9233 @kindex C-c C-e
9234 @item C-c C-e
9235 @vindex org-export-run-in-background
9236 Dispatcher for export and publishing commands. Displays a help-window
9237 listing the additional key(s) needed to launch an export or publishing
9238 command. The prefix arg is passed through to the exporter. A double prefix
9239 @kbd{C-u C-u} causes most commands to be executed in the background, in a
9240 separate Emacs process@footnote{To make this behavior the default, customize
9241 the variable @code{org-export-run-in-background}.}.
9242 @kindex C-c C-e v
9243 @item C-c C-e v
9244 Like @kbd{C-c C-e}, but only export the text that is currently visible
9245 (i.e. not hidden by outline visibility).
9246 @kindex C-u C-u C-c C-e
9247 @item C-u C-u C-c C-e
9248 @vindex org-export-run-in-background
9249 Call an the exporter, but reverse the setting of
9250 @code{org-export-run-in-background}, i.e. request background processing if
9251 not set, or force processing in the current Emacs process if set.
9252 @end table
9253
9254 @node ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, HTML export, The export dispatcher, Exporting
9255 @section ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export
9256 @cindex ASCII export
9257 @cindex Latin-1 export
9258 @cindex UTF-8 export
9259
9260 ASCII export produces a simple and very readable version of an Org-mode
9261 file, containing only plain ASCII. Latin-1 and UTF-8 export augment the file
9262 with special characters and symbols available in these encodings.
9263
9264 @cindex region, active
9265 @cindex active region
9266 @cindex transient-mark-mode
9267 @table @kbd
9268 @kindex C-c C-e a
9269 @item C-c C-e a
9270 @cindex property, EXPORT_FILE_NAME
9271 Export as ASCII file. For an Org file, @file{myfile.org}, the ASCII file
9272 will be @file{myfile.txt}. The file will be overwritten without
9273 warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This requires
9274 @code{transient-mark-mode} be turned on.}, only the region will be
9275 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
9276 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will
9277 become the document title. If the tree head entry has or inherits an
9278 @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME} property, that name will be used for the
9279 export.
9280 @kindex C-c C-e A
9281 @item C-c C-e A
9282 Export to a temporary buffer, do not create a file.
9283 @kindex C-c C-e n
9284 @kindex C-c C-e N
9285 @item C-c C-e n @ @ @r{and} @ @ C-c C-e N
9286 Like the above commands, but use Latin-1 encoding.
9287 @kindex C-c C-e u
9288 @kindex C-c C-e U
9289 @item C-c C-e u @ @ @r{and} @ @ C-c C-e U
9290 Like the above commands, but use UTF-8 encoding.
9291 @kindex C-c C-e v a
9292 @kindex C-c C-e v n
9293 @kindex C-c C-e v u
9294 @item C-c C-e v a @ @ @r{and} @ @ C-c C-e v n @ @ @r{and} @ @ C-c C-e v u
9295 Export only the visible part of the document.
9296 @end table
9297
9298 @cindex headline levels, for exporting
9299 In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become
9300 headlines, defining a general document structure. Additional levels
9301 will be exported as itemized lists. If you want that transition to occur
9302 at a different level, specify it with a prefix argument. For example,
9303
9304 @example
9305 @kbd{C-1 C-c C-e a}
9306 @end example
9307
9308 @noindent
9309 creates only top level headlines and does the rest as items. When
9310 headlines are converted to items, the indentation of the text following
9311 the headline is changed to fit nicely under the item. This is done with
9312 the assumption that the first body line indicates the base indentation of
9313 the body text. Any indentation larger than this is adjusted to preserve
9314 the layout relative to the first line. Should there be lines with less
9315 indentation than the first, these are left alone.
9316
9317 @vindex org-export-ascii-links-to-notes
9318 Links will be exported in a footnote-like style, with the descriptive part in
9319 the text and the link in a note before the next heading. See the variable
9320 @code{org-export-ascii-links-to-notes} for details and other options.
9321
9322 @node HTML export, LaTeX and PDF export, ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, Exporting
9323 @section HTML export
9324 @cindex HTML export
9325
9326 Org-mode contains an HTML (XHTML 1.0 strict) exporter with extensive
9327 HTML formatting, in ways similar to John Gruber's @emph{markdown}
9328 language, but with additional support for tables.
9329
9330 @menu
9331 * HTML Export commands:: How to invoke HTML export
9332 * Quoting HTML tags:: Using direct HTML in Org-mode
9333 * Links in HTML export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
9334 * Tables in HTML export:: How to modify the formatting of tables
9335 * Images in HTML export:: How to insert figures into HTML output
9336 * Text areas in HTML export:: An alternative way to show an example
9337 * CSS support:: Changing the appearance of the output
9338 * JavaScript support:: Info and Folding in a web browser
9339 @end menu
9340
9341 @node HTML Export commands, Quoting HTML tags, HTML export, HTML export
9342 @subsection HTML export commands
9343
9344 @cindex region, active
9345 @cindex active region
9346 @cindex transient-mark-mode
9347 @table @kbd
9348 @kindex C-c C-e h
9349 @item C-c C-e h
9350 @cindex property, EXPORT_FILE_NAME
9351 Export as HTML file @file{myfile.html}. For an Org file @file{myfile.org},
9352 the ASCII file will be @file{myfile.html}. The file will be overwritten
9353 without warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This requires
9354 @code{transient-mark-mode} be turned on.}, only the region will be
9355 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
9356 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
9357 title. If the tree head entry has, or inherits, an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
9358 property, that name will be used for the export.
9359 @kindex C-c C-e b
9360 @item C-c C-e b
9361 Export as HTML file and immediately open it with a browser.
9362 @kindex C-c C-e H
9363 @item C-c C-e H
9364 Export to a temporary buffer, do not create a file.
9365 @kindex C-c C-e R
9366 @item C-c C-e R
9367 Export the active region to a temporary buffer. With a prefix argument, do
9368 not produce the file header and footer, but just the plain HTML section for
9369 the region. This is good for cut-and-paste operations.
9370 @kindex C-c C-e v h
9371 @kindex C-c C-e v b
9372 @kindex C-c C-e v H
9373 @kindex C-c C-e v R
9374 @item C-c C-e v h
9375 @item C-c C-e v b
9376 @item C-c C-e v H
9377 @item C-c C-e v R
9378 Export only the visible part of the document.
9379 @item M-x org-export-region-as-html
9380 Convert the region to HTML under the assumption that it was Org-mode
9381 syntax before. This is a global command that can be invoked in any
9382 buffer.
9383 @item M-x org-replace-region-by-HTML
9384 Replace the active region (assumed to be in Org-mode syntax) by HTML
9385 code.
9386 @end table
9387
9388 @cindex headline levels, for exporting
9389 In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become headlines,
9390 defining a general document structure. Additional levels will be exported as
9391 itemized lists. If you want that transition to occur at a different level,
9392 specify it with a numeric prefix argument. For example,
9393
9394 @example
9395 @kbd{C-2 C-c C-e b}
9396 @end example
9397
9398 @noindent
9399 creates two levels of headings and does the rest as items.
9400
9401 @node Quoting HTML tags, Links in HTML export, HTML Export commands, HTML export
9402 @subsection Quoting HTML tags
9403
9404 Plain @samp{<} and @samp{>} are always transformed to @samp{&lt;} and
9405 @samp{&gt;} in HTML export. If you want to include simple HTML tags
9406 which should be interpreted as such, mark them with @samp{@@} as in
9407 @samp{@@<b>bold text@@</b>}. Note that this really works only for
9408 simple tags. For more extensive HTML that should be copied verbatim to
9409 the exported file use either
9410
9411 @cindex #+HTML
9412 @cindex #+BEGIN_HTML
9413 @example
9414 #+HTML: Literal HTML code for export
9415 @end example
9416
9417 @noindent or
9418 @cindex #+BEGIN_HTML
9419
9420 @example
9421 #+BEGIN_HTML
9422 All lines between these markers are exported literally
9423 #+END_HTML
9424 @end example
9425
9426
9427 @node Links in HTML export, Tables in HTML export, Quoting HTML tags, HTML export
9428 @subsection Links in HTML export
9429
9430 @cindex links, in HTML export
9431 @cindex internal links, in HTML export
9432 @cindex external links, in HTML export
9433 Internal links (@pxref{Internal links}) will continue to work in HTML. This
9434 includes automatic links created by radio targets (@pxref{Radio
9435 targets}). Links to external files will still work if the target file is on
9436 the same @i{relative} path as the published Org file. Links to other
9437 @file{.org} files will be translated into HTML links under the assumption
9438 that an HTML version also exists of the linked file, at the same relative
9439 path. @samp{id:} links can then be used to jump to specific entries across
9440 files. For information related to linking files while publishing them to a
9441 publishing directory see @ref{Publishing links}.
9442
9443 If you want to specify attributes for links, you can do so using a special
9444 @code{#+ATTR_HTML} line to define attributes that will be added to the
9445 @code{<a>} or @code{<img>} tags. Here is an example that sets @code{title}
9446 and @code{style} attributes for a link:
9447
9448 @cindex #+ATTR_HTML
9449 @example
9450 #+ATTR_HTML: title="The Org-mode homepage" style="color:red;"
9451 [[http://orgmode.org]]
9452 @end example
9453
9454 @node Tables in HTML export, Images in HTML export, Links in HTML export, HTML export
9455 @subsection Tables
9456 @cindex tables, in HTML
9457 @vindex org-export-html-table-tag
9458
9459 Org-mode tables are exported to HTML using the table tag defined in
9460 @code{org-export-html-table-tag}. The default setting makes tables without
9461 cell borders and frame. If you would like to change this for individual
9462 tables, place something like the following before the table:
9463
9464 @cindex #+CAPTION
9465 @cindex #+ATTR_HTML
9466 @example
9467 #+CAPTION: This is a table with lines around and between cells
9468 #+ATTR_HTML: border="2" rules="all" frame="all"
9469 @end example
9470
9471 @node Images in HTML export, Text areas in HTML export, Tables in HTML export, HTML export
9472 @subsection Images in HTML export
9473
9474 @cindex images, inline in HTML
9475 @cindex inlining images in HTML
9476 @vindex org-export-html-inline-images
9477 HTML export can inline images given as links in the Org file, and
9478 it can make an image the clickable part of a link. By
9479 default@footnote{But see the variable
9480 @code{org-export-html-inline-images}.}, images are inlined if a link does
9481 not have a description. So @samp{[[file:myimg.jpg]]} will be inlined,
9482 while @samp{[[file:myimg.jpg][the image]]} will just produce a link
9483 @samp{the image} that points to the image. If the description part
9484 itself is a @code{file:} link or a @code{http:} URL pointing to an
9485 image, this image will be inlined and activated so that clicking on the
9486 image will activate the link. For example, to include a thumbnail that
9487 will link to a high resolution version of the image, you could use:
9488
9489 @example
9490 [[file:highres.jpg][file:thumb.jpg]]
9491 @end example
9492
9493 If you need to add attributes to an inlined image, use a @code{#+ATTR_HTML}.
9494 In the example below we specify the @code{alt} and @code{title} attributes to
9495 support text viewers and accessibility, and align it to the right.
9496
9497 @cindex #+CAPTION
9498 @cindex #+ATTR_HTML
9499 @example
9500 #+CAPTION: A black cat stalking a spider
9501 #+ATTR_HTML: alt="cat/spider image" title="Action!" align="right"
9502 [[./img/a.jpg]]
9503 @end example
9504
9505 @noindent
9506 and you could use @code{http} addresses just as well.
9507
9508 @node Text areas in HTML export, CSS support, Images in HTML export, HTML export
9509 @subsection Text areas in HTML export
9510
9511 @cindex text areas, in HTML
9512 An alternative way to publish literal code examples in HTML is to use text
9513 areas, where the example can even be edited before pasting it into an
9514 application. It is triggered by a @code{-t} switch at an @code{example} or
9515 @code{src} block. Using this switch disables any options for syntax and
9516 label highlighting, and line numbering, which may be present. You may also
9517 use @code{-h} and @code{-w} switches to specify the height and width of the
9518 text area, which default to the number of lines in the example, and 80,
9519 respectively. For example
9520
9521 @example
9522 #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE -t -w 40
9523 (defun org-xor (a b)
9524 "Exclusive or."
9525 (if a (not b) b))
9526 #+END_EXAMPLE
9527 @end example
9528
9529
9530 @node CSS support, JavaScript support, Text areas in HTML export, HTML export
9531 @subsection CSS support
9532 @cindex CSS, for HTML export
9533 @cindex HTML export, CSS
9534
9535 @vindex org-export-html-todo-kwd-class-prefix
9536 @vindex org-export-html-tag-class-prefix
9537 You can also give style information for the exported file. The HTML exporter
9538 assigns the following special CSS classes@footnote{If the classes on TODO
9539 keywords and tags lead to conflicts, use the variables
9540 @code{org-export-html-todo-kwd-class-prefix} and
9541 @code{org-export-html-tag-class-prefix} to make them unique.} to appropriate
9542 parts of the document---your style specifications may change these, in
9543 addition to any of the standard classes like for headlines, tables, etc.
9544 @example
9545 p.author @r{author information, including email}
9546 p.date @r{publishing date}
9547 p.creator @r{creator info, about org-mode version}
9548 .title @r{document title}
9549 .todo @r{TODO keywords, all not-done states}
9550 .done @r{the DONE keywords, all stated the count as done}
9551 .WAITING @r{each TODO keyword also uses a class named after itself}
9552 .timestamp @r{timestamp}
9553 .timestamp-kwd @r{keyword associated with a timestamp, like SCHEDULED}
9554 .timestamp-wrapper @r{span around keyword plus timestamp}
9555 .tag @r{tag in a headline}
9556 ._HOME @r{each tag uses itself as a class, "@@" replaced by "_"}
9557 .target @r{target for links}
9558 .linenr @r{the line number in a code example}
9559 .code-highlighted @r{for highlighting referenced code lines}
9560 div.outline-N @r{div for outline level N (headline plus text))}
9561 div.outline-text-N @r{extra div for text at outline level N}
9562 .section-number-N @r{section number in headlines, different for each level}
9563 div.figure @r{how to format an inlined image}
9564 pre.src @r{formatted source code}
9565 pre.example @r{normal example}
9566 p.verse @r{verse paragraph}
9567 div.footnotes @r{footnote section headline}
9568 p.footnote @r{footnote definition paragraph, containing a footnote}
9569 .footref @r{a footnote reference number (always a <sup>)}
9570 .footnum @r{footnote number in footnote definition (always <sup>)}
9571 @end example
9572
9573 @vindex org-export-html-style-default
9574 @vindex org-export-html-style-include-default
9575 @vindex org-export-html-style
9576 @vindex org-export-html-extra
9577 @vindex org-export-html-style-default
9578 Each exported file contains a compact default style that defines these
9579 classes in a basic way@footnote{This style is defined in the constant
9580 @code{org-export-html-style-default}, which you should not modify. To turn
9581 inclusion of these defaults off, customize
9582 @code{org-export-html-style-include-default}}. You may overwrite these
9583 settings, or add to them by using the variables @code{org-export-html-style}
9584 (for Org-wide settings) and @code{org-export-html-style-extra} (for more
9585 granular settings, like file-local settings). To set the latter variable
9586 individually for each file, you can use
9587
9588 @cindex #+STYLE
9589 @example
9590 #+STYLE: <link rel="stylesheet" type="text/css" href="stylesheet.css" />
9591 @end example
9592
9593 @noindent
9594 For longer style definitions, you can use several such lines. You could also
9595 directly write a @code{<style>} @code{</style>} section in this way, without
9596 referring to an external file.
9597
9598 @c FIXME: More about header and footer styles
9599 @c FIXME: Talk about links and targets.
9600
9601 @node JavaScript support, , CSS support, HTML export
9602 @subsection JavaScript supported display of web pages
9603
9604 @cindex Rose, Sebastian
9605 Sebastian Rose has written a JavaScript program especially designed to
9606 enhance the web viewing experience of HTML files created with Org. This
9607 program allows you to view large files in two different ways. The first one
9608 is an @emph{Info}-like mode where each section is displayed separately and
9609 navigation can be done with the @kbd{n} and @kbd{p} keys (and some other keys
9610 as well, press @kbd{?} for an overview of the available keys). The second
9611 view type is a @emph{folding} view much like Org provides inside Emacs. The
9612 script is available at @url{http://orgmode.org/org-info.js} and you can find
9613 the documentation for it at @url{http://orgmode.org/worg/code/org-info-js/}.
9614 We host the script at our site, but if you use it a lot, you might
9615 not want to be dependent on @url{orgmode.org} and prefer to install a local
9616 copy on your own web server.
9617
9618 To use the script, you need to make sure that the @file{org-jsinfo.el} module
9619 gets loaded. It should be loaded by default, but you can try @kbd{M-x
9620 customize-variable @key{RET} org-modules @key{RET}} to convince yourself that
9621 this is indeed the case. All it then takes to make use of the program is
9622 adding a single line to the Org file:
9623
9624 @cindex #+INFOJS_OPT
9625 @example
9626 #+INFOJS_OPT: view:info toc:nil
9627 @end example
9628
9629 @noindent
9630 If this line is found, the HTML header will automatically contain the code
9631 needed to invoke the script. Using the line above, you can set the following
9632 viewing options:
9633
9634 @example
9635 path: @r{The path to the script. The default is to grab the script from}
9636 @r{@url{http://orgmode.org/org-info.js}, but you might want to have}
9637 @r{a local copy and use a path like @samp{../scripts/org-info.js}.}
9638 view: @r{Initial view when website is first shown. Possible values are:}
9639 info @r{Info-like interface with one section per page.}
9640 overview @r{Folding interface, initially showing only top-level.}
9641 content @r{Folding interface, starting with all headlines visible.}
9642 showall @r{Folding interface, all headlines and text visible.}
9643 sdepth: @r{Maximum headline level that will still become an independent}
9644 @r{section for info and folding modes. The default is taken from}
9645 @r{@code{org-export-headline-levels} (= the @code{H} switch in @code{#+OPTIONS}).}
9646 @r{If this is smaller than in @code{org-export-headline-levels}, each}
9647 @r{info/folding section can still contain child headlines.}
9648 toc: @r{Should the table of content @emph{initially} be visible?}
9649 @r{Even when @code{nil}, you can always get to the "toc" with @kbd{i}.}
9650 tdepth: @r{The depth of the table of contents. The defaults are taken from}
9651 @r{the variables @code{org-export-headline-levels} and @code{org-export-with-toc}.}
9652 ftoc: @r{Does the css of the page specify a fixed position for the "toc"?}
9653 @r{If yes, the toc will never be displayed as a section.}
9654 ltoc: @r{Should there be short contents (children) in each section?}
9655 @r{Make this @code{above} if the section should be above initial text.}
9656 mouse: @r{Headings are highlighted when the mouse is over them. Should be}
9657 @r{@samp{underline} (default) or a background color like @samp{#cccccc}.}
9658 buttons: @r{Should view-toggle buttons be everywhere? When @code{nil} (the}
9659 @r{default), only one such button will be present.}
9660 @end example
9661 @noindent
9662 @vindex org-infojs-options
9663 @vindex org-export-html-use-infojs
9664 You can choose default values for these options by customizing the variable
9665 @code{org-infojs-options}. If you always want to apply the script to your
9666 pages, configure the variable @code{org-export-html-use-infojs}.
9667
9668 @node LaTeX and PDF export, DocBook export, HTML export, Exporting
9669 @section La@TeX{} and PDF export
9670 @cindex La@TeX{} export
9671 @cindex PDF export
9672 @cindex Guerry, Bastien
9673
9674 Org-mode contains a La@TeX{} exporter written by Bastien Guerry. With
9675 further processing@footnote{The default LaTeX output is designed for
9676 processing with pdftex or latex. It includes packages that are not
9677 compatible with xetex and possibly luatex. See the variables
9678 @code{org-export-latex-default-packages-alist} and
9679 @code{org-export-latex-packages-alist}.}, this backend is also used to
9680 produce PDF output. Since the La@TeX{} output uses @file{hyperref} to
9681 implement links and cross references, the PDF output file will be fully
9682 linked.
9683
9684 @menu
9685 * LaTeX/PDF export commands:: Which key invokes which commands
9686 * Header and sectioning:: Setting up the export file structure
9687 * Quoting LaTeX code:: Incorporating literal La@TeX{} code
9688 * Tables in LaTeX export:: Options for exporting tables to La@TeX{}
9689 * Images in LaTeX export:: How to insert figures into La@TeX{} output
9690 * Beamer class export:: Turning the file into a presentation
9691 @end menu
9692
9693 @node LaTeX/PDF export commands, Header and sectioning, LaTeX and PDF export, LaTeX and PDF export
9694 @subsection La@TeX{} export commands
9695
9696 @cindex region, active
9697 @cindex active region
9698 @cindex transient-mark-mode
9699 @table @kbd
9700 @kindex C-c C-e l
9701 @item C-c C-e l
9702 @cindex property EXPORT_FILE_NAME
9703 Export as La@TeX{} file @file{myfile.tex}. For an Org file
9704 @file{myfile.org}, the ASCII file will be @file{myfile.tex}. The file will
9705 be overwritten without warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This
9706 requires @code{transient-mark-mode} be turned on.}, only the region will be
9707 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
9708 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
9709 title. If the tree head entry has or inherits an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
9710 property, that name will be used for the export.
9711 @kindex C-c C-e L
9712 @item C-c C-e L
9713 Export to a temporary buffer, do not create a file.
9714 @kindex C-c C-e v l
9715 @kindex C-c C-e v L
9716 @item C-c C-e v l
9717 @item C-c C-e v L
9718 Export only the visible part of the document.
9719 @item M-x org-export-region-as-latex
9720 Convert the region to La@TeX{} under the assumption that it was Org-mode
9721 syntax before. This is a global command that can be invoked in any
9722 buffer.
9723 @item M-x org-replace-region-by-latex
9724 Replace the active region (assumed to be in Org-mode syntax) by La@TeX{}
9725 code.
9726 @kindex C-c C-e p
9727 @item C-c C-e p
9728 Export as La@TeX{} and then process to PDF.
9729 @kindex C-c C-e d
9730 @item C-c C-e d
9731 Export as La@TeX{} and then process to PDF, then open the resulting PDF file.
9732 @end table
9733
9734 @cindex headline levels, for exporting
9735 @vindex org-latex-low-levels
9736 In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become
9737 headlines, defining a general document structure. Additional levels
9738 will be exported as description lists. The exporter can ignore them or
9739 convert them to a custom string depending on
9740 @code{org-latex-low-levels}.
9741
9742 If you want that transition to occur at a different level, specify it
9743 with a numeric prefix argument. For example,
9744
9745 @example
9746 @kbd{C-2 C-c C-e l}
9747 @end example
9748
9749 @noindent
9750 creates two levels of headings and does the rest as items.
9751
9752 @node Header and sectioning, Quoting LaTeX code, LaTeX/PDF export commands, LaTeX and PDF export
9753 @subsection Header and sectioning structure
9754 @cindex La@TeX{} class
9755 @cindex La@TeX{} sectioning structure
9756 @cindex La@TeX{} header
9757 @cindex header, for LaTeX files
9758 @cindex sectioning structure, for LaTeX export
9759
9760 By default, the La@TeX{} output uses the class @code{article}.
9761
9762 @vindex org-export-latex-default-class
9763 @vindex org-export-latex-classes
9764 @vindex org-export-latex-default-packages-alist
9765 @vindex org-export-latex-packages-alist
9766 @cindex #+LATEX_HEADER
9767 @cindex #+LATEX_CLASS
9768 @cindex #+LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS
9769 @cindex property, LATEX_CLASS
9770 @cindex property, LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS
9771 You can change this globally by setting a different value for
9772 @code{org-export-latex-default-class} or locally by adding an option like
9773 @code{#+LaTeX_CLASS: myclass} in your file, or with a @code{:LaTeX_CLASS:}
9774 property that applies when exporting a region containing only this (sub)tree.
9775 The class must be listed in @code{org-export-latex-classes}. This variable
9776 defines a header template for each class@footnote{Into which the values of
9777 @code{org-export-latex-default-packages-alist} and
9778 @code{org-export-latex-packages-alist} are spliced.}, and allows you to
9779 define the sectioning structure for each class. You can also define your own
9780 classes there. @code{#+LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS} or a @code{LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS}
9781 property can specify the options for the @code{\documentclass} macro. You
9782 can also use @code{#+LATEX_HEADER: \usepackage@{xyz@}} to add lines to the
9783 header. See the docstring of @code{org-export-latex-classes} for more
9784 information.
9785
9786 @node Quoting LaTeX code, Tables in LaTeX export, Header and sectioning, LaTeX and PDF export
9787 @subsection Quoting La@TeX{} code
9788
9789 Embedded La@TeX{} as described in @ref{Embedded LaTeX}, will be correctly
9790 inserted into the La@TeX{} file. This includes simple macros like
9791 @samp{\ref@{LABEL@}} to create a cross reference to a figure. Furthermore,
9792 you can add special code that should only be present in La@TeX{} export with
9793 the following constructs:
9794
9795 @cindex #+LaTeX
9796 @cindex #+BEGIN_LaTeX
9797 @example
9798 #+LaTeX: Literal LaTeX code for export
9799 @end example
9800
9801 @noindent or
9802 @cindex #+BEGIN_LaTeX
9803
9804 @example
9805 #+BEGIN_LaTeX
9806 All lines between these markers are exported literally
9807 #+END_LaTeX
9808 @end example
9809
9810
9811 @node Tables in LaTeX export, Images in LaTeX export, Quoting LaTeX code, LaTeX and PDF export
9812 @subsection Tables in La@TeX{} export
9813 @cindex tables, in La@TeX{} export
9814
9815 For La@TeX{} export of a table, you can specify a label and a caption
9816 (@pxref{Images and tables}). You can also use the @code{ATTR_LaTeX} line to
9817 request a @code{longtable} environment for the table, so that it may span
9818 several pages, or provide the @code{multicolumn} keyword that will make the
9819 table span the page in a multicolumn environment (@code{table*} environment).
9820 Finally, you can set the alignment string:
9821
9822 @cindex #+CAPTION
9823 @cindex #+LABEL
9824 @cindex #+ATTR_LaTeX
9825 @example
9826 #+CAPTION: A long table
9827 #+LABEL: tbl:long
9828 #+ATTR_LaTeX: longtable align=l|lp@{3cm@}r|l
9829 | ..... | ..... |
9830 | ..... | ..... |
9831 @end example
9832
9833
9834 @node Images in LaTeX export, Beamer class export, Tables in LaTeX export, LaTeX and PDF export
9835 @subsection Images in La@TeX{} export
9836 @cindex images, inline in La@TeX{}
9837 @cindex inlining images in La@TeX{}
9838
9839 Images that are linked to without a description part in the link, like
9840 @samp{[[file:img.jpg]]} or @samp{[[./img.jpg]]} will be inserted into the PDF
9841 output file resulting from La@TeX{} processing. Org will use an
9842 @code{\includegraphics} macro to insert the image. If you have specified a
9843 caption and/or a label as described in @ref{Images and tables}, the figure
9844 will be wrapped into a @code{figure} environment and thus become a floating
9845 element. You can use an @code{#+ATTR_LaTeX:} line to specify the various
9846 options that can be used in the optional argument of the
9847 @code{\includegraphics} macro. To modify the placement option of the
9848 @code{figure} environment, add something like @samp{placement=[h!]} to the
9849 Attributes.
9850
9851 If you would like to let text flow around the image, add the word @samp{wrap}
9852 to the @code{#+ATTR_LaTeX:} line, which will make the figure occupy the left
9853 half of the page. To fine-tune, the @code{placement} field will be the set
9854 of additional arguments needed by the @code{wrapfigure} environment. Note
9855 that if you change the size of the image, you need to use compatible settings
9856 for @code{\includegraphics} and @code{wrapfigure}.
9857
9858 @cindex #+CAPTION
9859 @cindex #+LABEL
9860 @cindex #+ATTR_LaTeX
9861 @example
9862 #+CAPTION: The black-body emission of the disk around HR 4049
9863 #+LABEL: fig:SED-HR4049
9864 #+ATTR_LaTeX: width=5cm,angle=90
9865 [[./img/sed-hr4049.pdf]]
9866
9867 #+ATTR_LaTeX: width=0.38\textwidth wrap placement=@{r@}@{0.4\textwidth@}
9868 [[./img/hst.png]]
9869 @end example
9870
9871 If you need references to a label created in this way, write
9872 @samp{\ref@{fig:SED-HR4049@}} just like in La@TeX{}.
9873
9874 @node Beamer class export, , Images in LaTeX export, LaTeX and PDF export
9875 @subsection Beamer class export
9876
9877 The LaTeX class @file{beamer} allows production of high quality presentations
9878 using LaTeX and pdf processing. Org-mode has special support for turning an
9879 Org-mode file or tree into a @file{beamer} presentation.
9880
9881 When the LaTeX class for the current buffer (as set with @code{#+LaTeX_CLASS:
9882 beamer}) or subtree (set with a @code{LaTeX_CLASS} property) is
9883 @code{beamer}, a special export mode will turn the file or tree into a beamer
9884 presentation. Any tree with not-too-deep level nesting should in principle be
9885 exportable as a beamer presentation. By default, the top-level entries (or
9886 the first level below the selected subtree heading) will be turned into
9887 frames, and the outline structure below this level will become itemize lists.
9888 You can also configure the variable @code{org-beamer-frame-level} to a
9889 different level - then the hierarchy above frames will produce the sectioning
9890 structure of the presentation.
9891
9892 A template for useful in-buffer settings or properties can be inserted into
9893 the buffer with @kbd{M-x org-beamer-settings-template}. Among other things,
9894 this will install a column view format which is very handy for editing
9895 special properties used by beamer.
9896
9897 You can influence the structure of the presentation using the following
9898 properties:
9899
9900 @table @code
9901 @item BEAMER_env
9902 The environment that should be used to format this entry. Valid environments
9903 are defined in the constant @code{org-beamer-environments-default}, and you
9904 can define more in @code{org-beamer-environments-extra}. If this property is
9905 set, the entry will also get a @code{:B_environment:} tag to make this
9906 visible. This tag has no semantic meaning, it is only a visual aid.
9907 @item BEAMER_envargs
9908 The beamer-special arguments that should be used for the environment, like
9909 @code{[t]} or @code{[<+->]} of @code{<2-3>}. If the @code{BEAMER_col}
9910 property is also set, something like @code{C[t]} can be added here as well to
9911 set an options argument for the implied @code{columns} environment.
9912 @code{c[t]} will set an option for the implied @code{column} environment.
9913 @item BEAMER_col
9914 The width of a column that should start with this entry. If this property is
9915 set, the entry will also get a @code{:BMCOL:} property to make this visible.
9916 Also this tag is only a visual aid. When this is a plain number, it will be
9917 interpreted as a fraction of @code{\textwidth}. Otherwise it will be assumed
9918 that you have specified the units, like @samp{3cm}. The first such property
9919 in a frame will start a @code{columns} environment to surround the columns.
9920 This environment is closed when an entry has a @code{BEAMER_col} property
9921 with value 0 or 1, or automatically at the end of the frame.
9922 @item BEAMER_extra
9923 Additional commands that should be inserted after the environment has been
9924 opened. For example, when creating a frame, this can be used to specify
9925 transitions.
9926 @end table
9927
9928 Frames will automatically receive a @code{fragile} option if they contain
9929 source code that uses the verbatim environment. Special @file{beamer}
9930 specific code can be inserted using @code{#+BEAMER:} and
9931 @code{#+BEGIN_beamer...#+end_beamer} constructs, similar to other export
9932 backends, but with the difference that @code{#+LaTeX:} stuff will be included
9933 in the presentation as well.
9934
9935 Outline nodes with @code{BEAMER_env} property value @samp{note} or
9936 @samp{noteNH} will be formatted as beamer notes, i,e, they will be wrapped
9937 into @code{\note@{...@}}. The former will include the heading as part of the
9938 note text, the latter will ignore the heading of that node. To simplify note
9939 generation, it is actually enough to mark the note with a @emph{tag} (either
9940 @code{:B_note:} or @code{:B_noteNH:}) instead of creating the
9941 @code{BEAMER_env} property.
9942
9943 You can turn on a special minor mode @code{org-beamer-mode} for editing
9944 support with
9945
9946 @example
9947 #+STARTUP: beamer
9948 @end example
9949
9950 @table @kbd
9951 @kindex C-c C-b
9952 @item C-c C-b
9953 In @code{org-beamer-mode}, this key offers fast selection of a beamer
9954 environment or the @code{BEAMER_col} property.
9955 @end table
9956
9957 Column view provides a great way to set the environment of a node and other
9958 important parameters. Make sure you are using a COLUMN format that is geared
9959 toward this special purpose. The command @kbd{M-x
9960 org-beamer-settings-template} defines such a format.
9961
9962 Here is a simple example Org document that is intended for beamer export.
9963
9964 @smallexample
9965 #+LaTeX_CLASS: beamer
9966 #+TITLE: Example Presentation
9967 #+AUTHOR: Carsten Dominik
9968 #+LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS: [presentation]
9969 #+BEAMER_FRAME_LEVEL: 2
9970 #+BEAMER_HEADER_EXTRA: \usetheme@{Madrid@}\usecolortheme@{default@}
9971 #+COLUMNS: %35ITEM %10BEAMER_env(Env) %10BEAMER_envargs(Args) %4BEAMER_col(Col) %8BEAMER_extra(Ex)
9972
9973 * This is the first structural section
9974
9975 ** Frame 1 \\ with a subtitle
9976 *** Thanks to Eric Fraga :BMCOL:B_block:
9977 :PROPERTIES:
9978 :BEAMER_env: block
9979 :BEAMER_envargs: C[t]
9980 :BEAMER_col: 0.5
9981 :END:
9982 for the first viable beamer setup in Org
9983 *** Thanks to everyone else :BMCOL:B_block:
9984 :PROPERTIES:
9985 :BEAMER_col: 0.5
9986 :BEAMER_env: block
9987 :BEAMER_envargs: <2->
9988 :END:
9989 for contributing to the discussion
9990 **** This will be formatted as a beamer note :B_note:
9991 ** Frame 2 \\ where we will not use columns
9992 *** Request :B_block:
9993 Please test this stuff!
9994 :PROPERTIES:
9995 :BEAMER_env: block
9996 :END:
9997 @end smallexample
9998
9999 For more information, see the documentation on Worg.
10000
10001 @node DocBook export, TaskJuggler export, LaTeX and PDF export, Exporting
10002 @section DocBook export
10003 @cindex DocBook export
10004 @cindex PDF export
10005 @cindex Cui, Baoqiu
10006
10007 Org contains a DocBook exporter written by Baoqiu Cui. Once an Org file is
10008 exported to DocBook format, it can be further processed to produce other
10009 formats, including PDF, HTML, man pages, etc., using many available DocBook
10010 tools and stylesheets.
10011
10012 Currently DocBook exporter only supports DocBook V5.0.
10013
10014 @menu
10015 * DocBook export commands:: How to invoke DocBook export
10016 * Quoting DocBook code:: Incorporating DocBook code in Org files
10017 * Recursive sections:: Recursive sections in DocBook
10018 * Tables in DocBook export:: Tables are exported as HTML tables
10019 * Images in DocBook export:: How to insert figures into DocBook output
10020 * Special characters:: How to handle special characters
10021 @end menu
10022
10023 @node DocBook export commands, Quoting DocBook code, DocBook export, DocBook export
10024 @subsection DocBook export commands
10025
10026 @cindex region, active
10027 @cindex active region
10028 @cindex transient-mark-mode
10029 @table @kbd
10030 @kindex C-c C-e D
10031 @item C-c C-e D
10032 @cindex property EXPORT_FILE_NAME
10033 Export as DocBook file. For an Org file, @file{myfile.org}, the DocBook XML
10034 file will be @file{myfile.xml}. The file will be overwritten without
10035 warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This requires
10036 @code{transient-mark-mode} to be turned on}, only the region will be
10037 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
10038 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
10039 title. If the tree head entry has, or inherits, an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
10040 property, that name will be used for the export.
10041 @kindex C-c C-e V
10042 @item C-c C-e V
10043 Export as DocBook file, process to PDF, then open the resulting PDF file.
10044
10045 @vindex org-export-docbook-xslt-proc-command
10046 @vindex org-export-docbook-xsl-fo-proc-command
10047 Note that, in order to produce PDF output based on exported DocBook file, you
10048 need to have XSLT processor and XSL-FO processor software installed on your
10049 system. Check variables @code{org-export-docbook-xslt-proc-command} and
10050 @code{org-export-docbook-xsl-fo-proc-command}.
10051
10052 @vindex org-export-docbook-xslt-stylesheet
10053 The stylesheet argument @code{%s} in variable
10054 @code{org-export-docbook-xslt-proc-command} is replaced by the value of
10055 variable @code{org-export-docbook-xslt-stylesheet}, which needs to be set by
10056 the user. You can also overrule this global setting on a per-file basis by
10057 adding an in-buffer setting @code{#+XSLT:} to the Org file.
10058
10059 @kindex C-c C-e v D
10060 @item C-c C-e v D
10061 Export only the visible part of the document.
10062 @end table
10063
10064 @node Quoting DocBook code, Recursive sections, DocBook export commands, DocBook export
10065 @subsection Quoting DocBook code
10066
10067 You can quote DocBook code in Org files and copy it verbatim into exported
10068 DocBook file with the following constructs:
10069
10070 @cindex #+DOCBOOK
10071 @cindex #+BEGIN_DOCBOOK
10072 @example
10073 #+DOCBOOK: Literal DocBook code for export
10074 @end example
10075
10076 @noindent or
10077 @cindex #+BEGIN_DOCBOOK
10078
10079 @example
10080 #+BEGIN_DOCBOOK
10081 All lines between these markers are exported by DocBook exporter
10082 literally.
10083 #+END_DOCBOOK
10084 @end example
10085
10086 For example, you can use the following lines to include a DocBook warning
10087 admonition. As to what this warning says, you should pay attention to the
10088 document context when quoting DocBook code in Org files. You may make
10089 exported DocBook XML files invalid by not quoting DocBook code correctly.
10090
10091 @example
10092 #+BEGIN_DOCBOOK
10093 <warning>
10094 <para>You should know what you are doing when quoting DocBook XML code
10095 in your Org file. Invalid DocBook XML file may be generated by
10096 DocBook exporter if you are not careful!</para>
10097 </warning>
10098 #+END_DOCBOOK
10099 @end example
10100
10101 @node Recursive sections, Tables in DocBook export, Quoting DocBook code, DocBook export
10102 @subsection Recursive sections
10103 @cindex DocBook recursive sections
10104
10105 DocBook exporter exports Org files as articles using the @code{article}
10106 element in DocBook. Recursive sections, i.e. @code{section} elements, are
10107 used in exported articles. Top level headlines in Org files are exported as
10108 top level sections, and lower level headlines are exported as nested
10109 sections. The entire structure of Org files will be exported completely, no
10110 matter how many nested levels of headlines there are.
10111
10112 Using recursive sections makes it easy to port and reuse exported DocBook
10113 code in other DocBook document types like @code{book} or @code{set}.
10114
10115 @node Tables in DocBook export, Images in DocBook export, Recursive sections, DocBook export
10116 @subsection Tables in DocBook export
10117 @cindex tables, in DocBook export
10118
10119 Tables in Org files are exported as HTML tables, which have been supported since
10120 DocBook V4.3.
10121
10122 If a table does not have a caption, an informal table is generated using the
10123 @code{informaltable} element; otherwise, a formal table will be generated
10124 using the @code{table} element.
10125
10126 @node Images in DocBook export, Special characters, Tables in DocBook export, DocBook export
10127 @subsection Images in DocBook export
10128 @cindex images, inline in DocBook
10129 @cindex inlining images in DocBook
10130
10131 Images that are linked to without a description part in the link, like
10132 @samp{[[file:img.jpg]]} or @samp{[[./img.jpg]]}, will be exported to DocBook
10133 using @code{mediaobject} elements. Each @code{mediaobject} element contains
10134 an @code{imageobject} that wraps an @code{imagedata} element. If you have
10135 specified a caption for an image as described in @ref{Images and tables}, a
10136 @code{caption} element will be added in @code{mediaobject}. If a label is
10137 also specified, it will be exported as an @code{xml:id} attribute of the
10138 @code{mediaobject} element.
10139
10140 @vindex org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes
10141 Image attributes supported by the @code{imagedata} element, like @code{align}
10142 or @code{width}, can be specified in two ways: you can either customize
10143 variable @code{org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes} or use the
10144 @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} line. Attributes specified in variable
10145 @code{org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes} are applied to all inline
10146 images in the Org file to be exported (unless they are overridden by image
10147 attributes specified in @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} lines).
10148
10149 The @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} line can be used to specify additional image
10150 attributes or override default image attributes for individual images. If
10151 the same attribute appears in both the @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} line and
10152 variable @code{org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes}, the former
10153 takes precedence. Here is an example about how image attributes can be
10154 set:
10155
10156 @cindex #+CAPTION
10157 @cindex #+LABEL
10158 @cindex #+ATTR_DOCBOOK
10159 @example
10160 #+CAPTION: The logo of Org-mode
10161 #+LABEL: unicorn-svg
10162 #+ATTR_DOCBOOK: scalefit="1" width="100%" depth="100%"
10163 [[./img/org-mode-unicorn.svg]]
10164 @end example
10165
10166 @vindex org-export-docbook-inline-image-extensions
10167 By default, DocBook exporter recognizes the following image file types:
10168 @file{jpeg}, @file{jpg}, @file{png}, @file{gif}, and @file{svg}. You can
10169 customize variable @code{org-export-docbook-inline-image-extensions} to add
10170 more types to this list as long as DocBook supports them.
10171
10172 @node Special characters, , Images in DocBook export, DocBook export
10173 @subsection Special characters in DocBook export
10174 @cindex Special characters in DocBook export
10175
10176 @vindex org-export-docbook-doctype
10177 @vindex org-entities
10178 Special characters that are written in @TeX{}-like syntax, such as @code{\alpha},
10179 @code{\Gamma}, and @code{\Zeta}, are supported by DocBook exporter. These
10180 characters are rewritten to XML entities, like @code{&alpha;},
10181 @code{&Gamma;}, and @code{&Zeta;}, based on the list saved in variable
10182 @code{org-entities}. As long as the generated DocBook file includes the
10183 corresponding entities, these special characters are recognized.
10184
10185 You can customize variable @code{org-export-docbook-doctype} to include the
10186 entities you need. For example, you can set variable
10187 @code{org-export-docbook-doctype} to the following value to recognize all
10188 special characters included in XHTML entities:
10189
10190 @example
10191 "<!DOCTYPE article [
10192 <!ENTITY % xhtml1-symbol PUBLIC
10193 \"-//W3C//ENTITIES Symbol for HTML//EN//XML\"
10194 \"http://www.w3.org/2003/entities/2007/xhtml1-symbol.ent\"
10195 >
10196 %xhtml1-symbol;
10197 ]>
10198 "
10199 @end example
10200
10201 @node TaskJuggler export, Freemind export, DocBook export, Exporting
10202 @section TaskJuggler export
10203 @cindex TaskJuggler export
10204 @cindex Project management
10205
10206 @uref{http://www.taskjuggler.org/, TaskJuggler} is a project management tool.
10207 It provides an optimizing scheduler that computes your project time lines and
10208 resource assignments based on the project outline and the constraints that
10209 you have provided.
10210
10211 The TaskJuggler exporter is a bit different from other exporters, such as the
10212 HTML and LaTeX exporters for example, in that it does not export all the
10213 nodes of a document or strictly follow the order of the nodes in the
10214 document.
10215
10216 Instead the TaskJuggler exporter looks for a tree that defines the tasks and
10217 a optionally tree that defines the resources for this project. It then
10218 creates a TaskJuggler file based on these trees and the attributes defined in
10219 all the nodes.
10220
10221 @subsection TaskJuggler export commands
10222
10223 @table @kbd
10224 @kindex C-c C-e j
10225 @item C-c C-e j
10226 Export as TaskJuggler file.
10227
10228 @kindex C-c C-e J
10229 @item C-c C-e J
10230 Export as TaskJuggler file and then open the file with TaskJugglerUI.
10231 @end table
10232
10233 @subsection Tasks
10234
10235 @vindex org-export-taskjuggler-project-tag
10236 Create your tasks as you usually do with Org-mode. Assign efforts to each
10237 task using properties (it's easiest to do this in the column view). You
10238 should end up with something similar to the example by Peter Jones in
10239 @url{http://www.contextualdevelopment.com/static/artifacts/articles/2008/project-planning/project-planning.org}.
10240 Now mark the top node of your tasks with a tag named
10241 @code{:taskjuggler_project:} (or whatever you customized
10242 @code{org-export-taskjuggler-project-tag} to). You are now ready to export
10243 the project plan with @kbd{C-c C-e J} which will export the project plan and
10244 open a gantt chart in TaskJugglerUI.
10245
10246 @subsection Resources
10247
10248 @vindex org-export-taskjuggler-resource-tag
10249 Next you can define resources and assign those to work on specific tasks. You
10250 can group your resources hierarchically. Tag the top node of the resources
10251 with @code{:taskjuggler_resource:} (or whatever you customized
10252 @code{org-export-taskjuggler-resource-tag} to). You can optionally assign an
10253 identifier (named @samp{resource_id}) to the resources (using the standard
10254 Org properties commands, @pxref{Property syntax}) or you can let the exporter
10255 generate identifiers automatically (the exporter picks the first word of the
10256 headline as the identifier as long as it is unique, see the documentation of
10257 @code{org-taskjuggler-get-unique-id}). Using that identifier you can then
10258 allocate resources to tasks. This is again done with the @samp{allocate}
10259 property on the tasks. Do this in column view or when on the task type
10260 @kbd{C-c C-x p allocate @key{RET} <resource_id> @key{RET}}.
10261
10262 Once the allocations are done you can again export to TaskJuggler and check
10263 in the Resource Allocation Graph which person is working on what task at what
10264 time.
10265
10266 @subsection Export of properties
10267
10268 The exporter also takes TODO state information into consideration, i.e. if a
10269 task is marked as done it will have the corresponding attribute in
10270 TaskJuggler (@samp{complete 100}). Also it will export any property on a task
10271 resource or resource node which is known to TaskJuggler, such as
10272 @samp{limits}, @samp{vacation}, @samp{shift}, @samp{booking},
10273 @samp{efficiency}, @samp{journalentry}, @samp{rate} for resources or
10274 @samp{account}, @samp{start}, @samp{note}, @samp{duration}, @samp{end},
10275 @samp{journalentry}, @samp{milestone}, @samp{reference}, @samp{responsible},
10276 @samp{scheduling}, etc for tasks.
10277
10278 @subsection Dependencies
10279
10280 The exporter will handle dependencies that are defined in the tasks either
10281 with the @samp{ORDERED} attribute (@pxref{TODO dependencies}), with the
10282 @samp{BLOCKER} attribute (see org-depend.el) or alternatively with a
10283 @samp{depends} attribute. Both the @samp{BLOCKER} and the @samp{depends}
10284 attribute can be either @samp{previous-sibling} or a reference to an
10285 identifier (named @samp{task_id}) which is defined for another task in the
10286 project. @samp{BLOCKER} and the @samp{depends} attribute can define multiple
10287 dependencies separated by either space or comma. You can also specify
10288 optional attributes on the dependency by simply appending it. The following
10289 examples should illustrate this:
10290
10291 @example
10292 * Preparation
10293 :PROPERTIES:
10294 :task_id: preparation
10295 :ORDERED: t
10296 :END:
10297 * Training material
10298 :PROPERTIES:
10299 :task_id: training_material
10300 :ORDERED: t
10301 :END:
10302 ** Markup Guidelines
10303 :PROPERTIES:
10304 :Effort: 2.0
10305 :END:
10306 ** Workflow Guidelines
10307 :PROPERTIES:
10308 :Effort: 2.0
10309 :END:
10310 * Presentation
10311 :PROPERTIES:
10312 :Effort: 2.0
10313 :BLOCKER: training_material @{ gapduration 1d @} preparation
10314 :END:
10315 @end example
10316
10317 @subsection Reports
10318
10319 @vindex org-export-taskjuggler-default-reports
10320 TaskJuggler can produce many kinds of reports (e.g. gantt chart, resource
10321 allocation, etc). The user defines what kind of reports should be generated
10322 for a project in the TaskJuggler file. The exporter will automatically insert
10323 some default reports in the file. These defaults are defined in
10324 @code{org-export-taskjuggler-default-reports}. They can be modified using
10325 customize along with a number of other options. For a more complete list, see
10326 @kbd{M-x customize-group @key{RET} org-export-taskjuggler @key{RET}}.
10327
10328 For more information and examples see the Org-taskjuggler tutorial at
10329 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-tutorials/org-taskjuggler.php}.
10330
10331 @node Freemind export, XOXO export, TaskJuggler export, Exporting
10332 @section Freemind export
10333 @cindex Freemind export
10334 @cindex mind map
10335
10336 The Freemind exporter was written by Lennart Borgman.
10337
10338 @table @kbd
10339 @kindex C-c C-e m
10340 @item C-c C-e m
10341 Export as Freemind mind map @file{myfile.mm}.
10342 @end table
10343
10344 @node XOXO export, iCalendar export, Freemind export, Exporting
10345 @section XOXO export
10346 @cindex XOXO export
10347
10348 Org-mode contains an exporter that produces XOXO-style output.
10349 Currently, this exporter only handles the general outline structure and
10350 does not interpret any additional Org-mode features.
10351
10352 @table @kbd
10353 @kindex C-c C-e x
10354 @item C-c C-e x
10355 Export as XOXO file @file{myfile.html}.
10356 @kindex C-c C-e v
10357 @item C-c C-e v x
10358 Export only the visible part of the document.
10359 @end table
10360
10361 @node iCalendar export, , XOXO export, Exporting
10362 @section iCalendar export
10363 @cindex iCalendar export
10364
10365 @vindex org-icalendar-include-todo
10366 @vindex org-icalendar-use-deadline
10367 @vindex org-icalendar-use-scheduled
10368 @vindex org-icalendar-categories
10369 Some people use Org-mode for keeping track of projects, but still prefer a
10370 standard calendar application for anniversaries and appointments. In this
10371 case it can be useful to show deadlines and other time-stamped items in Org
10372 files in the calendar application. Org-mode can export calendar information
10373 in the standard iCalendar format. If you also want to have TODO entries
10374 included in the export, configure the variable
10375 @code{org-icalendar-include-todo}. Plain timestamps are exported as VEVENT,
10376 and TODO items as VTODO. It will also create events from deadlines that are
10377 in non-TODO items. Deadlines and scheduling dates in TODO items will be used
10378 to set the start and due dates for the TODO entry@footnote{See the variables
10379 @code{org-icalendar-use-deadline} and @code{org-icalendar-use-scheduled}.}.
10380 As categories, it will use the tags locally defined in the heading, and the
10381 file/tree category@footnote{To add inherited tags or the TODO state,
10382 configure the variable @code{org-icalendar-categories}.}.
10383
10384 @vindex org-icalendar-store-UID
10385 @cindex property, ID
10386 The iCalendar standard requires each entry to have a globally unique
10387 identifier (UID). Org creates these identifiers during export. If you set
10388 the variable @code{org-icalendar-store-UID}, the UID will be stored in the
10389 @code{:ID:} property of the entry and re-used next time you report this
10390 entry. Since a single entry can give rise to multiple iCalendar entries (as
10391 a timestamp, a deadline, a scheduled item, and as a TODO item), Org adds
10392 prefixes to the UID, depending on what triggered the inclusion of the entry.
10393 In this way the UID remains unique, but a synchronization program can still
10394 figure out from which entry all the different instances originate.
10395
10396 @table @kbd
10397 @kindex C-c C-e i
10398 @item C-c C-e i
10399 Create iCalendar entries for the current file and store them in the same
10400 directory, using a file extension @file{.ics}.
10401 @kindex C-c C-e I
10402 @item C-c C-e I
10403 @vindex org-agenda-files
10404 Like @kbd{C-c C-e i}, but do this for all files in
10405 @code{org-agenda-files}. For each of these files, a separate iCalendar
10406 file will be written.
10407 @kindex C-c C-e c
10408 @item C-c C-e c
10409 @vindex org-combined-agenda-icalendar-file
10410 Create a single large iCalendar file from all files in
10411 @code{org-agenda-files} and write it to the file given by
10412 @code{org-combined-agenda-icalendar-file}.
10413 @end table
10414
10415 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
10416 @vindex org-icalendar-include-body
10417 @cindex property, SUMMARY
10418 @cindex property, DESCRIPTION
10419 @cindex property, LOCATION
10420 The export will honor SUMMARY, DESCRIPTION and LOCATION@footnote{The LOCATION
10421 property can be inherited from higher in the hierarchy if you configure
10422 @code{org-use-property-inheritance} accordingly.} properties if the selected
10423 entries have them. If not, the summary will be derived from the headline,
10424 and the description from the body (limited to
10425 @code{org-icalendar-include-body} characters).
10426
10427 How this calendar is best read and updated, depends on the application
10428 you are using. The FAQ covers this issue.
10429
10430 @node Publishing, Working With Source Code, Exporting, Top
10431 @chapter Publishing
10432 @cindex publishing
10433
10434 Org includes a publishing management system that allows you to configure
10435 automatic HTML conversion of @emph{projects} composed of interlinked org
10436 files. You can also configure Org to automatically upload your exported HTML
10437 pages and related attachments, such as images and source code files, to a web
10438 server.
10439
10440 You can also use Org to convert files into PDF, or even combine HTML and PDF
10441 conversion so that files are available in both formats on the server.
10442
10443 Publishing has been contributed to Org by David O'Toole.
10444
10445 @menu
10446 * Configuration:: Defining projects
10447 * Uploading files:: How to get files up on the server
10448 * Sample configuration:: Example projects
10449 * Triggering publication:: Publication commands
10450 @end menu
10451
10452 @node Configuration, Uploading files, Publishing, Publishing
10453 @section Configuration
10454
10455 Publishing needs significant configuration to specify files, destination
10456 and many other properties of a project.
10457
10458 @menu
10459 * Project alist:: The central configuration variable
10460 * Sources and destinations:: From here to there
10461 * Selecting files:: What files are part of the project?
10462 * Publishing action:: Setting the function doing the publishing
10463 * Publishing options:: Tweaking HTML export
10464 * Publishing links:: Which links keep working after publishing?
10465 * Sitemap:: Generating a list of all pages
10466 * Generating an index:: An index that reaches across pages
10467 @end menu
10468
10469 @node Project alist, Sources and destinations, Configuration, Configuration
10470 @subsection The variable @code{org-publish-project-alist}
10471 @cindex org-publish-project-alist
10472 @cindex projects, for publishing
10473
10474 @vindex org-publish-project-alist
10475 Publishing is configured almost entirely through setting the value of one
10476 variable, called @code{org-publish-project-alist}. Each element of the list
10477 configures one project, and may be in one of the two following forms:
10478
10479 @lisp
10480 ("project-name" :property value :property value ...)
10481 @r{or}
10482 ("project-name" :components ("project-name" "project-name" ...))
10483
10484 @end lisp
10485
10486 In both cases, projects are configured by specifying property values. A
10487 project defines the set of files that will be published, as well as the
10488 publishing configuration to use when publishing those files. When a project
10489 takes the second form listed above, the individual members of the
10490 @code{:components} property are taken to be sub-projects, which group
10491 together files requiring different publishing options. When you publish such
10492 a ``meta-project'', all the components will also be published, in the
10493 sequence given.
10494
10495 @node Sources and destinations, Selecting files, Project alist, Configuration
10496 @subsection Sources and destinations for files
10497 @cindex directories, for publishing
10498
10499 Most properties are optional, but some should always be set. In
10500 particular, Org needs to know where to look for source files,
10501 and where to put published files.
10502
10503 @multitable @columnfractions 0.3 0.7
10504 @item @code{:base-directory}
10505 @tab Directory containing publishing source files
10506 @item @code{:publishing-directory}
10507 @tab Directory where output files will be published. You can directly
10508 publish to a webserver using a file name syntax appropriate for
10509 the Emacs @file{tramp} package. Or you can publish to a local directory and
10510 use external tools to upload your website (@pxref{Uploading files}).
10511 @item @code{:preparation-function}
10512 @tab Function or list of functions to be called before starting the
10513 publishing process, for example, to run @code{make} for updating files to be
10514 published. The project property list is scoped into this call as the
10515 variable @code{project-plist}.
10516 @item @code{:completion-function}
10517 @tab Function or list of functions called after finishing the publishing
10518 process, for example, to change permissions of the resulting files. The
10519 project property list is scoped into this call as the variable
10520 @code{project-plist}.
10521 @end multitable
10522 @noindent
10523
10524 @node Selecting files, Publishing action, Sources and destinations, Configuration
10525 @subsection Selecting files
10526 @cindex files, selecting for publishing
10527
10528 By default, all files with extension @file{.org} in the base directory
10529 are considered part of the project. This can be modified by setting the
10530 properties
10531 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
10532 @item @code{:base-extension}
10533 @tab Extension (without the dot!) of source files. This actually is a
10534 regular expression. Set this to the symbol @code{any} if you want to get all
10535 files in @code{:base-directory}, even without extension.
10536
10537 @item @code{:exclude}
10538 @tab Regular expression to match file names that should not be
10539 published, even though they have been selected on the basis of their
10540 extension.
10541
10542 @item @code{:include}
10543 @tab List of files to be included regardless of @code{:base-extension}
10544 and @code{:exclude}.
10545 @end multitable
10546
10547 @node Publishing action, Publishing options, Selecting files, Configuration
10548 @subsection Publishing action
10549 @cindex action, for publishing
10550
10551 Publishing means that a file is copied to the destination directory and
10552 possibly transformed in the process. The default transformation is to export
10553 Org files as HTML files, and this is done by the function
10554 @code{org-publish-org-to-html} which calls the HTML exporter (@pxref{HTML
10555 export}). But you also can publish your content as PDF files using
10556 @code{org-publish-org-to-pdf}. If you want to publish the Org file itself,
10557 but with @i{archived}, @i{commented}, and @i{tag-excluded} trees removed, use
10558 @code{org-publish-org-to-org} and set the parameters @code{:plain-source}
10559 and/or @code{:htmlized-source}. This will produce @file{file.org} and
10560 @file{file.org.html} in the publishing
10561 directory@footnote{@file{file-source.org} and @file{file-source.org.html} if
10562 source and publishing directories are equal. Note that with this kind of
10563 setup, you need to add @code{:exclude "-source\\.org"} to the project
10564 definition in @code{org-publish-project-alist} to avoid that the published
10565 source files will be considered as new org files the next time the project is
10566 published.}. Other files like images only
10567 need to be copied to the publishing destination, for this you may use
10568 @code{org-publish-attachment}. For non-Org files, you always need to
10569 specify the publishing function:
10570
10571 @multitable @columnfractions 0.3 0.7
10572 @item @code{:publishing-function}
10573 @tab Function executing the publication of a file. This may also be a
10574 list of functions, which will all be called in turn.
10575 @item @code{:plain-source}
10576 @tab Non-nil means, publish plain source.
10577 @item @code{:htmlized-source}
10578 @tab Non-nil means, publish htmlized source.
10579 @end multitable
10580
10581 The function must accept three arguments: a property list containing at least
10582 a @code{:publishing-directory} property, the name of the file to be
10583 published, and the path to the publishing directory of the output file. It
10584 should take the specified file, make the necessary transformation (if any)
10585 and place the result into the destination folder.
10586
10587 @node Publishing options, Publishing links, Publishing action, Configuration
10588 @subsection Options for the HTML/La@TeX{} exporters
10589 @cindex options, for publishing
10590
10591 The property list can be used to set many export options for the HTML
10592 and La@TeX{} exporters. In most cases, these properties correspond to user
10593 variables in Org. The table below lists these properties along
10594 with the variable they belong to. See the documentation string for the
10595 respective variable for details.
10596
10597 @vindex org-export-html-link-up
10598 @vindex org-export-html-link-home
10599 @vindex org-export-default-language
10600 @vindex org-display-custom-times
10601 @vindex org-export-headline-levels
10602 @vindex org-export-with-section-numbers
10603 @vindex org-export-section-number-format
10604 @vindex org-export-with-toc
10605 @vindex org-export-preserve-breaks
10606 @vindex org-export-with-archived-trees
10607 @vindex org-export-with-emphasize
10608 @vindex org-export-with-sub-superscripts
10609 @vindex org-export-with-special-strings
10610 @vindex org-export-with-footnotes
10611 @vindex org-export-with-drawers
10612 @vindex org-export-with-tags
10613 @vindex org-export-with-todo-keywords
10614 @vindex org-export-with-priority
10615 @vindex org-export-with-TeX-macros
10616 @vindex org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments
10617 @vindex org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading
10618 @vindex org-export-with-fixed-width
10619 @vindex org-export-with-timestamps
10620 @vindex org-export-author-info
10621 @vindex org-export-email
10622 @vindex org-export-creator-info
10623 @vindex org-export-with-tables
10624 @vindex org-export-highlight-first-table-line
10625 @vindex org-export-html-style-include-default
10626 @vindex org-export-html-style
10627 @vindex org-export-html-style-extra
10628 @vindex org-export-html-link-org-files-as-html
10629 @vindex org-export-html-inline-images
10630 @vindex org-export-html-extension
10631 @vindex org-export-html-table-tag
10632 @vindex org-export-html-expand
10633 @vindex org-export-html-with-timestamp
10634 @vindex org-export-publishing-directory
10635 @vindex org-export-html-preamble
10636 @vindex org-export-html-postamble
10637 @vindex org-export-html-auto-preamble
10638 @vindex org-export-html-auto-postamble
10639 @vindex user-full-name
10640 @vindex user-mail-address
10641 @vindex org-export-select-tags
10642 @vindex org-export-exclude-tags
10643
10644 @multitable @columnfractions 0.32 0.68
10645 @item @code{:link-up} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-up}
10646 @item @code{:link-home} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-home}
10647 @item @code{:language} @tab @code{org-export-default-language}
10648 @item @code{:customtime} @tab @code{org-display-custom-times}
10649 @item @code{:headline-levels} @tab @code{org-export-headline-levels}
10650 @item @code{:section-numbers} @tab @code{org-export-with-section-numbers}
10651 @item @code{:section-number-format} @tab @code{org-export-section-number-format}
10652 @item @code{:table-of-contents} @tab @code{org-export-with-toc}
10653 @item @code{:preserve-breaks} @tab @code{org-export-preserve-breaks}
10654 @item @code{:archived-trees} @tab @code{org-export-with-archived-trees}
10655 @item @code{:emphasize} @tab @code{org-export-with-emphasize}
10656 @item @code{:sub-superscript} @tab @code{org-export-with-sub-superscripts}
10657 @item @code{:special-strings} @tab @code{org-export-with-special-strings}
10658 @item @code{:footnotes} @tab @code{org-export-with-footnotes}
10659 @item @code{:drawers} @tab @code{org-export-with-drawers}
10660 @item @code{:tags} @tab @code{org-export-with-tags}
10661 @item @code{:todo-keywords} @tab @code{org-export-with-todo-keywords}
10662 @item @code{:priority} @tab @code{org-export-with-priority}
10663 @item @code{:TeX-macros} @tab @code{org-export-with-TeX-macros}
10664 @item @code{:LaTeX-fragments} @tab @code{org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments}
10665 @item @code{:latex-listings} @tab @code{org-export-latex-listings}
10666 @item @code{:skip-before-1st-heading} @tab @code{org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading}
10667 @item @code{:fixed-width} @tab @code{org-export-with-fixed-width}
10668 @item @code{:timestamps} @tab @code{org-export-with-timestamps}
10669 @item @code{:author-info} @tab @code{org-export-author-info}
10670 @item @code{:email-info} @tab @code{org-export-email-info}
10671 @item @code{:creator-info} @tab @code{org-export-creator-info}
10672 @item @code{:tables} @tab @code{org-export-with-tables}
10673 @item @code{:table-auto-headline} @tab @code{org-export-highlight-first-table-line}
10674 @item @code{:style-include-default} @tab @code{org-export-html-style-include-default}
10675 @item @code{:style} @tab @code{org-export-html-style}
10676 @item @code{:style-extra} @tab @code{org-export-html-style-extra}
10677 @item @code{:convert-org-links} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-org-files-as-html}
10678 @item @code{:inline-images} @tab @code{org-export-html-inline-images}
10679 @item @code{:html-extension} @tab @code{org-export-html-extension}
10680 @item @code{:xml-declaration} @tab @code{org-export-html-xml-declaration}
10681 @item @code{:html-table-tag} @tab @code{org-export-html-table-tag}
10682 @item @code{:expand-quoted-html} @tab @code{org-export-html-expand}
10683 @item @code{:timestamp} @tab @code{org-export-html-with-timestamp}
10684 @item @code{:publishing-directory} @tab @code{org-export-publishing-directory}
10685 @item @code{:preamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-preamble}
10686 @item @code{:postamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-postamble}
10687 @item @code{:auto-preamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-auto-preamble}
10688 @item @code{:auto-postamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-auto-postamble}
10689 @item @code{:author} @tab @code{user-full-name}
10690 @item @code{:email} @tab @code{user-mail-address} : @code{addr;addr;..}
10691 @item @code{:select-tags} @tab @code{org-export-select-tags}
10692 @item @code{:exclude-tags} @tab @code{org-export-exclude-tags}
10693 @item @code{:latex-image-options} @tab @code{org-export-latex-image-default-option}
10694 @end multitable
10695
10696 Most of the @code{org-export-with-*} variables have the same effect in
10697 both HTML and La@TeX{} exporters, except for @code{:TeX-macros} and
10698 @code{:LaTeX-fragments}, respectively @code{nil} and @code{t} in the
10699 La@TeX{} export.
10700
10701 @vindex org-publish-project-alist
10702 When a property is given a value in @code{org-publish-project-alist},
10703 its setting overrides the value of the corresponding user variable (if
10704 any) during publishing. Options set within a file (@pxref{Export
10705 options}), however, override everything.
10706
10707 @node Publishing links, Sitemap, Publishing options, Configuration
10708 @subsection Links between published files
10709 @cindex links, publishing
10710
10711 To create a link from one Org file to another, you would use
10712 something like @samp{[[file:foo.org][The foo]]} or simply
10713 @samp{file:foo.org.} (@pxref{Hyperlinks}). When published, this link
10714 becomes a link to @file{foo.html}. In this way, you can interlink the
10715 pages of your "org web" project and the links will work as expected when
10716 you publish them to HTML. If you also publish the Org source file and want
10717 to link to that, use an @code{http:} link instead of a @code{file:} link,
10718 because @code{file:} links are converted to link to the corresponding
10719 @file{html} file.
10720
10721 You may also link to related files, such as images. Provided you are careful
10722 with relative file names, and provided you have also configured Org to upload
10723 the related files, these links will work too. See @ref{Complex example}, for
10724 an example of this usage.
10725
10726 Sometimes an Org file to be published may contain links that are
10727 only valid in your production environment, but not in the publishing
10728 location. In this case, use the property
10729
10730 @multitable @columnfractions 0.4 0.6
10731 @item @code{:link-validation-function}
10732 @tab Function to validate links
10733 @end multitable
10734
10735 @noindent
10736 to define a function for checking link validity. This function must
10737 accept two arguments, the file name and a directory relative to which
10738 the file name is interpreted in the production environment. If this
10739 function returns @code{nil}, then the HTML generator will only insert a
10740 description into the HTML file, but no link. One option for this
10741 function is @code{org-publish-validate-link} which checks if the given
10742 file is part of any project in @code{org-publish-project-alist}.
10743
10744 @node Sitemap, Generating an index, Publishing links, Configuration
10745 @subsection Generating a sitemap
10746 @cindex sitemap, of published pages
10747
10748 The following properties may be used to control publishing of
10749 a map of files for a given project.
10750
10751 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.65
10752 @item @code{:auto-sitemap}
10753 @tab When non-nil, publish a sitemap during @code{org-publish-current-project}
10754 or @code{org-publish-all}.
10755
10756 @item @code{:sitemap-filename}
10757 @tab Filename for output of sitemap. Defaults to @file{sitemap.org} (which
10758 becomes @file{sitemap.html}).
10759
10760 @item @code{:sitemap-title}
10761 @tab Title of sitemap page. Defaults to name of file.
10762
10763 @item @code{:sitemap-function}
10764 @tab Plug-in function to use for generation of the sitemap.
10765 Defaults to @code{org-publish-org-sitemap}, which generates a plain list
10766 of links to all files in the project.
10767
10768 @item @code{:sitemap-sort-folders}
10769 @tab Where folders should appear in the sitemap. Set this to @code{first}
10770 (default) or @code{last} to display folders first or last,
10771 respectively. Any other value will mix files and folders.
10772
10773 @item @code{:sitemap-alphabetically}
10774 @tab The site map is normally sorted alphabetically. Set this explicitly to
10775 @code{nil} to turn off sorting.
10776
10777 @item @code{:sitemap-ignore-case}
10778 @tab Should sorting be case-sensitive? Default @code{nil}.
10779
10780 @end multitable
10781
10782 @node Generating an index, , Sitemap, Configuration
10783 @subsection Generating an index
10784 @cindex index, in a publishing project
10785
10786 Org-mode can generate an index across the files of a publishing project.
10787
10788 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
10789 @item @code{:makeindex}
10790 @tab When non-nil, generate in index in the file @file{theindex.org} and
10791 publish it as @file{theindex.html}.
10792 @end multitable
10793
10794 The file will be create when first publishing a project with the
10795 @code{:makeindex} set. The file only contains a statement @code{#+include:
10796 "theindex.inc"}. You can then built around this include statement by adding
10797 a title, style information etc.
10798
10799 @node Uploading files, Sample configuration, Configuration, Publishing
10800 @section Uploading files
10801 @cindex rsync
10802 @cindex unison
10803
10804 For those people already utilizing third party sync tools such as
10805 @command{rsync} or @command{unison}, it might be preferable not to use the built in
10806 @i{remote} publishing facilities of Org-mode which rely heavily on
10807 Tramp. Tramp, while very useful and powerful, tends not to be
10808 so efficient for multiple file transfer and has been known to cause problems
10809 under heavy usage.
10810
10811 Specialized synchronization utilities offer several advantages. In addition
10812 to timestamp comparison, they also do content and permissions/attribute
10813 checks. For this reason you might prefer to publish your web to a local
10814 directory (possibly even @i{in place} with your Org files) and then use
10815 @file{unison} or @file{rsync} to do the synchronization with the remote host.
10816
10817 Since Unison (for example) can be configured as to which files to transfer to
10818 a certain remote destination, it can greatly simplify the project publishing
10819 definition. Simply keep all files in the correct location, process your Org
10820 files with @code{org-publish} and let the synchronization tool do the rest.
10821 You do not need, in this scenario, to include attachments such as @file{jpg},
10822 @file{css} or @file{gif} files in the project definition since the 3rd party
10823 tool syncs them.
10824
10825 Publishing to a local directory is also much faster than to a remote one, so
10826 that you can afford more easily to republish entire projects. If you set
10827 @code{org-publish-use-timestamps-flag} to @code{nil}, you gain the main
10828 benefit of re-including any changed external files such as source example
10829 files you might include with @code{#+INCLUDE}. The timestamp mechanism in
10830 Org is not smart enough to detect if included files have been modified.
10831
10832 @node Sample configuration, Triggering publication, Uploading files, Publishing
10833 @section Sample configuration
10834
10835 Below we provide two example configurations. The first one is a simple
10836 project publishing only a set of Org files. The second example is
10837 more complex, with a multi-component project.
10838
10839 @menu
10840 * Simple example:: One-component publishing
10841 * Complex example:: A multi-component publishing example
10842 @end menu
10843
10844 @node Simple example, Complex example, Sample configuration, Sample configuration
10845 @subsection Example: simple publishing configuration
10846
10847 This example publishes a set of Org files to the @file{public_html}
10848 directory on the local machine.
10849
10850 @lisp
10851 (setq org-publish-project-alist
10852 '(("org"
10853 :base-directory "~/org/"
10854 :publishing-directory "~/public_html"
10855 :section-numbers nil
10856 :table-of-contents nil
10857 :style "<link rel=\"stylesheet\"
10858 href=\"../other/mystyle.css\"
10859 type=\"text/css\"/>")))
10860 @end lisp
10861
10862 @node Complex example, , Simple example, Sample configuration
10863 @subsection Example: complex publishing configuration
10864
10865 This more complicated example publishes an entire website, including
10866 Org files converted to HTML, image files, Emacs Lisp source code, and
10867 style sheets. The publishing directory is remote and private files are
10868 excluded.
10869
10870 To ensure that links are preserved, care should be taken to replicate
10871 your directory structure on the web server, and to use relative file
10872 paths. For example, if your Org files are kept in @file{~/org} and your
10873 publishable images in @file{~/images}, you would link to an image with
10874 @c
10875 @example
10876 file:../images/myimage.png
10877 @end example
10878 @c
10879 On the web server, the relative path to the image should be the
10880 same. You can accomplish this by setting up an "images" folder in the
10881 right place on the web server, and publishing images to it.
10882
10883 @lisp
10884 (setq org-publish-project-alist
10885 '(("orgfiles"
10886 :base-directory "~/org/"
10887 :base-extension "org"
10888 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/notebook/"
10889 :publishing-function org-publish-org-to-html
10890 :exclude "PrivatePage.org" ;; regexp
10891 :headline-levels 3
10892 :section-numbers nil
10893 :table-of-contents nil
10894 :style "<link rel=\"stylesheet\"
10895 href=\"../other/mystyle.css\" type=\"text/css\"/>"
10896 :auto-preamble t
10897 :auto-postamble nil)
10898
10899 ("images"
10900 :base-directory "~/images/"
10901 :base-extension "jpg\\|gif\\|png"
10902 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/images/"
10903 :publishing-function org-publish-attachment)
10904
10905 ("other"
10906 :base-directory "~/other/"
10907 :base-extension "css\\|el"
10908 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/other/"
10909 :publishing-function org-publish-attachment)
10910 ("website" :components ("orgfiles" "images" "other"))))
10911 @end lisp
10912
10913 @node Triggering publication, , Sample configuration, Publishing
10914 @section Triggering publication
10915
10916 Once properly configured, Org can publish with the following commands:
10917
10918 @table @kbd
10919 @kindex C-c C-e C
10920 @item C-c C-e C
10921 Prompt for a specific project and publish all files that belong to it.
10922 @kindex C-c C-e P
10923 @item C-c C-e P
10924 Publish the project containing the current file.
10925 @kindex C-c C-e F
10926 @item C-c C-e F
10927 Publish only the current file.
10928 @kindex C-c C-e E
10929 @item C-c C-e E
10930 Publish every project.
10931 @end table
10932
10933 @vindex org-publish-use-timestamps-flag
10934 Org uses timestamps to track when a file has changed. The above functions
10935 normally only publish changed files. You can override this and force
10936 publishing of all files by giving a prefix argument to any of the commands
10937 above, or by customizing the variable @code{org-publish-use-timestamps-flag}.
10938 This may be necessary in particular if files include other files via
10939 @code{#+SETUPFILE:} or @code{#+INCLUDE:}.
10940
10941 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
10942 @comment Working With Source Code, Miscellaneous, Publishing, Top
10943
10944 @node Working With Source Code, Miscellaneous, Publishing, Top
10945 @chapter Working with source code
10946 @cindex Schulte, Eric
10947 @cindex Davison, Dan
10948 @cindex source code, working with
10949
10950 Source code can be included in Org-mode documents using a @samp{src} block,
10951 e.g.
10952
10953 @example
10954 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
10955 (defun org-xor (a b)
10956 "Exclusive or."
10957 (if a (not b) b))
10958 #+END_SRC
10959 @end example
10960
10961 Org-mode provides a number of features for working with live source code,
10962 including editing of code blocks in their native major-mode, evaluation of
10963 code blocks, tangling of code blocks, and exporting code blocks and
10964 their results in several formats. This functionality was contributed by Dan
10965 Davison and Eric Schulte, and was originally named Org-babel.
10966
10967 The following sections describe Org-mode's code block handling facilities.
10968
10969 @menu
10970 * Structure of code blocks:: Code block syntax described
10971 * Editing source code:: Language major-mode editing
10972 * Exporting code blocks:: Export contents and/or results
10973 * Extracting source code:: Create pure source code files
10974 * Evaluating code blocks:: Place results of evaluation in the Org-mode buffer
10975 * Library of Babel:: Use and contribute to a library of useful code blocks
10976 * Languages:: List of supported code block languages
10977 * Header arguments:: Configure code block functionality
10978 * Results of evaluation:: How evaluation results are handled
10979 * Noweb reference syntax:: Literate programming in Org-mode
10980 * Key bindings and useful functions:: Work quickly with code blocks
10981 * Batch execution:: Call functions from the command line
10982 @end menu
10983
10984 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
10985 @comment Structure of code blocks, Editing source code, Working With Source Code, Working With Source Code
10986
10987 @node Structure of code blocks, Editing source code, Working With Source Code, Working With Source Code
10988 @section Structure of code blocks
10989 @cindex code block, structure
10990 @cindex source code, block structure
10991
10992 The structure of code blocks is as follows:
10993
10994 @example
10995 #+srcname: <name>
10996 #+begin_src <language> <switches> <header arguments>
10997 <body>
10998 #+end_src
10999 @end example
11000
11001 @table @code
11002 @item <name>
11003 This name is associated with the code block. This is similar to the
11004 @samp{#+tblname} lines that can be used to name tables in Org-mode files.
11005 Referencing the name of a code block makes it possible to evaluate the
11006 block from other places in the file, other files, or from Org-mode table
11007 formulas (see @ref{The spreadsheet}).
11008 @item <language>
11009 The language of the code in the block.
11010 @item <switches>
11011 Switches controlling exportation of the code block (see switches discussion in
11012 @ref{Literal examples})
11013 @item <header arguments>
11014 Optional header arguments control many aspects of evaluation, export and
11015 tangling of code blocks. See the @ref{Header arguments}
11016 section. Header arguments can also be set on a per-buffer or per-subtree
11017 basis using properties.
11018 @item <body>
11019 The source code.
11020 @end table
11021
11022 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
11023 @comment Editing source code, Exporting code blocks, Structure of code blocks, Working With Source Code
11024
11025 @node Editing source code, Exporting code blocks, Structure of code blocks, Working With Source Code
11026 @section Editing source code
11027 @cindex code block, editing
11028 @cindex source code, editing
11029
11030 @kindex C-c '
11031 Use @kbd{C-c '} to edit the current code block. This brings up
11032 a language major-mode edit buffer containing the body of the code
11033 block. Saving this buffer will write the new contents back to the Org
11034 buffer. Use @kbd{C-c '} again to exit.
11035
11036 The @code{org-src-mode} minor mode will be active in the edit buffer. The
11037 following variables can be used to configure the behavior of the edit
11038 buffer. See also the customization group @code{org-edit-structure} for
11039 further configuration options.
11040
11041 @table @code
11042 @item org-src-lang-modes
11043 If an Emacs major-mode named @code{<lang>-mode} exists, where
11044 @code{<lang>} is the language named in the header line of the code block,
11045 then the edit buffer will be placed in that major-mode. This variable
11046 can be used to map arbitrary language names to existing major modes.
11047 @item org-src-window-setup
11048 Controls the way Emacs windows are rearranged when the edit buffer is created.
11049 @item org-src-preserve-indentation
11050 This variable is especially useful for tangling languages such as
11051 python, in which whitespace indentation in the output is critical.
11052 @item org-src-ask-before-returning-to-edit-buffer
11053 By default, Org will ask before returning to an open edit buffer. Set
11054 this variable to nil to switch without asking.
11055 @end table
11056
11057 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
11058 @comment Exporting code blocks, Extracting source code, Editing source code, Working With Source Code
11059
11060 @node Exporting code blocks, Extracting source code, Editing source code, Working With Source Code
11061 @section Exporting code blocks
11062 @cindex code block, exporting
11063 @cindex source code, exporting
11064
11065 It is possible to export the @emph{contents} of code blocks, the
11066 @emph{results} of code block evaluation, @emph{neither}, or @emph{both}. For
11067 most languages, the default exports the contents of code blocks. However, for
11068 some languages (e.g. @code{ditaa}) the default exports the results of code
11069 block evaluation. For information on exporting code block bodies, see
11070 @ref{Literal examples}.
11071
11072 The @code{:exports} header argument can be used to specify export
11073 behavior:
11074
11075 @subsubheading Header arguments:
11076 @table @code
11077 @item :exports code
11078 The default in most languages. The body of the code block is exported, as
11079 described in @ref{Literal examples}.
11080 @item :exports results
11081 The code block will be evaluated and the results will be placed in the
11082 Org-mode buffer for export, either updating previous results of the code
11083 block located anywhere in the buffer or, if no previous results exist,
11084 placing the results immediately after the code block. The body of the code
11085 block will not be exported.
11086 @item :exports both
11087 Both the code block and its results will be exported.
11088 @item :exports none
11089 Neither the code block nor its results will be exported.
11090 @end table
11091
11092 It is possible to inhibit the evaluation of code blocks during export.
11093 Setting the the @code{org-export-babel-evaluate} variable to @code{nil} will
11094 ensure that no code blocks are evaluated as part of the export process. This
11095 can be useful in situations where potentially untrusted Org-mode files are
11096 exported in an automated fashion, for example when Org-mode is used as the
11097 markup language for a wiki.
11098
11099 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
11100 @comment Extracting source code, Evaluating code blocks, Exporting code blocks, Working With Source Code
11101 @node Extracting source code, Evaluating code blocks, Exporting code blocks, Working With Source Code
11102 @section Extracting source code
11103 @cindex source code, extracting
11104 @cindex code block, extracting source code
11105
11106 Creating pure source code files by extracting code from source blocks is
11107 referred to as ``tangling''---a term adopted from the literate programming
11108 community. During ``tangling'' of code blocks their bodies are expanded
11109 using @code{org-babel-expand-src-block} which can expand both variable and
11110 ``noweb'' style references (see @ref{Noweb reference syntax}).
11111
11112 @subsubheading Header arguments
11113 @table @code
11114 @item :tangle no
11115 The default. The code block is not included in the tangled output.
11116 @item :tangle yes
11117 Include the code block in the tangled output. The output file name is the
11118 name of the org file with the extension @samp{.org} replaced by the extension
11119 for the block language.
11120 @item :tangle filename
11121 Include the code block in the tangled output to file @samp{filename}.
11122 @end table
11123
11124 @kindex C-c C-v t
11125 @subsubheading Functions
11126 @table @code
11127 @item org-babel-tangle @kbd{C-c C-v t}
11128 Tangle the current file.
11129 @item org-babel-tangle-file
11130 Choose a file to tangle.
11131 @end table
11132
11133 @subsubheading Hooks
11134 @table @code
11135 @item org-babel-post-tangle-hook
11136 This hook is run from within code files tangled by @code{org-babel-tangle}.
11137 Example applications could include post-processing, compilation or evaluation
11138 of tangled code files.
11139 @end table
11140
11141 @node Evaluating code blocks, Library of Babel, Extracting source code, Working With Source Code
11142 @section Evaluating code blocks
11143 @cindex code block, evaluating
11144 @cindex source code, evaluating
11145
11146 Code blocks can be evaluated@footnote{Whenever code is evaluated there is a
11147 potential for that code to do harm. Org-mode provides a number of safeguards
11148 to ensure that it only evaluates code with explicit confirmation from the
11149 user. For information on these safeguards (and on how to disable them) see
11150 @ref{Code evaluation security}.} and the results placed in the Org-mode
11151 buffer. By default, evaluation is only turned on for @code{emacs-lisp} code
11152 blocks, however support exists for evaluating blocks in many languages. See
11153 @ref{Languages} for a list of supported languages. See @ref{Structure of
11154 code blocks} for information on the syntax used to define a code block.
11155
11156 @kindex C-c C-c
11157 There are a number of ways to evaluate code blocks. The simplest is to press
11158 @kbd{C-c C-c} or @kbd{C-c C-v e} with the point on a code block@footnote{The
11159 @code{org-babel-no-eval-on-ctrl-c-ctrl-c} variable can be used to remove code
11160 evaluation from the @kbd{C-c C-c} key binding.}. This will call the
11161 @code{org-babel-execute-src-block} function to evaluate the block and insert
11162 its results into the Org-mode buffer.
11163
11164 It is also possible to evaluate named code blocks from anywhere in an
11165 Org-mode buffer or an Org-mode table. @code{#+call} (or synonymously
11166 @code{#+function} or @code{#+lob}) lines can be used to remotely execute code
11167 blocks located in the current Org-mode buffer or in the ``Library of Babel''
11168 (see @ref{Library of Babel}). These lines use the following syntax.
11169
11170 @example
11171 #+call: <name>(<arguments>) <header arguments>
11172 #+function: <name>(<arguments>) <header arguments>
11173 #+lob: <name>(<arguments>) <header arguments>
11174 @end example
11175
11176 @table @code
11177 @item <name>
11178 The name of the code block to be evaluated.
11179 @item <arguments>
11180 Arguments specified in this section will be passed to the code block.
11181 @item <header arguments>
11182 Header arguments can be placed after the function invocation. See
11183 @ref{Header arguments} for more information on header arguments.
11184 @end table
11185
11186
11187 @node Library of Babel, Languages, Evaluating code blocks, Working With Source Code
11188 @section Library of Babel
11189 @cindex babel, library of
11190 @cindex source code, library
11191 @cindex code block, library
11192
11193 The ``Library of Babel'' is a library of code blocks
11194 that can be called from any Org-mode file. The library is housed in an
11195 Org-mode file located in the @samp{contrib} directory of Org-mode.
11196 Org-mode users can deposit functions they believe to be generally
11197 useful in the library.
11198
11199 Code blocks defined in the ``Library of Babel'' can be called remotely as if
11200 they were in the current Org-mode buffer (see @ref{Evaluating code blocks}
11201 for information on the syntax of remote code block evaluation).
11202
11203 @kindex C-c C-v l
11204 Code blocks located in any Org-mode file can be loaded into the ``Library of
11205 Babel'' with the @code{org-babel-lob-ingest} function, bound to @kbd{C-c C-v
11206 l}.
11207
11208 @node Languages, Header arguments, Library of Babel, Working With Source Code
11209 @section Languages
11210 @cindex babel, languages
11211 @cindex source code, languages
11212 @cindex code block, languages
11213
11214 Code blocks in the following languages are supported.
11215
11216 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.3 0.22 0.2
11217 @item @b{Language} @tab @b{Identifier} @tab @b{Language} @tab @b{Identifier}
11218 @item Asymptote @tab asymptote @tab C @tab C
11219 @item C++ @tab C++ @tab Clojure @tab clojure
11220 @item css @tab css @tab ditaa @tab ditaa
11221 @item Graphviz @tab dot @tab Emacs Lisp @tab emacs-lisp
11222 @item gnuplot @tab gnuplot @tab Haskell @tab haskell
11223 @item LaTeX @tab latex @tab Matlab @tab matlab
11224 @item Mscgen @tab mscgen @tab Objective Caml @tab ocaml
11225 @item Octave @tab octave @tab OZ @tab oz
11226 @item Perl @tab perl @tab Python @tab python
11227 @item R @tab R @tab Ruby @tab ruby
11228 @item Sass @tab sass @tab GNU Screen @tab screen
11229 @item shell @tab sh @tab SQL @tab sql
11230 @item Sqlite @tab sqlite
11231 @end multitable
11232
11233 Language-specific documentation is available for some languages. If
11234 available, it can be found at
11235 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/babel/languages}.
11236
11237 The @code{org-babel-load-languages} controls which languages are enabled for
11238 evaluation (by default only @code{emacs-lisp} is enabled). This variable can
11239 be set using the customization interface or by adding code like the following
11240 to your emacs configuration.
11241
11242 @quotation
11243 The following disables @code{emacs-lisp} evaluation and enables evaluation of
11244 @code{R} code blocks.
11245 @end quotation
11246
11247 @lisp
11248 (org-babel-do-load-languages
11249 'org-babel-load-languages
11250 '((emacs-lisp . nil)
11251 (R . t)))
11252 @end lisp
11253
11254 It is also possible to enable support for a language by loading the related
11255 elisp file with @code{require}.
11256
11257 @quotation
11258 The following adds support for evaluating @code{clojure} code blocks.
11259 @end quotation
11260
11261 @lisp
11262 (require 'ob-clojure)
11263 @end lisp
11264
11265 @node Header arguments, Results of evaluation, Languages, Working With Source Code
11266 @section Header arguments
11267 @cindex code block, header arguments
11268 @cindex source code, block header arguments
11269
11270 Code block functionality can be configured with header arguments. This
11271 section provides an overview of the use of header arguments, and then
11272 describes each header argument in detail.
11273
11274 @menu
11275 * Using header arguments:: Different ways to set header arguments
11276 * Specific header arguments:: List of header arguments
11277 @end menu
11278
11279 @node Using header arguments, Specific header arguments, Header arguments, Header arguments
11280 @subsection Using header arguments
11281
11282 The values of header arguments can be set in five different ways, each more
11283 specific (and having higher priority) than the last.
11284 @menu
11285 * System-wide header arguments:: Set global default values
11286 * Language-specific header arguments:: Set default values by language
11287 * Buffer-wide header arguments:: Set default values for a specific buffer
11288 * Header arguments in Org-mode properties:: Set default values for a buffer or heading
11289 * Code block specific header arguments:: The most common way to set values
11290 @end menu
11291
11292
11293 @node System-wide header arguments, Language-specific header arguments, Using header arguments, Using header arguments
11294 @subsubheading System-wide header arguments
11295 @vindex org-babel-default-header-args
11296 System-wide values of header arguments can be specified by customizing the
11297 @code{org-babel-default-header-args} variable:
11298
11299 @example
11300 :session => "none"
11301 :results => "replace"
11302 :exports => "code"
11303 :cache => "no"
11304 :noweb => "no"
11305 @end example
11306
11307 @c @example
11308 @c org-babel-default-header-args is a variable defined in `org-babel.el'.
11309 @c Its value is
11310 @c ((:session . "none")
11311 @c (:results . "replace")
11312 @c (:exports . "code")
11313 @c (:cache . "no")
11314 @c (:noweb . "no"))
11315
11316
11317 @c Documentation:
11318 @c Default arguments to use when evaluating a code block.
11319 @c @end example
11320
11321 For example, the following example could be used to set the default value of
11322 @code{:noweb} header arguments to @code{yes}. This would have the effect of
11323 expanding @code{:noweb} references by default when evaluating source code
11324 blocks.
11325
11326 @lisp
11327 (setq org-babel-default-header-args
11328 (cons '(:noweb . "yes")
11329 (assq-delete-all :noweb org-babel-default-header-args)))
11330 @end lisp
11331
11332 @node Language-specific header arguments, Buffer-wide header arguments, System-wide header arguments, Using header arguments
11333 @subsubheading Language-specific header arguments
11334 Each language can define its own set of default header arguments. See the
11335 language-specific documentation available online at
11336 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/babel}.
11337
11338 @node Buffer-wide header arguments, Header arguments in Org-mode properties, Language-specific header arguments, Using header arguments
11339 @subsubheading Buffer-wide header arguments
11340 Buffer-wide header arguments may be specified through the use of a special
11341 line placed anywhere in an Org-mode file. The line consists of the
11342 @code{#+BABEL:} keyword followed by a series of header arguments which may be
11343 specified using the standard header argument syntax.
11344
11345 For example the following would set @code{session} to @code{*R*}, and
11346 @code{results} to @code{silent} for every code block in the buffer, ensuring
11347 that all execution took place in the same session, and no results would be
11348 inserted into the buffer.
11349
11350 @example
11351 #+BABEL: :session *R* :results silent
11352 @end example
11353
11354 @node Header arguments in Org-mode properties, Code block specific header arguments, Buffer-wide header arguments, Using header arguments
11355 @subsubheading Header arguments in Org-mode properties
11356
11357 Header arguments are also read from Org-mode properties (see @ref{Property
11358 syntax}), which can be set on a buffer-wide or per-heading basis. An example
11359 of setting a header argument for all code blocks in a buffer is
11360
11361 @example
11362 #+property: tangle yes
11363 @end example
11364
11365 When properties are used to set default header arguments, they are looked up
11366 with inheritance, so the value of the @code{:cache} header argument will default
11367 to @code{yes} in all code blocks in the subtree rooted at the following
11368 heading:
11369
11370 @example
11371 * outline header
11372 :PROPERTIES:
11373 :cache: yes
11374 :END:
11375 @end example
11376
11377 @kindex C-c C-x p
11378 @vindex org-babel-default-header-args
11379 Properties defined in this way override the properties set in
11380 @code{org-babel-default-header-args}. It is convenient to use the
11381 @code{org-set-property} function bound to @kbd{C-c C-x p} to set properties
11382 in Org-mode documents.
11383
11384 @node Code block specific header arguments, , Header arguments in Org-mode properties, Using header arguments
11385 @subsubheading Code block specific header arguments
11386
11387 The most common way to assign values to header arguments is at the
11388 code block level. This can be done by listing a sequence of header
11389 arguments and their values as part of the @code{#+begin_src} line.
11390 Properties set in this way override both the values of
11391 @code{org-babel-default-header-args} and header arguments specified as
11392 properties. In the following example, the @code{:results} header argument
11393 is set to @code{silent}, meaning the results of execution will not be
11394 inserted in the buffer, and the @code{:exports} header argument is set to
11395 @code{code}, meaning only the body of the code block will be
11396 preserved on export to HTML or LaTeX.
11397
11398 @example
11399 #+source: factorial
11400 #+begin_src haskell :results silent :exports code :var n=0
11401 fac 0 = 1
11402 fac n = n * fac (n-1)
11403 #+end_src
11404 @end example
11405
11406 Similarly, it is possible to set header arguments for inline code blocks:
11407
11408 @example
11409 src_haskell[:exports both]@{fac 5@}
11410 @end example
11411
11412 Header arguments for ``Library of Babel'' or function call lines can be set as shown below:
11413
11414 @example
11415 #+call: factorial(n=5) :exports results
11416 @end example
11417
11418 @node Specific header arguments, , Using header arguments, Header arguments
11419 @subsection Specific header arguments
11420 The following header arguments are defined:
11421
11422 @menu
11423 * var:: Pass arguments to code blocks
11424 * results:: Specify the type of results and how they will
11425 be collected and handled
11426 * file:: Specify a path for file output
11427 * dir:: Specify the default (possibly remote)
11428 directory for code block execution
11429 * exports:: Export code and/or results
11430 * tangle:: Toggle tangling and specify file name
11431 * no-expand:: Turn off variable assignment and noweb
11432 expansion during tangling
11433 * comments:: Toggle insertion of comments in tangled
11434 code files
11435 * session:: Preserve the state of code evaluation
11436 * noweb:: Toggle expansion of noweb references
11437 * cache:: Avoid re-evaluating unchanged code blocks
11438 * hlines:: Handle horizontal lines in tables
11439 * colnames:: Handle column names in tables
11440 * rownames:: Handle row names in tables
11441 * shebang:: Make tangled files executable
11442 * eval:: Limit evaluation of specific code blocks
11443 @end menu
11444
11445 @node var, results, Specific header arguments, Specific header arguments
11446 @subsubsection @code{:var}
11447 The @code{:var} header argument is used to pass arguments to code blocks.
11448 The specifics of how arguments are included in a code block vary by language;
11449 these are addressed in the language-specific documentation. However, the
11450 syntax used to specify arguments is the same across all languages. The
11451 values passed to arguments can be literal values, values from org-mode tables
11452 and literal example blocks, or the results of other code blocks.
11453
11454 These values can be indexed in a manner similar to arrays---see the
11455 ``indexable variable values'' heading below.
11456
11457 The following syntax is used to pass arguments to code blocks using the
11458 @code{:var} header argument.
11459
11460 @example
11461 :var name=assign
11462 @end example
11463
11464 where @code{assign} can take one of the following forms
11465
11466 @itemize @bullet
11467 @item literal value
11468 either a string @code{"string"} or a number @code{9}.
11469 @item reference
11470 a table name:
11471
11472 @example
11473 #+tblname: example-table
11474 | 1 |
11475 | 2 |
11476 | 3 |
11477 | 4 |
11478
11479 #+source: table-length
11480 #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var table=example-table
11481 (length table)
11482 #+end_src
11483
11484 #+results: table-length
11485 : 4
11486 @end example
11487
11488 a code block name, as assigned by @code{#+srcname:}, followed by
11489 parentheses:
11490
11491 @example
11492 #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var length=table-length()
11493 (* 2 length)
11494 #+end_src
11495
11496 #+results:
11497 : 8
11498 @end example
11499
11500 In addition, an argument can be passed to the code block referenced
11501 by @code{:var}. The argument is passed within the parentheses following the
11502 code block name:
11503
11504 @example
11505 #+source: double
11506 #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var input=8
11507 (* 2 input)
11508 #+end_src
11509
11510 #+results: double
11511 : 16
11512
11513 #+source: squared
11514 #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var input=double(input=1)
11515 (* input input)
11516 #+end_src
11517
11518 #+results: squared
11519 : 4
11520 @end example
11521 @end itemize
11522
11523 @subsubheading Alternate argument syntax
11524 It is also possible to specify arguments in a potentially more natural way
11525 using the @code{#+source:} line of a code block. As in the following
11526 example arguments can be packed inside of parenthesis, separated by commas,
11527 following the source name.
11528
11529 @example
11530 #+source: double(input=0, x=2)
11531 #+begin_src emacs-lisp
11532 (* 2 (+ input x))
11533 #+end_src
11534 @end example
11535
11536 @subsubheading Indexable variable values
11537 It is possible to reference portions of variable values by ``indexing'' into
11538 the variables. Indexes are 0 based with negative values counting back from
11539 the end. If an index is separated by @code{,}s then each subsequent section
11540 will index into the next deepest nesting or dimension of the value. The
11541 following example assigns the last cell of the first row the table
11542 @code{example-table} to the variable @code{data}:
11543
11544 @example
11545 #+results: example-table
11546 | 1 | a |
11547 | 2 | b |
11548 | 3 | c |
11549 | 4 | d |
11550
11551 #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[0,-1]
11552 data
11553 #+end_src
11554
11555 #+results:
11556 : a
11557 @end example
11558
11559 Ranges of variable values can be referenced using two integers separated by a
11560 @code{:}, in which case the entire inclusive range is referenced. For
11561 example the following assigns the middle three rows of @code{example-table}
11562 to @code{data}.
11563
11564 @example
11565 #+results: example-table
11566 | 1 | a |
11567 | 2 | b |
11568 | 3 | c |
11569 | 4 | d |
11570 | 5 | 3 |
11571
11572 #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[1:3]
11573 data
11574 #+end_src
11575
11576 #+results:
11577 | 2 | b |
11578 | 3 | c |
11579 | 4 | d |
11580 @end example
11581
11582 Additionally, an empty index, or the single character @code{*}, are both
11583 interpreted to mean the entire range and as such are equivalent to
11584 @code{0:-1}, as shown in the following example in which the entire first
11585 column is referenced.
11586
11587 @example
11588 #+results: example-table
11589 | 1 | a |
11590 | 2 | b |
11591 | 3 | c |
11592 | 4 | d |
11593
11594 #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[,0]
11595 data
11596 #+end_src
11597
11598 #+results:
11599 | 1 | 2 | 3 | 4 |
11600 @end example
11601
11602 It is possible to index into the results of code blocks as well as tables.
11603 Any number of dimensions can be indexed. Dimensions are separated from one
11604 another by commas, as shown in the following example.
11605
11606 @example
11607 #+source: 3D
11608 #+begin_src emacs-lisp
11609 '(((1 2 3) (4 5 6) (7 8 9))
11610 ((10 11 12) (13 14 15) (16 17 18))
11611 ((19 20 21) (22 23 24) (25 26 27)))
11612 #+end_src
11613
11614 #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var data=3D[1,,1]
11615 data
11616 #+end_src
11617
11618 #+results:
11619 | 11 | 14 | 17 |
11620 @end example
11621
11622 @node results, file, var, Specific header arguments
11623 @subsubsection @code{:results}
11624
11625 There are three classes of @code{:results} header argument. Only one option of
11626 each type may be supplied per code block.
11627
11628 @itemize @bullet
11629 @item
11630 @b{collection} header arguments specify how the results should be collected
11631 from the code block
11632 @item
11633 @b{type} header arguments specify what type of result the code block will
11634 return---which has implications for how they will be inserted into the
11635 Org-mode buffer
11636 @item
11637 @b{handling} header arguments specify how the results of evaluating the code
11638 block should be handled.
11639 @end itemize
11640
11641 @subsubheading Collection
11642 The following options are mutually exclusive, and specify how the results
11643 should be collected from the code block.
11644
11645 @itemize @bullet
11646 @item @code{value}
11647 This is the default. The result is the value of the last statement in the
11648 code block. This header argument places the evaluation in functional
11649 mode. Note that in some languages, e.g., python, use of this result type
11650 requires that a @code{return} statement be included in the body of the source
11651 code block. E.g., @code{:results value}.
11652 @item @code{output}
11653 The result is the collection of everything printed to STDOUT during the
11654 execution of the code block. This header argument places the
11655 evaluation in scripting mode. E.g., @code{:results output}.
11656 @end itemize
11657
11658 @subsubheading Type
11659
11660 The following options are mutually exclusive and specify what type of results
11661 the code block will return. By default, results are inserted as either a
11662 table or scalar depending on their value.
11663
11664 @itemize @bullet
11665 @item @code{table}, @code{vector}
11666 The results should be interpreted as an Org-mode table. If a single value is
11667 returned, it will be converted into a table with one row and one column.
11668 E.g., @code{:results value table}.
11669 @item @code{scalar}, @code{verbatim}
11670 The results should be interpreted literally---they will not be
11671 converted into a table. The results will be inserted into the Org-mode
11672 buffer as quoted text. E.g., @code{:results value verbatim}.
11673 @item @code{file}
11674 The results will be interpreted as the path to a file, and will be inserted
11675 into the Org-mode buffer as a file link. E.g., @code{:results value file}.
11676 @item @code{raw}, @code{org}
11677 The results are interpreted as raw Org-mode code and are inserted directly
11678 into the buffer. If the results look like a table they will be aligned as
11679 such by Org-mode. E.g., @code{:results value raw}.
11680 @item @code{html}
11681 Results are assumed to be HTML and will be enclosed in a @code{begin_html}
11682 block. E.g., @code{:results value html}.
11683 @item @code{latex}
11684 Results assumed to be LaTeX and are enclosed in a @code{begin_latex} block.
11685 E.g., @code{:results value latex}.
11686 @item @code{code}
11687 Result are assumed to be parseable code and are enclosed in a code block.
11688 E.g., @code{:results value code}.
11689 @item @code{pp}
11690 The result is converted to pretty-printed code and is enclosed in a code
11691 block. This option currently supports Emacs Lisp, python, and ruby. E.g.,
11692 @code{:results value pp}.
11693 @end itemize
11694
11695 @subsubheading Handling
11696 The following results options indicate what happens with the
11697 results once they are collected.
11698
11699 @itemize @bullet
11700 @item @code{silent}
11701 The results will be echoed in the minibuffer but will not be inserted into
11702 the Org-mode buffer. E.g., @code{:results output silent}.
11703 @item @code{replace}
11704 The default value. Any existing results will be removed, and the new results
11705 will be inserted into the Org-mode buffer in their place. E.g.,
11706 @code{:results output replace}.
11707 @item @code{append}
11708 If there are pre-existing results of the code block then the new results will
11709 be appended to the existing results. Otherwise the new results will be
11710 inserted as with @code{replace}.
11711 @item @code{prepend}
11712 If there are pre-existing results of the code block then the new results will
11713 be prepended to the existing results. Otherwise the new results will be
11714 inserted as with @code{replace}.
11715 @end itemize
11716
11717 @node file, dir, results, Specific header arguments
11718 @subsubsection @code{:file}
11719
11720 The header argument @code{:file} is used to specify a path for file output.
11721 An Org-mode style @code{file:} link is inserted into the buffer as the result
11722 (see @ref{Link format}). Common examples are graphical output from R,
11723 gnuplot, ditaa and LaTeX code blocks.
11724
11725 Note that for some languages, including R, gnuplot, LaTeX and ditaa,
11726 graphical output is sent to the specified file without the file being
11727 referenced explicitly in the code block. See the documentation for the
11728 individual languages for details. In contrast, general purpose languages such
11729 as python and ruby require that the code explicitly create output
11730 corresponding to the path indicated by @code{:file}.
11731
11732
11733 @node dir, exports, file, Specific header arguments
11734 @subsubsection @code{:dir} and remote execution
11735
11736 While the @code{:file} header argument can be used to specify the path to the
11737 output file, @code{:dir} specifies the default directory during code block
11738 execution. If it is absent, then the directory associated with the current
11739 buffer is used. In other words, supplying @code{:dir path} temporarily has
11740 the same effect as changing the current directory with @kbd{M-x cd path}, and
11741 then not supplying @code{:dir}. Under the surface, @code{:dir} simply sets
11742 the value of the Emacs variable @code{default-directory}.
11743
11744 When using @code{:dir}, you should supply a relative path for file output
11745 (e.g. @code{:file myfile.jpg} or @code{:file results/myfile.jpg}) in which
11746 case that path will be interpreted relative to the default directory.
11747
11748 In other words, if you want your plot to go into a folder called Work in your
11749 home directory, you could use
11750
11751 @example
11752 #+begin_src R :file myplot.png :dir ~/Work
11753 matplot(matrix(rnorm(100), 10), type="l")
11754 #+end_src
11755 @end example
11756
11757 @subsubheading Remote execution
11758 A directory on a remote machine can be specified using tramp file syntax, in
11759 which case the code will be evaluated on the remote machine. An example is
11760
11761 @example
11762 #+begin_src R :file plot.png :dir /dand@@yakuba.princeton.edu:
11763 plot(1:10, main=system("hostname", intern=TRUE))
11764 #+end_src
11765 @end example
11766
11767 Text results will be returned to the local Org-mode buffer as usual, and file
11768 output will be created on the remote machine with relative paths interpreted
11769 relative to the remote directory. An Org-mode link to the remote file will be
11770 created.
11771
11772 So, in the above example a plot will be created on the remote machine,
11773 and a link of the following form will be inserted in the org buffer:
11774
11775 @example
11776 [[file:/scp:dand@@yakuba.princeton.edu:/home/dand/plot.png][plot.png]]
11777 @end example
11778
11779 Most of this functionality follows immediately from the fact that @code{:dir}
11780 sets the value of the Emacs variable @code{default-directory}, thanks to
11781 tramp. Those using XEmacs, or GNU Emacs prior to version 23 may need to
11782 install tramp separately in order for the these features to work correctly.
11783
11784 @subsubheading Further points
11785
11786 @itemize @bullet
11787 @item
11788 If @code{:dir} is used in conjunction with @code{:session}, although it will
11789 determine the starting directory for a new session as expected, no attempt is
11790 currently made to alter the directory associated with an existing session.
11791 @item
11792 @code{:dir} should typically not be used to create files during export with
11793 @code{:exports results} or @code{:exports both}. The reason is that, in order
11794 to retain portability of exported material between machines, during export
11795 links inserted into the buffer will *not* be expanded against @code{default
11796 directory}. Therefore, if @code{default-directory} is altered using
11797 @code{:dir}, it is probable that the file will be created in a location to
11798 which the link does not point.
11799 @end itemize
11800
11801 @node exports, tangle, dir, Specific header arguments
11802 @subsubsection @code{:exports}
11803
11804 The @code{:exports} header argument specifies what should be included in HTML
11805 or LaTeX exports of the Org-mode file.
11806
11807 @itemize @bullet
11808 @item @code{code}
11809 The default. The body of code is included into the exported file. E.g.,
11810 @code{:exports code}.
11811 @item @code{results}
11812 The result of evaluating the code is included in the exported file. E.g.,
11813 @code{:exports results}.
11814 @item @code{both}
11815 Both the code and results are included in the exported file. E.g.,
11816 @code{:exports both}.
11817 @item @code{none}
11818 Nothing is included in the exported file. E.g., @code{:exports none}.
11819 @end itemize
11820
11821 @node tangle, comments, exports, Specific header arguments
11822 @subsubsection @code{:tangle}
11823
11824 The @code{:tangle} header argument specifies whether or not the code
11825 block should be included in tangled extraction of source code files.
11826
11827 @itemize @bullet
11828 @item @code{yes}
11829 The code block is exported to a source code file named after the
11830 basename (name w/o extension) of the Org-mode file. E.g., @code{:tangle
11831 yes}.
11832 @item @code{no}
11833 The default. The code block is not exported to a source code file.
11834 E.g., @code{:tangle no}.
11835 @item other
11836 Any other string passed to the @code{:tangle} header argument is interpreted
11837 as a file basename to which the block will be exported. E.g., @code{:tangle
11838 basename}.
11839 @end itemize
11840
11841 @node comments, no-expand, tangle, Specific header arguments
11842 @subsubsection @code{:comments}
11843 By default code blocks are tangled to source-code files without any insertion
11844 of comments beyond those which may already exist in the body of the code
11845 block. The @code{:comments} header argument can be set to ``yes''
11846 e.g. @code{:comments yes} to enable the insertion of comments around code
11847 blocks during tangling. The inserted comments contain pointers back to the
11848 original Org file from which the comment was tangled.
11849
11850 @node no-expand, session, comments, Specific header arguments
11851 @subsubsection @code{:no-expand}
11852
11853 By default, code blocks are expanded with @code{org-babel-expand-src-block}
11854 during tangling. This has the effect of assigning values to variables
11855 specified with @code{:var} (see @ref{var}), and of replacing ``noweb''
11856 references (see @ref{Noweb reference syntax}) with their targets. The
11857 @code{:no-expand} header argument can be used to turn off this behavior.
11858
11859 @node session, noweb, no-expand, Specific header arguments
11860 @subsubsection @code{:session}
11861
11862 The @code{:session} header argument starts a session for an interpreted
11863 language where state is preserved.
11864
11865 By default, a session is not started.
11866
11867 A string passed to the @code{:session} header argument will give the session
11868 a name. This makes it possible to run concurrent sessions for each
11869 interpreted language.
11870
11871 @node noweb, cache, session, Specific header arguments
11872 @subsubsection @code{:noweb}
11873
11874 The @code{:noweb} header argument controls expansion of ``noweb'' style (see
11875 @ref{Noweb reference syntax}) references in a code block. This header
11876 argument can have one of two values: @code{yes} or @code{no}.
11877
11878 @itemize @bullet
11879 @item @code{no}
11880 The default. No ``noweb'' syntax specific action is taken on evaluating
11881 code blocks, However, noweb references will still be expanded during
11882 tangling.
11883 @item @code{yes}
11884 All ``noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will be
11885 expanded before the block is evaluated.
11886 @end itemize
11887
11888 @subsubheading Noweb prefix lines
11889 Noweb insertions are now placed behind the line prefix of the
11890 @code{<<reference>>}.
11891 This behavior is illustrated in the following example. Because the
11892 @code{<<example>>} noweb reference appears behind the SQL comment syntax,
11893 each line of the expanded noweb reference will be commented.
11894
11895 This code block:
11896
11897 @example
11898 -- <<example>>
11899 @end example
11900
11901
11902 expands to:
11903
11904 @example
11905 -- this is the
11906 -- multi-line body of example
11907 @end example
11908
11909 Note that noweb replacement text that does not contain any newlines will not
11910 be affected by this change, so it is still possible to use inline noweb
11911 references.
11912
11913 @node cache, hlines, noweb, Specific header arguments
11914 @subsubsection @code{:cache}
11915
11916 The @code{:cache} header argument controls the use of in-buffer caching of
11917 the results of evaluating code blocks. It can be used to avoid re-evaluating
11918 unchanged code blocks. This header argument can have one of two
11919 values: @code{yes} or @code{no}.
11920
11921 @itemize @bullet
11922 @item @code{no}
11923 The default. No caching takes place, and the code block will be evaluated
11924 every time it is called.
11925 @item @code{yes}
11926 Every time the code block is run a sha1 hash of the code and arguments
11927 passed to the block will be generated. This hash is packed into the
11928 @code{#+results:} line and will be checked on subsequent
11929 executions of the code block. If the code block has not
11930 changed since the last time it was evaluated, it will not be re-evaluated.
11931 @end itemize
11932
11933 @node hlines, colnames, cache, Specific header arguments
11934 @subsubsection @code{:hlines}
11935
11936 Tables are frequently represented with one or more horizontal lines, or
11937 hlines. The @code{:hlines} argument to a code block accepts the
11938 values @code{yes} or @code{no}, with a default value of @code{no}.
11939
11940 @itemize @bullet
11941 @item @code{no}
11942 Strips horizontal lines from the input table. In most languages this is the
11943 desired effect because an @code{hline} symbol is interpreted as an unbound
11944 variable and raises an error. Setting @code{:hlines no} or relying on the
11945 default value yields the following results.
11946
11947 @example
11948 #+tblname: many-cols
11949 | a | b | c |
11950 |---+---+---|
11951 | d | e | f |
11952 |---+---+---|
11953 | g | h | i |
11954
11955 #+source: echo-table
11956 #+begin_src python :var tab=many-cols
11957 return tab
11958 #+end_src
11959
11960 #+results: echo-table
11961 | a | b | c |
11962 | d | e | f |
11963 | g | h | i |
11964 @end example
11965
11966 @item @code{yes}
11967 Leaves hlines in the table. Setting @code{:hlines yes} has this effect.
11968
11969 @example
11970 #+tblname: many-cols
11971 | a | b | c |
11972 |---+---+---|
11973 | d | e | f |
11974 |---+---+---|
11975 | g | h | i |
11976
11977 #+source: echo-table
11978 #+begin_src python :var tab=many-cols :hlines yes
11979 return tab
11980 #+end_src
11981
11982 #+results: echo-table
11983 | a | b | c |
11984 |---+---+---|
11985 | d | e | f |
11986 |---+---+---|
11987 | g | h | i |
11988 @end example
11989 @end itemize
11990
11991 @node colnames, rownames, hlines, Specific header arguments
11992 @subsubsection @code{:colnames}
11993
11994 The @code{:colnames} header argument accepts the values @code{yes},
11995 @code{no}, or @code{nil} for unassigned. The default value is @code{nil}.
11996
11997 @itemize @bullet
11998 @item @code{nil}
11999 If an input table looks like it has column names
12000 (because its second row is an hline), then the column
12001 names will be removed from the table before
12002 processing, then reapplied to the results.
12003
12004 @example
12005 #+tblname: less-cols
12006 | a |
12007 |---|
12008 | b |
12009 | c |
12010
12011 #+srcname: echo-table-again
12012 #+begin_src python :var tab=less-cols
12013 return [[val + '*' for val in row] for row in tab]
12014 #+end_src
12015
12016 #+results: echo-table-again
12017 | a |
12018 |----|
12019 | b* |
12020 | c* |
12021 @end example
12022
12023 @item @code{no}
12024 No column name pre-processing takes place
12025
12026 @item @code{yes}
12027 Column names are removed and reapplied as with @code{nil} even if the table
12028 does not ``look like'' it has column names (i.e. the second row is not an
12029 hline)
12030 @end itemize
12031
12032 @node rownames, shebang, colnames, Specific header arguments
12033 @subsubsection @code{:rownames}
12034
12035 The @code{:rownames} header argument can take on the values @code{yes}
12036 or @code{no}, with a default value of @code{no}.
12037
12038 @itemize @bullet
12039 @item @code{no}
12040 No row name pre-processing will take place.
12041
12042 @item @code{yes}
12043 The first column of the table is removed from the table before processing,
12044 and is then reapplied to the results.
12045
12046 @example
12047 #+tblname: with-rownames
12048 | one | 1 | 2 | 3 | 4 | 5 |
12049 | two | 6 | 7 | 8 | 9 | 10 |
12050
12051 #+srcname: echo-table-once-again
12052 #+begin_src python :var tab=with-rownames :rownames yes
12053 return [[val + 10 for val in row] for row in tab]
12054 #+end_src
12055
12056 #+results: echo-table-once-again
12057 | one | 11 | 12 | 13 | 14 | 15 |
12058 | two | 16 | 17 | 18 | 19 | 20 |
12059 @end example
12060 @end itemize
12061
12062 @node shebang, eval, rownames, Specific header arguments
12063 @subsubsection @code{:shebang}
12064
12065 Setting the @code{:shebang} header argument to a string value
12066 (e.g. @code{:shebang "#!/bin/bash"}) causes the string to be inserted as the
12067 first line of any tangled file holding the code block, and the file
12068 permissions of the tangled file are set to make it executable.
12069
12070 @node eval, , shebang, Specific header arguments
12071 @subsubsection @code{:eval}
12072 The @code{:eval} header argument can be used to limit the evaluation of
12073 specific code blocks. @code{:eval} accepts two arguments ``never'' and
12074 ``query''. @code{:eval never} will ensure that a code block is never
12075 evaluated, this can be useful for protecting against the evaluation of
12076 dangerous code blocks. @code{:eval query} will require a query for every
12077 execution of a code block regardless of the value of the
12078 @code{org-confirm-babel-evaluate} variable.
12079
12080 @node Results of evaluation, Noweb reference syntax, Header arguments, Working With Source Code
12081 @section Results of evaluation
12082 @cindex code block, results of evaluation
12083 @cindex source code, results of evaluation
12084
12085 The way in which results are handled depends on whether a session is invoked,
12086 as well as on whether @code{:results value} or @code{:results output} is
12087 used. The following table shows the possibilities:
12088
12089 @multitable @columnfractions 0.26 0.33 0.41
12090 @item @tab @b{Non-session} @tab @b{Session}
12091 @item @code{:results value} @tab value of last expression @tab value of last expression
12092 @item @code{:results output} @tab contents of STDOUT @tab concatenation of interpreter output
12093 @end multitable
12094
12095 Note: With @code{:results value}, the result in both @code{:session} and
12096 non-session is returned to Org-mode as a table (a one- or two-dimensional
12097 vector of strings or numbers) when appropriate.
12098
12099 @subsection Non-session
12100 @subsubsection @code{:results value}
12101 This is the default. Internally, the value is obtained by wrapping the code
12102 in a function definition in the external language, and evaluating that
12103 function. Therefore, code should be written as if it were the body of such a
12104 function. In particular, note that python does not automatically return a
12105 value from a function unless a @code{return} statement is present, and so a
12106 @samp{return} statement will usually be required in python.
12107
12108 This is the only one of the four evaluation contexts in which the code is
12109 automatically wrapped in a function definition.
12110
12111 @subsubsection @code{:results output}
12112 The code is passed to the interpreter as an external process, and the
12113 contents of the standard output stream are returned as text. (In certain
12114 languages this also contains the error output stream; this is an area for
12115 future work.)
12116
12117 @subsection @code{:session}
12118 @subsubsection @code{:results value}
12119 The code is passed to the interpreter running as an interactive Emacs
12120 inferior process. The result returned is the result of the last evaluation
12121 performed by the interpreter. (This is obtained in a language-specific
12122 manner: the value of the variable @code{_} in python and ruby, and the value
12123 of @code{.Last.value} in R).
12124
12125 @subsubsection @code{:results output}
12126 The code is passed to the interpreter running as an interactive Emacs
12127 inferior process. The result returned is the concatenation of the sequence of
12128 (text) output from the interactive interpreter. Notice that this is not
12129 necessarily the same as what would be sent to @code{STDOUT} if the same code
12130 were passed to a non-interactive interpreter running as an external
12131 process. For example, compare the following two blocks:
12132
12133 @example
12134 #+begin_src python :results output
12135 print "hello"
12136 2
12137 print "bye"
12138 #+end_src
12139
12140 #+resname:
12141 : hello
12142 : bye
12143 @end example
12144
12145 In non-session mode, the '2' is not printed and does not appear.
12146 @example
12147 #+begin_src python :results output :session
12148 print "hello"
12149 2
12150 print "bye"
12151 #+end_src
12152
12153 #+resname:
12154 : hello
12155 : 2
12156 : bye
12157 @end example
12158
12159 But in @code{:session} mode, the interactive interpreter receives input '2'
12160 and prints out its value, '2'. (Indeed, the other print statements are
12161 unnecessary here).
12162
12163 @node Noweb reference syntax, Key bindings and useful functions, Results of evaluation, Working With Source Code
12164 @section Noweb reference syntax
12165 @cindex code block, noweb reference
12166 @cindex syntax, noweb
12167 @cindex source code, noweb reference
12168
12169 The ``noweb'' (see @uref{http://www.cs.tufts.edu/~nr/noweb/}) Literate
12170 Programming system allows named blocks of code to be referenced by using the
12171 familiar Noweb syntax:
12172
12173 @example
12174 <<code-block-name>>
12175 @end example
12176
12177 When a code block is tangled or evaluated, whether or not ``noweb''
12178 references are expanded depends upon the value of the @code{:noweb} header
12179 argument. If @code{:noweb yes}, then a Noweb reference is expanded before
12180 evaluation. If @code{:noweb no}, the default, then the reference is not
12181 expanded before evaluation.
12182
12183 Note: the default value, @code{:noweb no}, was chosen to ensure that
12184 correct code is not broken in a language, such as Ruby, where
12185 @code{<<arg>>} is a syntactically valid construct. If @code{<<arg>>} is not
12186 syntactically valid in languages that you use, then please consider setting
12187 the default value.
12188
12189 @node Key bindings and useful functions, Batch execution, Noweb reference syntax, Working With Source Code
12190 @section Key bindings and useful functions
12191 @cindex code block, key bindings
12192
12193 Many common Org-mode key sequences are re-bound depending on
12194 the context.
12195
12196 Within a code block, the following key bindings
12197 are active:
12198
12199 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
12200 @kindex C-c C-c
12201 @item @kbd{C-c C-c} @tab org-babel-execute-src-block
12202 @kindex C-c C-o
12203 @item @kbd{C-c C-o} @tab org-babel-open-src-block-result
12204 @kindex C-up
12205 @item @kbd{C-@key{up}} @tab org-babel-load-in-session
12206 @kindex M-down
12207 @item @kbd{M-@key{down}} @tab org-babel-pop-to-session
12208 @end multitable
12209
12210 In an Org-mode buffer, the following key bindings are active:
12211
12212 @multitable @columnfractions 0.45 0.55
12213 @kindex C-c C-v a
12214 @kindex C-c C-v C-a
12215 @item @kbd{C-c C-v a} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-a} @tab org-babel-sha1-hash
12216 @kindex C-c C-v b
12217 @kindex C-c C-v C-b
12218 @item @kbd{C-c C-v b} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-b} @tab org-babel-execute-buffer
12219 @kindex C-c C-v f
12220 @kindex C-c C-v C-f
12221 @item @kbd{C-c C-v f} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-f} @tab org-babel-tangle-file
12222 @kindex C-c C-v g
12223 @item @kbd{C-c C-v g} @tab org-babel-goto-named-source-block
12224 @kindex C-c C-v h
12225 @item @kbd{C-c C-v h} @tab org-babel-describe-bindings
12226 @kindex C-c C-v l
12227 @kindex C-c C-v C-l
12228 @item @kbd{C-c C-v l} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-l} @tab org-babel-lob-ingest
12229 @kindex C-c C-v p
12230 @kindex C-c C-v C-p
12231 @item @kbd{C-c C-v p} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-p} @tab org-babel-expand-src-block
12232 @kindex C-c C-v s
12233 @kindex C-c C-v C-s
12234 @item @kbd{C-c C-v s} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-s} @tab org-babel-execute-subtree
12235 @kindex C-c C-v t
12236 @kindex C-c C-v C-t
12237 @item @kbd{C-c C-v t} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-t} @tab org-babel-tangle
12238 @kindex C-c C-v z
12239 @kindex C-c C-v C-z
12240 @item @kbd{C-c C-v z} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-z} @tab org-babel-switch-to-session
12241 @end multitable
12242
12243 @c When possible these keybindings were extended to work when the control key is
12244 @c kept pressed, resulting in the following additional keybindings.
12245
12246 @c @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
12247 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-a} @tab org-babel-sha1-hash
12248 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-b} @tab org-babel-execute-buffer
12249 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-f} @tab org-babel-tangle-file
12250 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-l} @tab org-babel-lob-ingest
12251 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-p} @tab org-babel-expand-src-block
12252 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-s} @tab org-babel-execute-subtree
12253 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-t} @tab org-babel-tangle
12254 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-z} @tab org-babel-switch-to-session
12255 @c @end multitable
12256
12257 @node Batch execution, , Key bindings and useful functions, Working With Source Code
12258 @section Batch execution
12259 @cindex code block, batch execution
12260 @cindex source code, batch execution
12261
12262 It is possible to call functions from the command line. This shell
12263 script calls @code{org-babel-tangle} on every one of its arguments.
12264
12265 Be sure to adjust the paths to fit your system.
12266
12267 @example
12268 #!/bin/sh
12269 # -*- mode: shell-script -*-
12270 #
12271 # tangle a file with org-mode
12272 #
12273 DIR=`pwd`
12274 FILES=""
12275
12276 # wrap each argument in the code required to call tangle on it
12277 for i in $@@; do
12278 FILES="$FILES \"$i\""
12279 done
12280
12281 emacsclient \
12282 --eval "(progn
12283 (add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name \"~/src/org/lisp/\"))
12284 (add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name \"~/src/org/contrib/lisp/\"))
12285 (require 'org)(require 'org-exp)(require 'ob)(require 'ob-tangle)
12286 (mapc (lambda (file)
12287 (find-file (expand-file-name file \"$DIR\"))
12288 (org-babel-tangle)
12289 (kill-buffer)) '($FILES)))"
12290 @end example
12291
12292 @node Miscellaneous, Hacking, Working With Source Code, Top
12293 @chapter Miscellaneous
12294
12295 @menu
12296 * Completion:: M-TAB knows what you need
12297 * Speed keys:: Electric commands at the beginning of a headline
12298 * Code evaluation security:: Org mode files evaluate inline code
12299 * Customization:: Adapting Org to your taste
12300 * In-buffer settings:: Overview of the #+KEYWORDS
12301 * The very busy C-c C-c key:: When in doubt, press C-c C-c
12302 * Clean view:: Getting rid of leading stars in the outline
12303 * TTY keys:: Using Org on a tty
12304 * Interaction:: Other Emacs packages
12305 @end menu
12306
12307
12308 @node Completion, Speed keys, Miscellaneous, Miscellaneous
12309 @section Completion
12310 @cindex completion, of @TeX{} symbols
12311 @cindex completion, of TODO keywords
12312 @cindex completion, of dictionary words
12313 @cindex completion, of option keywords
12314 @cindex completion, of tags
12315 @cindex completion, of property keys
12316 @cindex completion, of link abbreviations
12317 @cindex @TeX{} symbol completion
12318 @cindex TODO keywords completion
12319 @cindex dictionary word completion
12320 @cindex option keyword completion
12321 @cindex tag completion
12322 @cindex link abbreviations, completion of
12323
12324 Emacs would not be Emacs without completion, and Org-mode uses it whenever it
12325 makes sense. If you prefer an @i{iswitchb}- or @i{ido}-like interface for
12326 some of the completion prompts, you can specify your preference by setting at
12327 most one of the variables @code{org-completion-use-iswitchb}
12328 @code{org-completion-use-ido}.
12329
12330 Org supports in-buffer completion. This type of completion does
12331 not make use of the minibuffer. You simply type a few letters into
12332 the buffer and use the key to complete text right there.
12333
12334 @table @kbd
12335 @kindex M-@key{TAB}
12336 @item M-@key{TAB}
12337 Complete word at point
12338 @itemize @bullet
12339 @item
12340 At the beginning of a headline, complete TODO keywords.
12341 @item
12342 After @samp{\}, complete @TeX{} symbols supported by the exporter.
12343 @item
12344 After @samp{*}, complete headlines in the current buffer so that they
12345 can be used in search links like @samp{[[*find this headline]]}.
12346 @item
12347 After @samp{:} in a headline, complete tags. The list of tags is taken
12348 from the variable @code{org-tag-alist} (possibly set through the
12349 @samp{#+TAGS} in-buffer option, @pxref{Setting tags}), or it is created
12350 dynamically from all tags used in the current buffer.
12351 @item
12352 After @samp{:} and not in a headline, complete property keys. The list
12353 of keys is constructed dynamically from all keys used in the current
12354 buffer.
12355 @item
12356 After @samp{[}, complete link abbreviations (@pxref{Link abbreviations}).
12357 @item
12358 After @samp{#+}, complete the special keywords like @samp{TYP_TODO} or
12359 @samp{OPTIONS} which set file-specific options for Org-mode. When the
12360 option keyword is already complete, pressing @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} again
12361 will insert example settings for this keyword.
12362 @item
12363 In the line after @samp{#+STARTUP: }, complete startup keywords,
12364 i.e. valid keys for this line.
12365 @item
12366 Elsewhere, complete dictionary words using Ispell.
12367 @end itemize
12368 @end table
12369
12370 @node Speed keys, Code evaluation security, Completion, Miscellaneous
12371 @section Speed keys
12372 @cindex speed keys
12373 @vindex org-use-speed-commands
12374 @vindex org-speed-commands-user
12375
12376 Single keys can be made to execute commands when the cursor is at the
12377 beginning of a headline, i.e. before the first star. Configure the variable
12378 @code{org-use-speed-commands} to activate this feature. There is a
12379 pre-defined list of commands, and you can add more such commands using the
12380 variable @code{org-speed-commands-user}. Speed keys do not only speed up
12381 navigation and other commands, but they also provide an alternative way to
12382 execute commands bound to keys that are not or not easily available on a tty,
12383 or on a small mobile device with a limited keyboard.
12384
12385 To see which commands are available, activate the feature and press @kbd{?}
12386 with the cursor at the beginning of a headline.
12387
12388 @node Code evaluation security, Customization, Speed keys, Miscellaneous
12389 @section Code evaluation and security issues
12390
12391 Org provides tool to work with the code snippets, including evaluating them.
12392
12393 Running code on your machine always comes with a security risk. Badly
12394 written or malicious code can be executed on purpose or by accident. Org has
12395 default settings which will only evaluate such code if you give explicit
12396 permission to do so, and as a casual user of these features you should leave
12397 these precautions intact.
12398
12399 For people who regularly work with such code, the confirmation prompts can
12400 become annoying, and you might want to turn them off. This can be done, but
12401 you must be aware of the risks that are involved.
12402
12403 Code evaluation can happen under the following circumstances:
12404
12405 @table @i
12406 @item Source code blocks
12407 Source code blocks can be evaluated during export, or when pressing @kbd{C-c
12408 C-c} in the block. The most important thing to realize here is that Org mode
12409 files which contain code snippets are in a certain sense like executable
12410 files. So you should accept them and load them into Emacs only from trusted
12411 sources - just like you would do with a program you install on your computer.
12412
12413 Make sure you know what you are doing before customizing the variables
12414 which take of the default security brakes.
12415
12416 @defopt org-confirm-babel-evaluate
12417 When set to t user is queried before code block evaluation
12418 @end defopt
12419
12420 @item Following @code{shell} and @code{elisp} links
12421 Org has two link types that can directly evaluate code (@pxref{External
12422 links}). These links can be problematic because the code to be evaluated his
12423 not visible.
12424
12425 @defopt org-confirm-shell-link-function
12426 Function to queries user about shell link execution.
12427 @end defopt
12428 @defopt org-confirm-elisp-link-function
12429 Functions to query user for Emacs Lisp link execution.
12430 @end defopt
12431
12432 @item Following @code{shell} and @code{elisp} links
12433 Org has two link types that can directly evaluate code (@pxref{External
12434 links}). These links can be problematic because the code to be evaluated his
12435 not visible. @b{Security advice:} Do not use these links, use source code
12436 blocks which make the associated actions much more transparent.
12437
12438 @item Formulas in tables
12439 Formulas in tables (@pxref{The spreadsheet}) are code that is evaluated
12440 either by the @i{calc} interpreter, or by the @i{Emacs Lisp} interpreter.
12441 @end table
12442
12443 @node Customization, In-buffer settings, Code evaluation security, Miscellaneous
12444 @section Customization
12445 @cindex customization
12446 @cindex options, for customization
12447 @cindex variables, for customization
12448
12449 There are more than 180 variables that can be used to customize
12450 Org. For the sake of compactness of the manual, I am not
12451 describing the variables here. A structured overview of customization
12452 variables is available with @kbd{M-x org-customize}. Or select
12453 @code{Browse Org Group} from the @code{Org->Customization} menu. Many
12454 settings can also be activated on a per-file basis, by putting special
12455 lines into the buffer (@pxref{In-buffer settings}).
12456
12457 @node In-buffer settings, The very busy C-c C-c key, Customization, Miscellaneous
12458 @section Summary of in-buffer settings
12459 @cindex in-buffer settings
12460 @cindex special keywords
12461
12462 Org-mode uses special lines in the buffer to define settings on a
12463 per-file basis. These lines start with a @samp{#+} followed by a
12464 keyword, a colon, and then individual words defining a setting. Several
12465 setting words can be in the same line, but you can also have multiple
12466 lines for the keyword. While these settings are described throughout
12467 the manual, here is a summary. After changing any of those lines in the
12468 buffer, press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the line to
12469 activate the changes immediately. Otherwise they become effective only
12470 when the file is visited again in a new Emacs session.
12471
12472 @vindex org-archive-location
12473 @table @kbd
12474 @item #+ARCHIVE: %s_done::
12475 This line sets the archive location for the agenda file. It applies for
12476 all subsequent lines until the next @samp{#+ARCHIVE} line, or the end
12477 of the file. The first such line also applies to any entries before it.
12478 The corresponding variable is @code{org-archive-location}.
12479 @item #+CATEGORY:
12480 This line sets the category for the agenda file. The category applies
12481 for all subsequent lines until the next @samp{#+CATEGORY} line, or the
12482 end of the file. The first such line also applies to any entries before it.
12483 @item #+COLUMNS: %25ITEM .....
12484 @cindex property, COLUMNS
12485 Set the default format for columns view. This format applies when
12486 columns view is invoked in locations where no @code{COLUMNS} property
12487 applies.
12488 @item #+CONSTANTS: name1=value1 ...
12489 @vindex org-table-formula-constants
12490 @vindex org-table-formula
12491 Set file-local values for constants to be used in table formulas. This
12492 line set the local variable @code{org-table-formula-constants-local}.
12493 The global version of this variable is
12494 @code{org-table-formula-constants}.
12495 @item #+FILETAGS: :tag1:tag2:tag3:
12496 Set tags that can be inherited by any entry in the file, including the
12497 top-level entries.
12498 @item #+DRAWERS: NAME1 .....
12499 @vindex org-drawers
12500 Set the file-local set of drawers. The corresponding global variable is
12501 @code{org-drawers}.
12502 @item #+LINK: linkword replace
12503 @vindex org-link-abbrev-alist
12504 These lines (several are allowed) specify link abbreviations.
12505 @xref{Link abbreviations}. The corresponding variable is
12506 @code{org-link-abbrev-alist}.
12507 @item #+PRIORITIES: highest lowest default
12508 @vindex org-highest-priority
12509 @vindex org-lowest-priority
12510 @vindex org-default-priority
12511 This line sets the limits and the default for the priorities. All three
12512 must be either letters A-Z or numbers 0-9. The highest priority must
12513 have a lower ASCII number that the lowest priority.
12514 @item #+PROPERTY: Property_Name Value
12515 This line sets a default inheritance value for entries in the current
12516 buffer, most useful for specifying the allowed values of a property.
12517 @cindex #+SETUPFILE
12518 @item #+SETUPFILE: file
12519 This line defines a file that holds more in-buffer setup. Normally this is
12520 entirely ignored. Only when the buffer is parsed for option-setting lines
12521 (i.e. when starting Org-mode for a file, when pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} in a
12522 settings line, or when exporting), then the contents of this file are parsed
12523 as if they had been included in the buffer. In particular, the file can be
12524 any other Org-mode file with internal setup. You can visit the file the
12525 cursor is in the line with @kbd{C-c '}.
12526 @item #+STARTUP:
12527 @cindex #+STARTUP:
12528 This line sets options to be used at startup of Org-mode, when an
12529 Org file is being visited.
12530
12531 The first set of options deals with the initial visibility of the outline
12532 tree. The corresponding variable for global default settings is
12533 @code{org-startup-folded}, with a default value @code{t}, which means
12534 @code{overview}.
12535 @vindex org-startup-folded
12536 @cindex @code{overview}, STARTUP keyword
12537 @cindex @code{content}, STARTUP keyword
12538 @cindex @code{showall}, STARTUP keyword
12539 @cindex @code{showeverything}, STARTUP keyword
12540 @example
12541 overview @r{top-level headlines only}
12542 content @r{all headlines}
12543 showall @r{no folding of any entries}
12544 showeverything @r{show even drawer contents}
12545 @end example
12546
12547 @vindex org-startup-indented
12548 @cindex @code{indent}, STARTUP keyword
12549 @cindex @code{noindent}, STARTUP keyword
12550 Dynamic virtual indentation is controlled by the variable
12551 @code{org-startup-indented}@footnote{Emacs 23 and Org-mode 6.29 are required}
12552 @example
12553 indent @r{start with @code{org-indent-mode} turned on}
12554 noindent @r{start with @code{org-indent-mode} turned off}
12555 @end example
12556
12557 @vindex org-startup-align-all-tables
12558 Then there are options for aligning tables upon visiting a file. This
12559 is useful in files containing narrowed table columns. The corresponding
12560 variable is @code{org-startup-align-all-tables}, with a default value
12561 @code{nil}.
12562 @cindex @code{align}, STARTUP keyword
12563 @cindex @code{noalign}, STARTUP keyword
12564 @example
12565 align @r{align all tables}
12566 noalign @r{don't align tables on startup}
12567 @end example
12568 @vindex org-log-done
12569 @vindex org-log-note-clock-out
12570 @vindex org-log-repeat
12571 Logging the closing and reopening of TODO items and clock intervals can be
12572 configured using these options (see variables @code{org-log-done},
12573 @code{org-log-note-clock-out} and @code{org-log-repeat})
12574 @cindex @code{logdone}, STARTUP keyword
12575 @cindex @code{lognotedone}, STARTUP keyword
12576 @cindex @code{nologdone}, STARTUP keyword
12577 @cindex @code{lognoteclock-out}, STARTUP keyword
12578 @cindex @code{nolognoteclock-out}, STARTUP keyword
12579 @cindex @code{logrepeat}, STARTUP keyword
12580 @cindex @code{lognoterepeat}, STARTUP keyword
12581 @cindex @code{nologrepeat}, STARTUP keyword
12582 @cindex @code{logreschedule}, STARTUP keyword
12583 @cindex @code{lognotereschedule}, STARTUP keyword
12584 @cindex @code{nologreschedule}, STARTUP keyword
12585 @cindex @code{logredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
12586 @cindex @code{lognoteredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
12587 @cindex @code{nologredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
12588 @cindex @code{logrefile}, STARTUP keyword
12589 @cindex @code{lognoterefile}, STARTUP keyword
12590 @cindex @code{nologrefile}, STARTUP keyword
12591 @example
12592 logdone @r{record a timestamp when an item is marked DONE}
12593 lognotedone @r{record timestamp and a note when DONE}
12594 nologdone @r{don't record when items are marked DONE}
12595 logrepeat @r{record a time when reinstating a repeating item}
12596 lognoterepeat @r{record a note when reinstating a repeating item}
12597 nologrepeat @r{do not record when reinstating repeating item}
12598 lognoteclock-out @r{record a note when clocking out}
12599 nolognoteclock-out @r{don't record a note when clocking out}
12600 logreschedule @r{record a timestamp when scheduling time changes}
12601 lognotereschedule @r{record a note when scheduling time changes}
12602 nologreschedule @r{do not record when a scheduling date changes}
12603 logredeadline @r{record a timestamp when deadline changes}
12604 lognoteredeadline @r{record a note when deadline changes}
12605 nologredeadline @r{do not record when a deadline date changes}
12606 logrefile @r{record a timestamp when refiling}
12607 lognoterefile @r{record a note when refiling}
12608 nologrefile @r{do not record when refiling}
12609 @end example
12610 @vindex org-hide-leading-stars
12611 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
12612 Here are the options for hiding leading stars in outline headings, and for
12613 indenting outlines. The corresponding variables are
12614 @code{org-hide-leading-stars} and @code{org-odd-levels-only}, both with a
12615 default setting @code{nil} (meaning @code{showstars} and @code{oddeven}).
12616 @cindex @code{hidestars}, STARTUP keyword
12617 @cindex @code{showstars}, STARTUP keyword
12618 @cindex @code{odd}, STARTUP keyword
12619 @cindex @code{even}, STARTUP keyword
12620 @example
12621 hidestars @r{make all but one of the stars starting a headline invisible.}
12622 showstars @r{show all stars starting a headline}
12623 indent @r{virtual indentation according to outline level}
12624 noindent @r{no virtual indentation according to outline level}
12625 odd @r{allow only odd outline levels (1,3,...)}
12626 oddeven @r{allow all outline levels}
12627 @end example
12628 @vindex org-put-time-stamp-overlays
12629 @vindex org-time-stamp-overlay-formats
12630 To turn on custom format overlays over timestamps (variables
12631 @code{org-put-time-stamp-overlays} and
12632 @code{org-time-stamp-overlay-formats}), use
12633 @cindex @code{customtime}, STARTUP keyword
12634 @example
12635 customtime @r{overlay custom time format}
12636 @end example
12637 @vindex constants-unit-system
12638 The following options influence the table spreadsheet (variable
12639 @code{constants-unit-system}).
12640 @cindex @code{constcgs}, STARTUP keyword
12641 @cindex @code{constSI}, STARTUP keyword
12642 @example
12643 constcgs @r{@file{constants.el} should use the c-g-s unit system}
12644 constSI @r{@file{constants.el} should use the SI unit system}
12645 @end example
12646 @vindex org-footnote-define-inline
12647 @vindex org-footnote-auto-label
12648 @vindex org-footnote-auto-adjust
12649 To influence footnote settings, use the following keywords. The
12650 corresponding variables are @code{org-footnote-define-inline},
12651 @code{org-footnote-auto-label}, and @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.
12652 @cindex @code{fninline}, STARTUP keyword
12653 @cindex @code{nofninline}, STARTUP keyword
12654 @cindex @code{fnlocal}, STARTUP keyword
12655 @cindex @code{fnprompt}, STARTUP keyword
12656 @cindex @code{fnauto}, STARTUP keyword
12657 @cindex @code{fnconfirm}, STARTUP keyword
12658 @cindex @code{fnplain}, STARTUP keyword
12659 @cindex @code{fnadjust}, STARTUP keyword
12660 @cindex @code{nofnadjust}, STARTUP keyword
12661 @example
12662 fninline @r{define footnotes inline}
12663 fnnoinline @r{define footnotes in separate section}
12664 fnlocal @r{define footnotes near first reference, but not inline}
12665 fnprompt @r{prompt for footnote labels}
12666 fnauto @r{create [fn:1]-like labels automatically (default)}
12667 fnconfirm @r{offer automatic label for editing or confirmation}
12668 fnplain @r{create [1]-like labels automatically}
12669 fnadjust @r{automatically renumber and sort footnotes}
12670 nofnadjust @r{do not renumber and sort automatically}
12671 @end example
12672 @cindex org-hide-block-startup
12673 To hide blocks on startup, use these keywords. The corresponding variable is
12674 @code{org-hide-block-startup}.
12675 @cindex @code{hideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
12676 @cindex @code{nohideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
12677 @example
12678 hideblocks @r{Hide all begin/end blocks on startup}
12679 nohideblocks @r{Do not hide blocks on startup}
12680 @end example
12681 @cindex org-pretty-entities
12682 The the display of entities as UTF8 characters is governed by the variable
12683 @code{org-pretty-entities} and the keywords
12684 @cindex @code{entitiespretty}, STARTUP keyword
12685 @cindex @code{entitiesplain}, STARTUP keyword
12686 @example
12687 entitiespretty @r{Show entities as UTF8 characters where possible}
12688 entitiesplain @r{Leave entities plain}
12689 @end example
12690 @item #+TAGS: TAG1(c1) TAG2(c2)
12691 @vindex org-tag-alist
12692 These lines (several such lines are allowed) specify the valid tags in
12693 this file, and (potentially) the corresponding @emph{fast tag selection}
12694 keys. The corresponding variable is @code{org-tag-alist}.
12695 @item #+TBLFM:
12696 This line contains the formulas for the table directly above the line.
12697 @item #+TITLE:, #+AUTHOR:, #+EMAIL:, #+LANGUAGE:, #+TEXT:, #+DATE:,
12698 @itemx #+OPTIONS:, #+BIND:, #+XSLT:,
12699 @itemx #+DESCRIPTION:, #+KEYWORDS:,
12700 @itemx #+LATEX_HEADER:, #+STYLE:, #+LINK_UP:, #+LINK_HOME:,
12701 @itemx #+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS:, #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS:
12702 These lines provide settings for exporting files. For more details see
12703 @ref{Export options}.
12704 @item #+TODO: #+SEQ_TODO: #+TYP_TODO:
12705 @vindex org-todo-keywords
12706 These lines set the TODO keywords and their interpretation in the
12707 current file. The corresponding variable is @code{org-todo-keywords}.
12708 @end table
12709
12710 @node The very busy C-c C-c key, Clean view, In-buffer settings, Miscellaneous
12711 @section The very busy C-c C-c key
12712 @kindex C-c C-c
12713 @cindex C-c C-c, overview
12714
12715 The key @kbd{C-c C-c} has many purposes in Org, which are all
12716 mentioned scattered throughout this manual. One specific function of
12717 this key is to add @emph{tags} to a headline (@pxref{Tags}). In many
12718 other circumstances it means something like @emph{``Hey Org, look
12719 here and update according to what you see here''}. Here is a summary of
12720 what this means in different contexts.
12721
12722 @itemize @minus
12723 @item
12724 If there are highlights in the buffer from the creation of a sparse
12725 tree, or from clock display, remove these highlights.
12726 @item
12727 If the cursor is in one of the special @code{#+KEYWORD} lines, this
12728 triggers scanning the buffer for these lines and updating the
12729 information.
12730 @item
12731 If the cursor is inside a table, realign the table. This command
12732 works even if the automatic table editor has been turned off.
12733 @item
12734 If the cursor is on a @code{#+TBLFM} line, re-apply the formulas to
12735 the entire table.
12736 @item
12737 If the current buffer is a capture buffer, close the note and file it.
12738 With a prefix argument, file it, without further interaction, to the
12739 default location.
12740 @item
12741 If the cursor is on a @code{<<<target>>>}, update radio targets and
12742 corresponding links in this buffer.
12743 @item
12744 If the cursor is in a property line or at the start or end of a property
12745 drawer, offer property commands.
12746 @item
12747 If the cursor is at a footnote reference, go to the corresponding
12748 definition, and vice versa.
12749 @item
12750 If the cursor is on a statistics cookie, update it.
12751 @item
12752 If the cursor is in a plain list item with a checkbox, toggle the status
12753 of the checkbox.
12754 @item
12755 If the cursor is on a numbered item in a plain list, renumber the
12756 ordered list.
12757 @item
12758 If the cursor is on the @code{#+BEGIN} line of a dynamic block, the
12759 block is updated.
12760 @end itemize
12761
12762 @node Clean view, TTY keys, The very busy C-c C-c key, Miscellaneous
12763 @section A cleaner outline view
12764 @cindex hiding leading stars
12765 @cindex dynamic indentation
12766 @cindex odd-levels-only outlines
12767 @cindex clean outline view
12768
12769 Some people find it noisy and distracting that the Org headlines start with a
12770 potentially large number of stars, and that text below the headlines is not
12771 indented. While this is no problem when writing a @emph{book-like} document
12772 where the outline headings are really section headings, in a more
12773 @emph{list-oriented} outline, indented structure is a lot cleaner:
12774
12775 @example
12776 @group
12777 * Top level headline | * Top level headline
12778 ** Second level | * Second level
12779 *** 3rd level | * 3rd level
12780 some text | some text
12781 *** 3rd level | * 3rd level
12782 more text | more text
12783 * Another top level headline | * Another top level headline
12784 @end group
12785 @end example
12786
12787 @noindent
12788
12789 If you are using at least Emacs 23.2@footnote{Emacs 23.1 can actually crash
12790 with @code{org-indent-mode}} and version 6.29 of Org, this kind of view can
12791 be achieved dynamically at display time using @code{org-indent-mode}. In
12792 this minor mode, all lines are prefixed for display with the necessary amount
12793 of space@footnote{@code{org-indent-mode} also sets the @code{wrap-prefix}
12794 property, such that @code{visual-line-mode} (or purely setting
12795 @code{word-wrap}) wraps long lines (including headlines) correctly indented.
12796 }. Also headlines are prefixed with additional stars, so that the amount of
12797 indentation shifts by two@footnote{See the variable
12798 @code{org-indent-indentation-per-level}.} spaces per level. All headline
12799 stars but the last one are made invisible using the @code{org-hide}
12800 face@footnote{Turning on @code{org-indent-mode} sets
12801 @code{org-hide-leading-stars} to @code{t} and @code{org-adapt-indentation} to
12802 @code{nil}.} - see below under @samp{2.} for more information on how this
12803 works. You can turn on @code{org-indent-mode} for all files by customizing
12804 the variable @code{org-startup-indented}, or you can turn it on for
12805 individual files using
12806
12807 @example
12808 #+STARTUP: indent
12809 @end example
12810
12811 If you want a similar effect in earlier version of Emacs and/or Org, or if
12812 you want the indentation to be hard space characters so that the plain text
12813 file looks as similar as possible to the Emacs display, Org supports you in
12814 the following way:
12815
12816 @enumerate
12817 @item
12818 @emph{Indentation of text below headlines}@*
12819 You may indent text below each headline to make the left boundary line up
12820 with the headline, like
12821
12822 @example
12823 *** 3rd level
12824 more text, now indented
12825 @end example
12826
12827 @vindex org-adapt-indentation
12828 Org supports this with paragraph filling, line wrapping, and structure
12829 editing@footnote{See also the variable @code{org-adapt-indentation}.},
12830 preserving or adapting the indentation as appropriate.
12831
12832 @item
12833 @vindex org-hide-leading-stars
12834 @emph{Hiding leading stars}@* You can modify the display in such a way that
12835 all leading stars become invisible. To do this in a global way, configure
12836 the variable @code{org-hide-leading-stars} or change this on a per-file basis
12837 with
12838
12839 @example
12840 #+STARTUP: hidestars
12841 #+STARTUP: showstars
12842 @end example
12843
12844 With hidden stars, the tree becomes:
12845
12846 @example
12847 @group
12848 * Top level headline
12849 * Second level
12850 * 3rd level
12851 ...
12852 @end group
12853 @end example
12854
12855 @noindent
12856 @vindex org-hide @r{(face)}
12857 The leading stars are not truly replaced by whitespace, they are only
12858 fontified with the face @code{org-hide} that uses the background color as
12859 font color. If you are not using either white or black background, you may
12860 have to customize this face to get the wanted effect. Another possibility is
12861 to set this font such that the extra stars are @i{almost} invisible, for
12862 example using the color @code{grey90} on a white background.
12863
12864 @item
12865 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
12866 Things become cleaner still if you skip all the even levels and use only odd
12867 levels 1, 3, 5..., effectively adding two stars to go from one outline level
12868 to the next@footnote{When you need to specify a level for a property search
12869 or refile targets, @samp{LEVEL=2} will correspond to 3 stars, etc@.}. In this
12870 way we get the outline view shown at the beginning of this section. In order
12871 to make the structure editing and export commands handle this convention
12872 correctly, configure the variable @code{org-odd-levels-only}, or set this on
12873 a per-file basis with one of the following lines:
12874
12875 @example
12876 #+STARTUP: odd
12877 #+STARTUP: oddeven
12878 @end example
12879
12880 You can convert an Org file from single-star-per-level to the
12881 double-star-per-level convention with @kbd{M-x org-convert-to-odd-levels
12882 RET} in that file. The reverse operation is @kbd{M-x
12883 org-convert-to-oddeven-levels}.
12884 @end enumerate
12885
12886 @node TTY keys, Interaction, Clean view, Miscellaneous
12887 @section Using Org on a tty
12888 @cindex tty key bindings
12889
12890 Because Org contains a large number of commands, by default many of
12891 Org's core commands are bound to keys that are generally not
12892 accessible on a tty, such as the cursor keys (@key{left}, @key{right},
12893 @key{up}, @key{down}), @key{TAB} and @key{RET}, in particular when used
12894 together with modifiers like @key{Meta} and/or @key{Shift}. To access
12895 these commands on a tty when special keys are unavailable, the following
12896 alternative bindings can be used. The tty bindings below will likely be
12897 more cumbersome; you may find for some of the bindings below that a
12898 customized workaround suits you better. For example, changing a timestamp
12899 is really only fun with @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} keys, whereas on a
12900 tty you would rather use @kbd{C-c .} to re-insert the timestamp.
12901
12902 @multitable @columnfractions 0.15 0.2 0.1 0.2
12903 @item @b{Default} @tab @b{Alternative 1} @tab @b{Speed key} @tab @b{Alternative 2}
12904 @item @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} @tab @kbd{C-u @key{TAB}} @tab @kbd{C} @tab
12905 @item @kbd{M-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x l} @tab @kbd{l} @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{left}}
12906 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x L} @tab @kbd{L} @tab
12907 @item @kbd{M-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x r} @tab @kbd{r} @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{right}}
12908 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x R} @tab @kbd{R} @tab
12909 @item @kbd{M-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x u} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{up}}
12910 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x U} @tab @kbd{U} @tab
12911 @item @kbd{M-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x d} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{down}}
12912 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x D} @tab @kbd{D} @tab
12913 @item @kbd{S-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x c} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
12914 @item @kbd{M-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x m} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{RET}}
12915 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x M} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
12916 @item @kbd{S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{left}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
12917 @item @kbd{S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{right}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
12918 @item @kbd{S-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{up}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
12919 @item @kbd{S-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{down}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
12920 @item @kbd{C-S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x @key{left}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
12921 @item @kbd{C-S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x @key{right}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
12922 @end multitable
12923
12924
12925 @node Interaction, , TTY keys, Miscellaneous
12926 @section Interaction with other packages
12927 @cindex packages, interaction with other
12928 Org lives in the world of GNU Emacs and interacts in various ways
12929 with other code out there.
12930
12931 @menu
12932 * Cooperation:: Packages Org cooperates with
12933 * Conflicts:: Packages that lead to conflicts
12934 @end menu
12935
12936 @node Cooperation, Conflicts, Interaction, Interaction
12937 @subsection Packages that Org cooperates with
12938
12939 @table @asis
12940 @cindex @file{calc.el}
12941 @cindex Gillespie, Dave
12942 @item @file{calc.el} by Dave Gillespie
12943 Org uses the Calc package for implementing spreadsheet
12944 functionality in its tables (@pxref{The spreadsheet}). Org
12945 checks for the availability of Calc by looking for the function
12946 @code{calc-eval} which will have been autoloaded during setup if Calc has
12947 been installed properly. As of Emacs 22, Calc is part of the Emacs
12948 distribution. Another possibility for interaction between the two
12949 packages is using Calc for embedded calculations. @xref{Embedded Mode,
12950 , Embedded Mode, Calc, GNU Emacs Calc Manual}.
12951 @item @file{constants.el} by Carsten Dominik
12952 @cindex @file{constants.el}
12953 @cindex Dominik, Carsten
12954 @vindex org-table-formula-constants
12955 In a table formula (@pxref{The spreadsheet}), it is possible to use
12956 names for natural constants or units. Instead of defining your own
12957 constants in the variable @code{org-table-formula-constants}, install
12958 the @file{constants} package which defines a large number of constants
12959 and units, and lets you use unit prefixes like @samp{M} for
12960 @samp{Mega}, etc@. You will need version 2.0 of this package, available
12961 at @url{http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik/Tools}. Org checks for
12962 the function @code{constants-get}, which has to be autoloaded in your
12963 setup. See the installation instructions in the file
12964 @file{constants.el}.
12965 @item @file{cdlatex.el} by Carsten Dominik
12966 @cindex @file{cdlatex.el}
12967 @cindex Dominik, Carsten
12968 Org-mode can make use of the CDLa@TeX{} package to efficiently enter
12969 La@TeX{} fragments into Org files. See @ref{CDLaTeX mode}.
12970 @item @file{imenu.el} by Ake Stenhoff and Lars Lindberg
12971 @cindex @file{imenu.el}
12972 Imenu allows menu access to an index of items in a file. Org-mode
12973 supports Imenu---all you need to do to get the index is the following:
12974 @lisp
12975 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook
12976 (lambda () (imenu-add-to-menubar "Imenu")))
12977 @end lisp
12978 @vindex org-imenu-depth
12979 By default the index is two levels deep---you can modify the depth using
12980 the option @code{org-imenu-depth}.
12981 @item @file{remember.el} by John Wiegley
12982 @cindex @file{remember.el}
12983 @cindex Wiegley, John
12984 Org used to use this package for capture, but no longer does.
12985 @item @file{speedbar.el} by Eric M. Ludlam
12986 @cindex @file{speedbar.el}
12987 @cindex Ludlam, Eric M.
12988 Speedbar is a package that creates a special frame displaying files and
12989 index items in files. Org-mode supports Speedbar and allows you to
12990 drill into Org files directly from the Speedbar. It also allows you to
12991 restrict the scope of agenda commands to a file or a subtree by using
12992 the command @kbd{<} in the Speedbar frame.
12993 @cindex @file{table.el}
12994 @item @file{table.el} by Takaaki Ota
12995 @kindex C-c C-c
12996 @cindex table editor, @file{table.el}
12997 @cindex @file{table.el}
12998 @cindex Ota, Takaaki
12999
13000 Complex ASCII tables with automatic line wrapping, column- and row-spanning,
13001 and alignment can be created using the Emacs table package by Takaaki Ota
13002 (@uref{http://sourceforge.net/projects/table}, and also part of Emacs 22).
13003 Org-mode will recognize these tables and export them properly. Because of
13004 interference with other Org-mode functionality, you unfortunately cannot edit
13005 these tables directly in the buffer. Instead, you need to use the command
13006 @kbd{C-c '} to edit them, similar to source code snippets.
13007
13008 @table @kbd
13009 @kindex C-c '
13010 @item C-c '
13011 Edit a @file{table.el} table. Works when the cursor is in a table.el table.
13012 @c
13013 @kindex C-c ~
13014 @item C-c ~
13015 Insert a @file{table.el} table. If there is already a table at point, this
13016 command converts it between the @file{table.el} format and the Org-mode
13017 format. See the documentation string of the command
13018 @code{org-convert-table} for the restrictions under which this is
13019 possible.
13020 @end table
13021 @file{table.el} is part of Emacs since Emacs 22.
13022 @item @file{footnote.el} by Steven L. Baur
13023 @cindex @file{footnote.el}
13024 @cindex Baur, Steven L.
13025 Org-mode recognizes numerical footnotes as provided by this package.
13026 However, Org-mode also has its own footnote support (@pxref{Footnotes}),
13027 which makes using @file{footnote.el} unnecessary.
13028 @end table
13029
13030 @node Conflicts, , Cooperation, Interaction
13031 @subsection Packages that lead to conflicts with Org-mode
13032
13033 @table @asis
13034
13035 @cindex @code{shift-selection-mode}
13036 @vindex org-support-shift-select
13037 In Emacs 23, @code{shift-selection-mode} is on by default, meaning that
13038 cursor motions combined with the shift key should start or enlarge regions.
13039 This conflicts with the use of @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} commands in Org to change
13040 timestamps, TODO keywords, priorities, and item bullet types if the cursor is
13041 at such a location. By default, @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} commands outside
13042 special contexts don't do anything, but you can customize the variable
13043 @code{org-support-shift-select}. Org-mode then tries to accommodate shift
13044 selection by (i) using it outside of the special contexts where special
13045 commands apply, and by (ii) extending an existing active region even if the
13046 cursor moves across a special context.
13047
13048 @item @file{CUA.el} by Kim. F. Storm
13049 @cindex @file{CUA.el}
13050 @cindex Storm, Kim. F.
13051 @vindex org-replace-disputed-keys
13052 Key bindings in Org conflict with the @kbd{S-<cursor>} keys used by CUA mode
13053 (as well as @code{pc-select-mode} and @code{s-region-mode}) to select and extend the
13054 region. In fact, Emacs 23 has this built-in in the form of
13055 @code{shift-selection-mode}, see previous paragraph. If you are using Emacs
13056 23, you probably don't want to use another package for this purpose. However,
13057 if you prefer to leave these keys to a different package while working in
13058 Org-mode, configure the variable @code{org-replace-disputed-keys}. When set,
13059 Org will move the following key bindings in Org files, and in the agenda
13060 buffer (but not during date selection).
13061
13062 @example
13063 S-UP -> M-p S-DOWN -> M-n
13064 S-LEFT -> M-- S-RIGHT -> M-+
13065 C-S-LEFT -> M-S-- C-S-RIGHT -> M-S-+
13066 @end example
13067
13068 @vindex org-disputed-keys
13069 Yes, these are unfortunately more difficult to remember. If you want
13070 to have other replacement keys, look at the variable
13071 @code{org-disputed-keys}.
13072
13073 @item @file{yasnippet.el}
13074 @cindex @file{yasnippet.el}
13075 The way Org-mode binds the TAB key (binding to @code{[tab]} instead of
13076 @code{"\t"}) overrules yasnippets' access to this key. The following code
13077 fixed this problem:
13078
13079 @lisp
13080 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook
13081 (lambda ()
13082 (org-set-local 'yas/trigger-key [tab])
13083 (define-key yas/keymap [tab] 'yas/next-field-group)))
13084 @end lisp
13085
13086 @item @file{windmove.el} by Hovav Shacham
13087 @cindex @file{windmove.el}
13088 This package also uses the @kbd{S-<cursor>} keys, so everything written
13089 in the paragraph above about CUA mode also applies here. If you want make
13090 the windmove function active in locations where Org-mode does not have
13091 special functionality on @kbd{S-@key{cursor}}, add this to your
13092 configuration:
13093
13094 @lisp
13095 ;; Make windmove work in org-mode:
13096 (add-hook 'org-shiftup-final-hook 'windmove-up)
13097 (add-hook 'org-shiftleft-final-hook 'windmove-left)
13098 (add-hook 'org-shiftdown-final-hook 'windmove-down)
13099 (add-hook 'org-shiftright-final-hook 'windmove-right)
13100 @end lisp
13101
13102 @item @file{viper.el} by Michael Kifer
13103 @cindex @file{viper.el}
13104 @kindex C-c /
13105 Viper uses @kbd{C-c /} and therefore makes this key not access the
13106 corresponding Org-mode command @code{org-sparse-tree}. You need to find
13107 another key for this command, or override the key in
13108 @code{viper-vi-global-user-map} with
13109
13110 @lisp
13111 (define-key viper-vi-global-user-map "C-c /" 'org-sparse-tree)
13112 @end lisp
13113
13114 @end table
13115
13116
13117 @node Hacking, MobileOrg, Miscellaneous, Top
13118 @appendix Hacking
13119 @cindex hacking
13120
13121 This appendix covers some aspects where users can extend the functionality of
13122 Org.
13123
13124 @menu
13125 * Hooks:: Who to reach into Org's internals
13126 * Add-on packages:: Available extensions
13127 * Adding hyperlink types:: New custom link types
13128 * Context-sensitive commands:: How to add functionality to such commands
13129 * Tables in arbitrary syntax:: Orgtbl for La@TeX{} and other programs
13130 * Dynamic blocks:: Automatically filled blocks
13131 * Special agenda views:: Customized views
13132 * Extracting agenda information:: Postprocessing of agenda information
13133 * Using the property API:: Writing programs that use entry properties
13134 * Using the mapping API:: Mapping over all or selected entries
13135 @end menu
13136
13137 @node Hooks, Add-on packages, Hacking, Hacking
13138 @section Hooks
13139 @cindex hooks
13140
13141 Org has a large number of hook variables that can be used to add
13142 functionality. This appendix about hacking is going to illustrate the
13143 use of some of them. A complete list of all hooks with documentation is
13144 maintained by the Worg project and can be found at
13145 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-configs/org-hooks.php}.
13146
13147 @node Add-on packages, Adding hyperlink types, Hooks, Hacking
13148 @section Add-on packages
13149 @cindex add-on packages
13150
13151 A large number of add-on packages have been written by various authors.
13152 These packages are not part of Emacs, but they are distributed as contributed
13153 packages with the separate release available at the Org-mode home page at
13154 @uref{http://orgmode.org}. The list of contributed packages, along with
13155 documentation about each package, is maintained by the Worg project at
13156 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/}.
13157
13158
13159
13160 @node Adding hyperlink types, Context-sensitive commands, Add-on packages, Hacking
13161 @section Adding hyperlink types
13162 @cindex hyperlinks, adding new types
13163
13164 Org has a large number of hyperlink types built-in
13165 (@pxref{Hyperlinks}). If you would like to add new link types, Org
13166 provides an interface for doing so. Let's look at an example file,
13167 @file{org-man.el}, that will add support for creating links like
13168 @samp{[[man:printf][The printf manpage]]} to show Unix manual pages inside
13169 Emacs:
13170
13171 @lisp
13172 ;;; org-man.el - Support for links to manpages in Org
13173
13174 (require 'org)
13175
13176 (org-add-link-type "man" 'org-man-open)
13177 (add-hook 'org-store-link-functions 'org-man-store-link)
13178
13179 (defcustom org-man-command 'man
13180 "The Emacs command to be used to display a man page."
13181 :group 'org-link
13182 :type '(choice (const man) (const woman)))
13183
13184 (defun org-man-open (path)
13185 "Visit the manpage on PATH.
13186 PATH should be a topic that can be thrown at the man command."
13187 (funcall org-man-command path))
13188
13189 (defun org-man-store-link ()
13190 "Store a link to a manpage."
13191 (when (memq major-mode '(Man-mode woman-mode))
13192 ;; This is a man page, we do make this link
13193 (let* ((page (org-man-get-page-name))
13194 (link (concat "man:" page))
13195 (description (format "Manpage for %s" page)))
13196 (org-store-link-props
13197 :type "man"
13198 :link link
13199 :description description))))
13200
13201 (defun org-man-get-page-name ()
13202 "Extract the page name from the buffer name."
13203 ;; This works for both `Man-mode' and `woman-mode'.
13204 (if (string-match " \\(\\S-+\\)\\*" (buffer-name))
13205 (match-string 1 (buffer-name))
13206 (error "Cannot create link to this man page")))
13207
13208 (provide 'org-man)
13209
13210 ;;; org-man.el ends here
13211 @end lisp
13212
13213 @noindent
13214 You would activate this new link type in @file{.emacs} with
13215
13216 @lisp
13217 (require 'org-man)
13218 @end lisp
13219
13220 @noindent
13221 Let's go through the file and see what it does.
13222 @enumerate
13223 @item
13224 It does @code{(require 'org)} to make sure that @file{org.el} has been
13225 loaded.
13226 @item
13227 The next line calls @code{org-add-link-type} to define a new link type
13228 with prefix @samp{man}. The call also contains the name of a function
13229 that will be called to follow such a link.
13230 @item
13231 @vindex org-store-link-functions
13232 The next line adds a function to @code{org-store-link-functions}, in
13233 order to allow the command @kbd{C-c l} to record a useful link in a
13234 buffer displaying a man page.
13235 @end enumerate
13236
13237 The rest of the file defines the necessary variables and functions.
13238 First there is a customization variable that determines which Emacs
13239 command should be used to display man pages. There are two options,
13240 @code{man} and @code{woman}. Then the function to follow a link is
13241 defined. It gets the link path as an argument---in this case the link
13242 path is just a topic for the manual command. The function calls the
13243 value of @code{org-man-command} to display the man page.
13244
13245 Finally the function @code{org-man-store-link} is defined. When you try
13246 to store a link with @kbd{C-c l}, this function will be called to
13247 try to make a link. The function must first decide if it is supposed to
13248 create the link for this buffer type; we do this by checking the value
13249 of the variable @code{major-mode}. If not, the function must exit and
13250 return the value @code{nil}. If yes, the link is created by getting the
13251 manual topic from the buffer name and prefixing it with the string
13252 @samp{man:}. Then it must call the command @code{org-store-link-props}
13253 and set the @code{:type} and @code{:link} properties. Optionally you
13254 can also set the @code{:description} property to provide a default for
13255 the link description when the link is later inserted into an Org
13256 buffer with @kbd{C-c C-l}.
13257
13258 When is makes sense for your new link type, you may also define a function
13259 @code{org-PREFIX-complete-link} that implements special (e.g. completion)
13260 support for inserting such a link with @kbd{C-c C-l}. Such a function should
13261 not accept any arguments, and return the full link with prefix.
13262
13263 @node Context-sensitive commands, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Adding hyperlink types, Hacking
13264 @section Context-sensitive commands
13265 @cindex context-sensitive commands, hooks
13266 @cindex add-ons, context-sensitive commands
13267 @vindex org-ctrl-c-ctrl-c-hook
13268
13269 Org has several commands that act differently depending on context. The most
13270 important example it the @kbd{C-c C-c} (@pxref{The very busy C-c C-c key}).
13271 Also the @kbd{M-cursor} and @kbd{M-S-cursor} keys have this property.
13272
13273 Add-ons can tap into this functionality by providing a function that detects
13274 special context for that add-on and executes functionality appropriate for
13275 the context. Here is an example from Dan Davison's @file{org-R.el} which
13276 allows you to evaluate commands based on the @file{R} programming language. For
13277 this package, special contexts are lines that start with @code{#+R:} or
13278 @code{#+RR:}.
13279
13280 @lisp
13281 (defun org-R-apply-maybe ()
13282 "Detect if this is context for org-R and execute R commands."
13283 (if (save-excursion
13284 (beginning-of-line 1)
13285 (looking-at "#\\+RR?:"))
13286 (progn (call-interactively 'org-R-apply)
13287 t) ;; to signal that we took action
13288 nil)) ;; to signal that we did not
13289
13290 (add-hook 'org-ctrl-c-ctrl-c-hook 'org-R-apply-maybe)
13291 @end lisp
13292
13293 The function first checks if the cursor is in such a line. If that is the
13294 case, @code{org-R-apply} is called and the function returns @code{t} to
13295 signal that action was taken, and @kbd{C-c C-c} will stop looking for other
13296 contexts. If the function finds it should do nothing locally, it returns @code{nil} so that other, similar functions can have a try.
13297
13298
13299 @node Tables in arbitrary syntax, Dynamic blocks, Context-sensitive commands, Hacking
13300 @section Tables and lists in arbitrary syntax
13301 @cindex tables, in other modes
13302 @cindex lists, in other modes
13303 @cindex Orgtbl mode
13304
13305 Since Orgtbl mode can be used as a minor mode in arbitrary buffers, a
13306 frequent feature request has been to make it work with native tables in
13307 specific languages, for example La@TeX{}. However, this is extremely
13308 hard to do in a general way, would lead to a customization nightmare,
13309 and would take away much of the simplicity of the Orgtbl-mode table
13310 editor.
13311
13312 This appendix describes a different approach. We keep the Orgtbl mode
13313 table in its native format (the @i{source table}), and use a custom
13314 function to @i{translate} the table to the correct syntax, and to
13315 @i{install} it in the right location (the @i{target table}). This puts
13316 the burden of writing conversion functions on the user, but it allows
13317 for a very flexible system.
13318
13319 Bastien added the ability to do the same with lists, in Orgstruct mode. You
13320 can use Org's facilities to edit and structure lists by turning
13321 @code{orgstruct-mode} on, then locally exporting such lists in another format
13322 (HTML, La@TeX{} or Texinfo.)
13323
13324
13325 @menu
13326 * Radio tables:: Sending and receiving radio tables
13327 * A LaTeX example:: Step by step, almost a tutorial
13328 * Translator functions:: Copy and modify
13329 * Radio lists:: Doing the same for lists
13330 @end menu
13331
13332 @node Radio tables, A LaTeX example, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Tables in arbitrary syntax
13333 @subsection Radio tables
13334 @cindex radio tables
13335
13336 To define the location of the target table, you first need to create two
13337 lines that are comments in the current mode, but contain magic words for
13338 Orgtbl mode to find. Orgtbl mode will insert the translated table
13339 between these lines, replacing whatever was there before. For example:
13340
13341 @example
13342 /* BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL table_name */
13343 /* END RECEIVE ORGTBL table_name */
13344 @end example
13345
13346 @noindent
13347 Just above the source table, we put a special line that tells
13348 Orgtbl mode how to translate this table and where to install it. For
13349 example:
13350 @cindex #+ORGTBL
13351 @example
13352 #+ORGTBL: SEND table_name translation_function arguments....
13353 @end example
13354
13355 @noindent
13356 @code{table_name} is the reference name for the table that is also used
13357 in the receiver lines. @code{translation_function} is the Lisp function
13358 that does the translation. Furthermore, the line can contain a list of
13359 arguments (alternating key and value) at the end. The arguments will be
13360 passed as a property list to the translation function for
13361 interpretation. A few standard parameters are already recognized and
13362 acted upon before the translation function is called:
13363
13364 @table @code
13365 @item :skip N
13366 Skip the first N lines of the table. Hlines do count as separate lines for
13367 this parameter!
13368
13369 @item :skipcols (n1 n2 ...)
13370 List of columns that should be skipped. If the table has a column with
13371 calculation marks, that column is automatically discarded as well.
13372 Please note that the translator function sees the table @emph{after} the
13373 removal of these columns, the function never knows that there have been
13374 additional columns.
13375 @end table
13376
13377 @noindent
13378 The one problem remaining is how to keep the source table in the buffer
13379 without disturbing the normal workings of the file, for example during
13380 compilation of a C file or processing of a La@TeX{} file. There are a
13381 number of different solutions:
13382
13383 @itemize @bullet
13384 @item
13385 The table could be placed in a block comment if that is supported by the
13386 language. For example, in C mode you could wrap the table between
13387 @samp{/*} and @samp{*/} lines.
13388 @item
13389 Sometimes it is possible to put the table after some kind of @i{END}
13390 statement, for example @samp{\bye} in @TeX{} and @samp{\end@{document@}}
13391 in La@TeX{}.
13392 @item
13393 You can just comment the table line-by-line whenever you want to process
13394 the file, and uncomment it whenever you need to edit the table. This
13395 only sounds tedious---the command @kbd{M-x orgtbl-toggle-comment}
13396 makes this comment-toggling very easy, in particular if you bind it to a
13397 key.
13398 @end itemize
13399
13400 @node A LaTeX example, Translator functions, Radio tables, Tables in arbitrary syntax
13401 @subsection A La@TeX{} example of radio tables
13402 @cindex La@TeX{}, and Orgtbl mode
13403
13404 The best way to wrap the source table in La@TeX{} is to use the
13405 @code{comment} environment provided by @file{comment.sty}. It has to be
13406 activated by placing @code{\usepackage@{comment@}} into the document
13407 header. Orgtbl mode can insert a radio table skeleton@footnote{By
13408 default this works only for La@TeX{}, HTML, and Texinfo. Configure the
13409 variable @code{orgtbl-radio-tables} to install templates for other
13410 modes.} with the command @kbd{M-x orgtbl-insert-radio-table}. You will
13411 be prompted for a table name, let's say we use @samp{salesfigures}. You
13412 will then get the following template:
13413
13414 @cindex #+ORGTBL, SEND
13415 @example
13416 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
13417 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
13418 \begin@{comment@}
13419 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex
13420 | | |
13421 \end@{comment@}
13422 @end example
13423
13424 @noindent
13425 @vindex La@TeX{}-verbatim-environments
13426 The @code{#+ORGTBL: SEND} line tells Orgtbl mode to use the function
13427 @code{orgtbl-to-latex} to convert the table into La@TeX{} and to put it
13428 into the receiver location with name @code{salesfigures}. You may now
13429 fill in the table, feel free to use the spreadsheet features@footnote{If
13430 the @samp{#+TBLFM} line contains an odd number of dollar characters,
13431 this may cause problems with font-lock in La@TeX{} mode. As shown in the
13432 example you can fix this by adding an extra line inside the
13433 @code{comment} environment that is used to balance the dollar
13434 expressions. If you are using AUC@TeX{} with the font-latex library, a
13435 much better solution is to add the @code{comment} environment to the
13436 variable @code{LaTeX-verbatim-environments}.}:
13437
13438 @example
13439 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
13440 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
13441 \begin@{comment@}
13442 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex
13443 | Month | Days | Nr sold | per day |
13444 |-------+------+---------+---------|
13445 | Jan | 23 | 55 | 2.4 |
13446 | Feb | 21 | 16 | 0.8 |
13447 | March | 22 | 278 | 12.6 |
13448 #+TBLFM: $4=$3/$2;%.1f
13449 % $ (optional extra dollar to keep font-lock happy, see footnote)
13450 \end@{comment@}
13451 @end example
13452
13453 @noindent
13454 When you are done, press @kbd{C-c C-c} in the table to get the converted
13455 table inserted between the two marker lines.
13456
13457 Now let's assume you want to make the table header by hand, because you
13458 want to control how columns are aligned, etc@. In this case we make sure
13459 that the table translator skips the first 2 lines of the source
13460 table, and tell the command to work as a @i{splice}, i.e. to not produce
13461 header and footer commands of the target table:
13462
13463 @example
13464 \begin@{tabular@}@{lrrr@}
13465 Month & \multicolumn@{1@}@{c@}@{Days@} & Nr.\ sold & per day\\
13466 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
13467 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
13468 \end@{tabular@}
13469 %
13470 \begin@{comment@}
13471 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex :splice t :skip 2
13472 | Month | Days | Nr sold | per day |
13473 |-------+------+---------+---------|
13474 | Jan | 23 | 55 | 2.4 |
13475 | Feb | 21 | 16 | 0.8 |
13476 | March | 22 | 278 | 12.6 |
13477 #+TBLFM: $4=$3/$2;%.1f
13478 \end@{comment@}
13479 @end example
13480
13481 The La@TeX{} translator function @code{orgtbl-to-latex} is already part of
13482 Orgtbl mode. It uses a @code{tabular} environment to typeset the table
13483 and marks horizontal lines with @code{\hline}. Furthermore, it
13484 interprets the following parameters (see also @pxref{Translator functions}):
13485
13486 @table @code
13487 @item :splice nil/t
13488 When set to t, return only table body lines, don't wrap them into a
13489 tabular environment. Default is nil.
13490
13491 @item :fmt fmt
13492 A format to be used to wrap each field, it should contain @code{%s} for the
13493 original field value. For example, to wrap each field value in dollars,
13494 you could use @code{:fmt "$%s$"}. This may also be a property list with
13495 column numbers and formats. for example @code{:fmt (2 "$%s$" 4 "%s\\%%")}.
13496 A function of one argument can be used in place of the strings; the
13497 function must return a formatted string.
13498
13499 @item :efmt efmt
13500 Use this format to print numbers with exponentials. The format should
13501 have @code{%s} twice for inserting mantissa and exponent, for example
13502 @code{"%s\\times10^@{%s@}"}. The default is @code{"%s\\,(%s)"}. This
13503 may also be a property list with column numbers and formats, for example
13504 @code{:efmt (2 "$%s\\times10^@{%s@}$" 4 "$%s\\cdot10^@{%s@}$")}. After
13505 @code{efmt} has been applied to a value, @code{fmt} will also be
13506 applied. Similar to @code{fmt}, functions of two arguments can be
13507 supplied instead of strings.
13508 @end table
13509
13510 @node Translator functions, Radio lists, A LaTeX example, Tables in arbitrary syntax
13511 @subsection Translator functions
13512 @cindex HTML, and Orgtbl mode
13513 @cindex translator function
13514
13515 Orgtbl mode has several translator functions built-in: @code{orgtbl-to-csv}
13516 (comma-separated values), @code{orgtbl-to-tsv} (TAB-separated values)
13517 @code{orgtbl-to-latex}, @code{orgtbl-to-html}, and @code{orgtbl-to-texinfo}.
13518 Except for @code{orgtbl-to-html}@footnote{The HTML translator uses the same
13519 code that produces tables during HTML export.}, these all use a generic
13520 translator, @code{orgtbl-to-generic}. For example, @code{orgtbl-to-latex}
13521 itself is a very short function that computes the column definitions for the
13522 @code{tabular} environment, defines a few field and line separators and then
13523 hands processing over to the generic translator. Here is the entire code:
13524
13525 @lisp
13526 @group
13527 (defun orgtbl-to-latex (table params)
13528 "Convert the Orgtbl mode TABLE to LaTeX."
13529 (let* ((alignment (mapconcat (lambda (x) (if x "r" "l"))
13530 org-table-last-alignment ""))
13531 (params2
13532 (list
13533 :tstart (concat "\\begin@{tabular@}@{" alignment "@}")
13534 :tend "\\end@{tabular@}"
13535 :lstart "" :lend " \\\\" :sep " & "
13536 :efmt "%s\\,(%s)" :hline "\\hline")))
13537 (orgtbl-to-generic table (org-combine-plists params2 params))))
13538 @end group
13539 @end lisp
13540
13541 As you can see, the properties passed into the function (variable
13542 @var{PARAMS}) are combined with the ones newly defined in the function
13543 (variable @var{PARAMS2}). The ones passed into the function (i.e. the
13544 ones set by the @samp{ORGTBL SEND} line) take precedence. So if you
13545 would like to use the La@TeX{} translator, but wanted the line endings to
13546 be @samp{\\[2mm]} instead of the default @samp{\\}, you could just
13547 overrule the default with
13548
13549 @example
13550 #+ORGTBL: SEND test orgtbl-to-latex :lend " \\\\[2mm]"
13551 @end example
13552
13553 For a new language, you can either write your own converter function in
13554 analogy with the La@TeX{} translator, or you can use the generic function
13555 directly. For example, if you have a language where a table is started
13556 with @samp{!BTBL!}, ended with @samp{!ETBL!}, and where table lines are
13557 started with @samp{!BL!}, ended with @samp{!EL!}, and where the field
13558 separator is a TAB, you could call the generic translator like this (on
13559 a single line!):
13560
13561 @example
13562 #+ORGTBL: SEND test orgtbl-to-generic :tstart "!BTBL!" :tend "!ETBL!"
13563 :lstart "!BL! " :lend " !EL!" :sep "\t"
13564 @end example
13565
13566 @noindent
13567 Please check the documentation string of the function
13568 @code{orgtbl-to-generic} for a full list of parameters understood by
13569 that function, and remember that you can pass each of them into
13570 @code{orgtbl-to-latex}, @code{orgtbl-to-texinfo}, and any other function
13571 using the generic function.
13572
13573 Of course you can also write a completely new function doing complicated
13574 things the generic translator cannot do. A translator function takes
13575 two arguments. The first argument is the table, a list of lines, each
13576 line either the symbol @code{hline} or a list of fields. The second
13577 argument is the property list containing all parameters specified in the
13578 @samp{#+ORGTBL: SEND} line. The function must return a single string
13579 containing the formatted table. If you write a generally useful
13580 translator, please post it on @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org} so that
13581 others can benefit from your work.
13582
13583 @node Radio lists, , Translator functions, Tables in arbitrary syntax
13584 @subsection Radio lists
13585 @cindex radio lists
13586 @cindex org-list-insert-radio-list
13587
13588 Sending and receiving radio lists works exactly the same way than sending and
13589 receiving radio tables (@pxref{Radio tables}). As for radio tables, you can
13590 insert radio lists templates in HTML, La@TeX{} and Texinfo modes by calling
13591 @code{org-list-insert-radio-list}.
13592
13593 Here are the differences with radio tables:
13594
13595 @itemize @minus
13596 @item
13597 Orgstruct mode must be active.
13598 @item
13599 Use the @code{ORGLST} keyword instead of @code{ORGTBL}.
13600 @item
13601 The available translation functions for radio lists don't take
13602 parameters.
13603 @item
13604 @kbd{C-c C-c} will work when pressed on the first item of the list.
13605 @end itemize
13606
13607 Here is a La@TeX{} example. Let's say that you have this in your
13608 La@TeX{} file:
13609
13610 @cindex #+ORGLST
13611 @example
13612 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGLST to-buy
13613 % END RECEIVE ORGLST to-buy
13614 \begin@{comment@}
13615 #+ORGLST: SEND to-buy org-list-to-latex
13616 - a new house
13617 - a new computer
13618 + a new keyboard
13619 + a new mouse
13620 - a new life
13621 \end@{comment@}
13622 @end example
13623
13624 Pressing `C-c C-c' on @code{a new house} and will insert the converted
13625 La@TeX{} list between the two marker lines.
13626
13627 @node Dynamic blocks, Special agenda views, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Hacking
13628 @section Dynamic blocks
13629 @cindex dynamic blocks
13630
13631 Org documents can contain @emph{dynamic blocks}. These are
13632 specially marked regions that are updated by some user-written function.
13633 A good example for such a block is the clock table inserted by the
13634 command @kbd{C-c C-x C-r} (@pxref{Clocking work time}).
13635
13636 Dynamic block are enclosed by a BEGIN-END structure that assigns a name
13637 to the block and can also specify parameters for the function producing
13638 the content of the block.
13639
13640 #+BEGIN:dynamic block
13641 @example
13642 #+BEGIN: myblock :parameter1 value1 :parameter2 value2 ...
13643
13644 #+END:
13645 @end example
13646
13647 Dynamic blocks are updated with the following commands
13648
13649 @table @kbd
13650 @kindex C-c C-x C-u
13651 @item C-c C-x C-u
13652 Update dynamic block at point.
13653 @kindex C-u C-c C-x C-u
13654 @item C-u C-c C-x C-u
13655 Update all dynamic blocks in the current file.
13656 @end table
13657
13658 Updating a dynamic block means to remove all the text between BEGIN and
13659 END, parse the BEGIN line for parameters and then call the specific
13660 writer function for this block to insert the new content. If you want
13661 to use the original content in the writer function, you can use the
13662 extra parameter @code{:content}.
13663
13664 For a block with name @code{myblock}, the writer function is
13665 @code{org-dblock-write:myblock} with as only parameter a property list
13666 with the parameters given in the begin line. Here is a trivial example
13667 of a block that keeps track of when the block update function was last
13668 run:
13669
13670 @example
13671 #+BEGIN: block-update-time :format "on %m/%d/%Y at %H:%M"
13672
13673 #+END:
13674 @end example
13675
13676 @noindent
13677 The corresponding block writer function could look like this:
13678
13679 @lisp
13680 (defun org-dblock-write:block-update-time (params)
13681 (let ((fmt (or (plist-get params :format) "%d. %m. %Y")))
13682 (insert "Last block update at: "
13683 (format-time-string fmt (current-time)))))
13684 @end lisp
13685
13686 If you want to make sure that all dynamic blocks are always up-to-date,
13687 you could add the function @code{org-update-all-dblocks} to a hook, for
13688 example @code{before-save-hook}. @code{org-update-all-dblocks} is
13689 written in a way such that it does nothing in buffers that are not in
13690 @code{org-mode}.
13691
13692 @node Special agenda views, Extracting agenda information, Dynamic blocks, Hacking
13693 @section Special agenda views
13694 @cindex agenda views, user-defined
13695
13696 Org provides a special hook that can be used to narrow down the
13697 selection made by any of the agenda views. You may specify a function
13698 that is used at each match to verify if the match should indeed be part
13699 of the agenda view, and if not, how much should be skipped.
13700
13701 Let's say you want to produce a list of projects that contain a WAITING
13702 tag anywhere in the project tree. Let's further assume that you have
13703 marked all tree headings that define a project with the TODO keyword
13704 PROJECT. In this case you would run a TODO search for the keyword
13705 PROJECT, but skip the match unless there is a WAITING tag anywhere in
13706 the subtree belonging to the project line.
13707
13708 To achieve this, you must write a function that searches the subtree for
13709 the tag. If the tag is found, the function must return @code{nil} to
13710 indicate that this match should not be skipped. If there is no such
13711 tag, return the location of the end of the subtree, to indicate that
13712 search should continue from there.
13713
13714 @lisp
13715 (defun my-skip-unless-waiting ()
13716 "Skip trees that are not waiting"
13717 (let ((subtree-end (save-excursion (org-end-of-subtree t))))
13718 (if (re-search-forward ":waiting:" subtree-end t)
13719 nil ; tag found, do not skip
13720 subtree-end))) ; tag not found, continue after end of subtree
13721 @end lisp
13722
13723 Now you may use this function in an agenda custom command, for example
13724 like this:
13725
13726 @lisp
13727 (org-add-agenda-custom-command
13728 '("b" todo "PROJECT"
13729 ((org-agenda-skip-function 'my-skip-unless-waiting)
13730 (org-agenda-overriding-header "Projects waiting for something: "))))
13731 @end lisp
13732
13733 @vindex org-agenda-overriding-header
13734 Note that this also binds @code{org-agenda-overriding-header} to get a
13735 meaningful header in the agenda view.
13736
13737 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
13738 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function
13739 A general way to create custom searches is to base them on a search for
13740 entries with a certain level limit. If you want to study all entries with
13741 your custom search function, simply do a search for
13742 @samp{LEVEL>0}@footnote{Note that, when using @code{org-odd-levels-only}, a
13743 level number corresponds to order in the hierarchy, not to the number of
13744 stars.}, and then use @code{org-agenda-skip-function} to select the entries
13745 you really want to have.
13746
13747 You may also put a Lisp form into @code{org-agenda-skip-function}. In
13748 particular, you may use the functions @code{org-agenda-skip-entry-if}
13749 and @code{org-agenda-skip-subtree-if} in this form, for example:
13750
13751 @table @code
13752 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'scheduled)
13753 Skip current entry if it has been scheduled.
13754 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'notscheduled)
13755 Skip current entry if it has not been scheduled.
13756 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'deadline)
13757 Skip current entry if it has a deadline.
13758 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'scheduled 'deadline)
13759 Skip current entry if it has a deadline, or if it is scheduled.
13760 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'todo '("TODO" "WAITING"))
13761 Skip current entry if the TODO keyword is TODO or WAITING.
13762 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'todo 'done)
13763 Skip current entry if the TODO keyword marks a DONE state.
13764 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'timestamp)
13765 Skip current entry if it has any timestamp, may also be deadline or scheduled.
13766 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry 'regexp "regular expression")
13767 Skip current entry if the regular expression matches in the entry.
13768 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry 'notregexp "regular expression")
13769 Skip current entry unless the regular expression matches.
13770 @item '(org-agenda-skip-subtree-if 'regexp "regular expression")
13771 Same as above, but check and skip the entire subtree.
13772 @end table
13773
13774 Therefore we could also have written the search for WAITING projects
13775 like this, even without defining a special function:
13776
13777 @lisp
13778 (org-add-agenda-custom-command
13779 '("b" todo "PROJECT"
13780 ((org-agenda-skip-function '(org-agenda-skip-subtree-if
13781 'regexp ":waiting:"))
13782 (org-agenda-overriding-header "Projects waiting for something: "))))
13783 @end lisp
13784
13785 @node Extracting agenda information, Using the property API, Special agenda views, Hacking
13786 @section Extracting agenda information
13787 @cindex agenda, pipe
13788 @cindex Scripts, for agenda processing
13789
13790 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
13791 Org provides commands to access agenda information for the command
13792 line in Emacs batch mode. This extracted information can be sent
13793 directly to a printer, or it can be read by a program that does further
13794 processing of the data. The first of these commands is the function
13795 @code{org-batch-agenda}, that produces an agenda view and sends it as
13796 ASCII text to STDOUT. The command takes a single string as parameter.
13797 If the string has length 1, it is used as a key to one of the commands
13798 you have configured in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}, basically any
13799 key you can use after @kbd{C-c a}. For example, to directly print the
13800 current TODO list, you could use
13801
13802 @example
13803 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -eval '(org-batch-agenda "t")' | lpr
13804 @end example
13805
13806 If the parameter is a string with 2 or more characters, it is used as a
13807 tags/TODO match string. For example, to print your local shopping list
13808 (all items with the tag @samp{shop}, but excluding the tag
13809 @samp{NewYork}), you could use
13810
13811 @example
13812 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs \
13813 -eval '(org-batch-agenda "+shop-NewYork")' | lpr
13814 @end example
13815
13816 @noindent
13817 You may also modify parameters on the fly like this:
13818
13819 @example
13820 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs \
13821 -eval '(org-batch-agenda "a" \
13822 org-agenda-ndays 30 \
13823 org-agenda-include-diary nil \
13824 org-agenda-files (quote ("~/org/project.org")))' \
13825 | lpr
13826 @end example
13827
13828 @noindent
13829 which will produce a 30-day agenda, fully restricted to the Org file
13830 @file{~/org/projects.org}, not even including the diary.
13831
13832 If you want to process the agenda data in more sophisticated ways, you
13833 can use the command @code{org-batch-agenda-csv} to get a comma-separated
13834 list of values for each agenda item. Each line in the output will
13835 contain a number of fields separated by commas. The fields in a line
13836 are:
13837
13838 @example
13839 category @r{The category of the item}
13840 head @r{The headline, without TODO keyword, TAGS and PRIORITY}
13841 type @r{The type of the agenda entry, can be}
13842 todo @r{selected in TODO match}
13843 tagsmatch @r{selected in tags match}
13844 diary @r{imported from diary}
13845 deadline @r{a deadline}
13846 scheduled @r{scheduled}
13847 timestamp @r{appointment, selected by timestamp}
13848 closed @r{entry was closed on date}
13849 upcoming-deadline @r{warning about nearing deadline}
13850 past-scheduled @r{forwarded scheduled item}
13851 block @r{entry has date block including date}
13852 todo @r{The TODO keyword, if any}
13853 tags @r{All tags including inherited ones, separated by colons}
13854 date @r{The relevant date, like 2007-2-14}
13855 time @r{The time, like 15:00-16:50}
13856 extra @r{String with extra planning info}
13857 priority-l @r{The priority letter if any was given}
13858 priority-n @r{The computed numerical priority}
13859 @end example
13860
13861 @noindent
13862 Time and date will only be given if a timestamp (or deadline/scheduled)
13863 led to the selection of the item.
13864
13865 A CSV list like this is very easy to use in a post-processing script.
13866 For example, here is a Perl program that gets the TODO list from
13867 Emacs/Org and prints all the items, preceded by a checkbox:
13868
13869 @example
13870 #!/usr/bin/perl
13871
13872 # define the Emacs command to run
13873 $cmd = "emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -eval '(org-batch-agenda-csv \"t\")'";
13874
13875 # run it and capture the output
13876 $agenda = qx@{$cmd 2>/dev/null@};
13877
13878 # loop over all lines
13879 foreach $line (split(/\n/,$agenda)) @{
13880 # get the individual values
13881 ($category,$head,$type,$todo,$tags,$date,$time,$extra,
13882 $priority_l,$priority_n) = split(/,/,$line);
13883 # process and print
13884 print "[ ] $head\n";
13885 @}
13886 @end example
13887
13888 @node Using the property API, Using the mapping API, Extracting agenda information, Hacking
13889 @section Using the property API
13890 @cindex API, for properties
13891 @cindex properties, API
13892
13893 Here is a description of the functions that can be used to work with
13894 properties.
13895
13896 @defun org-entry-properties &optional pom which
13897 Get all properties of the entry at point-or-marker POM.@*
13898 This includes the TODO keyword, the tags, time strings for deadline,
13899 scheduled, and clocking, and any additional properties defined in the
13900 entry. The return value is an alist, keys may occur multiple times
13901 if the property key was used several times.@*
13902 POM may also be nil, in which case the current entry is used.
13903 If WHICH is nil or `all', get all properties. If WHICH is
13904 `special' or `standard', only get that subclass.
13905 @end defun
13906 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
13907 @defun org-entry-get pom property &optional inherit
13908 Get value of PROPERTY for entry at point-or-marker POM. By default,
13909 this only looks at properties defined locally in the entry. If INHERIT
13910 is non-nil and the entry does not have the property, then also check
13911 higher levels of the hierarchy. If INHERIT is the symbol
13912 @code{selective}, use inheritance if and only if the setting of
13913 @code{org-use-property-inheritance} selects PROPERTY for inheritance.
13914 @end defun
13915
13916 @defun org-entry-delete pom property
13917 Delete the property PROPERTY from entry at point-or-marker POM.
13918 @end defun
13919
13920 @defun org-entry-put pom property value
13921 Set PROPERTY to VALUE for entry at point-or-marker POM.
13922 @end defun
13923
13924 @defun org-buffer-property-keys &optional include-specials
13925 Get all property keys in the current buffer.
13926 @end defun
13927
13928 @defun org-insert-property-drawer
13929 Insert a property drawer at point.
13930 @end defun
13931
13932 @defun org-entry-put-multivalued-property pom property &rest values
13933 Set PROPERTY at point-or-marker POM to VALUES. VALUES should be a list of
13934 strings. They will be concatenated, with spaces as separators.
13935 @end defun
13936
13937 @defun org-entry-get-multivalued-property pom property
13938 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
13939 values and return the values as a list of strings.
13940 @end defun
13941
13942 @defun org-entry-add-to-multivalued-property pom property value
13943 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
13944 values and make sure that VALUE is in this list.
13945 @end defun
13946
13947 @defun org-entry-remove-from-multivalued-property pom property value
13948 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
13949 values and make sure that VALUE is @emph{not} in this list.
13950 @end defun
13951
13952 @defun org-entry-member-in-multivalued-property pom property value
13953 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
13954 values and check if VALUE is in this list.
13955 @end defun
13956
13957 @defopt org-property-allowed-value-functions
13958 Hook for functions supplying allowed values for specific.
13959 The functions must take a single argument, the name of the property, and
13960 return a flat list of allowed values. If @samp{:ETC} is one of
13961 the values, use the values as completion help, but allow also other values
13962 to be entered. The functions must return @code{nil} if they are not
13963 responsible for this property.
13964 @end defopt
13965
13966 @node Using the mapping API, , Using the property API, Hacking
13967 @section Using the mapping API
13968 @cindex API, for mapping
13969 @cindex mapping entries, API
13970
13971 Org has sophisticated mapping capabilities to find all entries satisfying
13972 certain criteria. Internally, this functionality is used to produce agenda
13973 views, but there is also an API that can be used to execute arbitrary
13974 functions for each or selected entries. The main entry point for this API
13975 is:
13976
13977 @defun org-map-entries func &optional match scope &rest skip
13978 Call FUNC at each headline selected by MATCH in SCOPE.
13979
13980 FUNC is a function or a Lisp form. The function will be called without
13981 arguments, with the cursor positioned at the beginning of the headline.
13982 The return values of all calls to the function will be collected and
13983 returned as a list.
13984
13985 The call to FUNC will be wrapped into a save-excursion form, so FUNC
13986 does not need to preserve point. After evaluation, the cursor will be
13987 moved to the end of the line (presumably of the headline of the
13988 processed entry) and search continues from there. Under some
13989 circumstances, this may not produce the wanted results. For example,
13990 if you have removed (e.g. archived) the current (sub)tree it could
13991 mean that the next entry will be skipped entirely. In such cases, you
13992 can specify the position from where search should continue by making
13993 FUNC set the variable `org-map-continue-from' to the desired buffer
13994 position.
13995
13996 MATCH is a tags/property/todo match as it is used in the agenda match view.
13997 Only headlines that are matched by this query will be considered during
13998 the iteration. When MATCH is nil or t, all headlines will be
13999 visited by the iteration.
14000
14001 SCOPE determines the scope of this command. It can be any of:
14002
14003 @example
14004 nil @r{the current buffer, respecting the restriction if any}
14005 tree @r{the subtree started with the entry at point}
14006 file @r{the current buffer, without restriction}
14007 file-with-archives
14008 @r{the current buffer, and any archives associated with it}
14009 agenda @r{all agenda files}
14010 agenda-with-archives
14011 @r{all agenda files with any archive files associated with them}
14012 (file1 file2 ...)
14013 @r{if this is a list, all files in the list will be scanned}
14014 @end example
14015 @noindent
14016 The remaining args are treated as settings for the skipping facilities of
14017 the scanner. The following items can be given here:
14018
14019 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function
14020 @example
14021 archive @r{skip trees with the archive tag}
14022 comment @r{skip trees with the COMMENT keyword}
14023 function or Lisp form
14024 @r{will be used as value for @code{org-agenda-skip-function},}
14025 @r{so whenever the function returns t, FUNC}
14026 @r{will not be called for that entry and search will}
14027 @r{continue from the point where the function leaves it}
14028 @end example
14029 @end defun
14030
14031 The function given to that mapping routine can really do anything you like.
14032 It can use the property API (@pxref{Using the property API}) to gather more
14033 information about the entry, or in order to change metadata in the entry.
14034 Here are a couple of functions that might be handy:
14035
14036 @defun org-todo &optional arg
14037 Change the TODO state of the entry, see the docstring of the functions for
14038 the many possible values for the argument ARG.
14039 @end defun
14040
14041 @defun org-priority &optional action
14042 Change the priority of the entry, see the docstring of this function for the
14043 possible values for ACTION.
14044 @end defun
14045
14046 @defun org-toggle-tag tag &optional onoff
14047 Toggle the tag TAG in the current entry. Setting ONOFF to either @code{on}
14048 or @code{off} will not toggle tag, but ensure that it is either on or off.
14049 @end defun
14050
14051 @defun org-promote
14052 Promote the current entry.
14053 @end defun
14054
14055 @defun org-demote
14056 Demote the current entry.
14057 @end defun
14058
14059 Here is a simple example that will turn all entries in the current file with
14060 a tag @code{TOMORROW} into TODO entries with the keyword @code{UPCOMING}.
14061 Entries in comment trees and in archive trees will be ignored.
14062
14063 @lisp
14064 (org-map-entries
14065 '(org-todo "UPCOMING")
14066 "+TOMORROW" 'file 'archive 'comment)
14067 @end lisp
14068
14069 The following example counts the number of entries with TODO keyword
14070 @code{WAITING}, in all agenda files.
14071
14072 @lisp
14073 (length (org-map-entries t "/+WAITING" 'agenda))
14074 @end lisp
14075
14076 @node MobileOrg, History and Acknowledgments, Hacking, Top
14077 @appendix MobileOrg
14078 @cindex iPhone
14079 @cindex MobileOrg
14080
14081 @uref{http://mobileorg.ncogni.to/, MobileOrg} is an application for the
14082 @i{iPhone/iPod Touch} series of devices, developed by Richard Moreland.
14083 @i{MobileOrg} offers offline viewing and capture support for an Org-mode
14084 system rooted on a ``real'' computer. It does also allow you to record
14085 changes to existing entries. Android users should check out
14086 @uref{http://wiki.github.com/matburt/mobileorg-android/, MobileOrg Android}
14087 by Matt Jones.
14088
14089 This appendix describes the support Org has for creating agenda views in a
14090 format that can be displayed by @i{MobileOrg}, and for integrating notes
14091 captured and changes made by @i{MobileOrg} into the main system.
14092
14093 For changing tags and TODO states in MobileOrg, you should have set up the
14094 customization variables @code{org-todo-keywords} and @code{org-tags-alist} to
14095 cover all important tags and TODO keywords, even if individual files use only
14096 part of these. MobileOrg will also offer you states and tags set up with
14097 in-buffer settings, but it will understand the logistics of TODO state
14098 @i{sets} (@pxref{Per-file keywords}) and @i{mutually exclusive} tags
14099 (@pxref{Setting tags}) only for those set in these variables.
14100
14101 @menu
14102 * Setting up the staging area:: Where to interact with the mobile device
14103 * Pushing to MobileOrg:: Uploading Org files and agendas
14104 * Pulling from MobileOrg:: Integrating captured and flagged items
14105 @end menu
14106
14107 @node Setting up the staging area, Pushing to MobileOrg, MobileOrg, MobileOrg
14108 @section Setting up the staging area
14109
14110 MobileOrg needs to interact with Emacs through directory on a
14111 server@footnote{If you are using a public server, you might prefer to encrypt
14112 the files on the server. This can be done with Org-mode 6.35 and, hopefully,
14113 with MobileOrg 1.4 (please check before trying to use this). On the Emacs
14114 side, configure the variables @code{org-mobile-use-encryption} and
14115 @code{org-mobile-encryption-password}.}. The easiest way to create that
14116 directory is to use a free @uref{http://dropbox.com,Dropbox.com}
14117 account@footnote{If you cannot use Dropbox, or if your version of MobileOrg
14118 does not support it, you can use a webdav server. For more information,
14119 check out the the documentation of MobileOrg and also this
14120 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-faq.php#mobileorg_webdav, FAQ entry}.}.
14121 When MobileOrg first connects to your Dropbox, it will create a directory
14122 @i{MobileOrg} inside the Dropbox. After the directory has been created, tell
14123 Emacs about it:
14124
14125 @lisp
14126 (setq org-mobile-directory "~/Dropbox/MobileOrg")
14127 @end lisp
14128
14129 Org-mode has commands to put files for @i{MobileOrg} into that directory,
14130 and to read captured notes from there.
14131
14132 @node Pushing to MobileOrg, Pulling from MobileOrg, Setting up the staging area, MobileOrg
14133 @section Pushing to MobileOrg
14134
14135 This operation copies all files currently listed in @code{org-mobile-files}
14136 to the directory @code{org-mobile-directory}. By default this list contains
14137 all agenda files (as listed in @code{org-agenda-files}), but additional files
14138 can be included by customizing @code{org-mobiles-files}. File names will be
14139 staged with path relative to @code{org-directory}, so all files should be
14140 inside this directory. The push operation also creates a special Org file
14141 @file{agendas.org} with all custom agenda view defined by the
14142 user@footnote{While creating the agendas, Org-mode will force (see the
14143 variable @code{org-mobile-force-id-on-agenda-items}) ID properties on all
14144 referenced entries, so that these entries can be uniquely
14145 identified if @i{MobileOrg} flags them for further action.}. Finally, Org
14146 writes the file @file{index.org}, containing links to all other files.
14147 @i{MobileOrg} first reads this file from the server, and then downloads all
14148 agendas and Org files listed in it. To speed up the download, MobileOrg will
14149 only read files whose checksums@footnote{stored automatically in the file
14150 @file{checksums.dat}} have changed.
14151
14152 @node Pulling from MobileOrg, , Pushing to MobileOrg, MobileOrg
14153 @section Pulling from MobileOrg
14154
14155 When @i{MobileOrg} synchronizes with the server, it not only pulls the Org
14156 files for viewing. It also appends captured entries and pointers to flagged
14157 and changed entries to the file @file{mobileorg.org} on the server. Org has
14158 a @emph{pull} operation that integrates this information into an inbox file
14159 and operates on the pointers to flagged entries. Here is how it works:
14160
14161 @enumerate
14162 @item
14163 Org moves all entries found in
14164 @file{mobileorg.org}@footnote{@file{mobileorg.org} will be empty after this
14165 operation.} and appends them to the file pointed to by the variable
14166 @code{org-mobile-inbox-for-pull}. Each captured entry and each editing event
14167 will be a top-level entry in the inbox file.
14168 @item
14169 After moving the entries, Org will attempt to implement the changes made in
14170 @i{MobileOrg}. Some changes are applied directly and without user
14171 interaction. Examples are all changes to tags, TODO state, headline and body
14172 text that can be cleanly applied. Entries that have been flagged for further
14173 action will receive a tag @code{:FLAGGED:}, so that they can be easily found
14174 again. When there is a problem finding an entry or applying the change, the
14175 pointer entry will remain in the inbox and will be marked with an error
14176 message. You need to later resolve these issues by hand.
14177 @item
14178 Org will then generate an agenda view with all flagged entries. The user
14179 should then go through these entries and do whatever actions are necessary.
14180 If a note has been stored while flagging an entry in @i{MobileOrg}, that note
14181 will be displayed in the echo area when the cursor is on the corresponding
14182 agenda line.
14183 @table @kbd
14184 @kindex ?
14185 @item ?
14186 Pressing @kbd{?} in that special agenda will display the full flagging note in
14187 another window and also push it onto the kill ring. So you could use @kbd{?
14188 z C-y C-c C-c} to store that flagging note as a normal note in the entry.
14189 Pressing @kbd{?} twice in succession will offer to remove the
14190 @code{:FLAGGED:} tag along with the recorded flagging note (which is stored
14191 in a property). In this way you indicate, that the intended processing for
14192 this flagged entry is finished.
14193 @end table
14194 @end enumerate
14195
14196 @kindex C-c a ?
14197 If you are not able to process all flagged entries directly, you can always
14198 return to this agenda view using @kbd{C-c a ?}. Note, however, that there is
14199 a subtle difference. The view created automatically by @kbd{M-x
14200 org-mobile-pull @key{RET}} is guaranteed to search all files that have been
14201 addressed by the last pull. This might include a file that is not currently
14202 in your list of agenda files. If you later use @kbd{C-c a ?} to regenerate
14203 the view, only the current agenda files will be searched.
14204
14205 @node History and Acknowledgments, Main Index, MobileOrg, Top
14206 @appendix History and acknowledgments
14207 @cindex acknowledgments
14208 @cindex history
14209 @cindex thanks
14210
14211 Org was born in 2003, out of frustration over the user interface of the Emacs
14212 Outline mode. I was trying to organize my notes and projects, and using
14213 Emacs seemed to be the natural way to go. However, having to remember eleven
14214 different commands with two or three keys per command, only to hide and show
14215 parts of the outline tree, that seemed entirely unacceptable to me. Also,
14216 when using outlines to take notes, I constantly wanted to restructure the
14217 tree, organizing it parallel to my thoughts and plans. @emph{Visibility
14218 cycling} and @emph{structure editing} were originally implemented in the
14219 package @file{outline-magic.el}, but quickly moved to the more general
14220 @file{org.el}. As this environment became comfortable for project planning,
14221 the next step was adding @emph{TODO entries}, basic @emph{timestamps}, and
14222 @emph{table support}. These areas highlighted the two main goals that Org
14223 still has today: to be a new, outline-based, plain text mode with innovative
14224 and intuitive editing features, and to incorporate project planning
14225 functionality directly into a notes file.
14226
14227 Since the first release, literally thousands of emails to me or to
14228 @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org} have provided a constant stream of bug
14229 reports, feedback, new ideas, and sometimes patches and add-on code.
14230 Many thanks to everyone who has helped to improve this package. I am
14231 trying to keep here a list of the people who had significant influence
14232 in shaping one or more aspects of Org. The list may not be
14233 complete, if I have forgotten someone, please accept my apologies and
14234 let me know.
14235
14236 Before I get to this list, a few special mentions are in order:
14237
14238 @table @i
14239 @item Bastien Guerry
14240 Bastien has written a large number of extensions to Org (most of them
14241 integrated into the core by now), including the LaTeX exporter and the plain
14242 list parser. His support during the early days, when he basically acted as
14243 co-maintainer, was central to the success of this project. Bastien also
14244 invented Worg, helped establishing the Web presence of Org, and sponsors
14245 hosting costs for the orgmode.org website.
14246 @item Eric Schulte and Dan Davison
14247 Eric and Dan are jointly responsible for the Org-babel system, which turns
14248 Org into a multi-language environment for evaluating code and doing literate
14249 programming and reproducible research.
14250 @item John Wiegley
14251 John has also contributed a number of great ideas and patches
14252 directly to Org, including the attachment system (@file{org-attach.el}),
14253 integration with Apple Mail (@file{org-mac-message.el}), hierarchical
14254 dependencies of TODO items, habit tracking (@file{org-habits.el}), and
14255 encryption (@file{org-crypt.el}). Also, the capture system is really an
14256 extended copy of his great @file{remember.el}.
14257 @item Sebastian Rose
14258 Without Sebastian, the HTML/XHTML publishing of Org would be the pitiful work
14259 of an ignorant amateur. Sebastian has pushed this part of Org onto a much
14260 higher level. He also wrote @file{org-info.js}, a Java script for displaying
14261 webpages derived from Org using an Info-like or a folding interface with
14262 single-key navigation.
14263 @end table
14264
14265 @noindent OK, now to the full list of contributions! Again, please let me
14266 know what I am missing here!
14267
14268 @itemize @bullet
14269
14270 @item
14271 @i{Russel Adams} came up with the idea for drawers.
14272 @item
14273 @i{Thomas Baumann} wrote @file{org-bbdb.el} and @file{org-mhe.el}.
14274 @item
14275 @i{Christophe Bataillon} created the great unicorn logo that we use on the
14276 Org-mode website.
14277 @item
14278 @i{Alex Bochannek} provided a patch for rounding timestamps.
14279 @item
14280 @i{Jan Böcker} wrote @file{org-docview.el}.
14281 @item
14282 @i{Brad Bozarth} showed how to pull RSS feed data into Org-mode files.
14283 @item
14284 @i{Tom Breton} wrote @file{org-choose.el}.
14285 @item
14286 @i{Charles Cave}'s suggestion sparked the implementation of templates
14287 for Remember, which are now templates for capture.
14288 @item
14289 @i{Pavel Chalmoviansky} influenced the agenda treatment of items with
14290 specified time.
14291 @item
14292 @i{Gregory Chernov} patched support for Lisp forms into table
14293 calculations and improved XEmacs compatibility, in particular by porting
14294 @file{nouline.el} to XEmacs.
14295 @item
14296 @i{Sacha Chua} suggested copying some linking code from Planner.
14297 @item
14298 @i{Baoqiu Cui} contributed the DocBook exporter.
14299 @item
14300 @i{Eddward DeVilla} proposed and tested checkbox statistics. He also
14301 came up with the idea of properties, and that there should be an API for
14302 them.
14303 @item
14304 @i{Nick Dokos} tracked down several nasty bugs.
14305 @item
14306 @i{Kees Dullemond} used to edit projects lists directly in HTML and so
14307 inspired some of the early development, including HTML export. He also
14308 asked for a way to narrow wide table columns.
14309 @item
14310 @i{Thomas S. Dye} contributed documentation on Worg and helped integrating
14311 the Org-Babel documentation into the manual.
14312 @item
14313 @i{Christian Egli} converted the documentation into Texinfo format,
14314 patched CSS formatting into the HTML exporter, and inspired the agenda.
14315 @item
14316 @i{David Emery} provided a patch for custom CSS support in exported
14317 HTML agendas.
14318 @item
14319 @i{Nic Ferrier} contributed mailcap and XOXO support.
14320 @item
14321 @i{Miguel A. Figueroa-Villanueva} implemented hierarchical checkboxes.
14322 @item
14323 @i{John Foerch} figured out how to make incremental search show context
14324 around a match in a hidden outline tree.
14325 @item
14326 @i{Raimar Finken} wrote @file{org-git-line.el}.
14327 @item
14328 @i{Mikael Fornius} works as a mailing list moderator.
14329 @item
14330 @i{Austin Frank} works as a mailing list moderator.
14331 @item
14332 @i{Niels Giesen} had the idea to automatically archive DONE trees.
14333 @item
14334 @i{Kai Grossjohann} pointed out key-binding conflicts with other packages.
14335 @item
14336 @i{Bernt Hansen} has driven much of the support for auto-repeating tasks,
14337 task state change logging, and the clocktable. His clear explanations have
14338 been critical when we started to adopt the Git version control system.
14339 @item
14340 @i{Manuel Hermenegildo} has contributed various ideas, small fixes and
14341 patches.
14342 @item
14343 @i{Phil Jackson} wrote @file{org-irc.el}.
14344 @item
14345 @i{Scott Jaderholm} proposed footnotes, control over whitespace between
14346 folded entries, and column view for properties.
14347 @item
14348 @i{Matt Jones} wrote @i{MobileOrg Android}.
14349 @item
14350 @i{Tokuya Kameshima} wrote @file{org-wl.el} and @file{org-mew.el}.
14351 @item
14352 @i{Shidai Liu} ("Leo") asked for embedded La@TeX{} and tested it. He also
14353 provided frequent feedback and some patches.
14354 @item
14355 @i{Matt Lundin} has proposed last-row references for table formulas and named
14356 invisible anchors. He has also worked a lot on the FAQ.
14357 @item
14358 @i{David Maus} wrote @file{org-atom.el}, maintains the issues file for Org,
14359 and is a prolific contributor on the mailing list with competent replies,
14360 small fixes and patches.
14361 @item
14362 @i{Jason F. McBrayer} suggested agenda export to CSV format.
14363 @item
14364 @i{Max Mikhanosha} came up with the idea of refiling.
14365 @item
14366 @i{Dmitri Minaev} sent a patch to set priority limits on a per-file
14367 basis.
14368 @item
14369 @i{Stefan Monnier} provided a patch to keep the Emacs-Lisp compiler
14370 happy.
14371 @item
14372 @i{Richard Moreland} wrote @i{MobileOrg} for the iPhone.
14373 @item
14374 @i{Rick Moynihan} proposed allowing multiple TODO sequences in a file
14375 and being able to quickly restrict the agenda to a subtree.
14376 @item
14377 @i{Todd Neal} provided patches for links to Info files and Elisp forms.
14378 @item
14379 @i{Greg Newman} refreshed the unicorn logo into its current form.
14380 @item
14381 @i{Tim O'Callaghan} suggested in-file links, search options for general
14382 file links, and TAGS.
14383 @item
14384 @i{Osamu Okano} wrote @file{orgcard2ref.pl}, a perl program to create a text
14385 version of the reference card.
14386 @item
14387 @i{Takeshi Okano} translated the manual and David O'Toole's tutorial
14388 into Japanese.
14389 @item
14390 @i{Oliver Oppitz} suggested multi-state TODO items.
14391 @item
14392 @i{Scott Otterson} sparked the introduction of descriptive text for
14393 links, among other things.
14394 @item
14395 @i{Pete Phillips} helped during the development of the TAGS feature, and
14396 provided frequent feedback.
14397 @item
14398 @i{Martin Pohlack} provided the code snippet to bundle character insertion
14399 into bundles of 20 for undo.
14400 @item
14401 @i{T.V. Raman} reported bugs and suggested improvements.
14402 @item
14403 @i{Matthias Rempe} (Oelde) provided ideas, Windows support, and quality
14404 control.
14405 @item
14406 @i{Paul Rivier} provided the basic implementation of named footnotes. He
14407 also acted as mailing list moderator for some time.
14408 @item
14409 @i{Kevin Rogers} contributed code to access VM files on remote hosts.
14410 @item
14411 @i{Frank Ruell} solved the mystery of the @code{keymapp nil} bug, a
14412 conflict with @file{allout.el}.
14413 @item
14414 @i{Jason Riedy} generalized the send-receive mechanism for Orgtbl tables with
14415 extensive patches.
14416 @item
14417 @i{Philip Rooke} created the Org reference card, provided lots
14418 of feedback, developed and applied standards to the Org documentation.
14419 @item
14420 @i{Christian Schlauer} proposed angular brackets around links, among
14421 other things.
14422 @item
14423 @i{Paul Sexton} wrote @file{org-ctags.el}.
14424 @item
14425 Linking to VM/BBDB/Gnus was first inspired by @i{Tom Shannon}'s
14426 @file{organizer-mode.el}.
14427 @item
14428 @i{Ilya Shlyakhter} proposed the Archive Sibling, line numbering in literal
14429 examples, and remote highlighting for referenced code lines.
14430 @item
14431 @i{Stathis Sideris} wrote the @file{ditaa.jar} ASCII to PNG converter that is
14432 now packaged into Org's @file{contrib} directory.
14433 @item
14434 @i{Daniel Sinder} came up with the idea of internal archiving by locking
14435 subtrees.
14436 @item
14437 @i{Dale Smith} proposed link abbreviations.
14438 @item
14439 @i{James TD Smith} has contributed a large number of patches for useful
14440 tweaks and features.
14441 @item
14442 @i{Adam Spiers} asked for global linking commands, inspired the link
14443 extension system, added support for mairix, and proposed the mapping API.
14444 @item
14445 @i{Ulf Stegemann} created the table to translate special symbols to HTML,
14446 LaTeX, UTF-8, Latin-1 and ASCII.
14447 @item
14448 @i{Andy Stewart} contributed code to @file{org-w3m.el}, to copy HTML content
14449 with links transformation to Org syntax.
14450 @item
14451 @i{David O'Toole} wrote @file{org-publish.el} and drafted the manual
14452 chapter about publishing.
14453 @item
14454 @i{Stefan Vollmar} organized a video-recorded talk at the
14455 Max-Planck-Institute for Neurology. He also inspired the creation of a
14456 concept index for HTML export.
14457 @item
14458 @i{J@"urgen Vollmer} contributed code generating the table of contents
14459 in HTML output.
14460 @item
14461 @i{Samuel Wales} has provided important feedback and bug reports.
14462 @item
14463 @i{Chris Wallace} provided a patch implementing the @samp{QUOTE}
14464 keyword.
14465 @item
14466 @i{David Wainberg} suggested archiving, and improvements to the linking
14467 system.
14468 @item
14469 @i{Carsten Wimmer} suggested some changes and helped fix a bug in
14470 linking to Gnus.
14471 @item
14472 @i{Roland Winkler} requested additional key bindings to make Org
14473 work on a tty.
14474 @item
14475 @i{Piotr Zielinski} wrote @file{org-mouse.el}, proposed agenda blocks
14476 and contributed various ideas and code snippets.
14477 @end itemize
14478
14479
14480 @node Main Index, Key Index, History and Acknowledgments, Top
14481 @unnumbered Concept index
14482
14483 @printindex cp
14484
14485 @node Key Index, Variable Index, Main Index, Top
14486 @unnumbered Key index
14487
14488 @printindex ky
14489
14490 @node Variable Index, , Key Index, Top
14491 @unnumbered Variable index
14492
14493 This is not a complete index of variables and faces, only the ones that are
14494 mentioned in the manual. For a more complete list, use @kbd{M-x
14495 org-customize @key{RET}} and then click yourself through the tree.
14496
14497 @printindex vr
14498
14499 @bye
14500
14501 @ignore
14502 arch-tag: 7893d1Fe-cc57-4d13-b5e5-f494a1CBC7ac
14503 @end ignore
14504
14505 @c Local variables:
14506 @c fill-column: 77
14507 @c End:
14508
14509
14510 @c LocalWords: webdavhost pre